Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
(NIV
).
Copyright 1973, 1978, 1984 by Biblica, Inc. Used by permission of Zondervan. All rights reserved worldwide.
www.zondervan.com.
American Standard Version (ASV).
King James Version (KJV).
The following copyrighted versions of the Bible are used by permission:
The Contemporary English Version (CEV). Copyright by the American Bible Society, 1991, 1992.
The Holy Bible, English Standard Version (ESV), copyright 2001 by Crossway Bibles, a division of Good News Publishers. All
rights reserved.
Good News Translation
(Todays English Version, Second Edition) (GNT). Copyright 1992 American Bible Society. All
rights reserved.
GODS WORD
(GW). Copyright 1995 by Gods Word to the Nations. Used by permission of Baker Publishing Group.
All rights reserved.
Holman Christian Standard Bible
(HCSB). Copyright 1999, 2000, 2002, 2003 by Holman Bible Publishers. All rights
reserved.
International Standard Version (ISV). Copyright 1996-2011 The ISV Foundation. All rights reserved internationally.
The New American Bible (NAB). Copyright 1970 by the Confraternity of Christian Doctrine, 3211 4th St. N.E., Washing-
ton, DC 20017-1194. All rights reserved.
The New American Standard Bible
(NASB
), copyright The Lockman Foundation 1960, 1962, 1963, 1968, 1971, 1972,
1973, 1975, 1977, 1995.
The New Century Version (NCV). Copyright 1987, 1988, 1991 by Thomas Nelson, Inc. All rights reserved.
The New English Bible (NEB), the Delegates of the Oxford University Press and the Syndics of the Cambridge University
Press 1961, 1970.
The NET Bible
(NET), copyright 1996-2006 by Biblical Studies Press, L.L.C., http://bible.org. Quoted by permission. All
rights reserved.
The Holy Bible, New International Version
(NIV 2011
(TNIV
+ tet t
y yod y
K/k kaf k
l lamed l
M/m mem m
N/n nun n
s samek s
( ayin (
P/p pe p; f (spirant)
C/c tsade s
q qof q
r resh r
#& sin s
#$ shin s^
t tav t; th (spirant)
S
A
M
P
L
E
S
A
M
P
L
E
19
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
BIBLIOGRAPHY
Achtemeier, Paul J. 1985. Harpers Bible Dictionary. 1st ed. San Francisco: Harper & Row.
Aland, Barbara, Kurt Aland, Matthew Black, Carlo M. Martini, Bruce M. Metzger, and Allen Wikgren, eds.
1993. The Greek New Testament. 4th ed. Stuttgart: Deutsche Bibelgesellschaft.
Aland, Barbara, Kurt Aland, Johannes Karavidopoulos, Carlo M. Martini, and Bruce M. Metzger, eds. 2004.
Novum Testamentum Graece Post Eberhard et Erwin Nestle. 27th ed. Stuttgart: Deutsche Bibelgesell-
schaft.
Allison, Dale C. 1992. Peter and Cephas: One and the Same. JBL 111:489-95.
Amiot, Franois. 1946. Saint Paul. Eptre aux Galates. Eptre aux Thessaloniciens. Verbum Salutis, 14. Paris:
Beauchesne.
Annen, Franz. 1990. thaumazo3 . Pages 134-35 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Arichea, Daniel C., Jr., and Eugene Albert Nida. 1976. A Handbook on Pauls Letter to the Galatians. Helps
for Translators. New York: United Bible Societies.
Arnold, Clinton C. 1996. Returning to the Domain of the Powers: Stoicheia as Evil Spirits in Galatians
4:3, 9. NovT 38:55-76.
Auln, Gustav. 2003. Christus Victor: An Historical Study of the Three Main Types of the Idea of Atonement.
Trans. A. G. Herbert. Eugene, Ore.: Wipf & Stock.
Bachmann, Michael. 1998. 4QMMT und Galaterbrief, mtzshi hchorh und ERGA NOMOU. ZNW 89:91-113.
________. 2000. HIEROSOLYMA und IEROUSALHM im Galaterbrief. ZNW 91:288-89.
Bacon, B. W. 1929. Pauls Triumph at Antioch. Journal of Religion 9:204-23.
Baird, William. 1957. What Is the Kerygma? A Study of 1 Cor. 15:3-8 and Gal. 1:11-17. JBL 76:181-91.
Balz, Horst Robert. 1990a. kosmos. Pages 309-12 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. Syria. Pages 311-12 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
________. 1990c. tarasso3 . Pages 335-36 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Balz, Horst Robert, and Gerhard Schneider, eds. 1990a. Exegetical Dictionary of the New Testament. 10 vols.
Translated by Virgil P. Howard and James W. Thompson. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 1990b. ko3mos. Page 333 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Bammel, Ernst. 1968. pto3chos, ktl. Pages 884-915 in vol. 6 of TDNT.
Banks, Robert. 1980. Pauls Idea of Community: The Early House Churches in Their Historical Setting. Green-
wood, S.C.: Attic Press.
Barclay, John M. G. 1987. Mirror Reading a Polemical Letter: Galatians as a Test Case. JSNT 31:73-93.
________. 1988. Obeying the Truth: A Study of Pauls Ethics in Galatians. Studies of the New Testament and
Its World. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
Barclay, William. 1962. Flesh and Spirit: An Examination of Galatians 5:19-23. New York: SCM Press.
Barr, James. 1961. The Semantics of Biblical Language. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Barrett, C. K. 1963. Reading Through Romans. London: Epworth.
________. 1970. The Signs of an Apostle. London: Epworth.
________. 1976. The Allegory of Abraham, Sarah, and Hagar in the Argument of Galatians. Pages 1-16 in
Rechtfertigung: Festschrift fr Ernst Ksemann zum 70 Geburtstag. Edited by Johannes Friedrick, Wolf-
gang Pohlmann, and Peter Stuhlmacher. Tbingen: Mohr-Siebeck.
________. 1982. The Allegory of Abraham, Sarah, and Hagar in the Argument of Galatians. Pages 154-70 in
Essays on Paul. Philadelphia: Westminster.
________. 1985. Freedom and Obligation. London: SPCK.
Barth, Gerhard. 1990. pistis. Pages 91-97 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Barth, Karl. 1972. The Epistle to the Romans. Translated by Edwyn C. Hoskyns. London: Oxford.
Bauer, Walter, William Arndt, and Frederick W. Danker. 2000. A Greek-English Lexicon of the New Testament
and Other Early Christian Literature. 3rd ed. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Bauernfeind, Otto. 1972. trecho3 , ktl. Pages 225-35 in vol. 8 of TDNT.
Baumgarten, Jrg. 1990. kairos. Pages 232-35 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Baur, F. C. 2003. Paul the Apostle of Jesus Christ: His Life and Works, His Epistles and Teachings. Two Volumes
in One. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson. Reprint of Paul, the Apostle of Jesus Christ: His Life and Works,
His Epistles and Teachings; A Contribution to a Critical History of Primitive Christianity. 2 vols. Lon-
don: Williams & Norgate, 1873-75. Translation of the 1845 German original.
Beale, G. K. 1999. Peace and Mercy upon the Israel of God. The Old Testament Background of Galatians
6,16b. Biblica 80:204-23.
Behm, Johannes. 1964a. anatithe3mi, ktl. Pages 353-56 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
S
A
M
P
L
E
20
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
________. 1964b. kardia, ktl. Pages 605-14 in vol. 3 of TDNT.
Beker, J. Christiaan. 1980. Paul the Apostle: The Triumph of God in Life and Thought. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Belleville, Linda L. 1986. Under Law: Structural Analysis and the Pauline Concept of Law in Galatians
3.214.11. JSNT 26:53-78.
Berger, Klaus. 1990a. proso3pon. Pages 180-81 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. charizomai. Pages 456-57 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Bertram, Georg. 1971. strepho3 . Pages 713-29 in vol. 7 of TDNT.
Betz, Hans Dieter. 1979. Galatians: A Commentary on Pauls Letter to the Churches in Galatia. Hermenia.
Philadelphia: Fortress.
Betz, Otto. 1990. ioudaizo3, ktl. Pages 192-93 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Bieder, Werner. 1990. thanatos, ktl. Pages 129-33 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Bietenhard, Hans. 1967. onama, ktl. Pages 242-83 in vol. 5 in TDNT.
Bigg, Charles. 1901. A Critical and Exegetical Commentary on the Epistles of St. Peter and St. Jude. International
Critical Commentary. Edinburg: T. & T. Clark.
Bird, Michael F. 2010. Crossing Over Sea and Land: Jewish Missionary Activity in the Second Temple Period.
Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
Blass, Friedrich, Albert Debrunner, and Robert Walter Funk. 1961. A Greek Grammar of the New Testament
and Other Early Christian Literature. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Bligh, John. 1969. Galatians: A Discussion on St. Pauls Epistle. Householder Commentary. London: St. Pauls.
Blunt, A. W. F. 1925. The Epistle of Paul to the Galatians. Clarendon Bible. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
Boers, Hendrikus W. 1975. The Form Critical Study of Pauls Letters. I Thessalonians as a Case Study. NTS
22:140-58.
________. 1976. Gen. 15:6 and the Discourse Structure of Galatians. Seminar paper presented at the Society
of Biblical Literature annual meeting.
Boice, James Montgomery. 1976. Galatians. Pages 407-508 in vol. 10 of The Expositors Bible Commentary:
Romans Through Galatians. Edited by Frank E. Gaebelein and others. Grand Rapids: Zondervan.
Bonnard, Pierre. 1953. LEptre de Saint Paul aux Galates; Charles Masson, LEptre de Saint Paul aux Eph-
esiens. Commentaire du Nouveau Testament, 9. Neuchatel: Delachaux & Niestl.
Borgen, Peder, Kre Fuglseth, and Roald Skarsten, eds. 2005. The Works of Philo: Greek Text with Morphology.
Bellingham, Wash.: Logos Research Systems.
Boring, M. Eugene, Klaus Berger, and Carsten Colpe. 1995. Hellenistic Commentary to the New Testament.
Nashville: Abingdon.
Bornkamm, Gnter. 1971. Paul. Translated by D. M. G. Stalker. New York: Harper & Row.
Borse, Udo. 1984. Der Brief an die Galater. Regensburger Neues Testament. Regensburg: Pustet.
Braun, Herbert. 1965. planao3 , ktl. Pages 228-53 in vol. 6 of TDNT.
Brawley, Robert L. 2002. Contextuality, Intertextuality, and the Hendiadic Relationship of Promise and Law
in Galatians. ZNW 93:99-119.
Brinsmead, Bernard Hungerford. 1982. Galatians, Dialogical Response to Opponents. Society of Biblical Lit-
erature Dissertation Series 65. Missoula, Mont.: Scholars Press.
Broer, Ingo. 1990. angelos. Pages 13-16 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Brown, Colin, ed. 1986. The New International Dictionary of New Testament Theology. 3 vols. Translated by a
team of translators, with additions and revisions, from Theologisches Begriffslexikon zum Neuen Testa-
ment, edited by Lothar Coenen, Erich Beyreuther, and Hans Bietenhard. Grand Rapids: Zondervan.
Bruce, Frederick Fyvie. 1975. Further Thoughts on Pauls Autobiography (Galatians 1:112:14). Pages 21-
29 in Jesus und Paulus: Festschrift fr Werner Georg Kmmel zum 70 Geburtstag. Edited by E. Earle
Ellis and Erich Grasser. Gttingen: Vandenhoeck & Ruprecht.
________. 1977. Paul: Apostle of the Heart Set Free. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 1982. The Epistle to the Galatians. New International Greek Testament Commentary. Grand Rap-
ids: Eerdmans.
________. 1985. The Pauline Circle. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Bchsel, Friedrich. 1964. ara, ktl. Pages 448-51 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
________. 1965. thymos, ktl. Pages 167-72 in vol. 3 of TDNT.
Bhner, Jan-Adolf. 1990. apostolos. Pages 142-46 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Bullinger, Ethelbert William. 1898. Figures of Speech Used in the Bible. New York: E. & J. B. Young & Co.
Bultmann, Rudolf, and others. 1964. zao3 , ktl. Pages 832-75 in vol. 2 of TDNT.
Bultmann, Rudolf. 1965. kauchaomai, ktl. Pages 645-53 in vol. 3 of TDNT.
________. 1968a. peitho3 , ktl. Pages 1-11 in vol. 6 of TDNT.
________. 1968b. pisteuo3 , ktl. Pages 174-228 in vol. 6 of TDNT.
________. 1970. Theology of the New Testament: Complete in One Volume. Translated by Kendrick Grobel.
New York: Harper.
Burend, Carsten. 2004. Paulus in Arabien. ZNW 95:129-30.
S
A
M
P
L
E
21
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Burgess, Theodore C. 1900. Epideictic Literature. University of Chicago Studies in Classical Philology 3:89-
261.
Burke, Trevor J. 2006. Adoption into Gods Family: Exploring a Pauline Metaphor. New Studies in Biblical
Theology 22. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity.
Burnett, Gary W. 2001. Paul and the Salvation of the Individual. Biblical Interpretation 57. Leiden: Brill.
Burton, Ernest De Witt. 1898. Syntax of the Moods and Tenses in New Testament Greek. 3rd ed. Edinburg:
T. & T. Clark.
________. 1920. A Critical and Exegetical Commentary on the Epistle to the Galatians. International Critical
Commentary. New York: Scribners.
Byrne, Brendan. 1996. Romans. Sacra Pagina 6. Collegeville, Minn.: Liturgical Press.
Calvin, John. 1841. Commentaries on the Epistles of Paul to the Galatians and Ephesians. Translated by William
Pringle. Edinburgh: Thomas Clark.
Campbell, Douglas A. 2002. An Anchor for Pauline Chronology: Pauls Flight from The Ethnarch of King
Aretas (2 Cor 11:32-33). JBL 121:279-302.
Campenhausen, Hans von. 1969. Ecclesiastical Authority and Spiritual Power in the Church of the First Three
Centuries. Translated by J. A. Baker. Stanford: Stanford University Press.
Carr, Wesley. 1981. Angels and Principalities. Society for New Testament Studies Monograph Series 42. Cam-
bridge: Cambridge University Press.
Carson, D. A., Douglas J. Moo, and Leon Morris. 1992. An Introduction to the New Testament. Grand Rapids:
Zondervan.
Carver, Frank G. 2009. 2 Corinthians. NBBC. Kansas City: Beacon Hill Press of Kansas City.
Castelli, Elizabeth A. 1991. Imitating Paul: A Discourse of Power. Literary Currents in Biblical Interpretation.
Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
Catchpole, David R. 1977. Paul, James, and the Apostolic Decree. NTS 23:428-44.
Charles, R. H., ed. 1913. The Apocrypha and Pseudepigrapha of the Old Testament. 2 vols. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Charlesworth, James H., ed. 1983-85. The Old Testament Pseudepigrapha. 2 vols. New York: Doubleday.
Chilton, Bruce, and Craig A. Evans, eds. 1999. James the Just and Christian Origins. Supplements to NovT.
Leiden: Brill Academic.
Choi, Hung-Sik. 2005. Pistis in Galatians 5:5-6: Neglected Evidence for the Faithfulness of Christ. JBL
124:467-90.
Ciampa, Roy E. 1998. The Presence and Function of Scripture in Galatians 1 and 2. WUNT 2 / 102. Tbingen:
Mohr-Siebeck.
Cohen, Shaye J. D. 1986. Was Timothy Jewish (Acts 16:1-3)? Patristic Exegesis, Rabbinic Law, and Matri-
lineal Descent. JBL 105:251-68.
Cole, R. Alan. 1989. The Epistle of Paul to the Galatians: An Introduction and Commentary. 2nd
ed. Tyndale
New Testament Commentaries 9. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Collins, Raymond F. 1992. John (PERSON). Page 886 in vol. 3 of ABD.
Conzelmann, Hans. 1973. History of Primitive Christianity. Translated by John L. Steely. Nashville: Abingdon.
Cooper, Stephen A. 2000. Narratio and Exhoratio in Galatians According to Marius Victorinus Rhetor. ZNW
91:107-35.
Cosgrove, Charles H. 1978-79. The Mosaic Law Preaches Faith: A Study in Galatians 3. Westminster Theologi-
cal Journal 41:146-64.
________. 1987. The Law Has Given Sarah No Children (Gal 4:21-30). NovT 29:219-35.
________. 1988. The Cross and the Spirit: A Study in the Argument and Theology of Galatians. Macon, Ga.:
Mercer University Press.
Cousar, Charles B. 1982. Galatians. Interpretation. Atlanta: John Knox Press.
Cranford, Michael. 1994. The Possibility of Perfect Obedience: Paul and an Implied Premise in Galatians
3:10 and 5:3. NovT 36:242-58.
Crowneld, Frederic R. 1945. The Singular Problem of the Dual Galatians. JBL 64:491-500.
Cullmann, Oscar. 1956. The Early Church: Studies in Early Christian History and Theology. Translated and
edited by A. J. B. Higgins. Philadelphia: Westminster.
Culpepper, R. Alan. 2000. John: The Son of Zebedee. Minneapolis: Fortress.
Dabelstein, Rolf. 1990. exagorazo3 . Page 1 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Dahl, Nils Alstrup. 1973. Pauls Letter to the Galatians: Epistolary Genre, Content, and Structure. Paper
circulated among members of the Society of Biblical Literature Paul Seminar.
Dalton, William J. 1990. The Meaning of We in Galatians. Australian Biblical Review 38:33-44.
Daniels, Jon B. 1992. Barnabas (PERSON). Page 611 in vol. 1 of ABD.
Das, A. Andrew. 2001. Paul, the Law, and the Covenant. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
Davis, Basil S. 1999. The Meaning of Proegraphe3 in the Context of Galatians 3.1. NTS 45:194-212.
Dayton, Donald W. 1988. Discovering an Evangelical Heritage. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
S
A
M
P
L
E
22
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Deissmann, Adolf. 1910. Light from the Ancient East: The New Testament Illustrated by Recently Discovered
Texts of the Graeco-Roman World. Translated by Lionel R. M. Strachan. New York: Hodder & Stough-
ton.
Denniston, J. D. 1959. The Greek Particles. 2nd ed. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
Di Mattei, Steven. 2006. Pauls Allegory of the Two Covenants (Gal 4.21-31) in Light of First-Century Hel-
lenistic Rhetoric and Jewish Hermeneutics. NTS 52:102-22.
Dodd, Brian. 1999. Pauls Paradigmatic I: Personal Example as Literary Strategy. JSNT Supplement 177.
Shefeld: Shefeld Academic Press.
Donaldson, Terence L. 1986. The Curse of the Law and the Inclusion of the Gentiles: Galatians 3:13-14.
NTS 32:94-112.
________. 1989. Zealot and Convert: The Origin of Pauls Christ-Torah Antithesis. CBQ 51:655-82.
Donfried, Karl Paul. 1976. Justication and Last Judgment in Paul. ZNW 67:90-110.
________. 1987. The Kingdom of God in Paul. Pages 175-90 in The Kingdom of God in Twentieth-Century
Interpretation. Edited by W. Willis. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
________. 1992a. Chronology: New Testament. Pages 1010-22 in vol. 1 of ABD.
________. 1992b. Peter (PERSON). Pages 251-63 in vol. 5 of ABD.
Downs, David J. 2006. Chronology of the NT. Pages 628-31 in vol. 1 of NIDB.
Drane, John W. 1975. Paul: Libertine or Legalist? A Study in the Theology of the Major Pauline Epistles. London:
SPCK.
Duncan, George S. 1934. The Epistle of Paul to the Galatians. Moffatt New Testament Commentary. London:
Hodder & Stoughton.
Dunn, James D. G. 1990. Jesus, Paul, and the Law. Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
________. 1993. The Epistle to the Galatians. Blacks New Testament Commentaries. Peabody, Mass.: Hen-
drickson.
________. 1998. The Theology of Paul the Apostle. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 2005. The New Perspective on Paul. Rev. ed. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 2006. The Parting of the Ways. London: SCM Press.
Dunn, James D. G., ed. 1996. Paul and the Mosaic Law. Tbingen: Mohr.
Eason, Andrew Mark. 2003. Women in Gods Army: Gender and Equality in the Early Salvation Army. Studies
in Women and Religion. Waterloo, Ont.: Canadian Corporation for Studies in Religion.
Eastman, Susan G. 2001. The Evil Eye and the Curse of the Law: Galatians 3.1 Revisited. JSNT 83:69-87.
________. 2006. Cast Out the Slave Woman and Her Son: The Dynamics of Exclusion and Inclusion in
Galatians 4.30. JSNT 28:309-36.
________. 2007. Recovering Pauls Mother Tongue: Language and Theology in Galatians. Grand Rapids: Ee-
rdmans.
________. 2010. Israel and the Mercy of God: A Rereading of Galatians 6.16 and Romans 9.11. NTS 56:367-
95.
Eckert, Jost. 1971. Die urchristliche Verkndigung im Streit Zwischen Paulus und seinen Gegnern nach dem
Galaterbrief. Biblische Untersuchungen 6. Munich: Friedrich Pustet Regensburg.
Edwards, Mark J., ed. 1999. Galatians, Ephesians, Philippians. Ancient Christian Commentary on Scripture
NT 8. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity Press.
Ehrman, Bart D. 1990. Cephas and Peter. JBL 109:463-74.
Ellicott, Charles J. 1863. St. Pauls Epistle to the Galatians: A Critical and Grammatical Commentary. 3rd ed.
London: Longman, Green, Longman, Roberts, & Green.
Ellinger, Karl, and Wilhelm Rudolph, eds. 1998. Biblia Hebraica Stutgartensia. Stuttgart: Deutsche Bibelge-
sellschaft.
Elliott, John H. 1990. Paul, the Galatians, and the Evil Eye. Currents in Theology and Mission 17:262-73.
________. 1992. Peter, Second Epistle of. Pages 282-87 in vol. 5 of ABD.
Elliott, Susan M. 1999. Choose Your Mother, Choose Your Master: Galatians 4:215:1 in the Shadow of the
Anatolian Mother of the Gods. JBL 118:661-83.
________. 2008. Cutting Too Close for Comfort: Pauls Letter to the Galatians in Its Anatolian Cultic Context.
Library of New Testament Studies 248. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
Ellis, E. Earle. 1957. Pauls Use of the Old Testament. Edinburgh: Oliver & Boyd.
Esser, Hans-Helmut. 1976. Law, Custom, Elements. Pages 436-56 in vol. 2 of NIDNTT.
Fee, Gordon D. 2007. Galatians. Pentecostal Commentary. Bladford Forum, U.K.: Deo Publishing.
Feldman, Louis H. 1986. The Omnipresence of the God-Fearers. Biblical Archaeology Review 12:58-63.
Fendrich, Herbert. 1990. krazo3 . Pages 313-14 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Ferguson, Everett. 1992. Agape Meal. Pages 90-91 in vol. 1 of ABD.
Fiedler, Peter. 1990. hamartia. Pages 65-69 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Fiori, Benjamin. 1986. The Function of Personal Example in the Socratic and Pastoral Epistles. Analecta Biblica
105. Rome: Biblical Institute Press.
S
A
M
P
L
E
23
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Fitzmyer, Joseph A. 1968a. The Letter to the Galatians. Pages 236-46 in vol. 2 of The Jerome Biblical Com-
mentary. 2 vols. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall.
________. 1968b. A Life of Paul. Pages 215-22 in vol. 2 of The Jerome Biblical Commentary. 2 vols. Englewood
Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall.
________. 1990. kyrios. Pages 328-31 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Flemming, Dean. 2005. Contextualization in the New Testament: Patterns for Theology and Mission. Downers
Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity.
________. 2009. Philippians: A Commentary in the Wesleyan Tradition. NBBC. Kansas City: Beacon Hill Press
of Kansas City.
Foerster, Werner. 1964. aresko3 , ktl. Pages 454-57 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
Foster, Richard J. 1998. Celebration of Discipline: The Path to Spiritual Growth. 3rd ed. New York: HarperCol-
lins.
Frankemlle, Hubert. 1990.prayte3s, ktl. Pages 146-47 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Freedman, David Noel, ed. 1992. The Anchor Bible Dictionary. 6 vols. New York: Doubleday.
Frey, Jrg. 1999. Die paulinische Antithese von >>Fleisch<< und >>Geist<< und die palstinisch-jdische
Weisheitstradition. ZNW 90:45-77.
Friedrich, Johannes H. 1990a. dynamis, ktl. Pages 355-58 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. kle3ronomos, ktl. Pages 298-99 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Fuchs, Ernst. 1971. skopos, ktl. Pages 413-17 in vol. 7 of TDNT.
Furnish, Victor Paul. 1972. The Love Commandment in the New Testament. Nashville: Abingdon.
Gagnon, Robert A. J. 2001. The Bible and Homosexual Practice: Texts and Hermeneutics. Nashville: Abingdon.
Garlington, Don. 2007. An Exposition of Galatians: A Reading from the New Perspective. 3rd ed. Eugene, Ore.:
Wipf & Stock.
Gaston, Lloyd. 1987. Paul and the Torah. Vancouver, B.C.: University of British Columbia.
Gaventa, Beverly Roberts. 1986a. From Darkness to Light: Aspects of Conversion in the New Testament. Over-
tures to Biblical Theology 20. Philadelphia: Fortress.
________. 1986b. Galatians 1 and 2: Autobiography as Paradigm. NovT 28:309-26.
________. 2007. Our Mother Saint Paul. Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
George, Timothy. 1994. Galatians. New American Commentary 30. Nashville: Broadman & Holman.
Georgi, Dieter. 1992. Remembering the Poor: The History of Pauls Collection for Jerusalem. Translated by I.
Racz. Nashville: Abingdon.
Giesen, Heinz. 1990. hypokrisis, ktl. Page 403 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Gilman, Florence Morgan. 1992. James, Brother of Jesus. Pages 620-21 in vol. 3 of the ABD.
Glick, Leonard B. 2005. Marked in Your Flesh: Circumcision from Ancient Judea to Modern America. New York:
Oxford University Press.
Goddard, A. J., and S. A. Cummins. 1993. Ill or Ill-Treated? Conict and Persecution as the Context of Pauls
Original Ministry in Galatia (Galatians 4.12-20). JSNT 52:93-126.
Goldstein, Horst. 1990. enkrateia, ktl. Pages 377-78 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Gorman, Michael J. 2001. Cruciformity: Pauls Narrative Spirituality of the Cross. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Graf, David F. 1992. Aretas. Pages 373-76 in vol. 1 of ABD.
Greathouse, William M., and George Lyons. 2008a. Romans 18: A Commentary in the Wesleyan Tradition.
NBBC. Kansas City: Beacon Hill Press of Kansas City.
________. 2008b. Romans 916: A Commentary in the Wesleyan Tradition. NBBC. Kansas City: Beacon Hill
Press of Kansas City.
Grundmann, Walter. 1964. hamartano3 , ktl. Pages 267-316 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
________. 1971. syn, ktl. Pages 766-97 in vol. 7 of TDNT.
Gundry, Stanley, ed. 1996. Five Views on Law and Gospel. Grand Rapids: Zondervan.
Gundry-Volf, Judith M. 1991. Paul and Perseverance: Staying In and Falling Away. Louisville, Ky.: Westmin-
ster/John Knox.
Guthrie, Donald. 1969. Galatians. London: Thomas Nelson.
________. 1971. New Testament Introduction. 3rd ed. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity Press.
Gttgemanns, Erhardt. 1966. Der leidende Apostel und sein Herr. Forschungen zur Religion und Literatur des
Alten und Neuen Testaments 90. Gttingen: Vandenhoeck & Ruprecht.
Haenchen, Ernst. 1971. The Acts of the Apostles. Translated by R. McL. Wilson and others. Philadelphia:
Westminster.
Hahn, Ferdinand. 1990. huios. Pages 381-92 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Hainz, Josef. 1990. koino3nia, ktl. Pages 303-5 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Hansen, G. Walter. 1989. Abraham in Galatians. Epistolary and Rhetorical Contexts. JSNT Supplement 29.
Shefeld: JSOT Press.
________. 2010. Galatians. IVP New Testament Commentary. Downers Grove, Ill.: IVP Academic.
Hanson, Paul D. 2001. The People Called: The Growth of Community in the Bible with a New Introduction.
Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
S
A
M
P
L
E
24
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Hardin, Justin K. 2008. Galatians and the Imperial Cult: A Critical Analysis of the First-Century Social Context
of Pauls Letter. WUNT 2 / 237. Tbingen: Mohr-Siebeck.
Hare, Douglas R. A. 1967. The Theme of Jewish Persecution of Christians in the Gospel According to St. Matthew.
Society for New Testament Studies Monograph Series 6. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Harmon, Matthew S. 2010. She Must and Shall Go Free: Pauls Isaianic Gospel in Galatians. Beihefte zur
Zeitschrift fr die neutestamentliche Wissenschaft und die Kunde der lteren Kirche 168. Berlin:
de Gruyter.
Harrill, J. Albert. 2000. The Use of the New Testament in the American Slave Controversy: A Case History
in the Hermeneutical Tension Between Biblical Criticism and Christian Moral Debate. Religion and
American Culture 10:149-86.
Harrisville, Roy A. 1994. Pistis Christou: Witness of the Fathers. NovT 36:233-41.
Hartin, Patrick J. 2004. James of Jerusalem: Heir to Jesus of Nazareth. Interfaces. Collegeville, Minn.: Liturgi-
cal Press.
Hawthorne, Gerald F., Ralph P. Martin, and Daniel G. Reid, eds. 1993. Dictionary of Paul and His Letters.
Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity Press.
Hays, Richard B. 1983. The Faith of Jesus Christ: An Investigation of the Narrative Structure of Galatians
3:14:11. Society of Biblical Literature Dissertation Series 56. Chico, Calif.: Scholars Press.
________. 1993. Echoes of Scripture in the Letters of Paul. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press.
________. 2000. Galatians. Pages 183-348 in vol. 11 of The New Interpreters Bible. Nashville: Abingdon.
Hegermann, Harald. 1990. diathe3ke3 . Pages 299-301 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Heiligenthal, Roman. 1990. ergon. Pages 49-51 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Hendricksen, William. 1968. Galatians. Baker New Testament Commentary 8. Grand Rapids: Baker.
Hengel, Martin. 1974. Judaism and Hellenism. 2 vols. Translated by John Bowden. Philadelphia: Fortress.
________. 1976. The Son of God: The Origin of Christology in the History of Jewish-Hellenistic Religion. Trans-
lated by John Bowden. Philadelphia: Fortress.
________. 1977. Crucixion in the Ancient World and the Folly of the Message of the Cross. Translated by John
Bowden. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Hengel, Martin, and Anna Maria Schwemer. 1997. Paul Between Damascus and Antioch: The Unknown Years.
Translated by John Bowden. Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
Hennecke, Edgar, and Wilhelm Schneemelcher, eds. 1963-65. New Testament Apocrypha. 2 vols. Translated
by R. McL. Wilson and others. Philadelphia: Westminster.
Hester, James D. 1968. Pauls Concept of Inheritance: A Contribution to the Understanding of Heilsgeschichte.
London: Oliver & Boyd.
________. 1991. Placing the Blame: The Presence of Epideictic in Galatians 12. Pages 281-307 in Persua-
sive Artistry: Studies in New Testament Rhetoric in Honor of George A. Kennedy. Edited by Duane F.
Watson. JSNT Supplement 50. Shefeld: JSOT Press.
Hoehner, H. W. 1996. Chronology of the New Testament. Pages 192-99 of NBD.
Hogan, Pauline Nigh. 2008. No Longer Male and Female: Interpreting Galatians 3.28 in Early Christianity.
Library of New Testament Studies 380. New York: T. & T. Clark.
Hollander, Harm W. 1990. makrothymia, ktl. Pages 380-81 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Holmberg, Bengt. 1978. Paul and Power: The Structure of Authority in the Primitive Church as Reected in the
Pauline Epistles. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Holmes, Michael William. 1999. The Apostolic Fathers: Greek Texts and English Translations. Updated ed.
Grand Rapids: Baker.
Holtz, Traugott. 1974. Die Beteutung des Apostelkonzils fr Paulus. NovT 16:110-48.
________. 1990. apokalypto3 , ktl. Pages 130-32 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Hong, In-Gyu. 1993. The Law in Galatians. JSNT Supplement 81. Shefeld: Shefeld Academic Press.
Hooker, Morna D. 1971. Interchange in Christ. Journal of Theological Studies, ns 22:349-61.
________. 1978. Interchange and Atonement. Bulletin of the John Rylands Library 60:462-81.
________. 1989. pistis christou. NTS 35:321-41.
________. 1990. From Adam to Christ: Essays on Paul. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Horstmann, Axel. 1990. oida. Pages 493-94 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Howard, George. 2004. Paul: Crisis in Galatia. A Study in Early Christian Theology. Society for New Testa-
ment Studies Monograph Series 35. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Hubbard, Moyer V. 2002. New Creation in Pauls Letters and Thought. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press.
Hbner, Hans. 1984. Law in Pauls Thought: A Contribution to the Development of Pauline Thought. Translated
by James C. G. Greig. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
________. 1990a. ale3theia. Pages 57-60 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. chronos. Pages 488-89 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
________. 1990c. eido3lon, ktl. Pages 386-88 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
S
A
M
P
L
E
25
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Hultgren, Arland. 1976. Pauls Pre-Christian Persecutions of the Church: Their Purpose, Locale, and Nature.
JBL 95:97-111.
Hurtado, Larry W. 1979. The Jerusalem Collection and the Book of Galatians. JSNT 5:46-62.
________. 1993. Son of God. Pages 900-906 in DPL.
Jay, Nancy. 1992. Throughout Your Generations Forever: Sacrice, Religion, and Paternity. Chicago: University
of Chicago Press.
Jeremias, Joachim. 1964. The Lords Prayer. Translated by John Reumann. Philadelphia: Fortress.
________. 1969. Jerusalem in the Time of Jesus. Translated by F. H. Cave and C. H. Cave. London: SCM Press.
Jervell, Jacob. 1972. Luke and the People of God. Minneapolis: Augsburg.
Jervis, L. Mary. 1999. Galatians. New International Biblical Commentary 9. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
Jewett, Robert. 1970. The Agitators and the Galatian Congregation. NTS 17:198-212.
________. 1979. A Chronology of Pauls Life. Philadelphia: Fortress.
________. 1985. Chronology, New Testament. Page 165 in HBD.
________. 2008. Romans. Hermenia. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Jones, F. Stanley. 1992. Clementines, Pseudo-. Pages 1061-62 in vol. 1 of ABD.
Jones, Horace L., ed. and trans. 1917-1932. The Geography of Strabo. Loeb Classical Library. 8 vols. Cam-
bridge: Harvard University Press and Heinemann.
Jurgens, William A. 1970. Faith of the Early Fathers. Vol. 1. Collegeville, Minn.: Liturgical Press.
Kahl, Brigitte. 2010. Galatians Re-Imagined. Reading with the Eyes of the Vanquished. Paul in Critical Con-
texts. Minneapolis: Fortress.
Ksemann, Ernst. 1969. Sentences of Holy Law in the New Testament. Pages 66-81 in New Testament Ques-
tions of Today. Translated by W. J. Montague. Philadelphia: Fortress.
________. 1980. Commentary on Romans. Translated and edited by Geoffrey W. Bromiley. Grand Rapids:
Eerdmans.
Kellermann, Ulrich. 1990a. aphorizo3 . Pages 183-84 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. sperma, ktl. Pages 263-64 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Kennedy, George A. 1984. New Testament Interpretation Through Rhetorical Criticism. Studies in Religion.
Chapel Hill, N.C.: University of North Carolina Press.
Kern, Philip H. 1998. Rhetoric and Galatians: Assessing an Approach to Pauls Epistle. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press.
Kertelge, Karl. 1990. dikaioo3 . Pages 330-34 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Kim, Seyoon. 1981. The Origin of Pauls Gospel. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 1997. The Mystery of Rom. 11:25-26 Once More. NTS 43:412-29.
Kittel, Gerhard. 1964a. akouo3 , ktl. Pages 216-25 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
________. 1964b. angelos in the NT. Pages 82-87 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
________. 1964c. dokeo3 , doxa, ktl. Pages 232-55 in vol. 2 of TDNT.
Kittel, Gerhard, and Gerhard Friedrich, eds. 1964-76. Theological Dictionary of the New Testament. 10 vols.
Translated and edited by Geoffrey William Bromiley. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Klostermann, Erich. 1959. Zur Apologie des Paulus Galater 1, 10-2, 21. Gottes ist der Orient, Festschrift fr
Otto Eissfeldt zu seinem 70 Geburtstag. Berlin: Evangelische Verlagsanstalt.
Knox, John. 1950. Chapters in a Life of Paul. New York: Abingdon-Cokesbury.
Koperski, Veronica. 2001. What Are They Saying About Paul and the Law? Mahwah, N.J.: Paulist Press.
Koptak, Paul E. 1990. Rhetorical Identication in Pauls Autobiographical Narrative: Galatians 1.13-2.14
JSNT 40:97-115.
Kraft, H. 1990. stylos. Page 281 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Kremer, Jacob. 1990. pathe3ma. Pages 1-2 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Kuhn, Heinz-Wolfgang. 1975. Jesus als Gekreuzigter in der frhchristlicher Verkndigung bis zur Mitte des
2. Jahrhunderts. Zeitschrift fr Theologie und Kirche 72:1-46.
________. 1990. systauroo3 . Page 313 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Kmmel, Werner Georg. 1975. Introduction to the New Testament. Rev. ed. Translated by Howard Clark Kee.
Nashville: Abingdon.
Lagrange, M.-J. 1926. Saint Paul. Eptre aux Galates. 2nd ed. Etudies bibliques. Paris: Lecoffre.
Laird, Rebecca. 1993. Ordained Women in the Church of the Nazarene: The First Generation. Kansas City:
Nazarene Publishing House.
Lambrecht, Jan. 1990. exapostello3 . Pages 2-3 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Lategan, B. 1988. Is Paul Defending His Apostleship in Galatians? NTS 34:411-30.
Leary, T. J. 1992. Pauls Improper Name. NTS 38:467-69.
Lgasse, Simon. 1990. eudokeo3 . Page 75 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 2000. Lptre de Paul aux Galates. Lectio Divina 9. Paris: Cerf.
Leivestad, R. 1990. mne3moneuo3 . Pages 435-36 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Liddell, Henry George, Robert Scott, Henry Stuart Jones, and Roderick McKenzie. 1996. A Greek-English
Lexicon. Rev. and augm. throughout. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
S
A
M
P
L
E
26
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Lietzmann, Hans. 1932. An die Galater. 3rd ed. Handbuch zum Neuen Testament 10. Tbingen: Mohr-
Siebeck.
Lightfoot, J. B. 1874. St. Pauls Epistle to the Galatians. A Revised Text with Introduction, Notes, and Disserta-
tions. 4th ed. London: Macmillan.
________. 1886. St. Pauls Epistles to the Colossians and to Philemon. 8th ed. London: Macmillan.
Lim, David S. 1993. Fullness. Pages 319-20 in DPL.
Limbeck, M. 1990. atheteo3 . Page 35 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Lincoln, Andrew T. 1981. Paradise Now and Not Yet: Studies in the Role of the Heavenly Dimension in Pauls
Thought with Special Reference to His Eschatology. Society for New Testament Studies Monograph
Series 43. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
________. 2002. Ephesians. Word Biblical Commentary. Dallas: Word.
Longenecker, Richard N. 1982. The Pedagogical Nature of the Law in Galatians 3:194:7. Journal of the
Evangelical Theological Society 25:53.
________. 1990. Galatians. Word Biblical Commentary 54. Dallas: Word.
________. 1999. Biblical Exegesis in the Apostolic Period. 2nd ed. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Louw, Johannes P., and Eugene Albert Nida. 1989. Greek-English Lexicon of the New Testament: Based on
Semantic Domains. 2nd ed. 2 vols. New York: United Bible Societies.
Ldemann, Gerd. 1984. Paul, Apostle to the Gentiles: Studies in Chronology. Translated by F. Stanley Jones.
London: SCM Press.
Lhrmann, Dieter. 1992. Galatians. A Continental Commentary. Minneapolis: Fortress.
Lull, David. 1980. The Spirit in Galatia: Pauls Interpretation of Pneuma as Divine Power. Society of Biblical
Literature Dissertation Series 46. Chico, Calif.: Scholars Press.
Lust, Johan, Erik Eynikel, and Katrin Hauspie. 2003. A Greek-English Lexicon of the Septuagint: Revised Edi-
tion. Stuttgart: Deutsche Bibelgesellschaft.
Luther, Martin. 1953. A Commentary on the Epistle to the Galatians. Translated by Edwin Sandys. London:
Clark.
Lyall, Francis. 1969. Roman Law in the Writings of PaulAdoption. JBL 88:458-66.
Lyons, George. 1985. Pauline Autobiography: Toward a New Understanding. Society of Biblical Literature
Dissertation Series 73. Atlanta: Scholars Press.
________. 1995. Modeling the Holiness Ethos: A Study Based on First Thessalonians. WesTJ 30, 1:187-211.
________. 2007. Church and Holiness in Ephesians. Pages 238-56 in Holiness and Ecclesiology in the New
Testament. Edited by Kent E. Brower and Andy Johnson. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Lyons, George, and William Malas, Jr. 2007. Paul and His Friends Within the Greco-Roman Context. WesTJ
42, 1:50-69.
MacGorman, J. W. 1975. The Law as Paidago3gos: A Study in Pauline Analogy. Pages 103-11 in New Testa-
ment Studies: Essays in Honor of Ray Summers in His Sixty-Fifth Year. Edited by Huber L Drumwright
and Curtis Vaughan. Waco, Tex.: Baylor University.
MacLennan, Robert S., and A. Thomas Kraabel. 1986. The God-FearersA Literary and Theological Inven-
tion. Biblical Archaeology Review 12, 5:46-53.
MacPherson, David. 2000. The Rapture Plot. 2nd ed. Simpsonville, S.C.: Millennium III Publishers.
Maier, Christl M. 2007. Psalm 87 as a Reappraisal of the Zion Tradition and Its Reception in Galatians 4:26.
CBQ 69:473-86.
Malina, Bruce J., and Jerome H. Neyrey. 1996. Portraits of Paul: An Archaeology of Ancient Personality. Louis-
ville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
Malina, Bruce J., and John J. Pilch. 2006. Social Science Commentary on the Letters of Paul. Minneapolis:
Fortress.
Marcus, Joel. 2001. Under the Law: The Background of a Pauline Expression. CBQ 63:72-83.
Marlowe, Michael. 2004. The Israel of God (Galatians 6:16). No pages. Accessed May 9, 2011. Online:
http://www.bible-researcher.com/gal6-16.html.
Marshall, I. Howard. 1969. Kept by the Power of God: A Study of Perseverance and Falling Away. Minneapolis:
Bethany Fellowship.
Marshall, I. Howard, and Otto Michel. 1986. Son, Son of God, Son of Man, Servant of God, Son of David.
Pages 644-45 in vol. 3 of NIDNTT.
Martin, Dale. 1990. Slavery as Salvation: The Metaphor of Slavery in Pauline Christianity. New Haven, Conn.:
Yale University Press.
Martin, Troy W. 1995. Apostasy to Paganism: The Rhetorical Stasis of the Galatian Controversy. JBL
114:437-61.
________. 1996. Pagan and Judeo-Christian Time-Keeping Schemes in Gal 4:10 and Col 2:16. NTS 42:105-
19.
________. 1999. Whose Flesh? What Temptation? (Galatians 4:13-14). JSNT 74:65-91.
S
A
M
P
L
E
27
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
________. 2007. Circumcision in Galatia and the Holiness of Gods Ecclesiae. Pages 219-37 in Holiness
and Ecclesiology in the New Testament. Edited by Kent E. Brower and Andy Johnson. Grand Rapids:
Eerdmans.
Martyn, J. Louis. 1997. Galatians: A New Translation with Introduction and Commentary. Anchor Bible 33A.
New York: Doubleday.
Marxsen, Willi. 1974. Introduction to the New Testament. Translated by G. Buswell. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Matera, Frank J. 1988. The Culmination of Pauls Argument to the Galatians: Gal. 5.16:17. JSNT 32:79-
91.
________. 1992. Galatians. Sacra Pagina 9. Collegeville, Minn.: Liturgical Press.
Matlock, Barry. 2007. The Rhetoric of pistis in Paul: Galatians 2.16, 3.22, Romans 3.22, and Philippians 3.9.
JSNT 30:173-203.
Mauer, Christian. 1972. tithe3mi. Pages 151-68 in vol. 8 of TDNT.
McComiskey, Thomas Edward. 1985. The Covenants of Promise: A Theology of the Old Testament Covenants.
Grand Rapids: Baker.
McGrath, Alister E. 2003. A Brief History of Heaven. Blackwell Brief Histories of Religion. London: Blackwell
Publishing.
McKnight, Scot. 1995. Galatians. NIV Application Commentary. Grand Rapids: Zondervan.
Meeks, Wayne A. 1974. The Image of the Androgyne: Some Uses of a Symbol in Earliest Christianity. History
of Religions 13:165-208.
________. 2003. The First Urban Christians: The Social World of the Apostle. 2nd ed. New Haven, Conn.: Yale
University Press.
Merkel, Helmut. 1990. ze3lo3te3s. Page 101 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Merklein, Helmut. 1990. pto3chos. Pages 193-95 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Metzger, Bruce Manning. 1994. A Textual Commentary on the Greek New Testament, Second Edition a Com-
panion Volume to the United Bible Societies Greek New Testament. 4th rev. ed. London: United Bible
Societies.
Meyer, Heinrich August Wilhelm. 1873. Critical and Exegetical Handbook to the Epistle to the Galatians.
Translated by G. H. Venables. Critical and Exegetical Commentary on the New Testament 7. Trans-
lated and edited by William P. Dickson. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
Meyer, Rudolf. 1968. peritemno3 , ktl. Pages 72-84 in vol. 6 of TDNT.
Michel, Otto. 1990. Pate3r. Pages 53-57 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Michaelis, Wilhelm. 1967. mimeomai, ktl. Pages 659-74 in vol. 4 of TDNT.
Mitchell, Margaret M. 1991. Paul and the Rhetoric of Reconciliation: An Exegetical Investigation of the Language
and Composition of 1 Corinthians. Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John Knox.
________. 2000. Review: Rhetoric and Galatians: Reassessing an Approach to Pauls Epistles. Journal of Religion
80:479-80.
Mitchell, Stephen. 1993. The Rise of the Church. Vol. 1 of Anatolia, Land, Men, and Gods in Asia Minor.
Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Mitternacht, Dieter. 2007. A Structure of Persuasion in Galatians: Epistolary and Rhetorical Appeal in an
Aural Setting. Acta Theologica Supplementum 9:53-98.
Moo, Douglas J. 1983. Law, Works of the Law, and Legalism in Paul. Westminster Journal of Theology 45:73-
100.
Moule, C. F. D. 1961. Worship in the New Testament. Ecumenical Studies in Worship 9. London: Lutterworth.
Moulton, James Hope. 1985. A Grammar of New Testament Greek, Volume 1: Prolegomena. 3rd ed. Edin-
burgh: T. & T. Clark.
Moulton, James Hope, and George Milligan. 1930. The Vocabulary of the Greek Testament. London: Hodder
& Stoughton.
Moulton, James Hope, and Nigel Turner. 1963. A Grammar of New Testament Greek, Volume 3: Syntax.
Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
Mullins, Terrence Y. 1964. Disclosure, a Literary Form in the New Testament. NovT 7:44-50.
Munck, Johannes. 1959. Paul and the Salvation of Mankind. Translated by Frank Clarke. Richmond, Va.:
John Knox.
Murphy-OConnor, Jerome. 1993. Paul in Arabia. CBQ 55:732-37.
________. 1999. hierosolyma/ierousalhm in Galatians. ZNW 90:280-81.
Mussner, Franz. 1977. Der Galaterbrief. Herders theologischer Kommentar zum Neuen Testament 9. 3rd ed.
Freiburg: Herder.
Nanos, Mark D., ed. 2002a. The Galatians Debate: Contemporary Issues in Rhetorical and Historical Interpreta-
tion. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
________. 2002b. The Irony of Galatians. Pauls Letter in First-Century Context. Minneapolis: Fortress.
________. 2010. Galatians. Pages 455-74 in The Blackwell Companion to the New Testament. Edited by David
E. Aune. Malden, Mass.: Wiley-Blackwell.
Nickle, Keith F. 1966. The Collection: A Study in Pauline Strategy. Naperville, Ill.: Allenson.
S
A
M
P
L
E
28
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Niederwimmer, Kurt. 1990. eleutheros. Pages 432-34 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Nock, A. Darby. 1938. St. Paul. London: Oxford University Press.
Norris, Frederick W. 1992. Antioch of Syria. Pages 265-69 in vol. 1 of ABD.
OBrien, Kelli S. 2006. The Curse of the Law (Galatians 3.13): Crucixion, Persecution, and Deuteronomy
21.22-23. JSNT 29:55-66.
Oepke, Albrecht. 1973. Der Brief des Paulus an die Galater. 3rd ed. Revised by J. Rohde. Theologischer Hand-
kommentar zum Neuen Testament 9. Berlin: Evangelische Verlagsanstalt.
Ogg, George. 1968. The Chronology of the Life of Saint Paul. London: Epworth.
Pannenberg, Wolfhart. 1968. Jesus: God and Man. Translated by Lewis L. Wilkins and Duane A Priebe.
Philadelphia: Westminster.
Paulsen, H. 1990. energeo3 . Pages 453-54 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Perrin, Norman. 1974. The New Testament: An Introduction: Proclamation and Parenesis, Myth and History.
New York: Harcourt Brace Jovanovich.
Petzke, Gerd. 1990. ktizo3 , ktl. Pages 325-26 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Ptzner, Victor C. 1967. Paul and the Agon Motif: Traditional Athletic Imagery in the Pauline Literature. Sup-
plements to Novum Testamentum 16. Leiden: Brill.
Phillips, Thomas E. 2009. Paul, His Letters, and Acts. Library of Pauline Studies. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
Pilch, John J. 1973. Pauls Usage and Understanding of Apokalypsis in Galatians 12: A Structural Investiga-
tion. PhD diss., Marquette University, 1972. Ann Arbor: University Microlms.
Plmacher, Eckhard. 1990. stoicheion, ktl. Pages 277-78 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Phlmann, Wolfgang. 1990. morphoo3 . Pages 443-44 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Popkes, Wiard. 1990a. paradido3mi. Pages 18-20 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. paradosis. Page 21 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
________. 1990c. peirazo3 , ktl. Pages 64-67 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Porteous, Norman. 1967. Jerusalem-Zion: The Growth of a Symbol. Pages 93-111 in Living the Mystery:
Collected Essays. Oxford: Blackwell.
Porter, Stanley E. 1997. Handbook of Classical Rhetoric in the Hellenistic Period, 330 B.C.-A.D. 400. Leiden:
Brill.
________. 1999. Idioms of the Greek New Testament. Shefeld: JSOT.
________, ed. 2006. Hearing the Old Testament in the New Testament. McMaster New Testament Studies.
Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Porter, Stanley E., and Craig A. Evans. 2000. Dictionary of New Testament Background: A Compendium of
Contemporary Biblical Scholarship. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity Press.
Powers, Daniel G. 2001. Salvation Through Participation: An Examination of the Notion of the Believers Corpo-
rate Unity with Christ in Early Christian Soteriology. Contributions to Biblical Exegesis and Theology
29. Leuven: Peeters.
Rahlfs, Alfred, and Robert Hanhart, eds. 2006. Septuaginta. Stuttgart: Deutsche Bibelgesellschaft.
Risnen, Heiki. 1983. Paul and the Law. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Ramsay, W. M. 1896. St. Paul the Traveller and the Roman Citizen. New York: Putnams Sons.
Ramsay, William M. 1994. The Westminster Guide to the Books of the Bible. Louisville, Ky.: Westminster/John
Knox.
Rapa, Robert K. 2008. Galatians. Pages 547-640 in Expositors Bible Commentary 11: RomansGalatians.
Rev. ed. Grand Rapids: Zondervan.
Reed, Daniel G. 1993. Elements / Elemental Spirits of the World. Pages 229-33 in DPL.
Reinbold, Wolfgang. 2000. Gal 3,6-14 und das Problem der Erfllbarkeit des Gesetzes bei Paulus. ZNW
91:91-106.
Rendall, Frederic. 1903. The Epistle to the Galatians. Pages 121-200 in vol. 3 in The Expositors Greek Testa-
ment. 5 vols. Edited by W. Robertson Nicoll. London: Hodder & Stoughton, 1897-1910.
Rengstorf, Karl Heinrich. 1964a. apostolos, ktl. Pages 407-47 in vol. 1 of TDNT.
________. 1964b. doulos, ktl. Pages 261-80 in vol. 2 in TDNT.
__________. 1964c. zygos in the NT. Pages 898-901 in vol. 2 of TDNT.
Richardson, Peter. 1969. Israel in the Apostolic Church. Society for New Testament Studies Monograph Series
10. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
________. 1980. Pauline Inconsistency: I Corinthians 9:19-23 and Galatians 2:11-14. NTS 26:347-62.
Riches, John. 2008. Galatians Through the Centuries. Blackwell Bible Commentaries. Malden, Mass.: Black-
well.
Ridderbos, Herman Nicolaas. 1953. The Epistle of Paul to the Churches of Galatia. Translated by Henry Zylas-
tra. New International Commentary, New Testament. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 1975. Paul: An Outline of His Theology. Translated by John Richard de Witt. Grand Rapids: Ee-
rdmans.
Riddle, Donald W. 1940. The Cephas-Peter Problem, and a Possible Solution. JBL 59:169-80.
S
A
M
P
L
E
29
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Robertson, A. T. 1919. A Grammar of the Greek New Testament in the Light of Historical Research. New York:
Hodder & Stoughton.
Robertson, O. Palmer. 2000. The Israel of God: Yesterday, Today, and Tomorrow. Phillipsburgh, N.J.: Presbyte-
rian and Reformed Publishing.
Robinson, James M., ed. 1996. The Nag Hammadi Library in English. 4th rev. ed. Translated by Members
of the Coptic Gnostic Library Project of the Institute for Antiquity and Christianity, Claremont
California. Leiden: Brill.
Robinson, Thomas A. 1991. Mastering Greek Vocabulary. 2nd rev. ed. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
Rogers, Elinor MacDonald. 1989. A Semantic Structure Analysis of Galatians. Edited by John Callow. Dallas:
Summer Institute of Linguistics.
Roloff, Jrgen. 1990. Ekkle3sia. Pages 410-15 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Russell, Jeffrey Burton. 1998. A History of Heaven. New ed. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press.
Russell, Walter B., III. 1991. Pauls Use of sarx and pneuma in Galatians 56 in Light of the Argument of
Galatians. PhD diss., Westminster Theological Seminary (Philadelphia).
________. 1993a. Rhetorical Analysis of Galatians, Part 1. Bibliotheca Sacra 150:341-58.
________. 1993b. Rhetorical Analysis of Galatians, Part 2. Bibliotheca Sacra 150:416-39.
________. 1995. The Apostle Pauls Redemptive-Historical Argumentation in Galatians 5:13-26. Westmin-
ster Theological Journal 57:333-57.
Ryken, Leland, James C. Wilhoit, and Tremper Longman III. 1998. Dictionary of Biblical Imagery. Downers
Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity Press.
Sakenfeld, Katherine Doob, ed. 2006-9. New Interpreters Dictionary of the Bible. 5 vols. Nashville: Abingdon.
Sampley, J. Paul. 1977. Before God, I do not lie (Gal 1.20): Pauls Self-defense in Light of Roman Legal
Praxis. NTS 23:477-82.
________. 1980. Pauline Partnership in Christ. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Sand, Alexander. 1990a. kano3n. Page 249 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. kardia. Pages 249-51 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 1990c. therizo3 , ktl. Pages 144-46 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Sanday, W., and A. C. Headlam. 1929. A Critical and Exegetical Commentary on the Epistle to the Romans. The
International Critical Commentary. New York: Charles Scribners Sons.
Sanders, B. 1981. Imitating Paul. 1 Cor. 4:1-16. HTR 74:353-63.
Sanders, E. P. 1983. Paul the Law and the Jewish People. Minneapolis: Fortress.
Sandnes, Karl O. 1991. PaulOne of the Prophets? A Contribution to the Apostles Self-Understanding. WUNT
2 / 43. Tbingen: Mohr-Siebeck.
Schenk, Wolfgang. 1990. prokopto3 , ktl. Pages 157-58 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Schille, Gottfried. 1990. Galatikos. Page 232 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Schlier, Heinrich. 1964. eleutheros, ktl. Pages 487-502 in vol. 2 of TDNT.
________. 1965. Der Brief an die Galater. 4th ed. Kritisch-exegetischer Kommentar ber das Neue Testament
(Meyer-Kommentar). Gttingen: Vandenhoeck & Ruprecht.
Schmidt, Karl Ludwig. 1965. kaleo3 , ktl. Pages 487-536 in vol. 3 of TDNT.
Schmithals, Walter. 1965. Paul and James. Translated by Corothea M. Barton. Studies in Biblical Theology,
First Series 46. Naperville, Ill.: Allenson.
________. 1972. Paul and the Gnostics. Translated John E. Steely. Nashville: Abingdon.
________. 1990. gino3sko3 . Pages 248-51 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Schneider, Gerhard. 1990. paidago3gos. Pages 2-3 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Schottroff, Luise. 1990a. zo3 . Pages 105-9 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. zo3iopoieo3 . Page 110 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Schreiner, Thomas R. 1991. Works of Law in Paul. NovT 33:217-44.
________. 1998. The Law and Its Fulllment: A Pauline Theology of Law. Grand Rapids: Baker Academic.
________. 2010. Galatians. Zondervan Exegetical Commentary on the New Testament 9. Grand Rapids:
Zondervan.
Schrenk, Gottlob. 1967. Pages 945-1022 in vol. 5 of TDNT.
Schunack, Gerd. 1990. dokeo3 . Pages 340-41 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Schrer, Emil. 1890. A History of the Jewish People in the Time of Jesus Christ. 4 vols. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
Schtz, John Howard. 1975. Paul and the Anatomy of Apostolic Authority. Society for New Testament Studies
Monograph Series 26. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Schweitzer, Albert. 1968. The Mysticism of Paul the Apostle. Translated by William Montgomery. New York:
Seabury. German original 1931.
Schweizer, Eduard. 1988. Slaves of the Elements and Worshipers of Angels: Gal 4:3, 9 and Col 2:8, 18, 20.
JBL 107:455-68.
Scott, Ian W. 2007. Common Ground? The Role of Galatians 2.16 in Pauls Argument. NTS 53:425-35.
Scott, James M. 1992. Adoption as Sons of God: An Exegetical Investigation into the Background of
huiothesia in the Pauline Corpus. WUNT 2 / 48. Tbingen: Mohr-Siebeck.
S
A
M
P
L
E
30
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Segal, Alan F. 1990. Paul the Convert: The Apostolate and Apostasy of Saul the Pharisee. New Haven, Conn.:
Yale University Press.
Serro, C. Jeanne Orjala. 2011. James: A Commentary in the Wesleyan Tradition. NBBC. Kansas City: Beacon
Hill Press of Kansas City.
Shauf, Scott. 2006. Galatians 2.20 in Context. NTS 52:86-101.
Sieffert, Friedrich. 1886. Handbuch ber den Brief an die Galater. 7th ed. Kritisch-exegetischer Kommentar
ber das Neue Testament (Meyer-Kommentar). Gttingen: Vandenhoeck & Ruprecht.
Silva, Moiss. 2001. Interpreting Galatians. Explorations in Exegetical Method. 2nd ed. Grand Rapids: Baker
Academic.
Sloan, Robert B. 1991. Why the Law Cannot Save. NovT 33:35-60.
Smallwood, E. Mary. 2001. The Jews Under Roman Rule: From Pompey to Diocletian: A Study in Political Rela-
tions. Studies in Judaism in Late Antiquity 20. Leiden: Brill.
Smiles, Vincent M. 1998. The Gospel and the Law in Galatia: Pauls Response to Jewish-Christian Separatism
and the Threat of Galatian Apostasy. Collegeville, Minn.: Liturgical Press.
Smit, Joop. 1989. The Letter to the Galatians: A Deliberative Speech. NTS 35:1-26.
Smith, Morton. 1957. Pauline Problems: Apropos of J. Munck, Paulus und die Heilgeschichte. HTR 50:107-
32.
________. 1996. The Reason for the Persecution of Paul and the Obscurity of Acts. Pages 87-96 in Studies
in the Cult of Yahweh. Vol. 2, New Testament, Early Christianity, and Magic. Edited by Shaye J. D.
Cohen. Leiden: E. J. Brill.
Smith, Timothy L. 2004. Revivalism and Social Reform: American Protestantism on the Eve of the Civil War.
Eugene, Ore.: Wipf & Stock.
Spencer, F. Scott. 2006. Barnabas. Page 395 in vol. 1 of NIDB.
Spicq, Ceslas. 1994. Theological Lexicon of the New Testament. 3 vols. Translated by James D. Ernest. Peabody,
Mass.: Hendrickson.
Sthlin, Gustav. 1965. kopetos, ktl. Pages 830-60 in vol. 3 of TDNT.
Stanley, Christopher D. 1990. Under a Curse: A Fresh Reading of Galatians 3:10-14. NTS 36:481-511.
________. 1996. Neither Jew nor Greek: Ethnic Conict in Graeco-Roman Society. JSNT 64:101-24.
________. 1999. Pearls before Swine: Did Pauls Audiences Understand His Biblical Quotations? NovT
41:124-44.
Stanley, David M. 1959. Become Imitators of Me: The Pauline Conception of Apostolic Tradition. Biblica
40:874-76.
Stendahl, Krister. 1976. Paul Among Jews and Gentiles and Other Essays. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Stirewalt, M. Luther, Jr. 2003. Paul, the Letter Writer. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Stott, John R. W. 1968. The Message of Galatians. The Bible Speaks Today. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity
Press.
Strelan, J. G. 1975. Burden-Bearing and the Law of Christ: A Re-Examination of Galatians 6:2. JBL 94:266-
76.
Stuhlmacker, Peter. 1968. Das paulinische Evangelium I. Vorgeschichte. Forschungen zur Religion und Litera-
ture des Alten und Neuen Testaments 95. Gttingen: Vandenhoeck & Ruprecht.
Stutzman, Robert. 2008. An Exegetical Summary of Galatians. 2nd ed. Dallas: SIL International.
Swanson, J. 1997. Dictionary of Biblical Languages with Semantic Domains: Greek (New Testament) (electronic
ed.). Oak Harbor, Wash.: Logos Research Systems, Inc.
Thielmann, Frank. 1994. Paul and the Law. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity Press.
Thompson, Richard P. Forthcoming. Acts: A Commentary in the Wesleyan Tradition. NBBC. Kansas City:
Beacon Hill Press of Kansas City.
Thyen, Hartwig. 1990a. Io3anne3s. Pages 210-13 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. katharos, ktl. Pages 218-20 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
Trench, R. C. 1858. Synonyms of the New Testament. 3rd ed. Rev. and Enlarged. New York: Redeld.
Tsang, Sam. 2005. From Slaves to Sons: A New Rhetoric Analysis on Pauls Slave Metaphors in His Letter to the
Galatians. Studies in Biblical Literature 81. New York: Peter Lang.
Vermes, Geza. 1981. Jesus and the Jew: A Historians Reading of the Gospels. Philadelphia: Fortress.
Vielhauer, Philipp. 1975. Geschichte der urchristlichen Literatur. Berlin: de Gruyter.
Walker, William O., Jr. 1985. Acts and the Pauline Corpus Reconsidered. JSNT 24:3-23.
________. 2003. Does the We in Gal 2.15 Include His Opponents? NTS 49:560-65.
________. 2004. Galatians 2:8 and the Question of Pauls Apostleship. JBL 123:323-27.
Wallace, Daniel B. 1990. Galatians 3:19-20: A Crux Interpretum for Pauls View of the Law. Westminster
Theological Journal 52:225-45.
Walter, Nikolaus. 1990a. ethnos, ktl. Pages 381-83 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. stigma, ktl. Pages 276-77 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Wanke, Joachim. 1990. Helle3n, ktl. Pages 435-36 in vol. 1 of EDNT.
Wedderburn, A. J. M. 1993. The Apostolic Decree: Tradition and Redaction. NovT 35:362-89.
S
A
M
P
L
E
31
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Wegenast, Klaus. 1986. kate3cheo3 . Pages 771-72 in vol. 3 of NIDNTT.
Weima, J. A. D. 1993. Gal. 6:11-18: A Hermeneutical Key to the Galatian Letter. Calvin Theological Journal
28:90-107.
Weiss, Johannes. 1959. Earliest Christianity: A History of the Period A.D. 30-150. 2 vols. (Completed after the
authors death by Rudolf Knopf.) Translated by Frederick C. Grant. New York: Harper and Brothers.
German original: Das Urchristentum 1917.
Wengst, Klaus. 1972. Der Apostel und die Tradition. Zeitschrift fr Theologie und Kirche. 69:155-56.
Werblowsky, Raphael Jehudah Zwi, and Geoffrey Wigoder. 1997. The Oxford Dictionary of the Jewish Reli-
gion. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Wesley, John. 1950. Explanatory Notes upon the New Testament. Reprint. London: Epworth.
________. 1979. The Works of John Wesley. 3rd ed. 14 vols. Edited by Thomas Jackson. Repr. 1872. London:
Wesleyan Conference Ofce, 1872. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Westerholm, Stephen. 1988. Israels Law and the Churchs Faith. Paul and His Recent Interpreters. Grand
Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 2003. Perspectives Old and New on Paul: The Lutheran Paul and His Critics. Grand Rapids:
Eerdmans.
________. 2004. The Righteousness of the Law and the Righteousness of Faith in Romans. Interpretation
58:253-64.
White, John L. 1986. Light from Ancient Letters. Foundations and Facets: New Testament. Philadelphia: For-
tress.
________. 1993. Apostolic Mission and Apostolic Message: Congruence in Pauls Epistolary Rhetoric, Struc-
ture, and Imagery. Pages 145-61 in Origins and Method: Towards a New Understanding of Judaism
and Christianity: Essays in Honor of John C. Hurd. Edited by B. H. McLean. JSNT Supplement 86.
Shefeld: JSOT Press.
________. 1999. The Apostle of God: Paul and the Promise of Abraham. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrickson.
Wikenhauser, Alfred. 1963. New Testament Introduction. Translated by Joseph Cunningham. New York:
Herder & Herder.
________. 1964. Pauline Mysticism: Christ in the Mystical Teaching of St. Paul. Translated by Joseph Cunning-
ham. New York: Herder & Herder.
Wilcox, Max. 1977. Upon the Tree: Deut 21:22-23 in the New Testament. JBL 96:85-99.
Williams, A. Lukyn. 1921. The Epistle of Paul the Apostle to the Galatians. Cambridge Bible. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
Williams, Sam K. 1987. Justication and the Spirit in Galatians. JSNT 29:91-100.
________. 1988. Promise in Galatians: A Reading of Pauls Reading of Scripture. JBL 107:709-20.
Wilson, Todd A. 2004. Wilderness Apostasy and Pauls Portrayal of the Crisis in Galatians. NTS 50:550-71.
________. 2007. The Curse of the Law and the Crisis in Galatia: Reassessing the Purpose of Galatians. WUNT
2 / 225. Tbingen: Mohr-Siebeck.
Winer, George Benedikt. 1825. A Greek Grammar of the New Testament. Translated by Moses Stuart and
Edward Robinson. Andover, Mass.: Flagg and Gould.
Winger, Michael. 1986. Unreal Conditions in the Letters of Paul. JBL 105:110-12.
________. 1999. From Grace to Sin: Names and Abstractions in Pauls Letters. NovT 41:145-75.
Winter, Bruce W. 1994. Seek the Welfare of the City: Christians as Benefactors and Citizens. First-Century
Christians in the Graeco-Roman World. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Wischenmeyer, Otto. 1986. Das Gebet der Nchstenliebe bei Paulus. Biblische Zeitschrift 30:161-87.
Witherington, Ben, III. 1993. Christology. Pages 100-115 in DPL.
________. 1994. Pauls Narrative Thought World: The Tapestry of Tragedy and Triumph. Louisville, Ky.: West-
minster/John Knox.
________. 1997. The Acts of the Apostles: A Socio-Rhetorical Commentary. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 1998a. Grace in Galatia: A Commentary on Pauls Letter to the Galatians. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
________. 1998b. The Paul Quest: The Renewed Search for the Jew of Tarsus. Downers Grove, Ill.: InterVarsity.
Wolter, Michael. 1990a. histe3mi. Pages 205-7 in vol. 2 of EDNT.
________. 1990b. parapto3ma. Pages 33-34 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
Wrede, William. 1908. Paul. Translated by Edward Lummis. Boston: American Unitarian Association.
Wright, N. T. 1991. The Climax of the Covenant: Christ and the Law in Pauline Theology. Minneapolis: Fortress.
________. 1996. Paul, Arabia, and Elijah. JBL 115:683-92.
________. 2008. Surprised by Hope: Rethinking Heaven, the Resurrection, and the Mission of the Church. New
York: HarperOne.
Yonge, Charles Duke, trans. 1993. The Works of Philo: Complete and Unabridged. Peabody, Mass.: Hendrick-
son.
Young, E. M. 1977. Full the Law of Christ: An Examination of Galatians 6.2. Studia Biblica et Theologica
7:31-42.
Young, Norman H. 1987. Paidagogos: The Social Setting of a Pauline Metaphor. NovT 29:150-76.
S
A
M
P
L
E
32
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
________. 1998. Whos Cursed: And Why? (Galatians 3:10-14). JBL 117:79-92.
Young, Richard A. 1994. Intermediate New Testament Greek: A Linguistic and Exegetical Approach. Nashville:
Broadman & Holman.
Zahn, Theodor von. 1909. Introduction to the New Testament. 3 vols. Translated by Melancthon Williams
Jacobus and others. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark.
Ziesler, John A. 1972. The Meaning of Righteousness in Paul: A Linguistic and Theological Inquiry. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
________. 1992. The Epistle to the Galatians. Epworth Commentaries. London: Epworth.
Zmijewski, Josef. 1990. chre3stote3s. Pages 475-77 in vol. 3 of EDNT.
S
A
M
P
L
E
33
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
TABLE OF SIDEBARS
Sidebars Location
Godfearers Introduction
Further Reading on Apocalyptic 1:1-5
Further Reading: First-Century Slavery 1:10
Pleasing People 1:10
Conversion vs. Vocation 1:12
The Spelling of Jerusalem 1:17
Map of Ancient Arabia 1:17
Pauline Chronology 1:17
Cephas = Peter 1:18
James Outside the NT 1:19
Map of Asia Minor, Syria and Cilicia, and Cyprus 1:21
Barnabas 2:1
Titus 2:1
Why Circumcision Mattered 2:3
The Rest of the Story 2:4
Freedom in Galatians 2:4
John 2:9
The Apostolic Conference: A Historical Reconstruction 2:10
Why Didnt Paul Criticize James? 2:12
Did Pauls Position Prevail in Antioch? 2:14
Law in Galatians 2:16
Flesh 2:16
Cruciformity 2:19
He Gave Himself 2:20
The Evil Eye 3:1
Suffering and Early Christianity 3:4
The Gift of the Spirit 3:5
Abraham in Romans 4 3:6
Gentiles as Ethnophaulism 3:8
Did Paul Consider Perfect Obedience to the Law Possible? 3:11
Faith vs. Works in Romans 4 3:12
Redemption 3:13
Salvation as Interchange 3:13
Promise 3:14
Gnostic Excesses 3:20
Under Law 3:23
S
A
M
P
L
E
34
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Further Reading: First-Century Attitudes Toward Women 3:26-29
The Language of Baptism in the New Testament 3:27
Clothed with Christ 3:27
Light from 1 Corinthians 3:28
Speculating About Pauls Illness 4:13
Paul as Parent 4:19
Table of Contrasts: Two Covenants 4:25
Heavenly, Future, Invisible Jerusalem 4:26
Victory in Heaven, Suffering on Earth 4:27
The Disputed Interpretation of Galatians 4:30 4:30
The Translation of Sarx 5:13
The Spirit and the Kingdom of God 5:21
Love in Pauls Letters 5:22
Test Everything 6:4
S
A
M
P
L
E
35
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
INTRODUCTION
This introduction summarizes the essential behind-the-text
information necessary for making sense of the ancient letter we
call Galatians. On the essentials most interpreters agree. More in-
depth commentaries and introductions may be consulted for de-
tails (see Nanos 2010). Some hotly debated issues have little effect
on the interpretation of the letter.
Limited internal information as to what prompted Paul to
write has made Galatians the victim of highly speculative recon-
structions. These depend more on the imagination of scholars than
on the textual data. I call attention to major disagreements among
interpreters and indicate when I depart from the scholarly consen-
sus. See the commentary () for exegetical evidence supporting
the conclusions stated briey here.
A. Author
The letter claims the apostle Paul wrote it ( 1:1; 5:2). No
serious contemporary scholar questions that claim (see Burton
1920, lxv; Betz 1979, 1). In fact, most appeal to Galatians to as-
sess the authenticity of the other Pauline letters. It remains uncer-
tain what inuence Pauls anonymous co-senders ( 1:2) and the
amanuensis responsible for writing the letter ( 6:11) may also
have had on the letters composition.
B. Addressees
Paul addressed an original audience consisting of his former-
ly pagan converts ( 4:8). These so-called Gentile Christians (
2:2) apparently met in household gatherings in unnamed urban
centers in Galatia ( 1:2; 3:1-5; 4:12-16). During Roman times
Galatia referred to a province in central Anatoliaa wide stripe
down the middle of Asia Minor stretching from the Black Sea
in the north to the Mediterranean in the south ( 1:21). It was
S
A
M
P
L
E
36
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
named for the Gallic tribes who migrated there from Western Europe early in
the third century B.C. (see Mitchell 1993; Kahl 2010, 31-75). When it became
a Roman province late in the rst century B.C., the southern regions of Pisidia,
Pamphilia, Lycaonia, and Phrygia were attached to the old Celtic kingdoms
territory in the north.
Scholars have for over a century debated inconclusively whether the
communities Paul addressed were in north (territorial) or south (provincial)
Galatia. The north was populated primarily by ethnic Galatians, descendants
of the Gauls. Its major cities included Ankyra, Pessinus, and Tavium. During
the mid-rst century, there were few (Betz 1979, 5) or no (Martyn 1997, 16)
Jewish communities in northern Galatia. The more densely populated south
included descendants of a variety of tribes and ethnic groups, including Jews.
Its major cities were Derbe, Lystra, Iconium, and Pisidian Antioch.
Acts reports Pauls travels in both parts of the province (13:14, 51; 14:6;
16:6; 18:23; 20:4). But it never mentions churches in the north, nor that he
wrote letters. (So much for the argument from silence!) Since Paul did not iden-
tify his addressees specically and known literary and archaeological data have
not resolved the debate, certainty is impossible. Fortunately, ones decision on
the dispute has little effect on the interpretation of the letter (Schreiner 2010,
22-31).
Pauls founding visit to Galatia was not on his missionary agenda. Appar-
ently recovering from injuries received from persecution for preaching else-
where, the Galatians assisted him in his recovery. They warmly welcomed
and befriended him, and joyfully accepted the gospel he preached ( 3:1-5;
4:13-14).
Modern readers should be aware of two socioreligious realities of central
Anatolia in the second half of the rst century A.D., regardless of the location
of Pauls churches there. They are the native cult of the mountain mother god-
desses, whose devotees practiced self-castration (see Elliott 1999 and 2008),
and the omnipresent cult of the Roman emperor (see Winter 1994, 125-43;
Hardin 2008; Kahl 2010).
That a Jewish Christian itinerate preacher like Paul had made friends
and Christian converts in the unfriendly world of Greco-Roman paganism
was nothing short of a miracle ( 3:1-5; 4:12-20). After all he had invested
in them, he was not prepared simply to abandon them to preachers of a false
gospel ( 1:6-9).
Modern readers of Galatians must always keep in mind that they are
reading anothers mail. The original audience of Pauls circular letter to his
churches in Galatia did not have the luxury of studying it as we may. They
lived in a scribal culture where illiteracy [was] the rule rather than the excep-
tion (Mitternacht 2007, 53).
Many of the detailed nuances of the text that occupy commentaries (in-
cluding this one) probably went unnoticed by those who rst listened to the
S
A
M
P
L
E
37
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
apostles emissary read the letter in their hearing. Mitternacht surveys what
the aural audience would have remembered based on situational pertinence,
epistolary formulas, rhetorical features, strategic maneuvers, and scriptural
proofs. He concludes:
Having heard the letter from beginning to end, the listeners in Gala-
tia were left with a lasting impression that Pauls concern for the Gala-
tian addressees was that they should share his passion for the passion of
Christ. His request Become as I meant no less than Participate with
me in the imitatio Christi crucixi. (Mitternacht 2007, 91)
Throughout the commentary, I refer to this dominant concern of the letter
with the term cruciformity ( 2:19 sidebar).
C. Date
The date of the letter remains as uncertain as its destination. If Paul
wrote to churches in the southern part of the province (Acts 1314), Gala-
tians could be his earliest letter, as early as A.D. 48 (Carson, Moo, and Morris
1992, 294). This assumes that Pauls Jerusalem visit reported in Acts 11:28-
30 is the same as that in Gal 2:1-10. But if the Jerusalem meetings reported
in Acts 15 and Gal 2:1-10 recount the same event (as seems likely, 1:17;
2:10), the letter must have been written sometime after A.D. 47-51, whether
addressed to churches in the north or south.
The word rst in 4:13 () need not imply that Paul made more than
one visit to Galatia before writing the letter. Depending on the force of the
word quickly in 1:6 (), he may have written soon after his visit. Certainty
is impossible. But the striking similarities between Galatians and Romans
commend a date nearer that of the latter. We can date Romans condently
ca. A.D. 57 (see Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 23). This would suggest a date
for Galatians ca. A.D. 54 or 55. When Paul wrote, his circumstances prevented
him from revisiting Galatia ( 4:20), perhaps during his ministry in Macedo-
nia or Ephesus (Kmmel 1975, 303-4).
D. Occasion
Paul never explained why he wrote the letter. His rst readers almost
certainly knew well enough. But this lack of information puts those who can
only eavesdrop on his side of the conversation at a distinct disadvantage.
Paul did not indicate the letters occasion (what prompted him to write)
or its purpose (what he expected the Galatians to do in response). This de-
ciency of data has opened the door to a variety of theories. Most of these are
plausible enough. But they often reveal more about the assumptions of their
scholarly sponsors than about Galatians.
Those who take seriously the canonical authority of the biblical text
must acknowledge when we move from exegesis to speculation. My insistence
on the priority of Galatians itself over imaginative reconstructions of its oc-
S
A
M
P
L
E
38
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
casion puts me in a minority of commentators. Readers may decide for them-
selves whether my alternative approach succeeds in making sense of what we
can know with some certainty.
I distinguish clearly what Paul explicitly wrote from what scholars have
proposed to ll in the gaps. I focus on the information from three perspec-
tivesthat of Paul, the Galatians, and the Agitatorsthe anonymous antago-
nists lurking in the background.
We should admit from the outset that all we know about each of these
three depends entirely on what Paul saw t to mention in the letter. We can be
certain that the Galatians and the Agitators would have presented themselves
somewhat differently. And we should admit that Paul did not claim to play
fair. He was not trying to be objective and failed. He was writing to winto
persuade the Galatians that the Agitators were wrong and to get them to reaf-
rm his understanding of the gospel.
1. Paul
Sometime after the apostles departure from Galatia, his converts there
were thrown into confusion ( 5:10) by unnamed preachers who persuaded
( 5:8) them of the plausibility of a different gospel ( 1:6-10). He consid-
ered this message a perversion of the true gospel of Christ and really no gos-
pel at all ( 1:7; 2:5, 14). Paul was astonished ( 1:6), incensed ( 1:8-9;
5:12), mystied ( 2:14; 4:9, 15), fearful, exasperated ( 4:11), conciliatory,
perplexed ( 4:20), concerned ( 5:2-4), and overwhelmed ( 6:17) by
the turn of events. But nothing in the letter indicates that he was put on the
defensive (against Schreiner 2010, 33-34).
Paul did not say how he learned of the threatened defection of the Ga-
latians or how much he knew about those responsible. Were his informants
friends or foes? Did he know of specic problems in one community and as-
sume that similar problems existed in all the Christian households scattered
in several cities ( 1:2)? Did he send the same circular letter to them all
because the threat was endemic and of such epidemic proportions that it re-
quired a shotgun approach to attack it? Or, did he offer a one-size-ts-all
solution simply because he did not know the details? We would like to know
more than we do about how many churches Paul addressed, how far apart they
were, and how these churches networked.
All we can know depends upon Pauls letter. We are uninformed as
to how the Galatians or the Agitators saw the situation he addressed. The
churchs canonization of Galatians assigns the apostles perspective a privi-
leged standing. He claimed to speak for God ( 1:1, 11) and made no attempt
to be open-minded or even-handed in his response to the developments in
Galatia. He was not concerned to put the best possible interpretation on the
motives of the opposition or the response of the Galatians to them. His singu-
lar goal was to persuade the Galatians to his point of view ( 5:10).
S
A
M
P
L
E
39
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2. The Galatians
Paul characterized the consequences of the Galatians openness to the
persuasion of the opposing preachers as desertion, apostasy ( 1:6; 4:9),
confusion ( 1:7; 5:10), folly, deception ( 3:1, 3), alienation from Christ,
falling from grace ( 5:4), tripped up, disobedience to the truth ( 5:7),
inuenced by evil ( 5:9), and self-destructive factionalism ( 5:15). Their
friendship with the Agitators threatened to render their previous experienc-
es as Christians for nothing ( 3:4). They had treated Paul, their former
friend, as an enemy ( 4:16), so that he feared his efforts on their behalf were
wasted ( 4:11).
But Paul was not prepared to give up on the Galatians. He was con-
dent in the Lord that they would accept his point of view ( 5:10). From the
outset of the letter, his conditional curse on those aligned with the false gospel
( 1:8-9) urged his audience to reject the Agitators. He reminded them of the
undeniable reality of their conversion ( 3:1-5). Their reception of the Spirit
was proof sufcient that they were already the children of Abraham ( 3:14,
26-29; 4:6-7).
Paul insisted that no mark in the Galatians esh could perfect what
the Spirit had already done ( 3:2-4). Christ had freed them from their old
lives of slavery ( 4:45:1). Circumcision would mean the surrender of that
freedom. They did not need to become Jews to gain full standing as children of
Abraham. They needed to resist the overtures of the Agitators to get circum-
cised, to stand rm in their Christ-won freedom ( 5:1, 13), and to keep in
step with the Spirit (5:25).
We can only speculate what made the circumcision-gospel appealing
to the Galatians. Were those rst persuaded of the necessity of circumcision
anxious to perfect their standing as Abrahams children ( ch 3)? Or, were
they convinced on more pragmatic grounds? For example, did they hope that
as Jewish converts they would be exempt from participation in the Imperial
cult? or, that circumcision would spare them from persecution by civil au-
thorities for their noncompliance ( 4:10; 6:12-13)?
Whatever the appeal from whatever the ultimate and secondary sources,
it seems obvious that the issue of circumcision caused internal division within
the Galatian Christian communities. Did the early adopters urge their fellow
Gentile Christians to join them in accepting the rite, thus becoming or joining
ranks with the Agitators? (Does misery love company?) The sociological reali-
ties of ancient household churches suggest that they probably would all either
have accepted circumcision or rejected it. Did the community send delegates
to Paul to resolve the internal dispute ( 1:2)? The letter answers none of
these questions.
There are reasons to challenge the typical scholarly assumption that the
majority of the Galatians were anxious to get circumcised. Widespread ac-
ceptance of Jewish circumcision among Gentiles is not attested except in in-
S
A
M
P
L
E
40
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
stances of military compulsion. Unless the Galatian situation is a phenomenon
unique to the Greco-Roman world, the Galatian churches were not looking
forward to circumcision (Martin 1996, 114-15).
It seems entirely possible that the majority in the Galatian communities
resisted the urging of the Agitators to get circumcised. It is even possible that
some were so repulsed by circumcision that they were prepared to abandon
Christianity and return to paganism rather than accept it (Martin 1995). But
there are other possibilities:
They may only have inquired of Paul as to whether or not the Agitators
were correct about the necessity or advisability of circumcision.
They may have asked him whether he considered them no better than
Godfearers. Or,
They may have communicated their reluctant willingness to get circum-
cised, if that was required for them to become children of Abraham.
Of course, these are only guesses. But would these alternative scenarios have
required a different letter than Paul wrote?
Godf earers
Contemporary scholars debate whether there existed a class of Gentiles
who were partial converts to Judaismsemi-proselytes or Jewish sympathizers.
New Testament scholars have long referred to Godfearers, citing references
to two remarkable centurions (Luke 7:1-10; Acts 10:2, 22, 35, 45; and 11:14; and
parallels in 13:16, 26, 43, 50; 16:14; 17:4, 17; 18:7).
Feldman (1986) appeals to extensive references in nearly contemporary
pagan literature, Philo and Josephus, rabbinic writings, and early Christian writers
supporting the existence of Godfearers. MacLennan and Kraabel (1986), how-
ever, emphasize that minimal archaeological evidence exists to support the claim
that there were Gentile half-Jews. They explain the alleged literary references as
allusions to Jews, Christians, and political (vs. religious) sympathizers with Jews.
3. The Agitators
Because of the disturbances they created in the Galatian churches (from
Pauls perspective), the anonymous advocates of the contrary gospel have
sometimes been called Agitators ( 1:7; 5:10, 12). The traditional designation
Judaizers ( 2:14) has fallen out of favor. Other labels, whether as neutral
as inuencers (Nanos 2002b) or as tendentious as the teachers (Martyn
1997), have failed to win broad support. (For a brief history of scholarship on
the Galatian troublemakers, see Longenecker 1990, lxxxviii-xcvi.)
Whatever we call them, Paul considered the Agitators departure from
the true gospel so serious that he was ready to consign them to eternal dam-
nation ( 1:8-9; 5:10). The confusion they fostered ( 1:7; 5:10) led him
consistently to malign their message, their methods, and their motives.
S
A
M
P
L
E
41
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
Paul explicitly claimed that the Agitators had duped the Galatians
( 3:1), insincerely attering them and pretending to be their friends only
to alienate them from Paul ( 4:17-18). They had thwarted the Galatians
Christian progress by keeping them from obeying the truth ( 5:7) and by
coercing them to be circumcised ( 2:3; 6:12). They had urged circumcision
for purely selsh reasons: to impress others, avoid persecution, and earn brag-
ging rights for their persuasion ( 6:12-13).
Paul usually referred to the Agitators in the third person, distinguish-
ing them from his Galatian audience. Sometimes he referred to them in the
plural ( 1:7; 5:12); sometimes, in the singular ( 5:10). It is unclear how
formidable was the opposition. There is a studied vagueness in this and other
references to the agitators (Rendall 1903, 152).
In 4:21 (), Paul addressed the Galatians in terms we might have ex-
pected applied to the Agitators (Martin 1995): you who want to be under the
law. Were those disturbing the tranquillity of the Galatian Christian commu-
nities insiders? Did Paul use the third person merely for rhetorical reasons
to marginalize those in the community he considered troublemakers? This
would cohere with the apostles warning in 5:15If you keep on biting and
devouring each other, watch out or you will be destroyed by each other. But
this is not the majority view.
Pauls nal explicit accusation against the Agitators in Galatians was
that they failed to obey the law ( 6:13). Most interpreters assume this was
merely ironic rhetoricaccusing the legalists of antinomianism ( 2:11-14).
But if the Agitators within the communities were new converts to Judaism
or curious inquirers, Paul may well have considered them slackers compared
to his pre-Christian rigor as a law-observant Jew (see 2 Cor 11:21b-33 ; Phil
3:2-6). This may also explain his insistence in Gal 5:3: I declare to every man
who lets himself be circumcised that he is obligated to obey the whole law. As
amateurs, the Agitators may not have realized the full implications of the cir-
cumcision covenant. But, of course, the consensus view may be correctthat
they knew full well, and conveniently failed to mention the ne print in the
contract to the community ( 5:3).
Most interpreters assume that the Agitators had some Jewish connec-
tion, although Paul does not say. Were they:
non-Christian Jews,
Jewish Christians,
non-Christian Gentile proselytes to Judaism, or
Gentile Christian proselytes?
We cannot be certain the Agitators were Jews, much less whether they
came from Judea, or Jerusalem specically, as many scholars presume (e.g.,
Betz 1979, 7, 90 n. 302, 92, 101, 104, 111). Perhaps the Galatian problem was
entirely homegrown.
S
A
M
P
L
E
42
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
One widely held scholarly assumption is that the Agitators in Galatia
(1:7-9), the false brothers in Jerusalem (2:4), the men . . . from James (v
12), and those who belonged to the circumcision group (v 12) all represent
the same position in Pauls mind (e.g., Betz 1979, 7, 92, 104, 107). This as-
sumption often spawns another, equally suspect hypothesisthat what Paul
said about his opponents in another setting applied equally to the Galatian
Agitators (e.g., Betz 1979, 90, 92).
The Antioch incident ( 2:11-14) may illustrate how unwarranted the
assumption is that James delegates visit to Antioch illustrates what must have
happened in Galatia. After they arrived, Peter returned to Jewish ways he had
previously abandoned. By his bad example other Jewish Christians did like-
wise. This made Gentile Christians in the community feel compelled to adopt
Jewish rites and culture.
Paul claimed that Peters hypocritical change of practice was motivated
by fear. But he did not say that Peter feared James or his representatives. He
feared those of the circumcision (2:12). Are these two simply to be equated? If
Paul knew that those who belonged to the circumcision group (v 12) were of
the same ilk as the false brothers he had resisted in Jerusalem ( v 4), much
less the same as the Galatian Agitators, his failure to offer any condemnation
of their activity in Antioch seems inexplicable. He confronted only Peter and
the other Jewish Christians who followed his lead. It is more than curious that
the Jerusalem visitors gave Peter reason to be afraid, but not Paul. Why?
Beyond Pauls explicit claims about the troublemakers in Galatia, any-
thing we may say about the Agitators is merely conjectural. Since knowledge
about them comes only through Pauls highly polemical, and often indirect
references to them, it is only possible to make educated guesses concern-
ing their identity and their teaching of the Galatians (Eastman 2007, 52).
Speculation and reconstruction are probably inevitable when we are reading
anothers mail. But all that favors the consensus views is scholarly inertia, not
conclusive evidence.
It is possible, as the consensus insists, that Pharisaic Christians had per-
suaded some Galatian Christians that Gentiles had to be circumcised to be
saved (Acts 15:1, 5; Gal 2:1-10). Or, that without circumcision they were
only Godfearers, lacking the essential eshly prerequisite for full standing
as Abrahams children ( 3:1-5)? But what would have prevented Pauls con-
verts from concluding entirely on their own that circumcision was expected
of them? All they would need to have done was to read Gods instructions to
Abraham in Gen 17:14Any uncircumcised male, who has not been circum-
cised in the esh, will be cut off from his people; he has broken my covenant
(see Munck 1959, 87-134; Richardson 1969, 90-97).
S
A
M
P
L
E
43
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
E. Purpose
One clear goal of Pauls letter was to eliminate the inuence of the Agi-
tators from the Christian communities in Galatia ( 1:8-9; 4:30; 5:10, 12).
Another was to embolden them to resist the Agitators so-called gospel (
1:7). Some interpreters assume that his reference to Gen 21:10 in Gal 4:30
( Get rid of the slave woman and her son) functioned as did Exod 12:15-16
in 1 Cor 5:7 (Get rid of the old yeast). That is, it gave scriptural warrant for
excommunicating the Agitators from the community.
But this ignores the rst explicit exhortation in the letter: I plead with
you, brothers, become like me, for I became like you (Gal 4:12). In 4:8-20
() Paul applied everything he had written up to this point in the letter to
the Galatians. All that follows are consequences that should arise from their
positive response to his central appeal (Mitternacht 2007, 75). The apostle
invited his straying converts to follow his example. His repetitions throughout
the letter would surely have led them to take this to invite them to side with
God as opposed to people, with the Spirit vs. the esh, with Christ vs. the
Law, with freedom vs. slavery, with the cross vs. circumcision.
Rhetorical Genre. Since the appearance of Betzs 1979 commentary on
Galatians, scholars have often attempted to identify the purpose of the letter
by appeal to its alleged rhetorical species (Kern 1998, 120-66). In fact, Betz
merely added a layer of sophisticated plausibility to the longstanding assump-
tion that Galatians was an apologetic letter. Paul allegedly wrote to defend the
divine source of his gospel and apostleship against the false accusations of his
opponents.
This is not the place to give a full account of ancient rhetorical theo-
ry and practice or its application to Galatians (see Kennedy 1984 and Kern
1998). But we must say enough to make clear what is at issue. Education in
the predominantly aural culture of antiquity consisted largely in the study
of rhetoricpersuasive speech. There were three basic species, less distin-
guished by form than functionthat is, by the purpose, positive or negative,
each pursued.
Judicial / forensic rhetoric originated in the courts of law. It pursued the
still familiar goals of prosecuting or defending those accused of wrongdoing.
Focusing on past events, it sought to accuse or excuse defendants. Betz (1979)
assumed that Galatians was Pauls apologetic defense of his gospel and apos-
tleship. He has been followed in this to some extent by Beker (1980, 273-78),
Brinsmead (1982, 41-55), Ldemann (1984), Smiles (1998), and others.
Deliberative rhetoric originated in the legislature. It pursued the goals of
advising or dissuading an audience as to benets or disadvantages of a future
course of action, frequently by appeal to examples. My 1982 dissertation ar-
gued that Galatians used deliberative rhetoric to persuade the Galatians to
abandon their plans to get circumcised and to return to his gospel of jus-
S
A
M
P
L
E
44
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
tication by faith alone (Lyons 1985, 173-74). Others have (independently
or building on my proposal) defended a similar reading of the letter, includ-
ing Kennedy (1984, 36-38, 148-50), Cosgrove (1988), Smit (1989), Matera
(1992), Witherington (1998a), and others. I do not assume that Paul self-con-
sciously followed the rhetorical handbooks, but that his goal was essentially
deliberative (see Kerns [1998, 141-46] critique of this approach).
Some interpreters identify Galatians as an amalgam of the judicial and
deliberative rhetorical species (e.g., Hansen 1989 and 2010; Longenecker
1990). They assume that the theological argument of the opening chapters
serves a defensive function; and the practical application, a hortatory purpose.
Epideictic / demonstrative rhetoric was at home in the ancient classroom
and in memorial settings. It focused on the present, praising the existing val-
ues and practices of a sympathetic audience. Or, negatively, it heaped blame on
the enemies or vices rejected by its audience. Few interpreters have identied
epideictic as the species of Galatians (but see White 1993, 159-60; and Hester
1991, 294-95).
Kern concludes that Galatians does not t any of the three species of
rhetoric as described in the handbooks (1998, 166; see 256-61). But this is
irrelevant to the question of whether rhetorical categories assist us in identify-
ing the purpose Paul hoped to accomplish in writing the letter (see Mitchell
2000; Nanos 2010, 466).
Mirror-Reading. Those who read Galatians as an apologetic letter imag-
ine they can reconstruct the accusations of the Agitators by simply reversing
Pauls denials and assertions. But no interpreter consistently reverses all of his
antithetical constructions. To do so would result in totally implausible and
contradictory claims by these reconstructed opponents. No interpreter has
shown persuasively how to decide which of the letters denials and statements
should be mirror-read and which should not (see the attempt by Barclay 1987;
see Lyons 1985, 82-105, for evidence to the contrary). I consider mirror-read-
ing a misguided interpretive method, methodologically prone to interpretive
abuse. In practice it allows historical conjectures to take precedence over the
text itself.
F. Organization
Most interpreters of Galatians since Betz (1979) essentially agree as to
its basic structural organization (see Kern 1998, 91-92; Russell 1993a and
1993b). Differences are largely matters of minor details and labels.
Everyone agrees that 1:1-5 is the epistolary prescript / salutation; and
6:11-18, the epistolary postscript / subscription / peroratio / conclusio /
epilogue / amplicatio.
There are marked differences as to whether the rebuke / exordium /
prooemium / proem / theme / proposition / prologue is to be identied
as 1:6-9, 6-10, 6-11, or 6-12.
S
A
M
P
L
E
45
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
This difference affects the identifcation of the beginning of the auto-
biographical narrative / narratio / proofs / probatio, whether 1:10, 11,
12, or 13. Scholars also disagree as to its conclusion, whether 2:14 or
2:21.
More marked differences are to be found in the various analyses of
the body of the letter / propositio and probatio / peroratio and refutatio
/ conrmatio and conclusio / experiential argument. Does it begin with
2:15 or 3:1? And does it conclude with 4:11; 4:31; 5:1; or 5:12?
These differences, in turn, affect defnitions of the limits of the moral
guidance section / exhortatio / refutatio / injunctions / causal argu-
ment. It clearly ends with 6:10. But does is begin with 4:12; 5:1; or
5:13?
G. Argumentative Logic
Paul identied himself as the primary sender of the letter, emphasizing
the divine origin of his apostolic ofce (1:1). His salutation mentions both the
death and resurrection of Christ (vv 1-5). Departing from standard epistolary
practice, he strongly rebuked the Galatians for departing from the gospel he
had preached and they had received, pronouncing a conditional curse on those
responsible for leading them astray (vv 6-9).
He insisted that his gospel was of divine origin (vv 10-12), offering
evidence supporting this claim by way of selected anecdotes reporting his
encounters with the other human leaders of the church (1:132:15). He
stressed the contrast between his life before and after his encounter with the
risen Christ. He insisted that he had remained faithful to his divine calling to
preach the truth of the gospel to non-Jews. This meant resisting any attempt
to compel non-Jews to adopt Jewish customs and practices, particularly food
laws and circumcision. He did not hesitate to point out the failures of other
leaders to remain as steadfast.
Paul reminded the Galatians of their conversions, effected by the Spirit,
not feeble human efforts. This made incongruous their misguided efforts to
improve on what God had begun in their human strength (3:1-5).
Paul appealed to the scriptural example of Abraham to reinforce his
conviction that God put him in right relationship with himself on the ba-
sis of faith alone. Abraham received Gods promise that the Gentiles would
be blessed through him and his great descendant, Christ. God fullled that
promise by allowing Christ to experience the curse of crucixion so that those
who have faith might be blessed with the freedom given those who receive the
Spirit (vv 6-14).
Paul insisted that Gods later gift of the Law did not affect the terms
of the promise (vv 15-18). The Law was merely a temporary measure to pre-
serve Abrahams descendants until Christs coming. It was never intended as a
means of salvation (vv 19-24). Christ brought an end to the ethnic, economic,
S
A
M
P
L
E
46
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
and gender differences that separated people. Consequently, all who believe
may have a share in the promised gift of the Spirit (vv 26-29). Paul used the
analogy of a minor child coming to majority to illustrate that with the coming
of Christ all that had prevented Jews and non-Jews from enjoying the heritage
God had promised was a thing of the past (4:1-7).
Paul reminded the Galatians of their pagan past and urged them not to
return to the bad old days as virtual slaves to nongods. Renewed slavery would
be the net effect, if they turned to Law or returned to paganism (vv 8-11).
He urged them to follow his example as they had when they rst became
friends (vv 12-20). This would require them to prefer pleasing God to pleas-
ing people, becoming the free persons God had called them to be, embracing
the cross of Christ, and accepting the suffering it might bring as Christ was
formed within their communities.
Paul appealed to an allegorical reading of the story of Abrahams two
wives and sons to urge them to rejoice in their status as believers in Christ. As
the free children of Abraham, they were to accept the inevitability of persecu-
tion and resist anything that might compromise the salvation-freedom Christ
had given them (vv 215:1).
He urged them in particular to refuse the efforts of the Agitators to
have them circumcised, even if doing so meant persecution. The covenant of
circumcision would strap them with an obligation to fulll the whole Law. In-
stead, they were to allow their faith to express their freedom in loving service
to one another. By this means they would achieve what the Law command-
ed and avoid the self-destruction their current inghting over circumcision
would bring (5:2-15).
To this end, Paul urged them to allow the Spirit to transform them into
a community that would express the virtues consistent with their status as
followers of Christ. To depend on their own self-centered human resources
would make their lives miserable both for them and for all those around them
(vv 16-25).
Paul urged those who were genuinely spiritual to restore any who fell
into transgression, to put aside competitive comparisons, and to remain faith-
ful themselves (6:1-5). He asked them to be generous with all their assets,
sharing with those who needed their assistance (vv 6-10).
Paul closed the letter in his own handwriting. He urged the Galatians
to reject the overtures of the Agitators to have them circumcised. He insisted
that the Agitators were selshly motivated to avoid persecution. As followers
of his example, the Galatians were to embrace the cross and to treat the old
order as if they were dead to one another. All that really mattered was the new
creation Christ was bringing to reality (vv 11-18).
S
A
M
P
L
E
47
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-5
COMMENTARY
A. Prescript (1:1-5)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Galatians begins, as do all ancient Greco-Roman letters,
with a three-part prescript: senders, recipients, and greetings (see
White 1986). Paul expands and adapts these, anticipating con-
cerns to be further developed in each letter. Here he claimed that
his call to be an apostle was
not from men nor by man,
but by Jesus Christ and God the Father.
Paul used similar antithetical constructions (not x, but y) through-
out Galatians ( 1:12, 17; 2:6-7; 4:7, 8-9, 14, 31; 5:6, 13; 6:13,
15). Such formulations reect Jewish inuences on his rhetoric.
Speculation about supposed charges by his opponents is unhelpful
(Witherington 1998a, 6 n. 6; Matera 1992, 41; Introduction).
Pauls older Jewish contemporary Philo credits Moses with a
similar claim: I did not of my own free will choose to superintend
and preside over public affairs, nor did I receive the ofce through
appointment by some other of humankind, but when God by clear
oracles . . . made evident his will to me . . . (Virtues 63; translation
by Witherington 1998a, 73; for Hellenistic parallels: see Boring,
Berger, and Colpe 1995, 460).
I . LETTER OPENING (GALATIANS 1:1-9)
S
A
M
P
L
E
48
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-5
Acts (7:58; 8:1, 3; 9:1, 4; 13:9; 22:7, 13; 26:14) indicates that Pauls
name in Hebrew was Saul. As a Roman citizen (Acts 16:37; 22:25-28), Paul
(Paulos: little or small) probably had a three-part name (praenomen, nomen,
and cognomen). If Paul was not his nickname, it was likely his family name
(cognomen). We are never told his full name (Witherington 1998a, 72). He
may have borne both Greek and Hebrew names from birth.
Paul identied himself as an apostle. In Judaism after his time the He-
brew equivalent, shaliach, applied to a temporary envoy, who represented
in his own person the person and rights of the one who commissioned him
(Rengstorf 1964a, 415). Pauls use of apostle for a permanent, divinely ap-
pointed missionary may be its earliest instance in Greek (Witherington 1998a,
70).
It remains uncertain precisely where in Galatia the churches Paul ad-
dressed were situated ( Introduction). Knowing the ethnic and geographic
identities would not signicantly affect our interpretation. Stereotypes being
what they are, not all Gauls were foolish ( 3:1), nor all Cretans liars (Titus
1:5-14).
Pauls familiar Christian greetingGrace and peace (Gal 1:2)co-opts
and changes both Greco-Roman and Jewish conventions. Only a slight spell-
ing difference distinguishes the customary Greco-Roman Greetings from
Pauls Grace. But he invested the Greek word with a theological force it had
acquired only in the LXX. In secular Greek it referred to the graciousness
and charm of a beautiful woman as well as to the disposition to goodwill and
generosity (Spicq 1994, 3:500).
Jesus Christ is the centerpiece of Pauls theology. The formulation Lord
Jesus Christ presumes the early Christian confession, Jesus is Lord (Rom
10:9; 1 Cor 12:3; Phil 2:11). In Greco-Roman practice, the title kyrios, Lord,
was a term of respect for human masters, as well as a designation for divine
beings. Paul and other early Christians consistently read kyrios in the LXX (in
which it replaced Yahwehthe divine name of Israels God) as references to
Jesus (see Matt 3:3; 21:9; Mark 1:3; 11:9; Luke 1:17, 76; 3:4; John 1:23; Acts
2:21; 15:17; Rom 10:13; 15:11).
Paul described the salvation Christ brought as rescue . . . from the pres-
ent evil age (Gal 1:4) based on assumptions adapted from the two-age doc-
trine of Jewish apocalyptic (see 2 Esd [= 4 Ezra] 6:7-10; 2 Bar. 15:7-8). This
worldview contrasted the fading, present evil world-order with the new righ-
teous order God was bringing (see Rom 8:38; 1 Cor 3:22).
Fur t her Readi ng on Apocal ypt i c
Collins, John Joseph. 1998. The Apocalyptic Imagination: An Introduction to Jewish Apoc-
alyptic Literature. Rev. ed. Biblical Resource Series. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans.
Hanson, Paul D. 1979. The Dawn of Apocalyptic: The Historical and Sociological Roots
of Jewish Apocalyptic Eschatology. Rev. ed. Philadelphia: Fortress.
S
A
M
P
L
E
49
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-2a
Reddish, Mitchell G., ed. 1990. Apocalyptic Literature: A Reader. Nashville: Abing-
don.
Rowland, Christopher. 1982. The Open Heaven: A Study of Apocalyptic in Judaism
and Early Christianity. New York: Crossroad.
Russell, D. S. 1964. The Method and Message of Jewish Apocalyptic: 200 BCAD
100. Philadelphia: Westminster.
I N THE TEXT
1. Senders (vv 1-2a)
L 1-2a Ancient letters always placed the name of their senders rstthe op-
posite of modern convention. Eight of Pauls letters mention co-senders (1
Corinthians; 2 Corinthians; Galatians; Philippians; Colossians; 1 Thessalo-
nians; 2 Thessalonians; Philemon). In Galatians, they remain anonymous,
called only all the brothers with me. In Phil 4:21-22, Paul distinguished the
brothers who are with me from the other believers in the city from which
he wrote. In Philippians he probably referred to missionary colleagues (e.g.,
Ellicott 1863, 3) as opposed to nearby Christians in general. And this may also
have been the case in Galatians (Betz 1979, 40). But it is possible that Paul
referred to delegates from Galatia who had come to him and were being sent
back with the letter (Stirewalt 2003, 94-97).
We cannot know to what extent Pauls co-senders played any role in the
letters actual composition. In Galatians, he wrote almost entirely in the rst
person singular (I). In 1 Thessalonians, which names Silas and Timothy as
co-senders (1:1), the rst person plural (we) dominates. But this does not
seem to indicate co-authorship (see 1 Thess 2:173:5).
In Gal 6:11-18, Paul mentioned writing in his own hand. In antiquity,
professional scribes took dictation. Perhaps, one of the unnamed brothers
served as Pauls amanuensis, much as Tertius did in Romans (see 16:22). Un-
doubtedly, Paul discussed the problems in Galatia with his colleagues, even if
he alone put their consensus into words.
In the prescript of most Pauline letters (except Philippians, 1 and 2
Thessalonians, and Philemon), Paul further identied himself as an apostle
(see Rengstorf 1964a; Lightfoot 1874, 92-101). The verbal noun apostle refers
to one sent to represent another. Pauls mission was taking the gospel to Gen-
tiles (1:15-16; 2:8; Rom 11:13; 2 Cor 5:19; 1 Thess 2:4-9).
Paul claimed to have become an apostle through the call of the risen
Christ (Gal 1:12, 16; 1 Cor 9:1; 15:9). Acts generally restricts the title to the
Twelve (1:21-26; but see 14:4, 14). But Pauls broader denition allowed him
to apply the title not only to himself but also to others not among the Twelve,
including:
Andronicus and Junia (Rom 16:7),
S
A
M
P
L
E
50
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-2a
Barnabas (1 Cor 9:1-6),
James ( Gal 1:19; see 1 Cor 15:7), and
perhaps others (see Phillips 2009, 146 n. 51).
At his call, Paul received the essential content of his gospel (Gal 1:12-13)
and the obligation to preach it (1 Cor 9:16). Like an OT prophet (see Isa 6:8;
61:1), an apostle spoke in behalf of God (see Bhner 1990, 143-44), as an
ambassador (2 Cor 5:18-20) representing the foreign policy of God.
Paul claimed that God called (see Gal 1:15; Rom 1:1) and sent him. If
his use of the term apostle was unprecedented, it almost certainly called for
clarication. He needed to explain that he was not merely the representative
of the church in Antioch (Acts 13:2-3; Witherington 1998a, 71) or any other
merely human agency. He represented only the Highest Authority.
Many commentators think Pauls claim was controversial. They assume
Pauls antithetically formulated assertions defend his right to the title apostle
against contrary claims by his opponents. Others question this reading: Why
did he nowhere else in the letter explicitly apply the title apostle to himself?
(Contrast Rom 1:1, 5; 11:13; 1 Cor 1:1, 17; 4:9; 9:1, 2, 5; 15:9.) And why in
Gal 1:17, 19 and 2:8 () did he not assert his apostolic status explicitly when
he had the opportunity? Instead, he omitted the term, when asserting it might
have strengthened his claim, had he needed it.
Perhaps, like Philos Moses, Paul described his ofce both negatively and
positively in the interests of clarity (see Bullinger 1898, 405). His repetitive
style merely appropriated the parallelism common in the OT.
On either reading, Paul claimed his calling to be an apostle came neither
from nor by any human, but by divine authorization. Grammatically, Pauls
antithetical repetition is an example of rhetorical pleonasmredundancy in
the interests of clarity (explainedand illustrated!). That is, he repeats his
single point positively and negatively to be sure he was understood, and not
misunderstood. If Paul made a single point, the variation between the plural
men and singular man has no particular signicance (so Arichea and Nida
1976, 4). He forcefully disallowed any human source for his apostolic call
direct or indirect.
Pauls specic style of antithesis (enantiosis) is a kind of pleonasm that
makes an afrmation by contraries involving opposites (Bullinger 1898,
718). That is, his point was in the positive halfhis claim to a divine calling
(see Rom 1:1). He frequently insisted upon the divine character of his apos-
tolate and message (see Rom 15:15-19; 1 Cor 2:4, 13; 1 Thess 1:5; 2:4, 13).
The human vs. divine antithesis is hardly unique to Galatians (see Rom 2:29;
3:4; 14:18; 1 Cor 1:25; 3:5; 13:1-3; 14:2; 15:47; 2 Cor 4:2; 5:11, 13; 8:21; Phil
2:5-7; 3:3; Col 2:7, 22; 3:23; 1 Thess 2:15; 4:8).
It is unnecessary to assume that Pauls antithetical formulation implied,
as those who read Galatians apologetically presume, that he denied everything
his opponents afrmed, and afrmed everything they denied. There is no evi-
S
A
M
P
L
E
51
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-2b
dence that his Galatian detractors tried to diminish his authority by claiming
his apostleship was of merely human origin, apart from the assumptions of
mirror-reading ( Introduction).
Pauls letters frequently refer to God as Father, especially in epistolary
prescripts, praise, and prayer (see Gal 1:3, 4; Rom 1:7; 15:6; 1 Cor 1:3; 8:6;
15:24; 2 Cor 1:2, 3; 11:31; Eph 1:2, 3; 4:6; 5:20; 6:23; Phil 1:2; 2:11; 4:20;
Col 1:2, 3; 3:17; 1 Thess 1:1, 3; 3:11, 13; 2 Thess 1:1, 2; 2:16; 1 Tim 1:2; 2
Tim 1:2; Titus 1:4; Phlm 3). Here he emphasized the Father-Son relationship
between God and Christ.
In Gal 1:3 Paul emphasized that God is also our Father. His concern
was not biological parentage in either v 1 or v 3. The title Father emphasized
Gods sovereign power as Creator, Ruler, and Redeemer. This usage reects
widespread Christian confessional and liturgical practice and the example of
Jesus (see Michel 1990; Schrenk 1967; Gal 4:6).
Appeal to the Father of Jesus Christ is always an occasion for the expo-
sition of salvation and blessing (Schrenk 1967, 1008) in Pauls letters. That
God the Father . . . raised Christ from the dead reects widely attested early
Christian confessions (see Acts 3:15; 4:10; 13:30; Rom 4:24; 6:4, 9; 7:4; 8:11;
10:9; 1 Cor 6:14; 15:12, 13, 15, 16, 20; 2 Cor 4:14; Eph 1:20; Col 2:12; 1
Thess 1:10; 2 Tim 2:8; 1 Pet 1:21; Pol. Phil. 2.1, 2; 12.2). His resurrection is
central to Christian faith.
This is the only mention Paul made of resurrection in Galatians. Else-
where, he focused on the cross, which occasioned its necessity. Letter pre-
scripts often (like rhetorical exordia) introduce central points of the corre-
spondence. So we must ask why Paul brought up resurrection here. It is not a
standard xture of his letter openings (only in Rom 1:4; 2 Cor 1:9; Eph 1:20;
1 Thess 1:10). References to the second coming are as common (1 Cor 1:7;
Phil 1:6; Col 1:12-13; 2 Thess 1:9-10).
Pauls mention of resurrection emphasizes that the end times had
dawned, giving urgency to the present. The new creation had begun ( Gal
6:15). The resurrection conrmed that the crucied one was the long-awaited
Messiah. The age of waiting until (3:19, 23; 4:2, 19) was over; the time had
fully come (4:4). God had sent the promised Spirit to his people (3:5; 4:6).
The time for Law was past. They were free!
2. Recipients (v 2b)
L 2b Pauls letter addresses the churches in Galatia. His other community
letters address a Christian community in a designated city (Rom 1:7; 1 Cor
1:2; 2 Cor 1:1; Phil 1:1; Col 1:2; 1 Thess 1:1; 2 Thess 1:1). He greeted as a
church only the communities in Corinth and Thessalonica (contrast Rom
1:7; [Eph 1:1bthe city name is textually suspect;] Phil 1:1b; Col 1:2). Ga-
latians alone explicitly refers to churches in a geographical region (see 1 Cor
16:1; 2 Tim 4:10; 1 Pet 1:1).
S
A
M
P
L
E
52
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:2b-3
Paul shows no interest in the etymological derivation of ekkle3sia, church.
The term never means called out ones (see Barr 1961, 119-29), but an as-
sembly of people (see Acts 19:32, 39 for secular uses), specically a Christian
congregation, the gathered people of God (see Roloff 1990).
Elsewhere in Galatians, Pauls only other reference to churches refers to
the Christian communities in Judea ( 1:13 and 22). The nature or mission of
the church is never discussed. But he addressed what it meant to be the people
of God (see Martin 2007) as fully here as in 1 and 2 Corinthians, where the
term church appears frequently. Galatians draws from a different repertoire
of images than that of the body of Christ or the bride of Christ, which domi-
nate Ephesians (see Lyons 2007).
3. Greetings (vv 3-5)
L 3 The greeting Grace and peace, with only minor variations, appears in
all of Pauls community letters (Rom 1:7; 1 Cor 1:3; 2 Cor 1:2; Eph 1:2; Phil
1:2; Col 1:2; 1 Thess 1:1; 2 Thess 1:2). A slight spelling change allowed Paul
to adapt the customary Greco-Roman Greetings, chairein, used in everyday
encounters and in letters (see 1 Macc 12:6; Acts 15:23; 23:26; Jas 1:1), creat-
ing a distinctively Christian blessing, Grace, charis ( Gal 1:6, 15; 2:9, 21;
5:4; 6:18).
For Paul, the abstract noun grace comprehends all of Gods gifts freely
provided in Christ (see 1:6; 2:21). This implicit prayer is that God in Christ
may deal favorably with his audience (Betz 1979, 40; Winger 1999, 153).
To grace Paul added a translation of the customary Jewish greeting, Shalom,
peace (see Judg 19:20; 1 Sam 25:5-6; Dan 4:1; 10:19; Tob 12:17; Greek: eire3 ne3 ;
Gal 5:22; 6:16). Precedents occur in Num 6:24-26; 2 Macc 1:1; 2 Bar. 78.2;
parallels in 1 Pet 1:2; 2 Pet 1:2; 2 John 3; Rev 1:4). Christian experience could be
characterized as peace with the God of peace (see Rom 5:1; 8:6; 15:33; 16:20; 1
Cor 7:15; 14:33; 2 Cor 13:11; Phil 4:7, 9; 1 Thess 5:23).
God our Father and the Lord Jesus Christ were the source of both Grace
and peace, as they were of Pauls apostleship (Gal 1:1). The possessive pro-
noun our in vv 3 and 4 includes all Christians. Gentile believers could also
claim God as their Father (Jervis 1999, 33-34).
Whenever Paul identied God as our Father, he always mentioned Jesus
Christ as Lord (Schrenk 1967, 1007). The prepositions varyby and from
in vv 1 and 3, probably for stylistic reasons. But their meaning is identical. By
joining God and Christ as objects of the same preposition, Paul emphasized
the essential equality of Father and Son.
Lord identies Jesus with the unutterable name of Israels God (Yah-
weh, in Phil 2:9-11 and Rom 14:9-11, both echoing Isa 45:23). The Greek
OT facilitated the churchs high Christology, but it did not initiate it. The
Aramaic prayer, Marana tha, Come, O Lord! (1 Cor 16:22), suggests that
Jesus was rst addressed as Lord among Jewish Christians. The title implies
S
A
M
P
L
E
53
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:3-4
that the exalted Jesus is on a par with Yahweh, yet not identied with him
(Fitzmyer 1990, 330).
That Jesus is Lord entailed more than a theological afrmation. It had
ethical implications, conceding his right to rule and our obligation to obey
him. But it also implicitly denied the political claims of lesser allegiances, like
those made for Caesar in Roman emperor worship (see 1 Cor 8:5-6).
L 4 Paul elaborated on Christ (v 3), adding that he gave himself for our sins
(see Mark 10:45; John 3:16; Rom 4:25; 8:32; Eph 5:2, 25; 1 Tim 2:6; Titus
2:14). This implicit reference to the crucixion becomes explicit and personal
in Gal 2:20 (with an intensied form of the Greek verb gave; 2:20).
Pauls language in both 1:4 and 2:20 emphasizes that Christs death for
our sins (see 1 Cor 15:3; Rom 4:25; 5:6, 8, 10; 8:34; 2 Cor 5:14) was volun-
tary and gracious ( 2:21). Christ was not coerced by the Father. And we
were wholly undeserving of his gift. Paul took for granted that all humans are
sinners (defended in Rom 1:183:23; 5:8), not only Gentiles (Gal 2:15, 17;
see Mark 14:41).
Paul attached no particular theological signicance to the preposition
hyper, for, here ( 3:13). It cannot support the doctrine of the vicarious, sub-
stitutionary atonement (demonstrated persuasively by Powers 2001, 54-58,
71-79; against Boice 1976, 427). This would seem to require the preposition
anti, instead of (see Lightfoot 1874, 73). Rather, hyper describes Christs death
as both for our sins (v 4) and for me (2:20; Rom 4:25 uses the preposition
dia). He died because we sinned.
Christs death rescued us according to the will of our God and Father.
Paul insisted that God chose to rescue us; but he did not explain why God re-
quired such an atoning act for human sins in order that fallen humanity could
be saved (Witherington 1998a, 76).
The plural form of sins is uncharacteristic of Paul. The Greek hamartia
appears sixty-four times in his letters, but only twelve times in the plural. Of
these, two are in OT quotations (Rom 4:7; 11:27); one quotes a Christian con-
fession (1 Cor 15:3); and ve appear in letters of disputed Pauline authorship
(Eph 2:1; Col 1:14; 1 Tim 5:22, 24; 2 Tim 3:6). That leaves Rom 7:5; 1 Cor
15:17; Gal 1:4; and 1 Thess 2:16.
Paul preferred to speak of Sin as a personied, almost demonic power
(Grundmann 1964, 311). He treated Sin as more than a failure to achieve
a standard or even than becoming and being guilty before God and ones
peers (Fiedler 1990, 66). Not only are sins bad choices, but they also identify
humans as hopelessly trapped victims in a fallen worldas slaves to Sin.
The purpose for which Christ died was to rescue us from the present
evil age. Only here in the NT is the expression translated present . . . age
implicitly contrasted with the coming age (e.g., Matt 12:32; Mark 10:30; Eph
1:21). Thus, it has much the same force as this age (1 Cor 1:20) or this
world (Rom 12:2).
S
A
M
P
L
E
54
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:4-5
By the gift of the Spirit, Christians already breathe the fresh air of the
new age of fulllment (see Gal 3:14; 4:4-6; 5:5, 16-25; Col 1:13). But the
evil age continues as a present reality. With the new creation (Gal 6:15),
Christ brought the powers of the coming age (Heb 6:5) into this world. The
kingdom of God as righteousness, peace and joy in the Holy Spirit already
exists (Rom 14:17). The last days, inaugurated by the death and resurrection
of Jesus, are now visible in the transformed lives of believers (Witherington
1998a, 77).
Pauls reference to the present age as evil refers to this secular human
way of living, in which sin has made a home (Theodoret, cited in Edwards
1999, 4). Thus, rescue does not mean escape from the material world, but
deliverance from domination by the ungodly world system (Louw and Nida
1989, 1:507 41.38; compare 1 Pet 1:18; John 17:13-19).
Christs mission of rescue was undertaken in order that he might set
us free. Paul personied the Present Age as a sinister slave master holding
humanity hostage. For now, the perverse world system persists, awaiting its
end. But it no longer holds sway over believers. Thus, he could claim: Through
the cross of Christ, the world has been crucied to me, and I to the world
(Gal 6:14).
The verb exaireo3, rescue, appears only here in Pauls letters (150 times in
the LXX; in the NT only in Acts 7:10, 34; 12:11; 23:27; 26:17). Christ volun-
tarily died to save us. But his death was according to the will of our God and
Father. It was neither suicidal nor accidental. It was a well-contrived Trinitar-
ian conspiracy to salvage humanity at great personal cost to God. The prepo-
sition kata indicates that Christs self-gift was in conformity with (BDAG,
512, s.v. B.5) what the Father wanted.
The conjunction and between the nouns God and Father does not dis-
tinguish them. Rather in this explicative use, it means that is (BDAG, 495,
s.v. 1.c). God is our Father (emphasis added), not simply the Father of our
Lord Jesus Christ ( Gal 1:1 and 3; compare Rom 15:6; 1 Cor 15:24; 2 Cor
1:3; 11:31; Eph 1:3; 4:6; 5:20; Phil 4:20; 1 Thess 1:3; 3:11, 13).
L 5 The prescript closes with a doxological relative clauseto whom be glory
for ever and ever. Amen (see Rom 16:27; Phil 4:20; 2 Tim 4:18; Heb 13:21; 1
Pet 4:11). The verb be is unexpressed but clearly assumed. The antecedent of
whom is God (Gal 1:3).
The word doxa, glory, in the LXX translates the Hebrew kabod), which
metaphorically describes God as radiant and weighty. Glory refers to his obvi-
ous perfection in goodness, saving grace (Rom 1:23; 3:7, 23), and power (6:4).
To give glory to God is not to bestow on him something he lacks. Glory is in-
nately his by the reality of his presence. To give God glory is to acknowledge
his existence and lordship (see Isa 1:3; 2 Bar. 48.40; 82.3-9).
English speakers still use the imagery of glory, although seldom the term
itself outside religious settings. An unusually intelligent person is bright,
S
A
M
P
L
E
55
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-5
even brilliant. A job well done is a shining performance. Celebrities are
stars. A student leader is a big man on campus. To wield power and inu-
ence is to throw ones weight around. Glory expresses the language of honor
and recognition. In honor-shame societies, like the ancient Mediterranean
world, those who were important possessed glory and deserved honor. To fail
to recognize this was to shame them (see Kittel 1964c, 232-55).
The expression forever translates a Greek idiom meaning (lit.) to the
ages of the ages. The proximity of the word age in Gal 1:4 may hint that Paul
urged his audience to praise God in this present evil age. They were not to
wait for future rescue but were to acknowledge what God had already done.
The Amen at this early point in the letter is surprising (see 6:18). Within
the worship setting in which it was rst read, this was an invitation to the as-
sembled Galatian congregations to give verbal afrmation: May it be so! Paul
would provoke their consternation soon enough.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Conventions. Back in the good old days, people actually wrote letters,
instead of sending email, updating their Facebook status, or dispatching text
messages. Everyone understood the conventions of letter-writing. We ad-
dressed total strangers as Dear but never closed business letters with Love.
A good deal of Gal 1:1-5 reects conventions of Pauls day. So, how seri-
ously should we take what he wrote here. How much of what Paul said merely
conformed to social expectations?
Because we have other letters from Paul, we know that they have simi-
lar beginnings. Convention dictated the basic three-part opening. But careful
examination reveals subtle differences between them. For example, Galatians,
like most of Pauls community letters, mentions co-senders. But only in Philip-
pians do Paul and his co-sender share the same title, servants of Christ (1:1).
Not surprisingly, Philippians emphasizes equality and servanthood. What
should the unique features of Galatians lead us to expect?
The differences between Pauls letters and those of his contemporaries
are also enlightening. Because we have read the rest of the NT, the greeting
Grace and peace does not strike us as unexpected. But the Galatians had no
NT. They would have noticed the unexpected variations from typical secular
letters.
Pastoral Care. Paul considered himself a missionary, a church planter
(Rom 15:20). But he gave pastoral care. Surprisingly, he wrote letters to con-
gregations he had founded after he had moved on. Galatians shows that Paul
was not interested in simply making converts. The obvious passion and pain
he communicated suggest that he did not espouse a doctrine of once-saved-
always-saved ( 5:4). But neither did he give up easily on his wavering con-
verts (see 4:19; 6:1-5).
S
A
M
P
L
E
56
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-5
Inspiration and Canonization. If it is remarkable that Paul wrote letters,
it is even more so that the church saw t to preserve and canonize them. The
literary genres in the OT include books of law, narrative, poetry, wisdom, and
prophecy. But no letters. Within a century after Paul wrote to churches in
particular places, churches throughout the Roman Empire were reading them
as they gathered for worship. By this repeated practice, the church came early
to recognize them as Scripture alongside the OT, not merely as letters of Paul.
Pauls readers across the centuries share his certainty that his message
was not simply a clever human invention. Wesleyans have always insisted that
the inspiration of Scripture is twofold. God inspired writers. But just as surely,
the Spirit inspires readers to recognize this inspiration.
Theological Subtleties. Pauls original audience probably heard rather than
read the letter. Would they have noticed Pauls subtle use of prepositions that
implied that God the Father and the Lord Jesus Christ were equally divine?
For an audience of former pagans, narrowing the scope of the divine from
many to just two gods would not have been a challenge. But for a Jewish
monotheist like Paul to hint that Christ was divine, if they caught it, must
have been surprising.
For those of us closely reading the letter this side of Nicea and the ecu-
menical creeds, the problem is the reverse. We may be troubled by Pauls ap-
parent binitarianism. Where is the third person of the Trinity?
It took the church more than four centuries to reach the consensus we
now recognize as Christian orthodoxy. Galatians is a preorthodox composi-
tion. Paul never imagined his letter would be scrutinized for Trinitarian preci-
sion. Trinity? Whats that? Nonetheless, Galatians provided proto-orthodox
believers with some of the data that compelled them to struggle to make sense
of their apparently paradoxical convictions: God was one. But God had re-
vealed himself as Father, Son, and Holy Spirit.
Reading Anothers Mail. As we read Pauls impassioned letter, we cannot
escape the awareness that we are reading anothers mail. And if he makes us
squirm at times by the vigor with which he presses his case, we can only guess
what it must have been like to have been among those rst stunned and stung
and stirred and silenced as they heard the letter read.
The opening lines of the letter, however, give few clues as to the tone the
apostle will shortly take. It begins as most ancient letters do. It is tempting to
skip over such preliminaries to get to the real meat. But if we do, we will miss
the central point Paul wanted to impress upon his audience.
Apostolic Authority. From at least the second century, as the church be-
came increasingly institutionalized, interpreters wrestled with the implica-
tions of Pauls claims to unmediated apostolic authority. Interest was piqued
again as the Reformers appealed to the apostle in their struggle with hierarchy
of the Roman Catholic Church (see Riches 2008, 71-75).
S
A
M
P
L
E
57
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:1-5
Even if Pauls more generous (compared to Lukes) views of the quali-
cations necessary for apostleship are accepted, there are no living apostles
today. Those with a divine call to preach the gospel, even to plant churches
where Christ has not been proclaimed before, lack one essential qualication:
a personal encounter with the risen Lord (1 Cor 9:1). Paul claimed these had
ended (15:3-7).
Protestants generally consider the Bible (particularly the NT, the re-
pository of the apostolic witness) to embody the authority that belonged to
apostles before the biblical canon was settled. Catholics vest that authority in
the Magisterium, the consensus teaching of the church across the ages. Protes-
tants, reluctant to assign such authority to tradition, concede that early creeds
and fathers of the church provide essential guidance as to how to resolve the
ambiguities of Scripture in an orthodox manner.
A so-called high view of Scripture is often thought to emphasize words
like inerrancy and infallibility. But these are claims the Bible never makes
for itself. Those who take seriously Galatians as an apostolic letter will submit
to its authority. Wesleyans appropriately acknowledge the role of tradition, ex-
perience, and reason in the formulation and validation of Christian doctrine.
But Scripture remains normative for Christian faith and practice.
Nonetheless, even apostles speaking for God must be interpreted. Paul
acknowledged in 1 Cor 5:9-13 that what he had written the Corinthians in
an earlier letter (now lost?) had been misunderstood. If his contemporaries
needed assistance, our interpretations cannot claim infallibility. We must not
presume that our reading of Paul speaks for God.
Speaking for God. Galatians is an apostolic letter. Paul spoke not for him-
self, but in behalf of the God who had called him to his mission. He spoke
not to outsiders, but to those who knew that the story of the cross (Gal 1:4)
preceded the wonder of the resurrection (v 1), despite the order in which he
mentioned them. He could use terms like grace and peace, sins and rescue,
and glory and Amen, condent that his readers knew what he meant. Are
members of our churches as well instructed (see 6:6)?
Most preachers could learn from Paul to speak with greater clarity. Mak-
ing the same point both positively and negatively helped assure that his aural
audience would not misunderstand him. Rhetorical repetition can be over-
done, of course. But who could miss the apostles emphasis here?
Some contemporary preachers would do well to be more cautious about
claiming to speak for God. If 1 Cor 15:8 is taken seriously, we must admit
that no one since the rst century speaks with anything like apostolic author-
ity. All claims of latter-day revelations must be tested by their faithfulness to
Scripture and to Christ (see 1 Thess 5:19-22; 1 Cor 12:1-3).
Overcoming Evil. Pauls description of salvation as rescue . . . from the
present evil age (1:4) gave an unfortunate foothold within Christian theol-
ogy to various forms of dualism. Proto-orthodox voices successfully resisted
S
A
M
P
L
E
58
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1: 6-9
gnostic explanations of evil. The ecumenical creeds begin by confessing God
as the Creator in direct challenge to gnostic claims that creation was the un-
fortunate work of a misguided, if not evil, lesser deity. The churchs efforts
to resist dualism continued from the patristic period into the modern era (see
Riches 2008, 77-82).
Dispensational premillennialism is perhaps the most virulent and in-
sidious form of dualism threatening contemporary evangelical Christianity. Its
novel eschatology rst appeared in the mid-nineteenth century. Early Chris-
tians expected the kingdom of God to invade and renew the present evil age.
Dispensationalists, instead, hope for a secret rapture that will spirit believers
out of this world (see MacPherson 2000).
Gospel Diplomacy. Paul knew that what he planned to write next would
be difcult to take. So he attempted to get his audience to afrm the truth of
his message from the outset. Imagine with me. Pauls designated reader in the
various churches of Galatia has just intoned the familiar words, to whom be
glory for ever and ever. Almost spontaneously, his Greek-speaking congrega-
tions must have found themselves repeating one of the few Hebrew words
they knew: Amen. How long did it take for their Amen to become ouch?
Before Paul turned to the difcult task of calling his agitated audience
back to the truth of the gospel (2:5, 14), he afrmed their Christian stand-
ing. He reminded them of what they shared. God was our Father (1:3, 4).
Christ died for our sins to rescue us (v 4). Later in the letter, we and you
will seem to stand at odds. But that is not where the letter begins or ends.
Before Paul pronounced a curse on anyone giving or receiving a false
so-called gospel in 1:6-9, he pronounced a conditional blessing on those who
would receive it: Grace and peace to you (v 3). And he would do much the
same before he closed the letter ( 6:16-18).
Most contemporary Christians seem oblivious to the power of such
prayers. These are just words. But Paul and his rst audience knew that
words did things. Some words resonate deep within us and empower us to
be and do what we otherwise could not. And some words leave deep wounds.
What could we learn from Pauls gospel diplomacy?
B. Epistolary Rebuke (1: 6-9)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Following the opening salutation in every other Pauline community let-
ter appears a thanksgiving / blessing. Its absence here would have been noticed
by the letters rst hearers. Epistolary thanksgivings in ancient letters typically
served as rhetorical exordia, introducing and anticipating key concerns of the
letter. This anti-thanksgiving serves the same function.
Paul expressed astonishment at unfortunate changes that had occurred
in the Galatian churches. He left these understated at rst, presuming his
S
A
M
P
L
E
59
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1: 6
Paul, Barnabas, and John Mark were set apart as missionaries by the
church in Antioch (13:1-3).
Pauls missionary travels took him through Cyprus (13:4-12), Pam-
phylia (13:13-14a; 14:24-28), Pisidia (13:14b-51; 14:21-23), and Lyca-
onia (13:5114:20).
The cities of Perga (13:13), Pisidian Antioch (13:14), Lystra, Der-
be, and Attalia (14:6) were technically located within the southern
boundaries of the Roman province of Galatia. Acts, however, seems
to reserve that designation for the northern part of the province (see
16:6; 18:23).
i
During his time in Cyprus, Paul abandoned his Jewish name, Saul
(13:9).
i
Non-Christian Jewish opponents repeatedly badgered the missionar-
ies, stirring up persecution against them (13:44-51; 14:2, 4-5, 19-20).
The church in Antioch experienced dissension and debate occasioned
by the visit of certain individuals . . . from Judea who taught: Unless
you are circumcised according to the custom of Moses, you cannot be
saved (15:1 NRSV).
Paul, Barnabas, and others were sent by the church at Antioch to Jeru-
salem to resolve the matter (15:2-3).
I N THE TEXT
L 21 In Greek, the verse begins as do 1:18 and 2:1 with Then (Epeita, so NIV
2011). This marks the transition to the second in a series of three chronologi-
cally ordered events. Paul went into the region of Syria and of Cilicia (see
Acts 15:41; see Rendall 1903, 157; Witherington 1998a, 124). Paul included
the secondhand report that he was preaching the faith he once tried to de-
stroy (Gal 1:23). That is, he was fullling his divine calling to preach Christ
among the Gentiles.
During Pauls era Syria referred to the geographical region between the
Euphrates River in the east and the Mediterranean Sea in the west, between
the Taurus Mountains in the north and Palestine to the south. This would
have included parts of modern Iraq, Syria, Jordan, Lebanon, and Turkey.
When the Romans assumed control of the Middle East in 64 B.C., Syria
became a Roman province. This also comprised eastern Cilicia, Galilee, Sa-
maria, Judea, and Idumea. Major cities included Antioch, Syrias capital, and
Damascus, both important urban centers of Hellenistic Judaism.
The NT normally uses Syria to refer to the region, rather than the prov-
ince (except Luke 2:2; Balz 1990b, 311-12). Cilicia was the southeastern re-
gion of Asia Minor (modern Turkey), which included its capital, the important
university city of Tarsus, Pauls birthplace (Acts 9:11, 30; 11:25; 21:39; 22:3).
Martyn overemphasizes what Paul did not mention in v 21: Syrian An-
tioch, Galatia, and Barnabas (1997, 182-86, 217). He appeals to the argument
S
A
M
P
L
E
96
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:21-22
from silence to support his supposition that Paul founded the churches of Ga-
latia after the Apostolic Council (2:1-10) and the Antioch incident (vv 11-21).
But Pauls account of his rst visit to Galatia (4:13-15) does not mention his
later partners, Silvanus / Silas and Timothy (Martyn 1997, 185 n. 242). Thus,
it is difcult to date Pauls mission to Galatia on the basis of what he failed to
say here or elsewhere.
Map of Asi a Mi nor, Syri a and Ci l i ci a, and Cyprus
GALATIA
CAPPADOCIA
CILICIA-
SYRIA
THRACIA
ASIA
LYCIA
CYPRUS
Pessinus
Ankyra
Tavium
Tarsus
Antioch
Antioch
Lystra
Derbe
Iconium
0 50 100 150 200 mi.
0 100 200 300 km.
L 22 Mentioning only that he was elsewhere, Paul reported what was happen-
ing back in Judea in the meantime: I was becoming unknown personally to
the Christian churches of Judea. If Paul persecuted the Jerusalem church, he
could not have been entirely unknown to Judean Christians. After all, Jeru-
salem was in Judea.
The Greek idiom translated personally unknown is literally unknown
to the face (see 2 Cor 8:24 [lit.: . . . to prove to the face of the churches];
1 Thess 2:17). The Judean church had no direct contact with Paul after his
conversion (Hultgren 1976, 105-6; Berger 1990a, 181). They knew him only
by reputation. They had not seen him since he became a Christian preacher.
S
A
M
P
L
E
97
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:22-23
Fullling his calling among the Gentiles for more than a decade was making
him increasingly a stranger in Judea (Rendall 1903, 157).
What did Paul mean by describing the churches of Judea as in Christ?
Did he assume that, apart from the added phrase, Judean assemblies were
indistinguishable from synagoguesa word Paul never used in his letters?
He also never used the word Christian, which is probably the effective force
of the expression in Christ here. In 1 Thess 2:14, he referred to the churches
of God, which are in Judea in Christ Jesus.
Of course, Paul knew nothing of the later architectural, institutional,
denominational, and dogmatic baggage surrounding our uses of the word
churches. The Greek terms we translate church and synagogue both meant
assembly. Without modication, both Greek terms could just as easily refer
to civic gatherings as to congregations of religious adherents. Scholars debate
whether either term referred to the buildings that housed such gatherings
during the rst century. Pauls churches met in private houses and tenements
(see Banks 1980; Meeks 2003). And it is not clear that he would have dened
Christianity as a religion distinct from Judaism.
L 23 Paul reported on the only news circulating among the Judean church-
es about him: The one who formerly [see v 13] was persecuting us now is
preaching the faith he formerly was trying to destroy.
The formerly-now contrast introduced in v 10 reemerges here. The
quotation reiterated Pauls account of his former life as a persecutor of Chris-
tians (v 13) and his divine calling to preach Christ (v 15), mostly in the same
words and verb tenses. The report the Judean Christians heard probably origi-
nated from Jerusalem, following Pauls brief rst visit there (vv 18-20).
There are two curious changes from what he wrote earlier, both involv-
ing the faith.
Paul referred to preaching the gos-
pel, the gospel of Christ, or Gods
Son in vv 7, 8, 9, and 16.
But the Judean Christians quoted
in v 23 referred to his preaching the
faith.
Paul earlier referred to trying to
destroy the church of God (v 13).
The quotation spoke of his trying to
destroy the faith.
This use of the faith is unprecedented in Pauls early letters. In the rst
instance, the faith is the des quae creditor, the content of faith itself, the Chris-
tian religion (compare Acts 6:7; Eph 4:5; 1 Tim 1:19; 2:7; 3:9; 4:1, 6; 6:21;
Titus 1:1; 2 Pet 1:1; Jude 3, 20; Barth 1990, 94; Betz 1979, 80 n. 235). In the
second, the faith refers to the living body of believers (Rendall 1903, 157).
Paul did not persecute Christians because of their lax attitude toward
the Law or because the church taught salvation apart from the Law. Rather it
was the faith, the positive Christian proclamation of the church, the message
of Jesus as Messiah crucied and risen, which evoked Pauls response as a per-
secutor (Hultgren 1976, 102). He considered this Jewish sect, which believed
S
A
M
P
L
E
98
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:23-24
that a crucied (and therefore cursed; Gal 3:10; Deut 21:23) man was
Israels Messiah, a dangerous national apostasy (Hultgren 1976, 103). And
the claim that he was risen from the dead must have seemed patently absurd.
L 24 The Judean believers responded with awe upon learning of the unex-
pectedly radical transformation of Paul from persecutor to preacher. Such a
change must have been the work of God. Thus, Paul added: And they were
glorifying God because of me.
They praised the Source of renewal for Paul and relief for them. The
verb praised was literally gave glory, in the sense of recognizing and praising
one who possesses glory ( Gal 1:5). The imperfect tense emphasizes that
their praise was an ongoing expression of gratitude to God for the conversion-
call of Paul. Again, the God / humanity contrast emerges as a major theme of
the letter ( 1:1, 10-12, 15-16).
In v 15 Paul described his call in terms of Isaiahs prophetic vocation:
The LORD called me before I was born, while I was in my mothers womb he
named me (Isa 49:1b NRSV). Here, he may echo Isa 49:3: And he said to me,
You are my servant, Israel, in whom I will be gloried (NRSV; Lightfoot 1874,
86; see Harmon [2010, esp. 249-65], who argues that Pauls reading of Isa
4055 signicantly shapes his theological reections throughout Galatians).
The prepositional phrase en emoi, because of me, appears elsewhere in
Galatians with an apparently different force. In 1:16 Paul described Gods
revelation of his risen Son as in me or to me. The same Greek phrase appears
again in 2:20.
v
FROM THE TEXT
We can only guess what the meeting was like between Peter, the one-
time sherman from Galilee and most prominent disciple of Jesus, and Paul,
the former persecutor of Christians and recent convert. Paul did not say.
Two weeks was more than ample time to get acquainted. What moti-
vated Pauls visit? Was he after reconciliation between the former enemies?
Or, was he seeking more detailed informationparticulars about the life and
teaching of Jesus? Paul did not say. And what did Peter learn about Paul? And
where did James t into this meeting? We can only wonder. Paul collapsed
two momentous weeks into twenty-eight Greek words (vv 18-19) and leaves
us guessing.
Then, after all his lack of specics, what motivated Paul to swear before
God that his report of the meeting was accurate? The wild speculations of
scholars more than compensate for Pauls studied silence. If Paul wrote to
quell rumors about his fractious relationship with the leaders of the Jerusalem
church, as mirror-reading interpreters presume ( Introduction), this totally
uninformative summary would only have added fuel to the re. Scholars who
imagine Paul needed to insist upon his independence from Jerusalem can nd
ammunition here. Likewise, those who insist that Paul needed to defend him-
S
A
M
P
L
E
99
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
1:21-24
self against charges that he had not been dependent enough on Jerusalem can
offer this as further evidence for their theory.
Is there a lesson here about the danger of all conspiracy theories? Theo-
rists always bring more to the table than the evidence can possibly bear. A
sympathetic reader gives an author the advantage of the doubt.
Before we presume Paul was up to something else, we should recall what
he claimed motivated his autobiographical remarks in vv 10-12:
The gospel he preached was not a human creation. He received it by
divine revelation from Christ. As a servant of Christ, he was not after
human approval.
His conversion from a persecutor of Christians into preacher of Christ
proved it (v 13). Changing sides almost certainly did not enhance his
reputation with his contemporaries (v 14; see 5:11).
In response to Gods call to preach Christ to the Gentiles, he went
immediately into Gentile territory and nally began to do what God
had been preparing him for since his birth (1:15-17).
He delayed consulting with any of his new Christian colleagues in
Jerusalem for three years (vv 17-18).
Throughout vv 18-24 Paul continued to offer proof of his thesis: His of-
ce and his gospel were of divine, not human origin. He divulged none of the
details about his meeting with his fellow apostles in Jerusalem probably be-
cause they were irrelevant to the situation in Galatia. Besides, he was not out
to win human approval. He was not eager to impress his audience with who
he knew or what they had said or done. Only God could vouch for his private
actions and inner motives (v 20).
Did a similar reticence to parade his missionary triumphs in Syria and
Cilicia before the Galatians account for the dearth of details about his activi-
ties there (v 21)? Acts is not so silent. Paul is obviously its human hero.
While Paul was far away from Judea and unknown, he was doing what
God had called him to dopreaching the faith he once tried to destroy (v
23). And those who heard the story praised Godnot Paul (v 24). Again,
Paul proved his thesis: He was not concerned to please people, but to serve
Christ.
Could we learn from Paul to be more discrete in the way we tell our
Christian stories? Are the accounts of our faith journeys designed to bring
praise to God or to bring reected glory to ourselves? In our conversations, do
we drop names of important people and mention entertaining details from
our chats with them to impress our audience of our importance?
It is sometimes difcult to discern when silence is golden and when it
is cowardly yellow. As we will see soon enough, especially in 2:11-21, Paul
was certainly not afraid to offer relevant details about his relations with other
people, when loyalty to God was at stake.
S
A
M
P
L
E
100
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:1-10
In fact, Paul never claimed the men from James opposed him in An-
tioch. On the contrary, whoever they were, whatever they said, or whatever
they did, they lled Peter with fear for those of the circumcision. This caused
him to depart from his true convictions (vv 11-14). If the unnamed represen-
tatives of James condemned Peter for aunting Jewish dietary laws in violation
of the terms of the Jerusalem agreement (Betz 1979, 108), Paul did not say so.
He did not say Peter feared James or his representatives. He feared those of the
circumcision. There are reasons to believe they were not simply to be equated.
I N THE TEXT
L 11 The change of scenes from the previous incident is introduced by But
when, as in the account of Pauls conversion-call in 1:15-17. Here it begins
a report of Peters reverse-conversion. Both accounts are set outside Jerusa-
lem. Whereas God took the initiative in Pauls conversion, humans played the
leading roles throughout this incident. The divine-human and formerly-now
antitheses throughout the narrative continue.
Interpreters (Calvin 1841, 40; Munck 1959, 74-75; Ldemann 1984, 56-
58) have argued (for a variety of reasons) that the Antioch incident in 2:11-21
occurred before the Apostolic Council in vv 1-10. The aorist verb e3lthen in v
11 could be translated with a pluperfect force (see Moulton and Turner 1963,
86 7): When Peter had come to Antioch . . . So this reading is not impossible.
But in antiquity, narratives were presumed to be in their natural his-
torical sequence unless the narrator gave explicit indications to the contrary.
Interpreters who rearrange the order may not be guilty of special pleading
(Witherington 1998a, 118), but they certainly must bear the burden of proof.
The incident began with Peters visit to Antioch. Paul offered reasons for
both his visits to Jerusalem (in 1:18-20 and 2:1-10). But he never explained
why Peter visited Antioch ( 2:9). Here, as always in his letters (except vv
7-8), Paul used Peters Semitic name, Cephas.
Although Antioch of Syria has not been previously mentioned in the
narrative, there is no reason to doubt Acts account of the origins of the church
or Pauls shared leadership role within it. Pauls second visit to Jerusalem prob-
ably brought him from Antioch ( vv 1-10). This church sponsored the early
missionary travels of Paul and Barnabas (Acts 13:1-3; 14:24-28; 15:1, 22-23,
30, 35; Gal 1:21 for a map of Syria; see Norris 1992; Betz 1979, 104-5; and
Longenecker 1990, 65-71, about Antioch).
Before Paul described anything Cephas specically said or did in An-
tioch, he anticipated the outcome of the entire incident with his opening sum-
mary generalization: When Peter came to Antioch, I opposed him to his face,
because he stood self-condemned. What happens face-to-face is clear, open,
direct, and public (Berger 1990a, 181). This sets up an implicit contrast be-
tween this incident and what happened privately in Jerusalem (2:2).
S
A
M
P
L
E
132
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:11-12
Paul took a stand against Peter. That is, he publicly accused him of mis-
conduct, because it had become obvious that he was clearly in the wrong. Paul
claimed Peter had convicted himself by his inappropriate behavior. Sociologi-
cally, such a public confrontation during a church gathering would have been
more awkward in the rst century than in the twenty-rst. Paul was prepared
to shame Peter publicly. One or the other was bound to lose face. If Peter
failed to respond, he would lose face, unless the church at Antioch consid-
ered Paul Peters inferior. If so, Peter could ignore the challenge and shame
Paul. But if Peter responded negatively, and his fellow Jewish Christians ap-
proved, Paul would also lose face in Antioch. This action on Pauls part was a
gamble in any case (Witherington 1998a, 151).
L 12 Paul introduced the evidence of Peters transparent guilt (v 11). Peters
wafing behavior was a reverse-conversion. He changed positions because he
feared the opinions of others. The familiar before-after and divine-human an-
titheses continue ( 1:10):
For before certain people came from James, Peter customarily ate to-
gether [see Luke 15:2; Acts 10:41; 11:3; 1 Cor 5:11] with the Gentiles.
But when they came, he gradually began to withdraw and separate
himself, because he was afraid of those of the circumcision.
The before clause refers to a one-time event. Its implicit subject is an
anonymous group, certain people. Given the patriarchal culture of the time,
the unnamed representatives of James who came to Antioch were undoubt-
edly males. That these men were from James suggests that the Lords broth-
er (1:19) had sent them to Antioch with his commendation (contrast Acts
15:24). Paul did not explain why they came or what they said or did there.
Their coming merely marked the change in Peters behavior. Only speculation
suggests that they demanded Peter to end his table fellowship with Gentiles
(so Betz 1979, 108).
The imperfect tense of the verb were eating together suggests that Pe-
ters practice of sharing meals at the same table with Gentiles had become cus-
tomary and continued for some time (see Acts 10:27-29; 11:2; Gal 2:12). Acts
11:18 reports that Peter justied his practice by appeal to divine revelation.
Why would the appearance of unnamed representatives of the putative leader
of the Jerusalem church in Antioch challenge Peters God-given convictions
and change his practice.
Paul never dened the nature of the meals at issue. It seems likely, how-
ever, that the meals Peter enjoyed with Gentile Christians were not simply
casual, haphazard events intended only to satisfy his hunger. They were prob-
ably quasi-religious ceremonial meals, set in the context of worship. Eating to-
gether dramatized and actualized the covenantal unity of the church as a sur-
rogate family. Shared meals demonstrated mutual trust, loyalty, and solidarity
(see Jude 12; see Luke 14:12-14; Acts 2:46; 6:1-2; Ign. Smyrn. 7-8; Ep. Apos.
15; Hippolytus, Trad. ap. 25-27; Did. 9-10; Diogn. 5; Tertullian, Apol. 39.16-
S
A
M
P
L
E
133
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:12
18; Clement of Alexandria, Paed. 2.1.4-9). The love feast was a fellowship
meal which was a principle occasion for charity to the poorer members of the
church (Ferguson 1992, 90).
Peters presence in Antioch seems puzzling, given the Jerusalem agree-
ment (Gal 2:9). But he was the apostle to the Jews (vv 7-9); and there was a
sizable Jewish population in the cityperhaps the fourth largest in the Roman
Empire at the time (Schrer 1890, 4:221-22). So he may have come to the
city to evangelize Jews and, naturally, participated in the communal life of the
mixed congregation there.
But James proxy-presence in Antioch is inexplicable. And if he was rep-
resented by believers advocating the circumcision of Gentilesthose from
the circumcision (2:12), it seems totally unexpected in light of the Apostolic
Council ( 2:1-10).
Paul offered no explanation for any of these unexpected visitors to An-
tioch. Unfortunately, the relation of the Jerusalem agreement . . . to the An-
tioch incident is less than clear (Dunn 1993, 122). It is unclear whether Peter
altered his eating habits because of the presence of the unnamed men from
James or because of their overt criticism of his behavior. Paul did not say.
And he did not identify the delegation beyond that they were from James.
Speculations differ widely as to why James sent them (see Lightfoot 1874, 112;
Rendall 1903, 162; Munck 1959, 106 n. 5; Betz 1979, 108; Bruce 1982, 130;
Longenecker 1990, 73; Dunn 1993, 119, 121; Martyn 1997, 233).
Peters reversal of his customary practice in Antioch coincided with the
visit of James emissaries there. But Paul credited Peters inconsistency to an-
other causefear: because he was afraid of those from the circumcision.
Who were these people? And are they to be identied with or distinguished
from James delegates?
In 2:7, 8, and 9 Paul used the circumcision as an ethnic designation for
Jews in contrast to Gentilesthe uncircumcision. But the designation
those from the circumcision seems to have a narrower reference here. After
all, both Paul and Peter were circumcised Jews (v 15). Peter had been divinely
empowered to preach to Jews (v 7) and recognized as an apostle to the Jews
(v 8). Why would eating meals with Gentiles make him fearful of fellow Jews
or Jewish Christians in Antioch or elsewhere?
Acts reports Peters successful justication of his practice of eating with
Gentiles in response to the criticism of those from the circumcision in Jeru-
salem on an earlier occasion (11:1-18). In v 2, the expression identies not
simply Jews, but Jewish Christians (i.e., circumcised believers).
Acts 15:1 refers to certain men who came down from Judea to Antioch.
They must be the believers who belonged to the party of the Pharisees at
the Apostolic Council (v 5). Not only were they circumcised, but they advo-
cated the circumcision of Gentile believers (v 1). James letter to the Gentile
believers in Antioch (v 23) insisted that those who had demanded their cir-
S
A
M
P
L
E
134
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:12
cumcision went out from us without our authorization (v 24). If Acts may be
trusted, the certain people who came down from James in Gal 2:12 must
be distinguished from the certain people (tines) of Acts 15:1. Instead, the
false brothers of Gal 2:4 must be those who advocated the circumcision of
Gentile believers in Acts 15:1 and 5 (Bruce 1982, 130).
Did James authorize the unnamed men who came from James men-
tioned in Gal 2:12? Or, did they merely appeal to James authority to enhance
their own? Are the men from James to be identied with those from the cir-
cumcision in v 12? Most interpreters simply assume the two designations refer
to the same people. Martyn (1997, 236-40) is one of the few who attempts to
offer evidence supporting the assumption.
But it seems more likely that Paul distinguished the two groups. Is it
plausible that James envoys were the Pharisaic Jewish Christians from Jerusa-
lem, the false brothers who tried to have Titus circumcised ( Gal 2:3-4)?
If so, how did this group, marginalized by the decision of the Apostolic Coun-
cil, come to represent James? Had they changed their minds, or had James
changed his?
Regardless, why did Paul offer no criticism of James or his emissar-
ies (see Schmithals 1965, 68)? Would it have been less serious for James to
change positions than for Peter to do so? If James changed sides, why did Paul
reserve his criticism solely for Peter and the Jewish Christians who joined him
in abandoning table fellowship with Gentile Christians?
Why did Paul not criticize James? Was it that James and his envoys acted
out of personal conviction (albeit mistaken in Pauls view), whereas Peter and
the other Jewish Christians acted out of convenience and compromise? Were
the former attempting to please God and the latter concerned only to please
people? What did James envoys say or do that caused Peter to be fearful
enough to reverse himself? We can only guess.
Why Di dn t Paul Cri t i ci ze J ames ?
Some interpreters hypothesize that Paul failed to criticize James and his
delegates because he was out of the city, evangelizing in Galatia, when they ar-
rived in Antioch. When he returned, Peter and the other Jewish Christians had
already broken fellowship with the Gentiles. Otherwise, Paul would have con-
fronted them all before the crisis got out of hand (Burton 1920, 109-10; Wither-
ington 1998a, 150, 155).
Most assume that those from the circumcision are the same people iden-
tied as James Jewish Christian representatives in Antioch. But a few dissent-
ers (e.g., Bruce 1982, 130-31; Longenecker 1990, 74-75; McKnight 1995, 104;
Witherington 1998a, 155) suggest instead that James agents made Peter fearful
of another group of non-Christian Jewish militants (Bruce 1982, 131). It was
not James demands that terried Peter, as Betz speculates (1979, 108), but the
warning they delivered.
S
A
M
P
L
E
135
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:12-13
It is possible that James people warned Peter that his fraternizing with un-
circumcised Gentiles put him and them (i.e., Jewish Christians in Judea) in danger
from zealous Jewish advocates of circumcision (see 5:11; 6:12; Bruce 1982, 130;
see Schmithals 1965, 66-68; Jewett 1970). Peter was not afraid that his careless
disregard for kosher laws in Antioch would result in a tongue-lashing from James
on his return to Jerusalem. Rather, he feared for his life and the survival of Jewish
Christianity due to threats from Jewish insurgents.
This interpretation, speculative though it is, spares James from guilt for
changing positions or otherwise violating the terms of the agreement reached at
the Apostolic Council. And it explains why Paul did not criticize him. But like the
majority view, it is only a plausible guess. Paul never said what prompted Peters
panic attack that led to his hypocrisy (v 13).
Peters about-face in Antioch did not happen overnight. The imperfect
tense of the two verbs describing his changed behavior suggests it was progres-
sive. Over a period of time, he gradually began to withdraw and separate
himself. His presence at communal meals with Gentile believers became in-
creasingly infrequent, until he nally stopped attending.
The LXX of Hab 2:4 uses the rst verb, hypostello3, draw back, as the an-
tithesis of faith. In Gal 3:11, Hab 2:4 features prominently in Pauls exposition
of justication by faith (see Rom 1:17; Heb 10:38). In secular Greek, the verb
referred to tactical military retreats or pragmatic political maneuvers (BDAG,
1041). Peters convictions remained unchanged, but he found it politically ex-
pedient to hide them (Betz 1979, 108).
The second verb, aphorizo3, separate, is a Jewish technical term describ-
ing cultic separation from the unclean (see 2 Cor 6:14; Betz 1979, 108). It is
from the same cognate family as the proper noun Pharisees ( 1:15; see Acts
15:5; Dunn 1993, 122; Kellermann 1990a, 184).
Peter chose a course of action strategically designed to relieve his fears.
He retreated to the safety of his former Jewish lifestyle, adhering to Israels
dietary and purity regulations. As Paul saw it, he did this for all the wrong
reasons: Was he more concerned to please people than God (Gal 1:10)? Was
he avoiding persecution (see 5:11; 6:12) by resorting to the self-serving pre-
tense he had during the trial of Jesus (Matt 26:69-75 || Mark 14:66-72 || Luke
22:54-62 || John 18:15-27)?
L 13 Paul used the term Jews for the rst time in the letter. All the members
the groups mentioned in vv 12 and 13 were of Jewish ethnicity. (1) The rest
of the Jews here distinguishes Jewish Christians in Antioch from (2) the Jew-
ish Christian envoys from James and (3) from those from the circumcision
(whether Christian or non-Christian) ( v 12).
Peters gradual abandoning of communal meals with Gentile believers
led the other Jewish-Christians in Antioch immediately to do the same. As
Paul saw it, the change meant that they had joined Peter in his hypocrisy. He
S
A
M
P
L
E
136
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:13-14
implied that neither Peter nor the other Jewish Christians acted sincerely.
They did not really consider it inappropriate to share meals with Gentiles.
They quit doing so, not out of conviction, but because they were intimidated,
whether by James representatives or the circumcision group ( v 12).
Paul indirectly charged the Jewish Christians of Antioch with being
more concerned about what humans thought than what God thought. They
only feigned allegiance to legal regulations maintaining the boundaries sepa-
rating Jews and Gentiles. But they did so out of self-interest.
Paul seemed less than surprised by Peters vacillation on the issue. Per-
haps he had learned of Cephass history of failure as a disciple during their
two weeks together in Jerusalem years earlier (1:18-20). Peters reputation as
leader of the Jewish-Christian mission (2:7-9) may explain why the others fol-
lowed his lead. But it is possible that whatever gave Peter cold feet about eating
with Gentiles sent chills up their spines as well. In any event, they joined him
in backing off from Antiochs open stance toward Jewish-Gentile relations.
Paul seemed genuinely astonished by just one result of Peters backslid-
ing. It was that by their hypocrisy even Barnabas was led astray. Barnabas
irrational accommodation to his former Jewish lifestyle conveyed a message of
pretentious superiority. He was not manipulated like the other Jewish Chris-
tians; he was misled by his emotions (Betz 1979, 110). His withdrawal implied
that Jews were better than Gentiles (v 14).
In the LXX, hypocrisy (see Job 34:30; 36:13) refers to conduct that is
not determined by God and is thus godless. If Paul used the word with this
connotation in mind, it is no wonder he considered the insincere withdrawal
of Jewish Christians from table fellowship with Gentile Christians a betrayal
of the gospel (v. 14) and thus an expression of unbelief (cf. also vv. 15-17)
(Giesen 1990). Those faithful to the gospel prefer Gods approval to human
approval (Gal 1:10).
L 14 Paul contrasted the behavior of Peter and the other Jewish Christians
(vv 11-13) and what Paul did when he saw their outrageous behavior. What
Peter and the other Jewish Christians did was more serious than hypocrisy
(v 13): they were not acting in line with the truth of the gospel (v 14). These
Jewish Christians had strayed from the right path. They had abandoned the
truth of the gospel by effectively surrendering Christian freedom. Unlike Paul
in Jerusalem, they gave in to the forces of slavery ( 2:4-5; 5:7).
Obviously, neither the truth nor the gospel is merely a matter of words.
Pauls concern was not merely orthodoxy (Betz 1979, 110), but orthopraxis.
The Christian message has practical implications that call for a way of liv-
ing consistent with that message (Schlier 1965, 85-86). The gospel was the
truth. But he emphasized not only the true understanding, but the practice of
the gospel. Peter and the other Jewish Christians had violated this by treat-
ing Gentiles as second-class Christians. Whatever their beliefs, their practice
S
A
M
P
L
E
137
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:14
implied that pagans had to become Jews and follow Jewish ways to be fully
Christian.
When Paul realized ( 2:7) the potential fallout that could result from
Jewish Christians abandoning table fellowship with Gentile Christians, he
spoke up. So far as he reported, he said nothing to James representatives nor
to the other Jewish Christians who had merely followed Peters bad example.
Peter alone was singled out as the target of Pauls scathing rhetoric.
Paul framed his response to Peter as a rhetorical question within a con-
ditional sentence: If you, although you are a Jew, are living like a Gentile
and not like a Jew, how can you try to compel Gentiles to live like Jews?
Rhetorical questions do not call for answers. This one is an implicit accusation,
in effect: You cant be a good Jew and do that! He addressed Cephas directly,
using the emphatic second person singular pronoun you. For an observant Jew
to eat with Gentiles was a agrant violation of the call to holiness. He was not
observing the expected boundary markers. Paul took this as evidence enough
that Peter did not live like a Jew but like a Gentile.
The protasis (if-clause) stated the obvious: Cephas had abandoned his
former Jewish way of life in Antioch. Thus, Pauls If actually meant Since. Ce-
phas concealed his identity as one born and bred a Jew (Lightfoot 1874, 114).
The adverbial participle, existing as a Jew, has a concessive force. It points out
the inconsistency between Peters ethnicity and lifestyle: although you are a
Jew, you are living like a Gentile.
The apodosis (conclusion) clause poses a rhetorical question about the
incongruity of Peters behavior: How is it that you are trying to compel Gen-
tiles to live like Jews? In questions denoting disapproval or rejection, po3s
[How] challenges, How dare you? (BDAG, 901, s.v. 1ag).
By regularly eating with Gentiles, Cephas gave no indication that he
considered himself obliged to observe Jewish purity laws requiring separation
from them. In this respect, at least, he was not living like an observant Jew,
but like a pagan. His table fellowship was only the external symbol of Cephas
total emancipation from Judaism (Betz 1979, 112).
So what was to be made of his return to Jewish customs? When he and
the other Jewish Christians in Antioch failed to observe the Torah, they lived
like pagans (vv 14-15). But they did not forfeit their salvation. Their practice
conceded that Christians are not justied by observing the law (v 16). Re-
turning to Law could not eliminate that concession. Instead, it implied that
Gentiles must become partakers of the Torah covenant (Betz 1979, 112).
Cephas had assumed the role of the false brothers at Jerusalem (vv
3-5). They had unsuccessfully tried to compel Titus to be circumcised (v 3).
Cephas was effectively compelling Gentiles to Judaize by the social pres-
sure of his bad example. Paul believed that if Jewish dietary laws were still
in force, one was obliged to keep the whole Law (see 5:3). Ironically, . . . by
attempting to preserve the integrity of the Jewish Christians as Jews, Cephas
S
A
M
P
L
E
138
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:14
was destroying the integrity of the Gentile Christians as believers in Christ,
forcing them to follow Jewish customs (Betz 1979, 112).
Paul almost certainly paraphrased his actual rebuke of Peter to make
it more applicable to the Galatian situation. What he said at the time may
have been something like: what your actions say to Gentiles is that Jewish
food laws are important and that they should adopt them too (Westerholm
2003, 367). We can only speculate as to whether, by calling public attention
to Peters inconsistency, Paul succeeded in persuading him to change his mind.
Paul did not say.
Di d Paul s Posi t i on Prevai l i n Ant i och?
Did Pauls challenging question prevent matters from getting worse in An-
tioch? There is no indication that Peters hypocrisy succeeded in forcing the Gen-
tile Christians of Antioch to live like Jews as Paul feared. But did it bring an end to
the shared table? Did segregated Jewish and Gentile Christian churches replace
the mixed community? Was Paul the only Jewish Christian who saw the negative
implications of Peters reversal? If so, it is difcult to claim that Pauls position
won the day (see the bibliography in Matera 1992, 91-92).
F. C. Baur (2003 [1845], 1:127-51) and the nineteenth-century Tbingen
School rst proposed the question (see Weiss 1959 [1917], 1:273-76; Bacon
1929). Today, perhaps a majority of scholars argue that Pauls silence about the
success of his challenge in Antioch indicates that he failed (e.g., Nock 1938, 110;
Bruce 1982, 79; Dunn 1993, 130; Witherington 1998a, 159). But why would Paul
need to gloat over his victory? He may have taken his own advice about gently
restoring a brother caught in a fault (Gal 6:1; George 1994, 181). Given what
we know of Peter from the Gospels, that he wavered in his understanding of
the Christian faith on this occasion is not surprising. Perhaps Pauls one public
rebuke of Peter was enough eventually to bring him around (Howard 2004, 43).
The abrupt end of the scene in Antioch (whether with 2:14 or v 21) allows
Peter no response to Pauls logic. Rhetorically Peter is rendered silent. . . . Con-
sequently, even if Paul lost at Antioch, . . . his argument on behalf of the gospel is
irrefutable (Matera 1992, 90).
And, even if Paul lost the debate, there is no reason to think, as do some
scholars, that he was forced to leave Antioch in disgrace and to strike out on an
independent mission. Betz correctly notes that the high regard for Paul in Acts
and in the letters of Ignatius, the bishop of Antioch, is difcult to understand, if
Paul was expelled from the Antioch church (Betz 1979, 111). Admittedly, these
authors were Gentile Christians. The reception history of Paul in later Jewish
Christianity is far less positive ( v 4 sidebar, The Rest of the Story).
Paul offered no excuses for Peters changed behavior in Antioch. His
role in the agreement reached at the Apostolic Council (see 2:1-10) makes it
entirely unlikely that Peter consciously intended to lead Gentile Christians
to adopt circumcision. We cannot know whether or not his intentions were
S
A
M
P
L
E
139
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:11-14
noble. Cephas may have been concerned only to avoid offending and further
alienating conservative Jewish Christians (as Paul advised in Rom 14). Or, his
motives may have been entirely self-servingto be spared the pain of criti-
cism from James / the ultraconservative faction of the Jerusalem church / of
the reprisals of Jewish zealots. Or, his motives may have been mixedcon-
cerned not only to save his own skin but also to spare the Jewish Christian
community in Judea from zealot reprisals.
Paul did not imply that Peter quit eating with Gentile Christians be-
cause he considered them unclean paganscontaminated, and despicable,
and abominable, as did some Jews (Jub. 22:16 OTP). Regardless of Peters
intentions, Paul considered the implications of his reversal for non-Jewish be-
lievers unconscionable. In Gal 2:15-21, he would explain why.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Reception History. From the earliest days of the church, Christian inter-
preters have struggled with the Antioch incident. Why did the Apostle Peter
behave so inconsistently? And why did the Apostle Paul rebuke him so sharply
and publicly? Were Pauls quarrelsome and vitriolic words properly Christlike
(see Matt 18:15-17)? Did he follow his own counsel about how to restore an
erring fellow believer (Gal 6:1; Longenecker 1990, 79)?
The early church fathers were forced to defend their leading apostles
against the attacks of both heretics and unbelievers. And they did so in dis-
ingenuous ways (Lightfoot 1874, 129). This controversy between the two
apostles was so painfully unedifying to some later fathers of the church that
they tried to remove the offence which it presented (Bruce 1982, 133). The
earliest efforts attempted to exonerate Peter:
Clement of Alexandria spared Peter by distinguishing him from Ce-
phas (Lightfoot 1874, 129-30; Riches 2008, 106).
Origen proposed that the dispute was entirely a ruse staged by the
apostles to condemn the Judaizers (Lightfoot 1874, 130; Riches 2008,
106-7).
i
Origen was followed by Chrysostom, Jerome, and others.
i
Augustine and Jerome exchanged a series of unbecoming public
letters, in which Augustine sharply took issue with Jerome, the
churchs senior biblical scholar at the time. He insisted that for
apostles to conspire to deceive was far more serious than Peters
moral cowardice and inconsistency. Later, Jerome quietly adopted
Augustines view (Lightfoot 1874, 131; Riches 2008, 107).
The interpretation of the Reformers Luther and Calvin reects their
own battles with the Roman Catholic Church and the papacy. Their major
concern was to exonerate Paul. Both charge Peter with a mortal sin and worse,
a heresy that if left uncorrected would have harmed the entire church (George
1994, 183-86; Riches 2008, 108-11).
S
A
M
P
L
E
140
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:11-14
Leaders Fail. We must acknowledge that even church leaders fail. We
do not need to engage in exegetical ingenuity to excuse either apostle for his
weaknesses or excesses. They were merely human. So were Jerome and Au-
gustine.
Pauls reminder that even Barnabas failed may have been encouraging
to the Galatians. The Galatians were not the only ones to have been misled.
For him it took only the powerful but unfortunately bad example of Peter. For
them it took pressure from the Agitators. And perhaps Barnabas should serve
as a warning to us: If Barnabas can fail, any one of us can.
Consistency Is Difcult. Peters character, as presented in the Gospels,
Acts, and Galatians, is remarkably consistent: He could be depended upon to
be inconsistent. This may explain why he found it so easy to accommodate to
a pagan culture and to revert to his former way of life equally easily. It takes
courage to live by the Spirit. There is a certain comfort that comes from liv-
ing strictly by the book. Peter wafed between the two ways. So do we (see
McKnight 1995, 112).
If Peter was inconsistent, so was Paul. His response to the errors of oth-
ers did not always and obviously reect the love he so eloquently hymned in 1
Cor 13. Consistency of theory and practice is difcult. Of course, we do not
know what he said to Cephas privately before confronting him publicly.
Hypocrisy vs. Reality. Ralph Waldo Emerson described foolish consis-
tency as the hobgoblin of little minds. But consistency is preferable to hy-
pocrisy. Our real creed is measured by our conduct. Do we practice what we
preach? (See Witherington 1998a, 165.)
Cultural Prejudice vs. the Truth of the Gospel. Peter and the Jewish Chris-
tians in Antioch found it easier to maintain their culturally ingrained prejudic-
es than to live out the truth of the gospel. The teaching of Jesus and the work
of the Spirit did not instantaneously overcome the habitual religious mind-set
these early Christians had acquired over a lifetime.
As the church has entered new missionary settings, it has repeatedly
been forced to address and redress cultural practices that are not theologically
indifferent. William Carey challenged the caste system in India in faithfulness
to Christ. Martin Luther King challenged American Christians to consider
the racial injustice on their own doorstep. And yet, half a century later, 11:00
A.M. Sunday morning remains the most segregated hour of the week in the
U.S. (see George 1994, 183).
There is no question that Western missionaries have sometimes been
guilty of wrongly imposing a veneer of Western culture on new converts in
the name of the gospel. Sorting out the difference between essentials and
nonessentials is no easier here and now than it was there and then in Antioch
(see Flemming 2005). Missionaries appropriately struggle to help converts in
male-dominated cultures see the injustice of sexism in the church. And yet
in the U.S., my female students divinely called to ministry must be at least
S
A
M
P
L
E
141
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:15-21
twice as good as their male counterparts to be seriously considered as pastoral
candidates. Who has the courage to confront us: How can you do that?
Peer Pressure. This is not just a problem for teenagers. The Jewish Chris-
tians of Antioch caved in under the pressure of Peters compelling reversal.
Adult Christians still struggle to deal with the freedom that has enabled some
believers to cross difcult social and cultural boundaries.
A former student and friend affectionately calls me his church-boy.
His pre-Christian experience gives him ready rapport with prison inmates and
drug addicts that my squeaky-clean background does not. His tattoos and long
hair frighten most Christians like me, until they get to know him. The Ameri-
can evangelical Christian subculture seems to think that all true believers will
think and talk and look like us.
Would pioneer missionary Hudson Taylor have accomplished all he did
in China had he not adopted the Chinese way of life? What about Harmon
Schmelzenbach in Africa or E. Stanley Jones in India? Before we pray that
Gods Spirit may grant us the same freedom that allowed them to distinguish
what was essentially Christian from what was culturally indifferent, recall: All
these modern examples faced severe criticism from their contemporaries for
their dangerous experiments in Christian freedom (see McKnight 1995, 113).
ii. The Implications (2:15-21)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
This passage is one of the more dense and debated passages in the entire
letter. Paul seems frequently to have used words and phrases as succinct sum-
maries of complex theological reections. There is always the danger that a
commentary on such a passage may require a commentary to make sense of it.
Where Does the Quotation End? Pauls address to Peter seems to continue
uninterrupted from 2:14 through 21 (Bruce 1982, 136). There are no quota-
tion marks in the Greek text. Some translations (like the NIV, NASB, and NRSV)
and commentatorsearly (Ellicott [1863, 36] citing Chrysostom, Theodoret,
and Jerome) and recent (e.g., Dunn 1993, 131-54; George 1994, 187-202)
close the quote only after v 21. But most (e.g., ESV, GNT, GW, HCSB, ISV, NAB, NCV,
NET, NJB, REB, TM; Betz 1979, 113-14; Longenecker 1990, 76-81)conclude
Pauls challenge to Peter after v 14.
Betz (1979, 113-14) overcondently (see Porter 1997, 541-47) identies
vv 15-21 as the rhetorical proposition of the letter. That is, he claims that it
summarizes Pauls argument to this point and introduces his arguments yet to
come. Regardless, there are sound reasons for treating vv 15-21 as a discrete
unit. It provides a smooth transition from the narrative background to the
central theological message of the letter.
To Whom Do the Pronouns Refer? Some scholars consider Pauls shifting
pronouns an important clue to the interpretation of the passage and the letter
S
A
M
P
L
E
142
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:15-21
as a whole (e.g., Kennedy 1984, 150; Witherington 1998a, 199). But it is de-
batable whether he used pronouns so consistently. The evidence of the entire
letter suggests that their specic antecedents must be determined contextu-
ally, on a case-by-case basis. The burden of proof would seem to rest on those
who assume he used pronouns uniformly.
In v 14 Paul directly addressed Cephas using the second person singu-
lar, you.
In vv 15-17 this gave way to his frst person plural, we confession.
i
This we could be limited to Peter and Paul (Dunn 1993, 132) or
include all Jewish Christians (Longenecker 1990, 83). But the im-
mediate context points to the Jewish Christians in Antioch who had
followed Peters hypocritical example.
i
But we could also include Pauls Gentile converts in Galatia (Gaston
1987, 70; Malina and Pilch 2006, 200).
J
It sometimes seems to refer exclusively to Paul alone. That is, it
means I.
J
It is sometimes used inclusively, with different additional ante-
cedents besides himself:
were troubling the Galatians, if he could have been with them in person (Betz
1979, 62).
Pauls Example. In vv 15-21 Paul continued his presentation of negative
and positive paradigms begun in vv 11-14. He compared and contrasted his
behavior with that of Peter and the Jewish Christians (see Lyons 1985, 135).
His concern was not to defend himself against the alleged charges of the Agita-
tors, but to clarify how he experienced and embodied the gospel he preached
as a model for the Galatians to imitate.
Pauls autobiographical remarks in vv 19-21 and 1:13-16a resemble the
pattern of Phil 3:4-22. In both instances he contrasted his Jewish past with
his Christian renunciation of all privileges for the sake of Christ (Lyons 1985,
147). The dramatic change in his life came as a result of his realization of the
signicance of the cross of Christ.
The Cross. No book in the NT mentions the cross or crucify even half as
often as Galatians (2:19; 3:1; 5:11, 24; 6:12, 14; only once in Romans [6:6]).
Crucixion and circumcision are antitheses in the letter. As the Galatians
embraced the shame of the cross rather than circumcision, they achieved the
honor God alone could bestowthe status of children of God and children of
Abraham (Russell 1991, 113-18; Witherington 1998a, 175).
Gentile Stereotypes. Pauls reference to Gentiles as sinners . . . by nature
in Gal 2:15 reects conventional Jewish stereotypes. Pagans were not simply
notoriously guilty of sin. They were born outside the Torah covenant, ignorant
of the Law (see Rom 3:1-2), and unable to obey it or achieve righteousness
through it (see Phil 3:5-6). They were sinners by default and by denition
(see 1 Sam 15:18; Ps 9:17; 1 Macc 1:34; Tob 13:6; Jub. 23:23-24; Pss. Sol. 1:1;
2:1; Burton 1920, 119; Betz 1979, 115 n. 25). And so they were destined for
destruction (Pss 1:1, 5; 37:34-36; 58:10; Prov 12:12-13; 24:20; Sir 7:16; 9:11;
41:5-11; Dunn 1993, 133).
Jews bore their name as a badge of cultural and religious superiority (see
Rom 2:17). They were not like the rest of humanity (see 3:7). God gave them
the Law to distinguish between righteous Jews and Gentile sinners. Of course,
Jews sinned when they transgressed the Law. But the Law provided ways and
means for them to be forgiven (Betz 1979, 115). Gentiles were hopeless sin-
ners, because they did not have the Law.
I N THE TEXT
L 15 We here has an exclusive force. It refers to Paul, Peter, and other Jewish
Christians, not to Paul and his Gentile audience in Galatia, nor to Paul and the
Agitators (Walker 2003; against Martyn 1997, 248). We are Jews by nature
[ 4:8] and not from the Gentiles, sinners. Jewish Christians were Jews by
birth, by ethnic descent, not proselytesnot Gentile converts to Judaism.
The antithetical contrast (Jews . . . not . . . Gentiles) presumes that Gen-
tiles are sinners by denition. This is the assumption underlying many Gospel
S
A
M
P
L
E
144
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:15-16
sayings referring to sinners (see Matt 5:46-47; 11:19; 26:45; Mark 2:15-17;
9:31; 14:41; Luke 6:32-34; 7:34; 15:1-2; 18:11; 24:7). Paul parted company
with Jewish tradition by insisting that the Law demonstrated Jewish solidar-
ity in sin along with the rest of humanity. Both needed justication through
Christ (Gal 2:16; see Rom 1:183:20).
Gentiles were not sinners simply because they were outside the cov-
enant of grace. They were sinners because they sinned. And they sinned be-
cause they did not know or acknowledge God (Gal 4:8-9; see Rom 1:18-32; 1
Cor 6:9-11; 1 Thess 1:9-10; 4:5). But Gentiles were not the only ones guilty
of sinning (see Rom 2:13:20; 1 Thess 2:14-16). It is what all humanity does
when left to human resources alone (Gal 5:19-21).
L 16 The implicit subject of the adverbial participle, knowing, here is cer-
tainly We (v 15). Its perfect tense stresses a present state that exists because
of a past event. We came to know that a human being is not justied by God
by works of Law. The presumed ethnic advantages of Jewswhether their
status as children of Abraham, the privileges of covenant, or the gift of Law
had left them no better off than Gentiles (see Rom 3:1-9). Paul claimed all
Jewish Christians shared the conviction that no one could become righteous
by works of Law (but see Scott 2007).
Law i n Gal at i ans
Of the 195 occurrences of nomos, law, in the NT, 121 appear in the Pau-
line letters and always in the singular. Over 100 of these occur in Romans and
Galatians alone (74 in Romans; 9 in 1 Corinthians; 32 in Galatians; 1 in Ephesians;
3 in Philippians; 2 in 1 Timothy). Considering its length, nomos appears more fre-
quently in Galatians than in Romans. There is no letter where the Law is a more
crucial or central subject than Galatians (Witherington 1998a, 341).
It is impossible adequately to summarize Pauls view of the Law in brief
scope. At least a dozen signicant books have been published on the subject in
the past thirty years (see Sanders 1983, Risnen 1983, Hbner 1984, Wester-
holm 1988, Dunn 1990, Wright 1991, Thielmann 1994, Dunn 1996, Gundry 1996,
Schreiner 1998, Das 2001, Kosperski 2001).
Some interpreters classify what Paul meant by the law under major head-
ings. Bultmann (1970, 1:259-71) delineates ve uses in Paul: the OT law, the whole
OT, the Pentateuch, a general norm or principle, and a compulsion or constraint.
Esser (1976, 444-45) lists seven Pauline uses: Scripture as a whole, the Pentateuch,
the Mosaic law, the Decalogue, specic laws, a metaphorical sense, and a personi-
ed use. But even such well-intentioned attempts are an oversimplication.
In Galatians Paul most frequently used the word law to refer to the so-
called Law of Mosesthat is, the Torah, the books of the Pentateuch, Genesis
Deuteronomy (see Gal 3:10: the Book of the Law). He particularly emphasized
the Law as the source of Pharisaic Judaisms 613 commandments demanding un-
swerving obedience. Circumcision stands as a symbolic representative for the de-
S
A
M
P
L
E
145
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
mand of the Law as a whole (5:3; see Cousar 1982, 49; Wallace 1990; Lhrmann
1992, 46).
Under Law. In 4:21 Paul invited those who wanted to be under the law to
listen to the law (NRSV). In the rst instance, he referred to those who would
let themselves be circumcised (5:2-3). The second referred to the story of the
troubled relationship between Sarah and her Egyptian maid Hagar (4:21-31), re-
ported in Gen 1617 and 21. Five times the expression under Law (hypo nomon)
in Galatians (3:23-25; 4:4, 5, 21; 5:18) describes the pre-Christian obligation of
Jews to observe the demands of the Law of Moses.
Works of Law. The expression works of Law never appears in the OT or
LXX nor in any other NT author. (See 1QS 5.21; 6.18; 2 Bar. 57:2. Nonetheless,
Marcus [2001] speculates that Pauls usage arose in response to the Agitators ap-
peal to Exod 19:17 || Deut 4:11.) But by works of Law (ex ergo3n nomou) appears
six times in Galatians:
Three times in 2:16 Paul emphasized that no one is justied by works of
Law.
In 3:2 and 5 he insisted that the Galatians did not receive the Spirit by
works of Law.
In 5:18 he added that those who are led by the Spirit are not under Law.
In 3:10 Paul claimed that those who tried to live by works of Law were
under a curse. The two expressions translated by the Law in 3:11, 17,
21; and 5:4 are probably abbreviated versions of the fuller expression.
Paul insisted that justicationright standing with God (and all that in-
volves)could not be achieved by human efforts to obey the Law of Moses. In
Galatians and Romans, works of Law refer to the adoption by Gentiles of se-
lected commandments understood as prerequisites for salvation (Gaston 1987,
69). In each instance, circumcision seems to be the specic law Paul had in mind.
For further reading in recent studies on works of Law, see:
Bonneau, Normand. 1997. The Logic of Pauls Argument on the Curse of
the Law in Galatians 3:10-14. NovT 39:60-80.
Catchpole, David. 2006. Galatians 3:10-13: Crucixion Curse and Resur-
rection Freedom. Pages 377-85 in Interpreting the New Testament
Text: Introduction to the Art and Science of Exegesis. Edited by Darrell
L. Bock and Buist M. Fanning. Wheaton, Ill.: Crossway Books.
Cranford. 1994.
Evans, Craig A. 2005. Paul and Works of the Law Language in Late Antiq-
uity. Pages 201-26 in Paul and His Opponents. Pauline Studies 2. Edited
by Stanley E. Porter. Leiden: Brill.
Garlington, Don. 1997. Role Reversal and Pauls Use of Scripture in Gala-
tians 3.10-13. JSNT 65:85-121.
Grindheim, Sigurd. 2007. Apostate Turned Prophet: Pauls Prophetic Self-
Understanding and Prophetic Hermeneutic with Special Reference
to Galatians 3.10-12. NTS 53:545-65.
Hong, In-Gyu. 1994. Does Paul Misrepresent the Jewish Law? Law and
Covenant in Gal. 3:1-14. NovT 36:164-82.
S
A
M
P
L
E
146
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
Lambrecht, Jan. 1994. Curse and Blessing: A Study of Galatians 3,10-
14. Pages 271-98 in Pauline Studies: Collected Essays. Bibliotheca
Ephemeridum Theologicarum Lovaniensium 115. Leuven: Leuven
University Press.
Schreiner, Thomas R. 1984. Is Perfect Obedience to the Law Possible? A
Re-Examination of Galatians 3:10. Journal of the Evangelical Theologi-
cal Society 27:151-60.
________. 1991. Works of Law in Paul. NovT 33:217-44.
Scott, James M. 1992. For as Many as Are of Works of the Law Are Under
a Curse (Galatians 3.10). Pages 187-221 in Paul and the Scriptures of
Israel. JSNT Supplement 83. Edited by James A. Sanders and Craig A.
Evans. Studies in Scripture in Early Judaism and Christianity 1. Shef-
eld: JSOT Press.
Smiles, Vincent M. 2008. The Blessing of Israel and the Curse of the Law:
A Study of Galatians 3:10-14. Studies in Christian-Jewish Relations 3:1-17.
Stanley 1990.
Waters, Guy. 2006. The End of Deuteronomy in the Epistles of Paul. WUNT 2
/ 221. Tbingen: Mohr-Siebeck.
Wright 1991. 137-56.
Young 1998.
Law vs. Christ. Paul considered being under Law and being in Christ to be
as incompatible as the old and new ages they represent (Gal 3:24-25; 4:4-5). By
rejecting works of Law, Paul denied that actions performed in obedience to
the Mosaic Law, or more specically acts performed in response to any and all
commandments of the Law had any saving efcacy for Gentiles (Witherington
1998a, 177). Far from contributing positively to the spiritual well-being of pagans,
circumcision had a toxic effect (5:2-3).
Through Law. Paul used the expression dia nomou in 2:19 to describe the
Law as an instrument of his metaphorical death: through the Law I died to the
Law. In v 21 he maintained that justication does not come through Law. The
Law of Moses cannot give life. It has no justifying power (Thielmann 1994, 139).
Only Christ justies (2:16, citing Ps 143:2).
Fullling the Law. During Pauls day, the question of the fulllability of the law
[was] not a primary question in Judaism (Lhrmann 1992, 47; see Cranford 1994).
For him, the antithesis was not Faith vs. Law, but faith in Jesus Christ vs. the Law.
The real theme of his statements on justication is thus Christology (Lhrmann
1992, 47).
The Laws inability to save was not a negative reection on God or the Law.
God never intended the Law as a means of salvation (3:21). It was intended to
regulate the way people lived. And it was a strict disciplinarian. The Law requires
perfect and exhaustive obedience (3:10, 11; 5:3; 6:13), which no human could
satisfy unaided by divine grace. Salvation comes only as Gods gift, which unde-
serving humans may freely receive by faith in God (3:11; 5:4; see Witherington
1998a, 343).
S
A
M
P
L
E
147
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
Law Obsolete in Christ. Christ came not merely to tweak the Law, but to
make it obsolete. Paul took issue with the so-called Holiness Code of Leviticus
(chs 1726), which dened the aim of Law as separation from all that is unclean,
whether thingsincluding food and placesor people (Witherington 1998a,
352). He rejected the requirement of circumcision and kosher laws because they
separated Jews and Gentiles. But his uniform use of the word nomos in the singu-
lar suggests that his quarrel was with the whole law (Gal 5:3), the entire law
(v 14), not just circumcision.
Paul was convinced that every man who lets himself be circumcised . . . is
obligated to obey the whole law (v 3). The Mosaic law as a whole, not particular
laws, was the problem. In other words Paul connects the ritual Law, including
the distinctive boundary rituals to the rest of the Law and says that one entails
the other. . . . He is not simply concerned with specic laws, nor with the social
function and effect of the Law of separating Jews from Gentiles (Witherington
1998a, 175; against Dunn 1990, 213 n. 11).
By rejecting works of Law, Paul attacked not merely legalismhuman at-
tempts at self-salvation (Dunn 1990, 238; Moo 1983). Nor did he merely reject
the boundary dening rituals and identity markers that separated Jews from
non-Jews (Witherington 1998a, 354).
Pauls most basic problem with the Law is that it is obsolete and therefore
following it is no longer appropriate. It is not the rule of the eschatological
age and it is not to be imposed in the new creation which is already com-
ing to be. . . . The Law had an important function and role to play in the
divine economy, but the rule of the Mosaic Law has had its day and ceased
to be. . . . Keeping the Law implies in Pauls mind that Christs death did
not accomplish what in fact he believes it did. (Witherington 1998a, 354)
In Rom 7:12 Paul afrmed that the law is holy, and the commandment is
holy, righteous and good. It was a good gift from God. But it was limited from
the outset.
It was designed for planned obsolescencefor the old age until the
coming of Christ (Gal 3:19). The Law was merely one expression of the
weak and miserable principles (4:9) of the old order ( 4:3 and 8).
It had a limited intentto point out sin, not cure it (3:19-22). It made
virtual slaves of its charges in order to protect them from the dangers of
sin ( 3:23-25).
And it had a restricted audienceJews and Jewish proselytes (see With-
erington 1998a, 355).
Spirit-Empowered Obedience. Despite all that Paul said negatively about Law
in Galatians, he never suggested that obedience to God did not matter for Chris-
tians. But only the Spirit makes this possible; and the Spirit is Gods gift received
by faith. The coming of the Messiah and the age of the Spirit meant that the nal
age had already dawned (see Thielmann 1994, 140).
The law the Agitators made most crucial in GalatiacircumcisionPaul
considered inconsequential ( 5:6; 6:15). Thus, the Apostolic Councils refusal
S
A
M
P
L
E
148
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
to require circumcision of Gentiles implied that Christians enjoyed total free-
dom from the Law (2:4; see vv 1-10). To accept circumcision not only would
mean the loss of Christian freedom but also would deny the saving sufciency of
Christ and to assume the obligation to obey the whole law (5:3).
Nevertheless, Paul claimed that Christian freedom should not be con-
fused with licentiousness or antinomianism (5:1, 13). The command of Lev
19:18You shall love your neighbor as yourself (NRSV)is still binding on
Christians. This one command sums up the entire law (Gal 5:14). Those who
live by the Spirit and are led by the Spirit . . . are not under law (5:16, 18). In
fact, there is no law against the virtues the Spirit inspires (5:23).
In 6:2 Paul urged Spirit-lled Galatians to fulll the law of Christ by bear-
ing one anothers burdens. By this, he did not refer simply to Christs reinterpre-
tation of the Law. He called Christians to the cruciform existence modeled by Je-
sus and empowered by the Spirit ( 2:20-21; 6:12-16; Witherington 1998a, 344;
Gorman 2001). The law of Christ denes what Christ expects of those already
living as new creatures in the new age as the old age lingers. What he expects the
Spirit empowers. Those who have faith in Christ express that faith through love
(5:6). Freed from slavery to Law, they are free to serve one another in love
(5:13), free to love their neighbors as themselves (5:14), and free to carry each
others burdens (6:2).
The force of the adverbial participle in 2:16 is ambiguous. It could be
translated:
as attendant circumstance: And we came to know that a person is
not justied by works of Law, but only by the faith of Jesus Christ
(Longenecker 1990, 83; Betz 1979, 115);
concessively: Yet we know that . . . (NCV, NLT, NRSV);
causally: because we came to know (Burton 1920, 119); or
temporally: when / after we came to know.
The context favors the causal reading: Jewish Christians realized that they too
were sinners because they experienced justication through what Christ did,
not because they had been Law-observant Jews.
The verb justify appears here for the rst time in Galatians. Words in its
cognate family appear fourteen times in the letter (2:16 [three times], 17, 21;
3:6, 8, 11 [twice], 21, 24; 5:4, 5 [twice]). The verbs are all in the passive voice,
except in 3:8, in which God is the subject. Humans receive justication; God
justies. Paul did not deny justication by works of Law to any one particular
person (NRSV; ESV; GNT). He insisted that humanity is not justied by this
means (see Rom 3:20; echoing Ps 143:2).
The verb dikaioo3, justify, is derived from the adjective dikaios, righteous
/ just (Gal 3:11). Virtually all such omicron contract-verbs convey a causative
force. Thus, the verb justify means cause to be righteous (see Robinson 1991,
140). Every NT use of dikaioo3 has a forensic / juridical stamp: justication
and vindication result from judgment (Kertelge 1990, 331). In an act of di-
S
A
M
P
L
E
149
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
vine judgment anticipating the nal judgment, God pronounces on the faith-
ful a verdict of righteous already in the present age. The opposite of justica-
tion is condemnation (see Matt 12:37).
God vindicates the faithful, not only counting, but actually making them
righteous. God does not consider people to be what they actually are not. On
the contrary, by virtue of justication, he empowers them to become what
they previously had not been (against Rendall 1903, 164).
The phrase by works of Law has been variously understood. Interpre-
tive translationssuch as by observing the law (NIV), by doing what the
Law requires (GNT), by practising the Law (NJB), or by obeying the Law
(NLT)present problems. How are they to be reconciled with Pauls claim in
Rom 2:13: Those who do the law . . . will be justied?
We should not assume Paul totally changed his mind on the subject by
the time he wrote Romans. He essentially repeated what he wrote in Gal 2:16
in Rom 3:20: Therefore, by works of Law all esh will not be justied before
God, for through Law comes knowledge of sin. Both passages echo Ps 143:2.
So, was Paul simply inconsistent? Did he adjust what he said about the Law to
suit the perceived needs of his different audiences (so Risnen 1983)?
Works of Law cannot be easily limited to the ritual and ceremonial as-
pects of the Mosaic law, such as circumcision and food laws (see Rom 2:14-
29). Nothing humans attempt to do as a means of self-justication succeeds.
Romans 2:13 does not contradict what Paul wrote elsewhere about the inad-
equacy of Law to save. It anticipates his claim in 8:1-4 that God in Christ has
done what the Law was incapable of doing, so that the Laws just requirement
might be fullled in Spirit-lled believers.
The Faith of Christ. Paul used the phrases ex ergo3n nomou (Rom 3:20; Gal
2:16 [three times]; 3:2, 5, 10) and ergo3n nomou, works of Law (Rom 3:28),
ex ergo3n, by works (4:2; 9:32), and ek nomou, by Law (4:16; see v 13) inter-
changeably. In Gal 2:16 the faith of Jesus Christ (see Rom 3:26) serves as the
antithesis of works of Law. But in 2 Esd (4 Ezra) 7:34-35; 1 Macc 2:51-52;
and Jas 2:14-26, faith and works are complementary (Heiligenthal 1990, 50;
see Schreiner 1991).
Paul claimed that Jewish Christians realized that justication could
not be achieved by human effort, but only through the faith of Jesus Christ
(Dunn 1990, 212 n. 9; BDAG, 267, s.v. ean 1cb; BDF, 191 376). Only Christ
justies, not Law (Burton 1920, 121; Longenecker 1990, 84).
All the Greek church fathers take pistis Christou (faith of Christ) to
mean faith in Christ (Harrisville 1994). Protestants likewise typically consid-
er the faith of Jesus Christ as an objective genitive, that is, the faith Christians
place in Jesus Christ (Dunn 1993, 138-39). If they are correct, it appears
that immediately following his reference to the faith of Jesus Christ, Paul re-
peated himself: Even we placed our faith in Christ Jesus (eis Christon Ie3soun).
The traditional reading does not adequately take into consideration the divine-
S
A
M
P
L
E
150
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
human antithesis that features prominently throughout the autobiographical
narrative. Why would Paul contrast one thing humans do (works of Law) with
another thing they do (believe in Christ)?
Such challenges to the traditional reading have persuaded some recent
interpreters that the faith of Jesus Christ is a subjective genitive. That is, it
refers to the faithfulness shown by Jesus Christ (Hays 1983; Hooker 1989;
Longenecker 1990, 87-89; Witherington 1994, 268-71; Jervis 1999, 69). Jesus
demonstrated his faithfulness to God by giving himself for our sins to rescue
us from the present evil age, according to the will of our God and Father (Gal
1:4). Thus, the faith of Jesus Christ refers to the faithfulness Jesus Christ
demonstrated on the cross. Advocates of this position argue that it makes
more sense linguistically to avoid the redundancy of asserting the necessity
of human faith twice (see Matlock 2007, 174-77; see Dunns [1993, 138-39]
objections to the subjective reading and Witheringtons point-by-point rebut-
tal [1998a, 179-83]).
The alternative translationthrough the faithfulness of Jesus Christ,
even we put our faith in Christ Jesusresults in a natural Pauline combina-
tion of divine initiative and human response. The universal scope of human sin
and the inadequacy of Law make obvious the universal need for justication
from a source other than human effort.
There can be no objection to translating the Greek word pistis faith-
fulness. Elsewhere Paul explicitly traced human justication to the death of
Christ (2:21; see Rom 5:19). In favor of the traditional Protestant reading is
Pauls normal use of pistis referring to human trust in God / Christ.
The question remains: If Paul referred to human faith in the rst phrase,
why would he repeat the point that even we believed in Christ Jesus in the
next? Traditional Protestant interpreters answer: to highlight the universal
availability of Gods righteousness. Righteousness is accessible only through
faith in Christbut it is offered freely to anyone who has faith in Christ.
The subjective readingthe faithfulness of Jesus Christattempts
to overcome the shortcomings of overly individualized, intellectualized, and
dogmatized conceptions of faith. Faith in early Christianity had a social di-
mension. By faith believers came to participate in the community of the con-
verted or entered into the spiritual fellowship of believers (Jewett 2008,
276 and 277). Even if the traditional objective genitive reading, faith in Christ,
is correct, faith has no power apart from its object. Faith merely receives the
gift of Gods righteousness through Christ (see 1 Cor 1:30-31).
Faith may refer to both the faithfulness of Christ and the human re-
sponse of faith. If Law as the system of salvation by human achievement is re-
jected as the means of being made righteous, faith as the system of trusting the
crucied Christ alone for salvation includes both aspects. The traditional Prot-
estant reading of the passage does not imply that faith is something humans do
to earn salvation, despite the failure of law-keeping as a means. The faithful-
S
A
M
P
L
E
151
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
ness of Christ alone made justication possible. But because righteousness is
by faith, it remains a gift pure and simple (Rom 3:21-26).
Not only Gentiles, whom Jews universally considered sinners, needed to
be justied by the faith of Jesus Christ. Even Jewish Christians (Arichea and
Nida 1976, 46), like Peter and Paul, had recognized the inability of works of
Law to justify. We too believed in Christ Jesus, so that we might be justied
by the faithfulness of Christ and not by works of Law.
The change in the order of the names, from Jesus Christ to Christ Je-
sus (the more common sequence in Paul), is of no signicance (Bruce 1982,
139). God justies those who trust in Christ alone, however he is identied,
for salvation. Divine justication is the reason for or purpose of faith [BDAG,
476] in Christ.
The rare aorist tense of the verbs believed and justied suggests that
Paul referred to the experience of conversion: So we, too, have put our faith
in Christ Jesus, that we might be made right with God (NCV). The human
act of embracing the faith (Rendall 1903, 164) was followed by the divine
act of justifying believers.
The faithfulness of Christ is the divine prerequisite for humans to be
made righteous. Its antithesis is human effort, doing works of Law. Humans
must place their trust in what Christ has done in order to be put right with
God. The objective means of justication is Christs death on the cross, not
the Law, and the subjective means of appropriating justication or right stand-
ing with God is faith in the faithfulness of Christ, not works of the Law
(Witherington 1998a, 182).
Universal Sin. The nal clause in v 16 explains what precedes by para-
phrasing it: because all esh will not be justied by deeds of Law. There
are two differences: the future tense of the verb and the substitution of esh
for humanity. Gods Law was not irrelevant for salvation. It simply could not
make people righteous. It could reveal what was wrong with humanity. Law
diagnosed the human problem; it could not cure it (Rom 4:15).
Jewish Christians had come to the realization that the Jewish law [had]
not fundamentally altered the human condition (Westerholm 2003, 371).
Only by faith in Jesus Christ had they been made righteous before God. Since
they were justied in the same way as were Gentiles, they too were found to
be sinners (Gal 2:17a). There were not two ways of salvationChrist and
Law, one for Gentiles and one for Jews. All humanity faced the same di-
lemma posed by human sins and their pending judgment, by human partici-
pation in an evil age and its pending dissolution, by human alignment with
supernatural powers whose day had passed and whose doom was imminent
(Westerholm 2003, 269).
This was not the diagnosis of Christians alone. Even many non-Chris-
tian Jewish writings of Pauls day numbered the majority of their Jewish
contemporaries . . . with the Gentile wicked. . . . What was new with Paul and
S
A
M
P
L
E
152
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16
his like-minded Christians was the conviction that life under the Jewish law,
however interpreted, was subject to the same condemnation that threatened
the Gentile world (Westerholm 2003, 369-70).
Allboth Jews and Gentilesare doomed sinners in need of justica-
tion. Paul validated this claim by appeal to Ps 143:2. In the MT of Ps 143:2
the psalmist insisted that no one living is righteous in Gods estimate. But,
perhaps under the inuence of 1 En. 81:5no esh is righteous in the sight
of the Lord (APOT), Paul wrote: no esh will be justied by works of Law.
The future tense of the verb might refer to the nal judgment (Betz 1979,
119). But with the negative, it might refer to the moral impossibility of some-
thing that neither can nor will ever happen (Ellicott 1863, 39).
Flesh refers literally to the muscle and skin that covers the bones of
humans and animals. But Paul used it in a wide variety of gurative ways,
particularly in Romans and Galatians. Here he used esh as a synecdoche
for human persons as a whole. Thus, esh is simply a synonym for humanity
(anthro3pos). As a result, Gal 2:16a and 16b say much the same thing.
Fl esh
The word sarx, esh, appears ninety-one times in the Pauline letters.
Twenty-six of these are in Romans; eleven each in 1 and 2 Corinthians; eighteen
in Galatians; nine each in Ephesians and Colossians; ve in Philippians; and one
each in 1 Timothy and Philemon. Considering the relative lengths of the two let-
ters, sarx appears twice as often in Galatians as in Romans.
Paul distinctively used Flesh as the personied antithesis of Spirit, con-
trasting weak human beings with the powerful, personal presence of God (in
Gal 3:3; 5:13, 16, 17, 19, 24; 6:8; see Rom 8:3). Paul used Flesh guratively to
mean more than humanity in rebellion against God. Flesh appeared as a demonic-
like power that dominates human life apart from God. Perhaps Paul conceived
of Flesh as a collective abstraction comparable to modern expressions such as
peer pressure or mob mentality. If so, Flesh vs. Spirit is a subtype of the re-
peated human-divine antithesis in Galatians.
Paul did not assume that humans were innately and incurably sinful in con-
trast to a holy God. They were merely weak and dependent beings. Problems
came when humans attempted to live autonomously. This understanding is co-
herent with the other ways Paul used sarx in Galatians.
In 1:16, esh and blood together refer to humanity as opposed to God.
In 2:20 to live in the esh refers to bodily existence as a human being.
In 4:13 a weakness of the esh and in 4:14 a trial in my esh appar-
ently refer to bodily illness.
In 4:23 and 29 a birth according to the esh is a natural birth.
In 6:12 a good showing in the esh is an outward human demonstration.
In 6:13 your esh simply means you as a human being.
Before the publication of the NIV in 1973, all standard translations of the
English Bible rendered the Greek word sarx literally and consistently as esh.
S
A
M
P
L
E
153
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:16-17
The NIVs distinctive, and always mistaken, translation of sarx as sinful nature
was not really a translation but a theologically biased commentary on the text.
It presumed a Reformed interpretation of esh as the material component of
human nature. The antithesis of matter vs. spirit depends more on Greek philo-
sophical assumptions than on a biblical understanding of human nature. Happily,
the 2011 update of the NIV restores the traditional reading the esh.
Flesh is not inherently sinful. It is weak (as in the Hebrew equivalent
basar; see Rom 8:3). To be the persons God created humans to be calls for the
resident, indwelling power of the Spirit of God. The human problem is not esh
but Sin. Only God can liberate humans from the alien power of Sins usurped
control (Rom 8:8-9; Gal 5:16-26).
Merely deprived of Gods presence, human sarx is neutral. Flesh may de-
scribe ones total human nature before or apart from Christs grace and the
liberating power of the Spirit. This is the sense of Rom 7:18I know that noth-
ing good lives in me, that is, in my esh. But esh becomes a negative real-
itydepraved sinful natureas a consequence of sinful choicesby abandoning
neutrality and becoming an enemy of God. Romans 5:12 insists: death came to
all people, because all sinned (NIV 2011).
The point of Pauls repetition becomes clear in Gal 2:19. The two pur-
pose-clauses in vv 16 and 19 seem to be parallel and mutually interpretive.
Humans are not justied by works of Law
but
through the faith of Jesus Christ
We believed in Jesus Christ
so that
we might be justied by the faith of Christ
and
not by works of Law
because
all esh will not be justied by works of Law.
In v 16, the verb dikaioo3, justify, appears in the aorist, present, and fu-
ture tenses, but always in the passive voice. Justicationright standing be-
fore God (past, present, and future)is always a gift of God (see Rom 3:20).
L 17 The meaning of Gal 2:17 remains controversial. It is formulated as a con-
ditional interrogative sentence. The verb in the protasis (conditional clause)
is modied by an adverbial participle phrase, describing the circumstances
under which the condition exists as a possibility.
Condition: (protasis) If we ourselves were also found to
be sinners,
Circumstance: while we were seeking to be to be
justied in Christ,
S
A
M
P
L
E
154
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:17
Consequence: (apodosis) is Christ then the servant of Sin?
The sentence is a rst class conditional sentence, which grammatically
assumes all of the protasis to be true (Longenecker 1990, 89). Obviously,
we seek to be justied in Christ, and our seeking makes it evident that we
ourselves are sinners. In the NT, the verb were found indicates not merely
the existence of a thing, but the manifestation or acknowledgment of that
existence (see Matt 1:18; Ellicott 1863, 40). The quest of Jewish Christians
for justication did not change their status; it merely made obvious what was
already truethat they were sinners as surely as were Gentiles.
The logical syllogism Paul took for granted seems to be:
Christ justies sinners.
We seek to be justied by Christ.
Therefore, we are sinners.
The conclusion of this logic serves as the protasis (conditional clause). The
false conclusion is that Christ promotes sin. Why did Paul pose a rhetorical
question with such an absurd conclusion?
Paul certainly found it unthinkable that Christ was responsible for uni-
versal human sinfulness. The coming of Christ did not turn Jews into sinners,
it merely exposed them for what they already were. Thus, Paul answered his
own question, Is Christ then the servant of Sin? with an emphatic denial,
Absolutely not! (elsewhere only in 3:21; Rom 3:4, 6, 31; 6:2, 15; 7:7, 13; 9:14;
11:1, 11; 1 Cor 6:15). Paul consistently used the expression to deny an im-
proper conclusion drawn from a true (fullled) premise (Smiles 1998, 373).
This was a standard xture of diatribe style.
In Christ. All would-be Christians, regardless of their ethnicity, seek
to be justifed in Christ. Nowhere else in Pauls letters is seeking associated
with justication (but see Matt 6:33 and the antithesis in Rom 10:3). Here
he referred to the human quest for the assurance of right standing with God.
This is not automatic, simply because of what Christ has done. Human faith is
necessary to receive the freely offered gift.
In its only other NT occurrence, the aorist passive innitive dikaio3the3nai,
to be justifed, is equated with the forgiveness of sins Jesus alone offers. One
could not be justied from [sins] by the law of Moses (Acts 13:39). A similar
explicit equation of justication and forgiveness appears in Rom 4:6-8.
The justication believers seek is en Christo3i. The preposition en has a
remarkable range of nuances (see BDAG, 326-30). Translating the expres-
sion in Christ suggests that being made right with God means that believers
somehow reside within Christ. Paul never explains how this occurs. In what
sense do Christians live in Christ and Christ in them? What is the nature of
the fellowship that exists between Christ and believers?
Are we to think of this as Christ-mysticism ( Gal 2:20)?
S
A
M
P
L
E
155
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:17
Are we to think of metaphorical space? Do justifed believers spiri-
tually reside in heaven, and heaven in them? But what would this
entail?
Do they enjoy the eschatological (end times) benefts of the life of the
future already in the present?
Do they live in a historical situation fundamentally altered by the
events of the life, death, and resurrection of Jesus Christ?
Do they live in Christlike ways, doing what he would do?
Figurative explanations of Pauls participation-language seem more plau-
sible than do the literal. But their meanings are far from transparent. We use
metaphors because literal explanations are inadequate. We must sometimes be
content to live in the metaphor.
New life in Christ is lived in a new sphere of inuence, invisible to the
naked eye. But the new quality of life believers enjoy in Christ visibly shapes
and inuences their present lives as surely as relationships of love mutually
bind them to loved ones. We thrive in an atmosphere charged with the power
of mutual commitments. Love lives where it is given and received. Love re-
quires love in response (see 2 Cor 5:14-15; 2:20).
Christs death for me proves he loves meactually, all of us ( Gal
2:20). Because Christ is who he is, mutual relations with him are necessarily
characterized by love. In vv 19-21, Paul claried what it meant to be justi-
ed in Christ with other metaphors: dying to the Law, being crucied with
Christ, dying yet living, Christ living in me, living by faith, being loved, re-
ceiving grace.
Non-Christian Jews regarded Gentiles as sinners (v 15) by denition,
largely because they do not have the law (Rom 2:14). Jewish Christians rec-
ognized Christ as the Gentiles only hope of justication. But they also came
to realize that they were not justied by works of Law but by the faithful-
ness of Jesus Christ. So they too have believed in Christ to be justied (Gal
2:16; see Rom 3:21-26). Christ is also the Jews only hope of justication.
Only those who are righteous do not need God to make them righteous. But,
in Rom 3:10 Paul proved from Scripture (Ps 14:1-3 = 53:1-3) that there is
no one righteous, not even one. Thus, speaking for himself, Peter, and other
Jewish Christians, Paul confessed: we ourselves are also found to be sinners.
The verb heurisko3 means to discover intellectually through refection,
observation, examination, or investigation (BDAG, 412, s.v. 2). Its passive
form indicates that this is not self-discovery, found on ones own. Rather, Paul
implied that Christ exposed Jews for what they already weresinners. The
words justied and found (in Gal 2:17) and prove (in v 18) are forensic
terms, the language of trials and courtrooms. Thus, Christ is the judge who
pronounces the verdict: sinners all!
Jews customarily reserved the term sinners for Gentiles and for particu-
larly notorious nonobservant Jewsprostitutes, tax collectors, and their ilk.
S
A
M
P
L
E
156
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:17-18
But if all Jews must also be justied, they are no different from Gentile sin-
ners (v 15). This is the case Paul would make at length in Rom 1:183:20.
Jews have no advantage over Gentiles with respect to sin (3:9). All are not
only sinners but also helpless slaves of Sin (vv 22b-24).
If such assumptions were already at work in Pauls thinking when he
wrote Galatians, the question in the apodosis (result clause) of 2:17 makes
perfect sense, is Christ then the servant of Sin? That is, is Christ responsible
for turning Jews into sinners who are no better off than lawless Gentiles? Paul
seemed to use Sin as a personied ruling power as he does in Romans (see
Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 110-11; Winger 1999, 168-74).
Pauls question was not simply whether Christ promotes sin, but wheth-
er he is also a victim of Sins sinister power. Of course, the answer to both
questions is No. Paul would argue in 3:22 that the truth is quite the contrary.
Christ is the solution to the problem of Sin, not its source. He is not Sins
servant, but its Master.
The Law was incapable of giving life (3:21). It could not empower peo-
ple to fulll its demands. By his death, as an apparent victim of Sin, Christ
offers freely the life and grace needed (2:19-21) to liberate enslaved humanity
to love one another (5:1-6, 13-15), and fulll the law of Christ (6:2).
Apart from the divine provision made in the death of Christ, all human
beingsincluding those under the lawlive effectively in the service,
not of God, but of sin. Their need is not for the forgiveness of incidental
sins, but for an (apocalyptic!) transformation of the conditions of human
existence: their life in sins service must end. (Westerholm 2003, 373)
In 2:19 and 20 Paul used the universal Christian I to insist that, for
believers in Christ, this has already happened. They have died to the law;
they have been crucied with Christ. Thus, it is unthinkable to return to the
old life under Law, which is Pauls point in v 18.
L 18 Here Paul provided the evidence for his emphatic denial in v 17 that
Christ was responsible for turning Jewish Christians into sinners. Both vv 17
and 18 are constructed as conditional sentences. The former poses a rhetorical
question, which the latter answers. How are Jewish Christians found to be
sinners? By being proven lawbreakers.
With v 18, Paul shifted from the rst person plural we (in vv 15-17)
perspective to the singular I. The conditional (ei as in v 17, not the expected
ean) suggests this is a real case. But it did not apply to Paul (BDF, 147 281),
or he would have written, If I were to rebuild what I tore down, I would make
myself a lawbreaker.
Here, Paul used I when he actually meant you. This allowed him dip-
lomatically to apply this to St. Peter personally (Ellicott 1863, 41). In vv
19-21 Pauls I clearly applied not only to Paul, although it certainly included
him. The Greco-Roman rhetorical literary device of proso3popeiaa speech
in character, allowed an imaginary person or type . . . to speak in the rst
S
A
M
P
L
E
157
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:18
person in order to make an emotionally effective argument (Jewett 2008,
443; see 441-45).
The I in here undoubtedly referred to anyone under similar circum-
stances (BDF, 147 281; Bruce 1982, 142). It described the situation of all
Jewish Christians (perhaps of all Christians, if Paul used law in the broad
sense of Rom 2:12-29). Romans 7:7-25 seems to be a further development of
this use of I (see Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 213-24).
First Corinthians 13:1-3 uses I in this typical sense. It was not simply
Paul who would be nothing should he exercise the various spiritual gifts with-
out love. This was true of anyone and everyone. Numerous parallels exist for
this universal I in Greco-Roman literature, in the Psalms, and elsewhere in
Pauls letters (see e.g., Rom 7; 1 Cor 8:13; 10:29-30; 13:1-3, 11-12).
Paul spoke for his fellow Jewish Christians in Antioch who hypocriti-
cally abandoned the table fellowship they had previously enjoyed with Gen-
tile believers. By practicing again the kosher laws they had abandoned (Gal
2:12-14), they rebuilt what they tore down. Paul used the form of a true (rst
class) condition, not a hypothetical (second class, contrary to fact) condition,
because the rebuilding had actually occurred (Longenecker 1990, 90).
The imagery of building demolition and reconstruction controls v 18. If
I am building again what I once tore down, I am bringing evidence against
myself that I am a transgressor. All who abandoned the Jewish way of life
only to return to it proved they were wrongdoerswhether by leaving or by
returning.
Perhaps Paul presupposed the legal principle he cited in Rom 4:15b:
where there is no law there is no transgression (so Betz 1979, 120). If so,
their transgression did not consist in returning to their former way of life. This
only showed what was true before (BDAG, 973, s.v. syniste3mi 3). They were
lawbreakers already, as their rebuilding proved.
Paul publicly condemned Peter because he had already condemned him-
self (Gal 2:11). In Rom 14:23 Paul argued that the man who has doubts is
condemned if he eats, because his eating is not from faith; and everything
that does not come from faith is sin. Peters transgression did not consist in a
bad-faith abandonment of Jewish ways. He had abandoned his former lifestyle
out of sincere conviction. His about-face return to Jewish separatism was cow-
ardly, hypocritical, and a bad example (Gal 2:12-13).
By no longer eating with Gentiles, Peter acted insincerely. His return to
Jewish ways did not make him a transgressor of the law (see Rom 2:25, 27;
Jas 2:9, 11); it merely proved it. Peters backsliding to Jewish separatism only
demonstrated that he already was a lawbreaker.
Peter condemned himself ( Gal 2:11) by abandoning table fellowship
with Gentiles contrary to his true convictions, motivated only by fear of the
circumcision ( v 13). Not only Peter, but the other Jewish Christians who
followed his hypocritical example, had deserted the true gospel (v 14).
S
A
M
P
L
E
158
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:18-19
Paul confronted only Cephas (v 11) with the charge of compelling the
Gentiles to Judaize (v 14). But his universal I in v 18 applied equally to
them all. Since all were lawbreakers, all were sinners (v 17; BDAG, 759, s.v.
parabate3s).
L 19 Paul claried and explained what he meant in vv 17-18. His main asser-
tion, I died to the law (emphasis added), was obviously intended guratively.
Dead men do not write letters. What is the reality Pauls metaphor represents?
and why did he use the imagery of death to describe it?
The explicit rst person singular pronoun, ego3, I, is noteworthy. That
it is repeated in v 20 is even more remarkable. Greek verbs do not require
explicit pronominal subjects, since these are clearly indicated by the changed
forms of the verbs. In this context, the verb apethanon would be translated I
died even without the pronoun ego3. Greek subject pronouns are usually em-
phatic. Orally, such an I should be stressed or translated I myself. In print, a
bolded, italicized, or underlined font is called for.
The aorist tense of I died may point to some prior event, perhaps conver-
sion, as the moment of the metaphorical death of the ego3. Romans 7:9 may
shed some light on Pauls meaning here: Once I [ego3] was alive apart from
law; but when the commandment came, sin sprang to life and I [ego3] died.
Before the commandment came, the power of Sin was already there. Law only
gave it the opportunity it needed. Paul summarized the process in Rom 7:10:
I [ego3] discovered that the very commandment . . . intended to bring life
actually brought death.
In Gal 3:21 Paul claimed that Law was never able to make alive (NRSV).
Law could diagnose Sin, show it for what it was. But it was always incapable
of curing it. At its best, Law pointed to the Physician (see vv 23-29). Only
the crucied and risen Christ could give life and righteousness by the gift of
himself (see vv 20-21).
With the coming of Christ, the role of Law came to an end ( vv 19-
20). Thus, believers in Christ can say that for all practical purposes, I died
to the law (v 19). Paul implied that Jewish Christian advocates of circumci-
sion assume that the Jewish covenant and laws still provided the framework
within which Gods people must live (Westerholm 2003, 368).
What did Paul mean by his claim, I died to law? As a dative of refer-
ence, his point might have been, I died so far as Law is concerned. But other
options are possible. He only complicated matters by adding through the law.
This might indicate the efcient cause of his death: I died to law because
of Law (BDAG, 224, s.v. dia 3.d). The imagery of death refers to his conver-
sion-call, which came through his encounter with the risen Lord, not the
instrumentality of Law (Rendall 1903, 165). Union with Christ annihilated
the authority of Law in his life (see Rom 2:27 and 4:11).
Paul extended, expanded, and explained the metaphor of death in Gal
2:20-21. But rst, he explicated the purpose or result of the death of the ego3:
S
A
M
P
L
E
159
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:19
so that I might live for God (see 4 Macc 7:19; 16:25). The antithetical contrast
between life and death employs biological imagery to identify the same reality
described in forensic imagery in Gal 2:17 and 21. That is, to be justied in
Christ (v 17) is to live for God (v 19).
In Rom 6:17:6 Paul shifted back and forth between the imagery of
death vs. life (6:1-13, 237:6) and the sociopolitical imagery of slavery vs.
freedom (6:14-22; see 2 Cor 4:10; Phil 3:10). Both images contrasted the old
pre-Christian vs. the new Christian existence. As in other ancient religions,
life is used to characterize salvation (Schottroff 1990a, 106). Death refers
to the former existence in sin.
The aorist tense of the verb live points to a particular moment when
Christians may be said guratively to have come to life. This might refer to their
conversion (see Gal 3:1-5), their baptism (vv 24-27; see Rom 6:3-5), or their
sanctication (see Rom 8:13). Baptism dramatizes the spiritual reality of ap-
propriating the life-giving benets of Christs saving death (Gal 2:20; see Rom
3:21-26; 2 Cor 5:14-15). It has associations with his burial and resurrection
(Rom 6:1-4) and with the inlling with the Holy Spirit (see, e.g., Acts 2:38).
Romans presents the end of the egocentric life as marking the beginning
of the life lived for God, particularly life in the Spirit (Rom 8:12-17). Through
justication, the compulsive power of sin is decisively broken. I die to live no
longer for myself, but for God (Gal 2:19; see Rom 6:7). Through sanctica-
tion, I freely offer my new life in service to God (Rom 6:157:6).
Unlike Romans, Galatians never uses the explicit language of sanctica-
tion / holiness. Nevertheless, it can be argued that in substance, Galatians is
not about justication by faith, as Luther and his followers through the cen-
turies have believed. It is about sanctication by faith. It is not about how one
gets sins forgiven. It is about how one is to live when that initial forgiveness has
been received (Ramsay 1994, 425).
This is not the claim of a Wesleyan partisan, but of a retired professor
of religion at Bethel University, the Cumberland Presbyterian Univer-
sity.
Ramsay refers to sanctifcation, not in the distinctively Wesleyan-Ho-
liness sense of a second work of grace, but as progressive growth in
holiness. Most Christian traditions agree that there can be no glorica-
tion unless justication is followed by sanctication (Donfried 1976).
As with the dative expression died to Law, the dative live to God is am-
biguous. It could mean he was made alive:
for God (dative of advantage),
so far as God is concerned (dative of reference),
in God (dative of metaphorical space), or
by God (dative of means).
Regardless of the precise meaning, the antithesis of death vs. life calls
attention to another antithesis: law vs. God.
S
A
M
P
L
E
160
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:19
I died to Law
so that
I might live to God.
The Law of God was intended to bring life, but it actually brought death
(Rom 7:10). The reason no one is justied before God by the law is because,
The righteous will live by faith (Gal 3:11). Paul had to quit being a law
man so that [he] could be Gods man (2:19 TM, emphasis added). The paral-
lels between vv 16 and 19
suggest that faith and death to the law are parallel to each other, as
are justied and live with respect to God. Faith, then, is a death to
the law that enables life to God. Furthermore, the language of crucied
with Christ (v. 20a), as does the phrase live with respect to God (v.
19) have a parallel in the phrase Christ lives in me (v. 20a). (Gorman
2001, 138)
Faith entails an end to human life as I have known it and the beginning of
the divine life. Faith means that life based on reliance on Law and what I can
do comes to an end. It means that my life depends entirely on the work of God
in Christ for a right relationship with God. By faith I identify with the cross
of Christ, so that by participating in the death of Christ, I may experience the
risen life of Christ (Gorman 2001, 138).
Despite traditional English verse divisions, the Greek text (and a few
recent English translations, e.g., GNT, HCSB, ISV, NAB, NJB, and NRSV) includes the
phrase I have been crucied with Christ (see Rom 6:4) at the end of v 19.
Paul expanded on the metaphor of death, specifying it as a violent death by
hanging on the cross along with Christ (see Grundmann 1971, 7:786-94 on
with Christ).
In what sense does Pauls gure of speech intersect with the reality it
represents? The verb systauroo3 is used literally in Matt 27:44; Mark 15:32;
and John 19:32 (and Gos. Pet. 4:14), referring to the thieves literally crucied
alongside Jesus of Nazareth on Golgotha. Paul never systematically explained
his understanding of the profound personal implications of Christ crucied.
He apparently took for granted that his audience adequately understood his
meaning (Dunn 1998, 211-12).
Of course, the apostle had not literally been crucied with Jesus (so 1
Cor 1:13). His point was to bring out the very radical nature of the personal
transformation effected by Pauls encounter with the risen Christ (Dunn
1993, 145). His life as an apostle was somehow cruciform. He embodied the
message he preached ( Gal 6:14-17; see 1 Thess 1:4-7; 2:1-8; Lyons 1985,
189-201, 218-21, 226-27). He shared the shame and suffering of his crucied
Lord. His apostolic call left him condemned to die, a spectacle to the whole
universe, a fool for Christ, weak, dishonored, brutally treated, home-
less, cursed, persecuted, slandered, the scum of the earth, the refuse of
the world (1 Cor 4:9-13).
S
A
M
P
L
E
161
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:19-20
Pauls message of a crucied Messiah seemed foolish, despised, even
scandalous, to unbelievers (see 1 Cor 1:17-31). But his identity was inextrica-
bly tied to Jesus Christ and him crucied (1 Cor 2:2; see Phil 3:4-21). The
very thought of changing his message to avoid persecution would abolish the
offense of the cross (Gal 5:11; see 6:13, 14, 17).
Cruci f ormi t y
He did not coin the term, but Michael J. Gorman is responsible for the
recent emphasis on cruciformity as an apt description of Pauls spirituality and
ethics. Cruciformity is what Paul means by conformity to the crucied Christ. . . .
This conformity is a dynamic correspondence in daily life to the strange story of
Christ crucied as the primary way of experiencing the love and grace of God
(Gorman 2001, 5).
Pauls experience of God was transformed by his encounter with the cru-
ciedand exaltedChrist (Gorman 2001, 15). If God the Father was like
his Son, he was a God of self-sacricing and self-giving love whose power and
wisdom are found in the weakness and folly of the cross. This view of God was
previously unknown in antiquity (Gorman 2001, 16). As a result, Paul was dead
tounplugged from, so to speakhis former self and life, and thereby alive to
and for God (Gorman 2001, 14).
In Philippians, Paul described cruciform existence as a call to downward
mobility (Phil 2:3) in imitation of the seless example of Christ (vv 4-11). The
apostle presented Timothy (2:19-24), Epaphroditus (2:25-30), and himself as sec-
ondary examples of cruciformity (3:3, 7, 10-11; see Flemming 2009, 105-6). For a
Christian to live otherwise was to live as enemies of the cross of Christ (3:18).
Paul commended the life of suffering and weakness for the sake of Christ
as his paradoxical source of strength (2 Cor 12:9-10). Followers of the Crucied
One should expect suffering in the present age (Rom 8:17, 18). The destiny of
believers is contingent on their union with the crucied and risen Lord (v 29). As
Christs path to resurrection and glory was through obedient suffering, so is ours.
Our heritage in Christ will be ours only if we suffer with him. This gives us the
condent hope of sharing also his glory (v 17).
Pauls letters indicate that to be crucied with Christ entails participating
in the mission of Christ to save the world through redemptive suffering. This is not
a masochistic pursuit of pain, but an unselsh willingness to love others as Christ
did, by giving his life so they might live (2 Cor 5:14-21). The apostle employs dozens
of syn-compound words, some freshly coined, to emphasize Christian communal-
ity in Christ (Jewett 2008, 398). Baptism ritually reenacts our incorporation into
Christs death (see Rom 6:4). Thus, it marks the beginning of communal crucifor-
mity, initiation into the body of Christ, the cruciform people of God.
L 20 Paul continued to use the emphatic I to stress his point: I myself no
longer live. This is the point he made from the opposite perspective in v 19:
S
A
M
P
L
E
162
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:20
I myself died. So far as the Law is concerned, Christians are as good as dead.
Egocentric existence has come to an end. Preoccupation with self is over.
The death into which we are baptized as Christians is at once Christs
and ours in his. Our old life comes to an end so we may enjoy a new quality of
life (Rom 6:4; see 2 Cor 5:17; Gal 6:15). God brings the power of the future
resurrection to bear on this present age as he gives believers a quality of life
that anticipates the nal age.
Paul personalized the central afrmation of the Christian faith (see 1
Cor 15:3-11) as crucixion and resurrection. The crucied Christ is now risen
and living: But Christ is living in me. In Gal 1:16 Paul described the occa-
sion of his conversion-call as Gods revelation of his Son to me (en emoi). And
in v 24 he reported that, upon hearing of Pauls new life, Judean Christians
praised God because of me [en emoi]. These translations of the prepositional
phrase en emoi do not t 2:20. Christ is not alive because of me or by means
of me. Christians are not responsible for the resurrection of Christ.
Albert Schweitzer famously interpreted Pauls language of being in
Christ (v 17) and Christ . . . in me (v 20; see Rom 8:10; 2 Cor 13:5; Eph 3:17;
Col 1:27) as Christ-mysticism. He considered it the unifying center of Pau-
line theology: The doctrine of righteousness by faith is . . . a subsidiary crater,
which has formed within the rim of the main craterthe mystical doctrine of
redemption through the being-in-Christ (1968, 225; see 212).
Being united with Christ may be described as a mystical experience in
the sense that it transcends rational explanation: direct, intimate communion
with God in Christ cannot be fully described (Hansen 2010, 75-76). But this
is not an account of a mystical experience (Cole 1989, 125) in the sense of
the so-called Hellenistic mystery religions of Pauls day or that of Eastern reli-
gions in ours (Hansen 2010, 76; see Longenecker 1990, 92-93).
If Christ living in me has a locative force, Paul referred to metaphorical
space. Christ does not literally reside inside the bodies of believers. Christ in
me is not a personality invasion. Becoming a Christian does not mean becom-
ing a zombiemindless, lifeless puppets animated by an invisible inward pres-
ence. The Christian life is neither automatic nor magic.
The crucied Christ is the risen Lord, who rules the lives of Christians.
He offers us the grace of God (v 21), enabling us to live as he directs. In this
way the ascended and invisible Christ continues to be visible and active in the
lives of Christians. He lives in me as I live no longer for myself but for him and
for others. Jesus Christ lives in me as I reect his cruciform way of life.
Paradoxically, after asserting, I no longer live (emphasis added), Paul in-
sisted, I now live. This is apparently a variation on the formerly-now antith-
esis prominent throughout the autobiographical narrative ( 1:1-10). Only
the phrase Christ lives in me, which separates the paradoxical claims, explains
how both could be true. This seems to be a metaphorical depiction of justi-
cation (Shauf 2006, 101).
S
A
M
P
L
E
163
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:20
Paul partially explained his paradoxical metaphor: his bodily existence
depended entirely on the risen Christ. The word translated the life in Greek
is actually the accusative neuter relative pronoun ho, what. The problem with
the traditional translation (the life, e.g., KJV, RSV, NRSV, NASB; Burton 1920,
138) is that there is no obvious antecedent to the relative pronoun. It assumes
an unspecied referent (Porter 1999, 251 [15, 3.2]). This might be the life.
But this Greek noun is feminine in gender and occurs only in 6:8. The lack of
gender agreement and antecedent suggest that Paul referred to the following
phrase: I now live by the faith of the Son of God.
Paul explained the paradoxical metaphor about dying to live as the
meaning of the living by the faith of the Son of God. This way of living is in
the esh ( 2:16), I live in the body. Becoming a Christian did not bring a
literal end to his bodily existence. But his encounter with the risen Christ (
1:15) transformed his entire life. It split his life in twoformerly-now. He
was not literally dead or crucied. Christ did not literally replace his ego3. He
had not yet been resurrected (see Phil 3:4-21). But his life as a Christian was
radically different because of the faith of the Son of God.
As in Gal 2:16 (), most translations take the faith of the Son of God to
refer to Pauls trust in Christ (genitive objective). But it could denote Christs
faithfulness to Paul (subjective). Longenecker (1990, 93-94), who reads the
construction in v 16 subjectively, takes v 20 objectively. The differences be-
tween the two passages are noteworthy:
In v 20, the genitive is the Son of God; in v 16, Jesus Christ.
Several early manuscripts have instead God and Christ (Metzger
1994, 593). They almost certainly took this to refer to human faith,
not divine faithfulness.
In v 20, faith is preceded by the preposition en, by; in v 16 dia, through,
precedes it: I live by faith.
If en has its usual instrumental force, Paul emphasized that he lived
by means of what the Son of God had done for him (Witherington
1998a, 191). But did he also live by means of [en] the esh?
If the preposition en referred to metaphorical space (see BDAG, 326-
30), Pauls point was that he lived simultaneously in the physical and
moral realms (Burton 1920, 138).
Similarly, en could refer to the orientation of Pauls life for faith in the
Son of God (Dunn 1993, 146). But did he live for the esh?
Despite v 19, life and death are not usually treated as antitheses in
Pauls letters (but see Eph 2:1-6). They were paradoxically complementary as
here in v 20 (see Rom 6:2-14). Likewise, esh and faith are not opposites.
The faithfulness of the Son of God alone enables creatures of esh to live.
Believers do not cease to be alive or human beings. As a Christian, I truly live
only because (NET) the crucied and risen Son of God . . . loved me and gave
S
A
M
P
L
E
164
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:20
himself for me. Thus, the two instances of en would seem to have different
nuances.
Pauls letters seldom refer to Christ explicitly as the Son of God (else-
where only in Rom 1:4; 2 Cor 1:19; Eph 4:13). But when God was under dis-
cussion, Paul often referred to his Son or the Son with the same force (Gal
1:16 []; 4:4, 6; Rom 1:3, 9; 5:10; 8:3, 29, 32; 1 Cor 1:9; 15:28; Col 1:13; 1
Thess 1:10). And references to God the Father often take Christs divine son-
ship for granted. But the infrequency is noteworthy compared to nearly four
hundred references to Jesus as Christ and three hundred as Lord.
A survey of the Pauline references to Son of God suggests that he did not
use the title to emphasize a particular aspect of Christs person. It was merely
an alternative christological designation. It allowed him to emphasize the kin-
ship relationship believers enjoy with Christ as Gods children (see Gal 3:7,
26; 4:6; Rom 8:14, 19, 29; 9:26; 2 Cor 6:18; and Gal 4:28, 31; Rom 8:16, 17,
21; 9:8; Eph 5:1; Phil 2:15). This probably explains his choice of christological
titles here.
As with Gal 2:16b, the traditional translation, I live by faith in the Son
of God (see, e.g., GNT, NAB, NASB, NCV, NJB, NRSV), should be reconsidered. The
KJV translates the Greek phrase literally: by the faith of the Son of God.
Most modern translations presume an objective genitive reading, with Christ
as the object of human faith. This was clearly Pauls point in v 16c, we, too,
have put our faith in Christ Jesus.
But the present context favors a subjective genitive reading, reected in
the ISV: I live by the faithfulness of the Son of God, and the NET: I live
because of the faithfulness of the Son of God. Christ is the subject who acts
in faithfulness to God. This would explain why Paul added who loved me and
gave himself for me (see Eph 5:2, 25; 1 Tim 2:6; Titus 2:14). These identify
what the Sons faithfulness to the will of the Father entailed ( Gal 1:3-4).
Most interpreters take the Son of God as the implied subject of the par-
ticiple loved (e.g., Betz 1979, 125). But Paul was often ambiguous enough to
allow either God or Christ to be considered the source of divine love directed
toward humanity (Rom 8:32, 37, 39; 2 Cor 5:14; 13:11, 14; Eph 2:4; 5:2, 25;
1 Thess 1:4; 2 Thess 2:13, 16; 3:5; Bruce 1982, 145).
The aorist tense of the participles loving and giving suggests that they
refer to the crucixion of Christ. As important as the incarnation, life, and
ministry of Christ may be, these were not Pauls concern here. The event of
the cross was the dening moment in Gods demonstration of love for sinful
humanity (see Rom 5:8-10).
He Gave Hi msel f
The word translated gave in v 20 is from an intensied form of give
(paradido3mi)Christ surrendered himself to death (Popkes 1990b, 18; compare
S
A
M
P
L
E
165
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:20-21
1 Cor 13:3). In Rom 4:25 Paul used this same verb when he wrote that Jesus our
Lord was delivered over to death for our sins.
Here, as elsewhere in early Christian usage paredothe3, he was handed
over, may refer both to Judas betrayal of Jesus and to Gods allowing Jesus to fall
into the hands of his enemies (see Mark 9:31; 10:33, 45; 14:1-2, 10, 21, 41; 15:1;
Matt 10:4 and Acts 2:23; 3:13; Rom 8:32; 1 Cor 11:23b). This usage echoes the
language of Isa 53:6, 12, which inuenced Christian reection on the passion of
Jesus and martyrdom (see 2 Cor 4:11; see Harmon 2010, 91-102).
In order to rescue us from the present evil age (Gal 1:4), Christ ac-
cepted death on the cross (see 1:1; 2:19-21). His willingness to die for us dem-
onstrated the grace of God (v 21). His death made righteousness before God
possible, something works of Law were unable to do (2:16, 21; 3:10-29). His
given life is the source of our new life and right standing with God.
Christs death on the cross was at once an act of faithfulness toward God
and of self-giving love for me (Gorman 2001, 162; see 175). My new life de-
pends entirely on his faithfulness to God, not on my ability to believe that he
is the Son of God, to perform works of Law, or anything else I can do. This,
of course, does not make my response of faith to Christs faithfulness unneces-
sary. On the contrary, his faithfulness invites me to respond in kind.
Verse 16 refers both to Christs faithfulness and to our faith in Christ.
But the faithfulness of Jesus Christ denes what faith looks like. It is clearly
not intellectual assent to a creed. It is not an achievement that replaces works
of Law as the means of right standing before God. It is a willingness to entrust
myself to God, love others as Christ did, and to give myself in their behalf,
even if it costs me my life, as it did him. It is no accident that Paul dened
the Christian life in 5:6 as faith expressing itself through love (see Gorman
2001, 139). Jesus death is not simply vicarious (hyper emou, for me) but also
exemplary (en emoi, in me).
The participle translated loved in v 20 is the rst of ve occurrences of
the agap- cognate family in Galatians (see 5:6, 13, 14, 22). Despite its com-
parative infrequency, it gures signicantly in the letter. Love:
defnes why the death of Christ matters (2:20);
is the only thing that has ultimate meaning in the Christians ethical
life ( 5:6);
is the ultimate reason why Christians have been given freedom ( v
13);
for our neighbor sums up the entire law ( v 14); and
is the frst fruit of the Spirit ( v 22), which demonstrate that those
who belong to Christ Jesus have crucied the esh together with its
passions and desires (v 25).
L 21 A contextual denition of the grace of God ( 1:3, 6; 2:9) must recog-
nize its intimate association in Pauls thinking with the saving death of Christ.
S
A
M
P
L
E
166
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:21
This was the seless gift of his life and the tangible demonstration of his love
for me. As a subjective genitive, God is the implicit subject of the verbal noun
grace, which describes his freely given expression of love. The grace of God
means that God gave the unprecedented gift of his divine life in exchange for
my mortal human life. By receiving Gods gift with gratitude, I renounce every
human scheme of self-salvation and accept Gods love in Christ.
Not only did Christ give his life for me, but Paul implied that his death
provided the righteousness before God (see v 17), which works of Law could
not ( v 16). Paul experiences the grace of God in Christs death as a fully
divine and fully human action. In Christs death, God is faithful to us, and
Christ is faithful to God. Christs faithful act . . . becomes the prototype of
humanitys appropriate . . . posture before this faithful God (Gorman 2001,
120). God justies those who share in the faithfulness of Jesus (Rom 3:26).
Thus, faith may be dened as being crucied with Christ (Gal 2:19) or as
continuing to live by the faithfulness of the Son of God (v 20).
Why did Paul insist, I am not invalidating the grace of God? Mirror-
reading interpreters assume his denial refuted a charge made against him by
the Agitators (e.g., Burton 1920, 140; Betz 1979, 126; Longenecker 1990, 94).
But the assumption that advocates of circumcision would have asserted the
reverse of this denial seems patently implausible. If Paul denied accusations,
it seems more likely that the Agitators would have claimed he presumed on
Gods grace, not that he set aside the grace of God.
In the context of the Antioch incident ( 2:11-16), Pauls denial may
have implied that Peters hypocritical reversal on table fellowship with Gen-
tiles effectively nullied what the saving death of Christ had accomplished.
Thus, his point may have been: I do not abandon Gods gift as Cephas did.
The LXX sometimes used atheto 3, set aside, to translate OT passages (e.g.,
Deut 21:14; Judg 9:23; 2 Kgs 18:7, 20; Isa 24:16; 1 Macc 11:36; 2 Macc 13:25;
see Gal 3:15; 1 Cor 1:19; 1 Tim 5:12) referring to the betrayal or nullication
of an existing covenant relationship (Limbeck 1990, 35). Peter betrayed the
spirit of the agreement reached at the Apostolic Council ( Gal 2:1-10).
Because of the faithfulness of the Son of God, all people can become
sons of God through faith in Christ Jesus (3:26). Paul refused to live as
if God had not fullled his covenant promises in Christ, bringing an end to
merely human divisions based on ethnicity, social status, and gender ( 3:28).
A conditional sentence substantiated Pauls claim not to set aside the
grace of God: For if righteousness [is] through Law, then Christ died to no
purpose. The protasis (conditional clause) has no explicit verb. In such situa-
tions, Greek usually assumes an implied form of the verb to be.
The abstract noun righteousness is from the same cognate family as the
three verbs translated justied in vv 16 and 17 (and 3:8, 11, 24; 5:4). The
noun form appears again in 3:6, 21; and 5:5. The substantive adjective, the
S
A
M
P
L
E
167
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:21
just, occurs in 3:11. In the LXX, righteousness was an ethical term, identify-
ing what ought to be done.
Accordingly, the righteous were those who did the right thing. Righ-
teousness before God meant faithfulness to the covenant and the demands
of its Law (Witherington 1998a, 174). If this was the basic meaning in the
OT and other early Jewish literature, it changed in Paul. He insisted that God
justies the unrighteous (Rom 3:9-26). God treated sinners as innocent, when
they were guilty (Westerholm 2004, 253; see Westerholm 2003, 261-83).
Traditionally, Protestants of the Reformed tradition emphasize righ-
teousness as merely forensic. God pronounces sinners righteous, but they
remain sinners. But, for Paul, justication was not merely a matter of an un-
deserved gracious verdict. Justication is relational, but it does not leave be-
lievers unchanged. More than Gods opinion of sinners is altered. Paul used
the terms justication and righteousness with behavioral nuances (Wester-
holm 2004, 256). Both relationships and lifestyles change: Paul joined the
forensic (legal) and ethical categories of righteousness (Longenecker 1990, 95;
Ziesler 1972, 172-85). Those God pronounces righteous, he makes righteous.
Paul presented righteousness . . . through the law (see 2:19; Rom 2:12;
3:20, 27; 4:13; 7:5, 7) as the foil for righteousness in Christ (Gal 2:17),
graciously given by God (v 21). He set in opposition two competing means of
justication in chiastic order (Arichea and Nida 1976, 51):
by works of Law (three times in v 16) vs. through the faithfulness of
Jesus Christ (v 16)
because of the faithfulness of the Son of God (v 20) vs. through the
law (v 21)
The faith-works antithesis appears to be a variation on the divine-human
tension Paul had stressed from the beginning of the letter. It contrasts a righ-
teousness humans imagine they can achieve and one God alone can give
grace. Paul called attention to the irreconcilable tension between the two be-
cause of Peters hypocrisy (v 13). He knew there was no justication by works
of Law, but only by faith (v 16). Yet he betrayed the truth of the gospel (v
14) by rebuilding the walls of Law separating Jews from non-Jews. This act of
bad-faith proved him to be a lawbreaker (v 18; vv 11-19).
Pauls larger concern was to challenge those Galatians, who want to
be under the law (4:21), who are trying to be justied by law (5:4). He
warned: All who seek righteousness by works of Law are under a curse
(3:10). It is evident that no one is being justied before God by Law, be-
cause the righteous by faith will live (v 11). By his death on the cross, Christ
redeemed us from the curse of the law . . . so that by faith we might receive the
promise of the Spirit (vv 13-14). The Law was intended as only a temporary,
stop-gap measure until the coming of Christ (vv 19-25).
In Pauls mind, the grace of God ( 5:4), the divine gift of righteous-
ness before God ( 2:16-17; 5:5), the life Christ gives believers (2:20;
S
A
M
P
L
E
168
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:15-21
3:11, 21), life in the Spirit ( 3:1, 3, 5, 14; 4:6; 5:5, 16-18), the gift of free-
dom (1:3-4; 4:8-9; 5:1, 13), and the life of self-giving love ( 5:5-6, 13) were
experientially indistinguishable and inseparable. These are all possibilities of
grace, benets of Christs saving death. No wonder Paul was horried by the
thought that Christ died for nothing (2:21).
Law could not empower humans to achieve its central commandto
love ones neighbor as oneself (5:14). Pauls ultimate concern in narrating the
love of Christ [was] to interpret his own life as a manifestation of that kind
of love . . . and to urge his communities to embody it as well (Gorman 2001,
177). He reduced his own biography to the gospel, not the gospel to his own
experience (Lhrmann 1992, 50).
Paul closed the introduction to the body of his letter with a conditional
statement and this unthinkable conclusion: if righteousness could be gained
through the law, then Christ died for nothing. Obviously (see v 16), he did
not think Christ died for nothing. But to force Gentile Christians to keep the
Mosaic law like Jews, as Peter had done in Antioch, would nullify the grace
of God.
Despite the form of Pauls condition (see BDF, 182 360; Witherington
1998a, 192), what he clearly meant was: If it were possible to be made righ-
teous by obeying the Law (and it is not), then Christ would have died for
nothing (and he certainly did not). This prepares the way for Pauls claim in
3:1-5 that it would be folly for the Galatians through human effort to attempt
to complete what God had begun in their lives through the Spirit.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Charles Wesleys evangelical conversion came just days before John Wes-
leys own heart-warming experience. In his Journal, Charles mentions the
inuence of Luthers commentary on Gal 2:20-21: I laboured, waited, and
prayed to feel who loved me and gave himself for me (cited in Bruce 1982,
146).
Universal Sinfulness. Paul profoundly shaped the Christian conscious-
ness that every human being was a sinner. Therefore, no one can be put right
with God on the basis of being Law-abiding. Paul shared the early Christian
conviction that only the sinless Christ could justify sinners. His Absolutely
not! demonstrates his revulsion at the very suggestion that Christ was a min-
ister of sin (v 17). Recently, new perspectives on Paul have demonstrated that
many of his Jewish contemporaries did not claim to be naturally sinless. They
recognized their covenantal relationship with God as a gracious gift. But this
did not prevent them from imagining there was no room in the covenant for
pagans who did not rst become Jews by conversion (Dunn 2005, 220-21).
Death to the Old Life. Paul described his realization as a zealous, obser-
vant Jew that he was a sinner in need of justication. To do so, he employed
the imagery of being crucied with Christ. The person he imagined he was
S
A
M
P
L
E
169
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
2:15-21
had to die, guratively speaking, before the person God had always intended
him to be could truly live ( 1:15). We cannot be certain how realistically
Paul conceived his crucixion with Christ. And we dare not read this passage
based on our level of comfort or discomfort with mystical experiences.
The Place of Law. Unlike most of his converts, Pauls former life was not
marked by the stereotypical sins associated with pagans (see Rom 1:18-32).
In fact, in Phil 3:6, he claimed that he was blameless according to the righ-
teousness of the Law. He did not come to Christ out of a guilty conscience or
a sense of failure. On the contrary, his success at Law-keeping was his undo-
ing (see Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 214-22). His zeal for the Law and the
traditions of Israel drove him to persecute the people of God. Only retrospec-
tively did he come to see the failure of Law as a means of justication before
God and his former life as needing to come to an end. He had to die to Law so
he could live to God (2:19).
Paul claimed to share with all Jewish Christians the conviction that right
standing with God could not be achieved by human efforts to obey the law
of Moses. He was convinced that it was necessary to choose either Law or
Christ. The Law had served its divinely appointed purpose. It had never been
intended as a means of salvation. Nothing humans attempt to do as a means of
self-justication succeeds. But with the coming of the new age, the Law had
become obsolete.
This did not imply that obedience to God no longer mattered for Chris-
tians. But only the Spirit makes obedience possible; and the Spirit is Gods gift
received by faith. The coming of the Messiah and the age of the Spirit meant
that the nal age had already dawned.
Did Paul think the Law became obsolete at a particular date on the cal-
endar, such as April 7, A.D. 30the likely date of Jesus crucixion? Did he
think in terms of a more personal and variable date, such as the age of account-
ability, which differs from person to person? or, Does every pre-Christian
have a B.C. relationship with Law before coming to faith in Christ?
Faith of Christ. It remains a matter of dispute whether the recent empha-
sis on the faithfulness of Jesus Christ correctly interprets the genitive con-
struction traditionally translated faith in Jesus Christ. Regardless, the debate
serves as an important reminder that human faith alone is no more saving than
obedience to the Law. What Christ did alone is essential. Had he not freely
chosen to act in faithful obedience to the Father and in faithfulness to fallen
humanity, human faith would be meaningless. Human faith begins with open-
ness to his gift and continues with a refusal to receive the grace of God in vain.
B. Life in the Spirit vs. Law (3:16:10)
Paul transitioned smoothly from the narrative background (chs 12) to
the argument itself (chs 36). He urged the Galatians to choose their future
based on this historical and theological background. The narrative prepared
S
A
M
P
L
E
170
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:1-18
them to think in terms of pairs of opposites: God vs. humanity, freedom vs.
slavery, faith vs. works of Law, Christ vs. Law. So far as Paul was concerned,
their choice was obvious (see Chrysostoms Homily on Gal 2:21 cited in Ed-
wards 1999, 34). Their Christian past was to serve as the basis for their Chris-
tian future.
1. The Promise of the Spirit Fullled (3:1-18)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Preoccupation with the gift of the Spirit gives coherence to the rst ar-
gument of the letter body in three subsections:
The rst (vv 1-5) consists of a series of rhetorical questions challeng-
ing the Galatians to consider the evidence of their own experience. Only the
Spirit they received when they began their Christian lives could bring them to
nal salvation. Works of Law would count for nothing.
The second (vv 6-14) appeals to the example of Abraham epitomized
in the citation from Gen 15:6 (see Rom 4:3). Abraham was put right with
God on the basis of faith, not Law. As believers, they shared in the blessing
of Abrahamthe promise of the Spirit, because Christs crucixion brought
redemption from the curse of the Law.
The third (vv 15-18) appeals to binding human agreements as an anal-
ogy to Gods covenant with Abraham. Paul was emphatic on two points:
Gods promise to Abraham was fulflled in Christ.
The Law, given later than the promise, did not alter or annul the con-
tent or the gift character of the promise.
a. The Evidence of Personal Experience (3:1-5)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
As Paul presented his argument, the Galatians future choice was clear:
deciding for God or humans. They could remain faithful to the freedom
Christ made possible through his death on the cross or return to their for-
mer slavery to pleasing people. Pauls autobiography modeled the choice they
should make. The false brothers, Peter, Barnabas, and the hypocritical Jewish
Christians of Antioch provided negative examples. Pauls embodiment of the
true gospel had called him to cruciformity ( 2:19). He invited the Galatians
to reect on their past and to choose among their possible futures the only
one that would be benecial. This was deliberative rhetoric ( Introduction).
The goal of deliberative rhetoric was to provide persuasive arguments
for pursuing a future course of action. It appealed to examples, positive and
negative, to illustrate the kind of behavior called for. Positively, Paul hoped to
persuade the Galatians that the future course he proposed would be bene-
cial and constructive. Negatively, he wanted to demonstrate that the future
S
A
M
P
L
E
171
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:1-5
offered by the Agitators was counterproductive and foolish (see 2:18; 5:2, 15,
20-21). Unless the Galatians were prepared to renounce their own experi-
ences of God, they [had to] listen to Pauls arguments (Witherington 1998a,
199).
The transition from chs 1 and 2 to chs 36 is natural enough. Paul had
just written of the consequences of his co-crucixion with Christ in 2:19-21.
This had terminated his onetime relationship with Law. In 3:1-5, he turned to
the unexpectedly opposite experience of the Galatians. They had heard the
message of the cross placarded before their eyes. But the interference of the
Agitators had led them inexplicably to consider abandoning the cross in favor
of the Law. No wonder Paul addressed them as foolish!
Pauls address to Peter at Antioch concludes ch 2. Its indirect and im-
plicit aside to his Galatian auditors in 2:15-21 becomes direct confrontation in
3:1-5. The new section in 3:1 begins with an insulting address: foolish Gala-
tians! This is followed by a series of rhetorically challenging questions. All but
the rst are antithetically framed either-or alternatives. Each alternative pair
contrasts the divine and human.
Chapters 1 and 2 provide the background for Pauls arguments against
circumcision in the balance of the letter. Galatians 3:1-5 introduce the rst
argument in the letter body. Here Paul reminded the Galatians that the Spirit
was the basis for their shared experience as Christians. Gods Spirit was re-
sponsible for beginning and sustaining their life of faith. The Agitators could
offer only inadequate human assistance.
Within the Greco-Roman cultural world, words in the chore3g- cognate
family were associated with the generosity of wealthy patrons (BDAG, 386).
In 3:5, the intensied form of this verb, rare in Pauls letters, emphasizes the
extravagant liberality of Gods gift of the Spirit. Paul pointed out the folly of
forfeiting their God-given heritage for the poverty of human benefactors.
Did Pauls Gentile audience grasp the signicance of his emphasis upon
the Spirit as the distinguishing mark of Christian standing in these verses (
3:14; 4:6)? In Jewish end-times expectation, the future age would not only be
distinguished by the coming of the Messiah, but by the universal outpouring
of the Spirit on all humanity (Isa 32:15; 44:3; 59:21; Ezek 11:19; 36:22-32;
37:1-14; 39:29; Joel 2:28-29).
I N THE TEXT
L 1 Paul began with the Greek interjection o3 (as in Rom 2:1, 3; 9:20; 1 Tim
6:20). This clearly identies the words foolish Galatians as personal address.
What is not clear is the precise nuance of both words.
Paul did not suggest that his audience was literally dim-witted or stupid.
Here (and in v 3) foolish translates a Greek term different from the ones Jesus
forbade his followers to use as a term of insult (rhaka and mo3ros in Matt 5:22).
The Galatians were not unwise (see Rom 1:22; 1 Cor 1:20, 27; 3:18; 4:10) nor
S
A
M
P
L
E
172
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:1
incapable of understanding. They were merely not exercising good judgment
(Louw and Nida 1989, 1:385). Did Paul consider them intellectually (Rom
1:14) or spiritually (Titus 3:3) foolish? Was his description intended to be
sympatheticOh, you poor, silly people! (see Luke 24:25)or insulting
How dumb can you get?
The precise meaning of the term Galatians is equally uncertain. It might
refer to the descendants of the Gauls, the Celtic tribes who migrated into
north-central Asia Minor during the third century B.C. But it also applied to
residents of the Roman province, which extended south into parts of the re-
gions of Lycaonia, Pamphylia, Isauria, Cilicia, and Paphlagonia (Schille 1990;
Introduction and 1:21 sidebar, Map of Asia Minor, Syria and Cilicia, and
Cyprus).
Following the less than complimentary personal address, Paul posed a
series of questions. First, Who has bewitched you? On the literal level, the lan-
guage refers to bringing someone under the inuence of the evil eye (BDAG,
171). Elsewhere in the letter the metaphorical language of enslavement refers
to bondage to personied powers such as Sin (3:22), Law (3:23-25; 4:5), or
the basic principles of the world (4:3, 9) rather than to some evil enchant-
ress. Jerome considered this a colloquial expression, which should not be
taken as a literal reference to witchcraft (cited in Edwards 1999, 35). We
might compare our use of the word fascination with no awareness of its
origins in witchcraft (see Lightfoot 1874, 133). Luther, however, took Paul
literally, considering his reference to sorcery among the works of the esh in
5:20 as evidence that witchcraft exists (1953, 163).
The Evi l Eye
Superstitions about the evil eye were widely espoused in antiquity (and
still are in central Turkey, the home of the Galatians). The OT demonstrates an
awareness of the belief (see Deut 28:54; Sir 14:6, 8; Wis 4:12). Certain animals,
persons, demons, or gods were considered able to bring disaster on others by
simply looking at them with envy (see Elliott 1990; Eastman 2001). The evil eye
was closely connected with notions about envy, jealousy, greed, [and] stingi-
ness (Witherington 1998a, 202, citing Plutarch, Quaest. conv. 680C683B).
The verb baskaino3, used in v 2, means bewitch; baskania means envy
(BDAG, 171). In rst-century society there was great fear of the evil eye, and
there were various practices, such as curses, the use of amulets, spitting, that
were thought to ward off or neutralize the effects of the evil eye (Witherington
1998a, 202; 4:15). Spells cast by the evil eye were just one variety of sorcery /
the occult arts in the Greco-Roman world.
Paul may have thought someone had cast a spell on the Galatians. And
the Galatians may have taken him literally, regardless of his intent. Or he may
have exploited the fear of the evil eye in his day to demonize the Agitators
S
A
M
P
L
E
173
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:1
(Witherington 1998a, 203). But it seems more likely that he and they took it
metaphorically. The other instances of graphic imagery in v 1 (eyes and por-
trayed) lend support to this gurative reading.
The aorist tense of the verb bewitched may refer to a particular inci-
dent in which the Agitators easily took advantage of the Galatians gullibility,
robbing them of their critical faculties. That they had been duped was an ac-
complished fact. They had been entrapped by charming suitors (see 4:17-18).
Pauls interrogative pronoun, Who, suggests that one man was solely re-
sponsible for bewitching the Galatians. Was he unaware of the mans name?
Or was he well informed of the situation? Was his question merely a rhetorical
reminder that some human, not God, was to blame for their present situation?
Paul directly addressed his readers as you (hymas). This marks the rst
appearance of the second person plural pronoun since 2:5. He referred to all
the members of the churches of Galatia collectively. Contemporary readers
need to remember that we are reading anothers mail. Not everything Paul said
to them about their unique historical situation can be generalized to apply to
us. For example, Paul did not personally preach to us.
Some interpreters place more weight on Pauls use of personal pronouns
than (I think) the evidence will bear. Pauls use of the rst person plural pro-
noun we and of the second person plural you is not entirely consistent (
2:15-21 BEHIND THE TEXT). It seems unlikely that the Jewish apostle to
the Gentiles made a point of using we to refer only to himself and other Jews
or Jewish Christians. He did not use we in its various inected forms (us,
our) always to the exclusion of his Gentile audience. And his you (and
your) does not always refer only to the Galatians, to the exclusion of Jews
and Jewish Christians. Although it is possible to make sense of Pauls argu-
ment in places with such distinctions in mind, it seems a stretch to make it
work throughout the letter.
Contemporary English translations might appear to indicate that Paul
followed his rst question with a statement. But the third sentence in v 1Be-
fore your very eyes Jesus Christ was clearly portrayed as cruciedis a Greek
relative clause. It is a part of the question, which modies the plural pronoun
you. By metonymy, eyes represented whole persons. Thus, Before your very
eyes meant To you. The imagery of the evil eye probably explains the use of
this gure of speech.
The passive form of the verb (was . . . portrayed) leaves the preacher
anonymous. Both Paul and the Galatians knew it was he who clearly portrayed
Christ crucied to them (see 4:13). Why did he fail to mention his role in
their conversions? Did he highlight again the divine-human antithesis ( 1:1,
6-9) and assign full responsibility for their conversions to God?
Rather than the expected verbs ke3rysso3 (proclaim aloud; BDAG,
543) or euangelizo3 (proclaim the gospel; BDAG, 402), Paul used prographo3
(show forth / portray publicly, proclaim or placard in public; also in Rom
S
A
M
P
L
E
174
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:1-2
15:4 and Eph 3:3; BDAG, 867) to describe his preaching. His Spirit-inspired
account of the crucixion painted a graphic and memorable word picture. Paul
would characterize the content of his preaching as Christ . . . crucifed (see 1
Cor 1:13, 23; 2:2) even more starkly in Gal 5:11 as the offense of the cross
(see 6:12, 14).
This is the second of six times that the verb stauroo3, crucify, appears
in Galatians ( 2:20; 5:11, 24; 6:12, 14). It appears only thirteen times else-
where in all Pauls letters. Six of these are in 1 Corinthians, a letter nearly
three times the length of Galatians. Twice in the salutation of Galatians (1:1,
4) and twice in the report of his speech to Peter (2:20, 21), he referred to the
death of Christ, without mentioning its violent mode. Obviously, the para-
doxically shameful yet redeeming death of Christ occupies a central place in
Galatians.
L 2 Paul introduced his second question with the ironic words, I would like to
learn just one thing from you. Irony seems implicit in Pauls choice of verbs.
Mathein, to learn, is from the same cognate family as the noun describing Jesus
followers as disciplesmathe3tai. Was Paul actually to be taught by his foolish
converts?
Nowhere else in the Pauline letters is the expected teacher-disciple hier-
archy similarly reversed (see Rom 16:17; 1 Cor 4:6; 14:31, 35; Eph 4:20; Phil
4:9, 11; Col 1:7; 1 Tim 2:11; 5:4, 13; 2 Tim 3:7, 14; Titus 3:14). Surely the Ga-
latians did not imagine they could turn the apostle into their disciple. Perhaps
his irony reects his consternation that they would even consider circumcision
an improvement on his gospel. Were they trying to persuade him that their
circumcision might spare them unnecessary suffering ( 5:11; 6:12)?
In the Greek question, the words works of Law stand rst in the sen-
tence, giving them special emphasis. Paul posed a simple either-or question to
the Galatians. Was the source of their experience of the Spiritfrom works
of Law or hearing of faith? He treated receiving the Spirit as an adequate
description of the experiential content of becoming a Christian. He was per-
suaded that every Christian had the Spirit of Christ (see Rom 8:9). Having
the Spirit was the irrefutable evidence that one had been justied ( Gal
2:16).
The logically passive verb you receive presumes that God was the unex-
pressed giver of the Spirit (see Gal 3:14; Rom 8:15; 1 Cor 2:12; 2 Cor 11:4). In
Gal 3:5 from works of Law again serves as the negative foil for the gift of the
Spirit. There again Paul referred indirectly to God as the One who continues
to give you the Spirit.
The aorist tense of the verb you receive points to the Galatians conver-
sion / baptism. At this moment they rst received the gift of the Spirit. Paul
asked them to validate the source of their Christian existence based on their
own experience: Did you receive the Spirit by observing the law, or by believ-
ing what you heard?
S
A
M
P
L
E
175
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:2
The Spirit, unmentioned until now, plays a signicant role throughout
the balance of the letter (see Lull 1980). A measure of the importance of
Pauls appeals to the Spirit may be seen in its antithetical opposites (With-
erington 1998a, 211). Each represents one aspect of the human side of the
divine-human antithesis stressed from the beginning of the letter:
works of Law (3:1-2)
Law (4:5-6; 5:18)
desires of the fesh (vv 16-17, 24-25)
works of the fesh (vv 19-23)
fesh (3:3; 6:8; Lull 1980, 27)
The rst alternative to faith in the gospel as the basis for the Galatians
experience of the Spirit is by observing the law (lit., by works of Law;
2:16). Even a foolish hearer of the letter must have realized this was incorrect
in Pauls view. Nothing humans could do would bring them into a right rela-
tionship with God. In case they missed it, he asserted in 3:10 that all who rely
on works of Law are under a curse.
In 3:2, the preposition ek (by) identies the potential origin, cause, [or]
reason why God gave the Spirit to the Galatians. The object of the preposi-
tion, works, refers to the things people do. The genitive noun, of Law, modi-
fying works, identies the legally binding deeds humans must do (an objective
or descriptive genitive; 2:16 sidebar, Law in Galatians). Beyond the four
Galatian references already noted, Paul used the expression ex ergo3n nomou
only in Rom 3:20. At the crucial conclusion of his case for the universal scope
of human sinfulness in Rom 1:183:20, he insisted that no one will be de-
clared righteous in Gods sight by works of Law; rather, through Law we
become conscious of Sin.
Paul considered the second alternative in Gal 3:2 correct. The Greek
phrase by hearing of faith is interpretively translated by believing what you
heard (e.g., NIV, NRSV, ISV, NET). No one becomes a Christian without rst hear-
ing and obediently responding to the preaching of the good news about Christ
(see Rom 10:14-18). Hays (1983, 143-45) summarizes ve ways in which ex
akoe3s pisteo3s has been translated:
from faithful hearing (hearing with faith [NASB and ESV])
from hearing (that is, from faith)
from hearing the faith
from the message that calls for faith
from the message about the faith
For obvious reasons, the biblical tradition frequently associates hearing
(akouo3) with heeding (hypakouo3; see 1 Kgs 22:19-23; Isa 6; Jer 1:11-16; Ezek 1;
Amos 7:1-9; 8:1-3; 9:1-4; Mark 4:9; Kittel 1964a). To hear the gospel appro-
priately was to respond to the divine message in obedience. Thus, the hearing
of faith here may be the equivalent of the obedience of faith in Rom 1:5 (see
15:18; Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 44). The essential difference between
S
A
M
P
L
E
176
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:2-3
observing the law and faithful hearing is the content of the message. The gos-
pel of the crucied Christ did not authorize anarchy or licentiousness.
L 3 Paul introduced his third question in Gal 3:3 with the preparatory ques-
tion, Are you so foolish? The word translated foolish is the same one as in v 1.
The word so did not invite the Galatians to evaluate to what degree they were
or were not foolish. Rather, Paul wanted them to consider how (i.e., in what
way) their folly expressed itself.
So, he asked: Are you proving your folly in this way: When you began
your Christian life by the Spirit, are you now trying to complete it by the
esh? The aorist participle translated beginning invited the Galatians to recall
their conversions / baptisms as Christians (see 2 Cor 8:6; Phil 1:6).
The dative noun pneumati, with the Spirit, indicates how the Galatians
began as Christians. The Holy Spirit was the divine agent who launched them
on their Christian journey. Thus, it was foolish for them now to attempt to
reach their destination sarki, by the esh. The NIVs by human effort cor-
rectly captures the force of this dative of agency. Throughout Galatians the
contrast between Spirit and esh functions as a subtype of the divine-human
antithesis central to Pauls argumentative strategy from the beginning (
2:16 sidebar, Flesh). Here, esh may be a metonym for circumcision, the
entrance ritual for the Mosaic covenant (see Gen 17:13; Sir 44:20; Wither-
ington 1998a, 214).
Another repeated antithesis throughout Galatians involves the temporal
adverb now:
in 1:23 in contrast with formerly
in 2:20 as the polar opposite of no longer
in 4:9 and 29 opposed to Formerly and at that time
in 4:25, contrasting the present [nyn] Jerusalem and the Jerusalem
that is above (v 26)
Only Gal 3:3 lacks an explicit counterpart to now. But the contrast between
the way the Galatians began their lives as Christians in the past and the way
they were attempting to continue them in the present is clearly in view.
The aorist participle beginning describes what once was true of Pauls
audience in spite of the action stated in the main verb. Thus, the adverbial
participle might be translated as a concessive: Although you began with the
Spirit . . . (NET). But the implicit formerly-now contrast lends support for a
temporal translation: When you began by the Spirit . . . (see ESV, HCSB, ISV, NAB,
NIV, NLT, TNIV).
The present tense of the main verb, you are nishing, might suggest that
the Galatians succeeded in perfecting their Christian lives through their own
efforts. But Paul obviously assumed this was impossible. Thus, the verb must
be a tendential present. They attempted to improve on the Spirits work, but
could not: . . . are you now trying to complete it by the esh? (BDAG, 383).
S
A
M
P
L
E
177
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:4
L 4 Pauls fourth question makes his negative assessment of the proposed
changes the Agitators had in mind for the Galatians perfectly obvious. If they
were to turn from faith in Christ alone to works of Law (v 2) or from depend-
ing on the Spirit to the esh (v 3), the truth of the gospel (1:6-9; 2:5, 14)
would be lost. But something even more serious was at stake.
Twice in 3:4 Paul used the adverb eike3i, for nothing, to describe the Ga-
latians Christian experiences. In 4:11, he expressed his fear that the changes
they were making could mean that his labors in their behalf would be wasted
(eike3i). In 1 Cor 15:2, he wrote of the dangerous possibility of believing in
vain (eike3i), and forfeiting the prospect of future salvation, by failing to hold
rmly to the word [he] preached.
Paul made a similar point in Gal 5:2, cautioning that Christ will be of
no value to Gentile Christians who let themselves be circumcised. In 5:4 he
warned that those who try to be justied by law have been alienated from
Christ; . . . fallen away from grace.
Pauls fourth question is: Have you suffered so much for nothingif it
really was for nothing? The Greek verb translated suffered here expresses
the passive idea corresponding to the active idea of did. That is, it refers to
everything that befalls a person, whether good or illwhat people experi-
ence as opposed to what they do. Thus, BDAG translates v 4a: have you had
such remarkable experiences in vain? (785). A number of recent English trans-
lations prefer instead the neutral term experience (see GNT, NAB, NCV, NLT,
NRSV, RSV, TNIV) here.
In most NT passages (e.g., Luke 22:15; 24:46; Acts 1:3; 3:18; 17:3; Heb
2:18; 5:8; 1 Pet 2:20) the verb had a largely negative nuancea painful expe-
rience, the endurance of suffering (BDAG, 785; in Pauls letters: 1 Cor 12:26;
Phil 1:29; 1 Thess 2:14; 2 Thess 1:5; 2 Tim 1:12). But does it in Gal 3:4? Like
the verbs beginning and end in v 3, learn (in v 2) and experience (v 3) often
appear as a pair in Greek literature (Betz 1979, 134 n. 67). This would sup-
port taking the verb in the neutral rather than a negative sense.
This reading is also supported by the grammatical antecedents of so
many things (BDAG, 1012) here. The most obvious antecedents would be
the prior events Paul reported in the present literary context, specically the
Galatians:
hearing his graphic account of the Crucifxion,
being persuaded by what they heard,
becoming Christians,
receiving the Spirit, and
witnessing miracles in their midst.
To defend the translation suffered, interpreters must make a speculative
reconstruction of events in the world behind the text. Two passages within the
letter hint that the Galatians suffered for their faith (see Rendall 1903, 167):
S
A
M
P
L
E
178
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:4
Pauls mention that the illness, which frst brought him to Galatia, was
a trial to them ( 4:14), and
The conclusion of his allegory of Abrahams two wives: At that time
the son born in the ordinary way persecuted the son born by the pow-
er of the Spirit. It is the same now ( 4:29).
If the Agitators were persecuting the Galatians, why would they nd
their gospel attractive? Paul suggests that the Agitators attered the Gala-
tians (vv 17-18). Would they have recognized the Agitators deceptive per-
suasive tactics as persecution apart from Pauls allegations of their sinister
intentions ( 5:7-8; 6:11)? Galatians 6:11 might imply that the appeal of the
circumcision gospel was that it was persecution-free.
Suf f eri ng and Earl y Chri st i ani t y
Paul suffered for preaching the gospel of Christ (see 1 Cor 4:8-13; 15:30-
32; 2 Cor 1:3-11; 4:7-12, 16-18; 6:3-10; 11:22-29; 12:7-10; Gal 4:19; 6:17; Phil 1:12-
17; 1 Thess 1:6; 2:2, 15). Did he suffer vicariously in behalf of the church to spare
it from suffering (see Col 1:24; 1 Thess 2:9)? Or was suffering the typical experi-
ence of ordinary believers (see Rom 5:3; 8:17-18)? Did believers suffer because
they were believers, or despite the fact that they were believers? That is, was
suffering the normal human experience believers shared with unbelievers because
they continued to live in the present evil age (Gal 1:4; see Rom 8:19-25, 31-39)?
What did Paul mean when he claimed that his converts participated in his
sufferings (2 Cor 1:7; 4:12; 11:4, 9; Eph 3:13; Phil 1:30; 4:14) and in the sufferings
of Christ (Phil 1:29; 3:10)? Did their shared suffering consist only in a deeply felt
empathy (see Rom 12:15)? Or were they victims of the same kinds of suffering the
apostle experienced (1 Thess 1:6; 2:2, 14-16)?
Paul had persecuted Jewish Christians before he became a Christian (1 Cor
15:9; Gal 1:13, 23; Phil 3:6). Explicit statements in his letters indicate that some
of his churches experienced suffering, painful trials, opposition, and persecution
because of their faith (see 2 Cor 8:1-2; Phil 1:27-30; 1 Thess 1:6; 2:14; 3:3-4, 7;
2 Thess 1:4-7). But was this true of all his churches? Regardless, it would seem
from Pauls advice in 1 Thess 4:11-12 that he did not consider persecution some-
thing his converts should actively seek.
Paul identied some of the suffering of his converts as self-inicted. That
is, it was a result of their sinful choices: church discipline (2 Cor 2:5-11) or divine
judgment (1 Cor 10:11-14; 11:29-32, 34). And he apparently thought of some
Christian suffering as the result of illness (Gal 4:13; Phil 2:25-30). That is, some
things Christians suffered were not because they are believers, but simply because
they were human. It was a negative experience to which all mortals were subject.
Suffering does not seem to have been the routine or universal experience
of all Pauls churches (see 1 Cor 4:8-13 [appreciating the irony]; 1 Thess 4:11-
12) or all early Christians (see 1 Cor 11:27-34). Therefore, it might be better to
translate the word epathete in Gal 3:4 in the neutral sense of experience rather
than suffer.
S
A
M
P
L
E
179
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:4-5
In v Gal 3:4b, Paul added a disclaimer to his fourth question: Did you
experience so much for nothing?if it really was for nothing (NRSV). Despite
the changes the Galatians had already made or were considering making, he
seemed to assume that they were not beyond recovery.
This should not be taken as evidence for some kind of once saved always
saved eternal security. His hope that their previous experiences were not
wasted did not depend on the assumption that God would save them single-
handedly, in spite of their rebellion. It was because he was condent that his
letter would succeed in persuading them to see the error of their ways and to
return to the truth of the gospel.
L 5 Pauls fth question essentially repeats his second. But it shifts the per-
spective from the Galatians receiving of the Spirit (v 2) to Gods giving of the
Spirit. Besides giving the Spirit, Paul refers to Gods working miracles among
them. But his reference to God is not explicit in Greek (despite the NIV).
Pauls Greek indicates that his nal question summarized the implica-
tions of the entire series: Therefore, does the One who offers [epichore3go3n]
you all the Spirit and who works [energo3n] deeds of power among you all do
so by works of Law or by hearing of faith?
God is the implied subject of both Greek verbs ( 1:5). The rst is rare
in Pauls letters (elsewhere only in 2 Cor 9:10; Col 2:19). In Phil 1:19 the cog-
nate noun epichore3 gia, help, is associated with the Spirit. Although the verb
in Gal 3:5 might be translated gives, the translation offers or provides (NASB)
seems preferable. Its present tense emphasizes the ongoing availability of the
Spirit, not a particular moment when believers receive the Spirit ( 3:2).
The cultural connotations of Pauls word choice almost certainly impressed his
rst readers with the generosity of Gods extravagant gift of the Spirit ( 3:1-5
BEHIND THE TEXT).
The Gi f t of t he Spi ri t
Normally, Paul used some form of the verb dido3mi, give (see Rom 5:5; 1
Cor 12:7, 8; 2 Cor 1:22; 5:5; Eph 1:17; 1 Thess 4:8; 2 Tim 1:7) to refer to Gods
gift of the Holy Spirit. In Gal 4:6, he referred to Gods sending (from apostelo3) of
the Spirit. As a result, the Spirit dwells (from oikeo3; see Rom 8:9, 11; 1 Cor 3:16;
2 Tim 1:14) within the church, and lls (from ple3roo3) it with Gods empowering
presence (Eph 5:18). Thus, all believers have (from echo3; see Rom 8:9, 23; 1 Cor
6:19; 7:40; 2 Cor 4:13) the Spirit. They are led (from ago3) by (Rom 8:14), walk
(from peripateo3) by (Gal 5:16), made alive (from zao3) by and keep in step (stoi-
cheo3) with (v 25) the Spirit.
We can only guess what kinds of miracles God may have worked among
the Galatians. The word translated miracles, dynamis, has a great range of
meaning in the NT (Friedrich 1990a, 358). It probably refers to miraculous
powers in Pauls list of spiritual gifts in 1 Cor 12:10 (see Matt 14:2; Mark
S
A
M
P
L
E
180
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 6-14
6:14). But it can refer to more ordinary, God-facilitated activities (see Eph
1:18-20; 3:20; Col 1:29).
The Greek participle in Gal 3:5 is an intensive form of the verb work.
The English word energy is derived from it. In Rom 7:5 and 1 Cor 4:12 it
clearly refers to an invisible, internal activity, not an external and obvious,
awe-inspiring event, which might call for the translation miracle. In Gal 2:8
Paul referred to Gods activity that empowered (energe3sas) Peter to his minis-
try with Jews; and, Paul to his ministry with Gentiles. In 5:6 he claimed that
the only thing that matters is faith expressing [energoumene3] itself through
love.
Thus, Pauls point in 3:5 may have been simply that God did things
in their lives they could never have done for themselves (see TM). This ts
the context better than the consensus of English translations, which refers to
miracles. The Spirit sometimes empowers believers to live courageously, obe-
diently, and effectively in the quiet miracle of transformed lives (see Friedrich
1990a, 357-58).
Pauls fth question asked the Galatians to choose between the same
two alternatives as in v 2: Did God powerfully work in your lives by works of
Law or because you believe what you heard? The differences between the
options in vv 2 and 5 exist only in English translations ( v 2).
Paul assumed that God gives the Spirit only to those who believe the
gospel of Christ. And in the next section of the letter, he attempted to prove
it by appeal to the Scriptures.
b. Proof by Appeal to Scripture: The Example of Abraham
(3:6-14)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Chrysostom plausibly construes the argumentative logic connecting Gal
3:1-5 and 6-14: Faith was the basis for Gods effective working among the
Galatians, apart from the Law. It was equally powerful in the life of Abraham,
before the Law was given. Paul assured them that faith, not Law, was the basis
for their kinship to Abraham (cited by Edwards 1999, 38).
Abrahams justication proved the apostles case that right standing with
God was entirely Gods doing, not a result of human effort. As he would later
in Rom 4, Paul appealed to the example of Abraham in Gen 1217. Was ap-
pealing to Abraham Pauls idea? Or, did the Agitators make this necessary?
The position occupied by Abraham in Jewish tradition seems to provide
the framework for Pauls exposition of Gen 1217. Here Abraham was not
simply one biblical gure among many, or even a particularly suitable choice.
He was the prototypical Jew. The choices Abraham made and the promises he
received were believed to be representative of the future of the entire nation.
It was impossible to dene Israel without dening Abraham and what it
S
A
M
P
L
E
181
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 6-14
meant to be his offspring (Gal 3:15-18). This may explain why Paul claimed
Abraham for the Christian faith, to show that believers, not observers of the
Law, are the offspring of Abraham and heirs of the promise he received (see
Gen 12:1-3).
Paul had to achieve two things in his scriptural recasting of Abraham.
First, he had to show that Scripture presented Abraham primarily as a person
of faith. He was made right with God on the basis of faith alone. Second, he
had to demonstrate that it was on the basis of righteousness by faith, apart from
the Law, that Abraham received for himself and his descendants the blessings
of salvation contained in Gods threefold promise (3:6-14). Although the ter-
minology of promise (v 14) is not explicit in Genesis, Gods words to Abraham
were understood by Paul and his contemporaries in these terms.
Blessing: The sequence of events in Gen 1217 is crucial to Pauls argu-
ment. The biblical account of Abraham begins with Gods call and promise
of sevenfold blessing in 12:1-3. Paul focused his attention particularly on the
seventh: all peoples of earth will be blessed through you (Gen 12:3; see Gal
3:8). This same promise is repeated in slightly different words in Gen 18:18
(following Abrahams entertaining of the three divine guests) and in 22:18
(following his obedient but aborted attempt to offer Isaac).
Despite Abrahams obedient response, he remained childless. And one
potential heir after another was disqualiedLot (Gen 13), Eliezer (Gen 15),
and Ishmael (Gen 1617). In response to Abrahams complaint about his
childlessness (Gen 15:2-3), God made two additional promises to Abraham:
progeny and land.
God promised Abraham that he would have a son and progeny as nu-
merous as the stars of heaven (Gen 15:4-5). To this specic promise he re-
sponded in faith (15:6a). And Scripture comments: God credited it to him as
righteousness (15:6b; Gal 3:6). After a lengthy covenant-making ceremony
(Gen 15:7-20), God promised Abraham that his descendants would inherit
the land of Canaan on which he stood (Gen 12:7; 13:15; 17:8; 24:7). Notably,
the land promise follows the gift of righteousness by faith and the progeny
promise.
Noncanonical Jewish tradition equated the land promise with the
promise that Abraham would bless all peoples on earth (see Gen 12:3). Ca-
naan came to represent the entire world (see Sir 44:21; Jub. 17:3; 22:14; 32:19;
1 En. 5:7; 4 Ezra 6:59). In an eschatological and transcendent sense, it was un-
derstood to comprehend even the world to come and the blessings of salvation
(see Matt 5:5; Heb 1:2). To be at Abrahams side came to be equated with
apocalyptic notions of paradise, the heavenly banquet, the intermediate state,
and even the consummated kingdom of God (see Luke 13:28-29; 16:22).
At stake in the discussion concerning Abraham in Gal 3:6-29 is nothing
less than the denition of Gods eschatological people: Who are the progeny
of Abraham? Who may have a share in the world to come, and upon what
S
A
M
P
L
E
182
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 6-14
terms? Paul appealed to Scripture to establish a place for uncircumcised be-
lievers within the community of salvation.
Contemporary Judaism (see Jas 2:18-24) considered Abraham the ar-
chetypical Jew. His exemplary faithfulness to the covenant involved observing
the Law before it was given. And it was on this basis that he was counted as
righteous. Jewish apocryphal writings claim that Abraham did not need grace,
because he perfectly observed the unwritten law of God (e.g., Jub. 16:28;
17:15-18; 18:16; 19:8; 24:11; 2 Bar. 57:1-2). Paul takes a 180-degree different
view of Abraham and the Law in Gal 3:19-29.
Had Paul appealed to the story of Abraham in his preaching on his visit
to Galatia? If so, he must have depended mostly on Gen 15:6, arguing, much
as he did in Galatians and Romans, that Abraham was the father of all believ-
ers, Jews and Gentiles. He almost certainly did not mention Gen 17, especially
vv 9-14. This passage insists that Gods covenant with Abraham required all
his male offspring to be circumcised. If they were not, they would be cut off
from his people (v 14).
Had the Agitators appealed to Gen 17 to urge circumcision upon the
Galatians? Or did the Galatians reach the conclusion that they needed to be
circumcised entirely on their own, by simply continuing to read Genesis be-
yond ch 15 ( Introduction)? We can only speculate. All we know with cer-
tainty about the situation depends on what Paul disclosed in his letter.
In some Jewish documents from Pauls day, we learn how and to what
extent he parted company with the rabbis on Abraham.
Some believed Abraham was reckoned as righteous because he proved
his faithfulness by offering Isaac (1 Macc 2:52; Sir 44:21; see Heb
11:8-12). His faithfulness in this test was meritorious for Abraham
and his descendants (see Longenecker 1990, 110-11).
Others considered Abraham the model Jew, who proved his faithful-
ness to God by observing the Law, particularly circumcision, centuries
before it was commanded (1 Macc 2:52; Sir 44:19-21; 2 Bar. 57:1-2;
Jub. 16:28; 17:15-18; 18:16; 19:824:11; esp. 23:10; CD 3:2; Philo,
Abr. 262-74 and Praem. 27; see Barrett 1963, 25-26).
Pauls Jewish contemporaries agreed that Abraham was justied by works of
Law! (contrast Gal 3:5).
Did the Agitators presume the traditional Jewish reading of the story
of Abraham in opposition to Pauls alternative view? Or, did Paul develop
his view of Abraham in response to the confusion created by the Agitators
interjection of the rabbinic understanding into the churches of Galatia? We
cannot be certain who set the exegetical agenda. Some scholars argue that
Pauls choice of texts and exegetical method was determined by the Agitators
(so Barrett 1976 / 1982). Others insist that, if Paul knew their arguments,
he could not simply have ignored the passages to which they most likely ap-
pealedGen 17:9-14 and Lev 12:3 (Witherington 1998a, 218).
S
A
M
P
L
E
183
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 6
I N THE TEXT
L 6 Paul began his exposition of the Abraham story with an abbreviated
Scripture-citation formula (see Betz 1979, 140 n. 13; Rom 1:17; 2:24; 3:4,
10; 4:17; 8:36; 9:13, 29, 33; 10:15; 11:8, 26; 15:3, 9, 21; 1 Cor 1:31; 2:9;
10:7; 2 Cor 8:15; 9:9; compare 2 Cor 6:16). Pauls failure to identify Gen
15:6 explicitly as Scripture is probably not signicant ( Gal 3:8). In Rom
4:2 he introduces his quotation of Gen 15:6 with the words, What does the
Scripture say?
Paul quoted the LXX of Gen 15:6 with three minor changes:
He omitted the initial conjunction And.
He replaced Genesis Abram with Abraham, a change that does not
occur until Gen 17:5.
He moved the name Abraham to the rst position in the sentence.
The aorist tense of the verb believed has an ingressive force, emphasizing
the beginning of Abrahams walk of faith ( Gal 2:16). Abraham began to
believe in God. Genesis emphasizes that Abraham believed Gods promise of
innumerable offspring (15:5). The second clause of the quotation identies
the result of the rst: Because Abraham trusted God, it was credited to him
as righteousness (Gal 3:6b).
God justied Abraham simply because he trusted Gods word (2:16, 17;
3:8, 11, 24; and 5:4). The verb was credited, accounted (KJV) or reckoned
(NASB, NRSV, RSV), is an accounting term meaning to set down on the credit
side. Paul used it metaphorically (as in Mal 3:16, which refers to Gods re-
cord book of human deeds [see Exod 32:32; Pss 56:8; 69:28; Isa 65:6; Dan
7:10; 12:1; Mal 3:16; Phil 4:3; Rev 3:5; 13:8; 17:8; 20:12, 15; Sanday and
Headlam 1929, 100]). The unstated actor in the transaction is obviously God.
Because Abraham trusted God, God gave him credit for something he had not
earnedrighteousness.
Abr aham i n Romans 4
Pauls later utilization of the Abraham story in Rom 4 elaborates on the
meaning of the verb reckoned in the midrash style of Jewish rabbis. He employed
their method to undermine their assumptions about Abraham. Following rabbinic
precedents, he appealed to Ps 32:1, in which the same verb appears. The method
assumed that such passages were mutually interpretive. Thus, to be counted righ-
teous was to be forgiven. Abraham was a justied sinner. Justication was not a
divine stamp of approval on a life of awless obedience, for God justies the
wicked (Rom 4:5). Despite their obvious similarities, the two passages approach
Abraham differently. And it is inappropriate to explain Galatians by appeal to
Pauls later letter to the Romans.
S
A
M
P
L
E
184
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:7
L 7 Pauls quotation of Gen 15:6 led to an immediate application. The verb
gino3skete could be construed as a commandUnderstandor a conclusion
you see (NRSV). In either case, his point was to introduce an inference. Since
God credited Abraham with righteousness, because he believed God, you
may be sure, then (BDAG, 127, s.v. ara) that people of faith are Abrahams
children.
Paul moved easily from the verb form pisteuo3, believe, in v 6 to the relat-
ed noun form, pistis, faith, in v 7. What is obvious in Greek is less so in English.
Those who believe is literally the ones from faith. The contrast between faith
and works of Law introduced in 2:16 () continues in 3:2 and 5. Did God
give the Galatians the Spirit because they heard with faith or because they did
works of Law? The ones from faith; these are sons of Abraham.
The antithetical framing of Pauls argument implies that the descen-
dants of Abraham (NRSV; see Lightfoot 1874, 156-59; and Burton 1920, 156-
59) are dened on the basis of faith, not on the basis of works of Law. The
mention of Gentiles in v 8 suggests that ones ethnicitynatural descentis
not a factor. But neither is ones gender ( 3:26-29). There is no reason to
think Pauls masculine plural noun, huioi (lit., sons), referred only to Abra-
hams male descendants. Thus, the translation children (KJV, NIV) is appropri-
ate. This gender-neutral rendering may be traced back to Tyndales sixteenth-
century chyldren. Galatians clearly addressed both males and females.
This becomes explicit in 3:26-29: You are all sons of God through
faith in Christ Jesus (v 26). Gender distinctions are inconsequential,
for you are all one in Christ Jesus (v 28).
It is also implicit in his use of the gender-neutral term tekna, chil-
dren, in 4:19, 25, 27, 28, and 31.
In the patriarchal culture of the rst century A.D., Pauls inclusion of
women among Abrahams sons may have elevated their status to equality. In
our gender-conscious culture, however, it may communicate the unintended
suggestion that women are excluded from the family of Gods chosen people.
Thus, children is the most appropriate translation. Of course, Paul used nei-
ther sons nor children in a literal biological sense. Their descent from Abra-
ham was dened by faith, not Law observance or ethnicity. To identify believ-
ers metaphorically as children emphasized the kinship-like relationship they
enjoyed with Abraham.
In Matt 5:45 and Luke 6:35 Jesus identied Gods children based on their
love, which was as all-inclusive as that of their heavenly Father. Similarly, John
8:31-47 denes paternity in terms of deeds, not natural descent. Gods children
relate to others as God does to them. Just so, Abrahams children follow his
example. Since Abraham believed God, so do his children. To be Abrahams
children in this NT sense means sharing his faith, not his genes. In Gal 3:15-18,
Paul would employ rabbinic exegesis to demonstrate the absurdity of the notion
that ones status as Abrahams children could be dened by the Law.
S
A
M
P
L
E
185
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 8
L 8 Verse 8 provides the scriptural evidence for Pauls conclusion in v 7. Paul
quoted the LXX of Gen 12:3 (compare 18:18 and 22:18) as prophetic. Using
personication, Paul claimed that the Scripture foresaw what God would do
in the future. What was future for Abraham, Paul identied as the present age
of fulllment in which he and his readers lived.
Paul always cited the OT as the Scripture (singular) when it was the
subject of a sentence (in the nominative case, as in Rom 4:3; 9:17; 10:11; 11:2;
Gal 3:8, 22; 4:30; 1 Tim 5:18; 2 Tim 3:16). In the oblique cases, he referred
to it as the Scriptures (plural, as in Rom 1:2; 15:4; 16:26; 1 Cor 15:3, 4).
Before citing the scriptural quotation, Paul explained its implications
with the clause: that God would justify the Gentiles by faith. In Greek, the
means of justicationby faith (see Gal 2:16; 3:2, 5, 6)stands in the em-
phatic rst position.
In 3:6 and 7, Paul treated (the verb) believe and having (the noun)
faith as equivalent. Similarly, he treated being credited with righteousness
(the abstract noun dikaiosyne3 in v 6) as equivalent to God justifying (the verb
dikaioi in v 8) someone (see Winger 1999). In both instances, the Greek verbs
and nouns belong to the same cognate families, which would have been obvi-
ous to his Greek-speaking audience. Unfortunately, English convention em-
ploys two different cognate families for the nouns and the verbs, obscuring
this connection.
Paul typically used the passive voice of the verb dikaioo3 to refer to the
act of being made righteous / justied. This allowed him to bring the recipi-
ents into the foreground of Gods activity. Of its twenty-seven appearances in
Pauls letters, v 8 is one of just six instances (Rom 3:26, 30; 4:5; 8:30 [twice],
33) in which he used the verb in the active voice. Only here is God explicitly
and emphatically identied as the grammatical subject of the verb: God justi-
es.
The Greek term ethne3 appears twice in v 8. It is translated Gentiles in
its rst instance (as in Gal 1:16; 2:2, 8, 9, 12, 14, 15; and 3:14); and, nations
in its second. For English readers, this obscures the obvious relevance of the
quotation to the apostles argument.
Some NT authors used the singular form, ethnos, with the neutral mean-
ing nation, applying it to the people of Israel as well as to foreigners (see, e.g.,
Matt 24:7; Mark 13:8; Luke 7:5; 21:10; 23:2; John 11:48, 50, 51, 52; 18:35;
Acts 2:5; 10:22, 35; 17:26; 24:2; 26:4; 28:19; Rev 5:9; 7:9; 14:6). But Paul
never used the term in the singular, following standard OT and Jewish usage.
He reserved the term ethne3 for non-Jews. During the NT period, Jews in gen-
eral distinguished the Hebrew terms (am, referring to the Jews as the people
of God, and go=yim, the non-Israelite peoples, that is, Gentiles.
S
A
M
P
L
E
186
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 8
Gent i l es as Et hnophaul i sm
Jews consistently associated a negative value judgment with the term Gen-
tiles. The term was intended as an ethnophaulisman ethnic slur. Jews consis-
tently stereotyped non-Jews as different from them using unattering terms (see
Matt 5:47; 6:7, 32; 8:11; Mark 10:42; Luke 12:30). Pauls letters reect some such
standard cultural assumptions: Gentiles do not know God (1 Thess 4:5). They
are sinners by nature (Gal 2:15; see 1 Cor 5:1; 12:2).
The Gospels often call attention to uncharacteristic exceptions to the
rule. Jesus recognized some Gentiles as more responsive to his message than
his Jewish contemporaries (e.g., Matt 3:9; 8:5-13; 11:20-24; 12:41-42; Mark 7:25-
30; Luke 17:12-19). Early Hellenistic Christians were willing to include Gentiles
without demanding that they adopt the customary Jewish boundary markers,
particularly circumcision. This liberal stance is apparently what led Paul in his
pre-Christian days to persecute Christians (Gal 1:13, 23).
After his encounter with the risen Christ, Paul became the churchs chief
defender of the Gentile mission. In Romans he insisted that Jews were no less
natural-born sinners than Gentiles (Rom 2:13:20, 23). Since there is only one
God, Paul concluded that he is equally the God of Gentiles and Jews (3:29). Paul
identied himself as called by God to be an apostle to the Gentiles (Gal 1:15-16;
2:2, 7-9; Rom 1:5; 15:6-18; 16:26; Eph 3:1-10; Col 1:27; 1 Tim 2:7; 2 Tim 4:17).
Because of his ministry among the Gentiles, Paul himself became a victim of
Jewish persecution (1 Thess 2:16; see Acts 17:5-15; 18:12-17; 20:3; 21:19-22, 27-
28). In Gal 5:11, he hinted that he was persecuted because he no longer preached
circumcision. In 6:12 he alleged that those who agitated the Galatians to become
circumcised did so only to avoid being persecuted for the cross of Christ.
Unlike most of Pauls Jewish contemporaries and some Jewish Christians,
he refused to dismiss the go=yim, Gentiles, as those who are far from God, even
enemies of God, or at least not elect by God (Walter 1990a, 382). He perhaps
used the term Gentile reluctantly. Both ethne3 and akrobysia were, after all,
intended as ethnic slurs. In Gal 3:28 he used the term Helle3n, Greek, as the
counterpart to Ioudaios, Jew (so also Rom 1:14, 16; 2:9, 10; 3:9; 10:12; 1 Cor
1:22, 24; 10:32; 12:13; Gal 2:3; Col 3:11).
Before citing Gen 12:3, Paul again interpretively characterized its im-
port: the Scripture . . . announced the gospel in advance to Abraham. This
includes the only NT appearance of the verb proeue3ngelisato. The compound
prexes the preposition before to the familiar verb preach the gospel (twenty-
one times in Pauls letters; thirty-one times elsewhere in the NT). Paul nor-
mally reserved this verb to describe the Christian message about Jesus Christ,
particularly his death and resurrection (1 Thess 3:6 is the only exception).
What Paul identied as good news here predated the coming of Christ
by nearly two millennia. And he did not focus on Christ, the divine benefactor
who made the good news possible, but on the unexpected beneciaries. The
S
A
M
P
L
E
187
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 8-10
gospel was anticipated in Gods promise of blessing to Abraham, which Paul
adapted from Gen 12:3All nations will be blessed through you. Instead of
All nations the LXX has all tribes on earth.
Pauls quotation does not exactly follow any of Genesis repetitions of
this promise.
In 17:4-6, God tells Abraham, You will be the father of many na-
tions. . . . for I have made you a father of many nations. . . . I will make
nations of you. But it fails to mention the blessing.
In 18:18, God reports his promise: All nations on earth will be blessed
through him. It uses the third person (him rather than you) and
adds on earth.
In 22:18, God promises Abraham: All nations on earth will be
blessed. But he does not say through you, rather through your off-
spring. And he adds the rationale, because you have obeyed me.
Gods repetition of the promise to Isaac in 26:4-5 would have been
even more problematic for Pauls purposes: Through your offspring
all nations on earth will be blessed, because Abraham obeyed me and
kept my requirements, my commands, my decrees and my laws.
Paul understood the promised blessing to have been based entirely on faith
and to have had the nature of proto-gospel.
L 9 Paul offered the contemporary consequences of the exegetical connec-
tion between Gen 15:6 and 12:3: So people of faith are blessed with faithful
Abraham. In Greek, those who have faith exactly repeats the words translated
those who believe in Gal 3:7. But in his application, Paul replaced the twice
repeated preposition en, through, with syn, along with. He emphasized not
Abrahams mediation of the blessing, but his sharing of it with all believers.
Thus, for the Gentiles to be blessed with Abraham meant to be blessed
in the same way he was. That is, they were counted as righteous without be-
ing circumcised or observing the Law. Like Abraham, they had only faith to
commend them to God; they had done nothing to merit Gods blessing: The
covenant sign of circumcision was not given until Gen 17. The offering of Isaac
was not mentioned until Gen 22. And the Law would not be given until cen-
turies later (Gal 3:17).
The apostle did not here specify the nature of the blessing to be be-
stowed on the nations. Only as his argument moved forward did it become
clear that the blessing consisted in the experience of the Spirit and the status
of justication. These were for Paul inconceivable apart from each other.
Each implies the other. Those persons upon whom God bestows the Spirit are
justied; the persons whom God reckons righteous have the Spirit poured out
upon them (Williams 1987, 97).
L 10 Genesis 22:18 and 26:5 suggest that Gods blessing upon the Gentiles
was a reward for Abrahams strict obedience to the Law. This might imply that
Gentile believers were to follow his example of Law observance, particularly
S
A
M
P
L
E
188
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:10
the covenant requirement of circumcision (Gen 17:9-14). But Paul reached
the opposite conclusion: For as many as are of the works of the Law are under
a curse (Gal 3:10 NASB). That is, God would execute the disaster threatened
in the pronouncement of the curse.
In Galatians, the expression by works of Law (see 2:16; 3:2, 5) always
serves as the antithesis of by faith. Faith was the only condition for sharing
Abrahams blessing. Believers were blessed with Abraham. But who were the
cursed unbelieversthose who are of the works of Law ( 2:16 sidebar, Law
in Galatians)?
Did Paul refer to legalists? Were his sights fxed on anyone who at-
tempted to enter into or sustain a right relationship with God on the
basis of strict obedience to the Jewish law (see 3:2-5, 6, 11)? Did he
use the expression as an equivalent describing those who attempted to
live the Christian life in the eshby human effort rather than by
dependence on God (see v 3)?
Did Paul refer to the Agitators? Are those who are of the works of
Law to be identied with those so concerned about making a good im-
pression in the esh that they were trying to compel [the Galatians]
to be circumcised (6:12)?
Did he refer to those from the circumcision (2:12; see v 16), whether
or not they were complicating matters in his Galatian churches? If so,
i
Did he refer only to non-Christian Jews?
i
Or, did he include false brothers (v 4)ultraconservative Jewish
Christians who required Gentile Christians to accept circumcision
and other Jewish customs (v 14)?
A curse ( 3:13) was the logical antithesis of the divine blessing believ-
ers shared with Abraham (see vv 8-9, 14). To insist on works of Law (see
2:16; 3:2, 5, 11, 12) entailed turning from the grace of Christ . . . to a differ-
ent gospelwhich is really no gospel at all (1:6-7). It was to bring upon one-
self the eternal condemnation of the conditional curse pronounced in vv 8-9.
Thus, Paul warned: You who are trying to be justied by law have been
alienated from Christ; you have fallen away from grace (5:4). The curse con-
sisted in severing ones relationship with Christ and the consequent loss of
nal salvation. To rely on the Law (as represented by circumcision) instead of
Christ invalidated the blessing promised Abraham on the condition of faith
alone ( 5:2-6; see Harmon 2010, 205).
Paul supported his claim that All who rely on observing the law are un-
der a curse by appeal to Deut 27:26 (LXX). Here, as thirty times elsewhere
in his letters, he introduced the scriptural quotation with it is written (only in
Romans; 1 and 2 Corinthians; and Gal 3:13; 4:22, 27).
With minor variations, the quotation follows the LXX. The most sig-
nicant departure is in the underlined words in this fairly literal translation:
Cursed is everyone who does not remain in all the things written in the
S
A
M
P
L
E
189
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:10-11
book of the Law to do them. The LXX refers to the words of this Law. Paul
generalized the application of the curse to include the entire Torah, consistent
with his warning in 5:3: Every man who lets himself be circumcised . . .
is obligated to obey the whole law. Those who are of works of Law must
scrupulously comply with every last demand of the Law. As a norm for life, it
requires absolute and entire observance. Any failure to do so will meet with
the certain disaster threatened by the curse.
Paul did not object to particular laws. Nor did he malign human moral
activity in general ( chs 56). His problem was with the Law itself. With
the coming of Christ, it had outlived its usefulness ( 3:19). Anyone who
chooses to abide by the Jewish Torah in order to secure participation in Abra-
hams blessing is placed in a situation where he or she is threatened instead
with a curse since the Law itself pronounces a curse on anyone who fails to
live up to every single one of its requirements (Stanley 1990, 500).
The Galatians risked putting themselves under a divine curse, if they
surrendered to the Agitators. Deliberative rhetoric called for more than posi-
tive reasons for future choices. Effective persuasion appealed to negative,
emotional arguments for avoiding their opposite (Aristotle, Rhet. 2.5.2, 9).
Warnings of the fearful consequences of abandoning the gospel were undoubt-
edly persuasive to an ancient audience that took seriously the power of bless-
ings and curses (Stanley 1990, 501; Witherington 1998a, 233).
L 11 Paul claimed: It is obvious that by Law no one is justied in the sight of
God! Why so? It is uncertain what Paul assumed comprehensive and constant
obedience to the Law demanded (v 10). Was it possible by conscientious at-
tention to the Laws demands for humans to avoid becoming subject to Gods
curse?
Di d Paul Consi der Per f ect Obedi ence
t o t he Law Possi bl e ?
The question . . . cannot be answered with complete certainty (Cranford
1994, 257). Pauls retrospective testimony in Phil 3:6-9 indicates that before he
became a Christian he considered his own righteousness by Law blameless. It
was not the personal experience of moral failure that led him to see the impos-
sibility of being justied by law as clear (GNT, NAB, NCV, NLT), evident (ESV, KJV,
NASB, NRSV), and obvious (ISV, NJB, TM; Gal 3:11). It was his life-changing encounter
with the risen Christ that did.
This event split his life in two. After it, he saw all he had previously consid-
ered assets, including his own righteousness by Law, as decits, even worthless
crap (skybala, a comparably coarse term; BDAG, 932). His earlier assump-
tions were mistaken (Phil 3:6-9). If Rom 7 is even remotely autobiographical, Paul
came to realize that even his best pre-Christian intentions achieved regrettable
results. Thinking he was pleasing God by persecuting heretics, he discovered
them to be the true people of God.
S
A
M
P
L
E
190
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:11
In Rom 3:9-19 Paul presented a catena of scriptural proofs for his conten-
tion that Jews and Gentiles alike are all under sin (v 9). This, in turn, is the
basis for his conclusion: Therefore no one will be declared righteous in [Gods]
sight by observing the law [ex ergo3n nomou] (3:20a). The similarity to Gal 3:11a
is unmistakable: Clearly no one is justied before God by the law. The
difference is that only in Romans did Paul present the evidence he considered
obvious when he wrote Galatians. But was it as obvious to the Galatians and
the Agitators as it was to him?
Both passages insist that God alone is qualied to judge who is right and
who is wrong. To be justied before God is to be made righteous in his sight
(BDAG, 757, s.v. para). It is not that God merely considers the unrighteous to
be righteous despite all the evidence to the contrary. Gods future declaration
that one is righteous will not be a miscarriage of justice. God makes people right
with him and empowers them by the gift of his Spirit actually to do right (see
Rom 8:1-4).
Only in Romans would Paul clarify why Law can diagnose the human prob-
lem, but is powerless to cure it (3:20b). Law can reveal what is wrong with us;
but it cannot make us righteous. Law effects, not Gods righteousness, but Gods
wrath (4:15). It is unable to justify because of its own victimization by Sin (ch 7).
In Galatians, the rst biblical rationale Paul offered in defense of the
self-evident impossibility of justication by the Law is Hab 2:4. The righ-
teous will live by faith. Pauls citation is not identical to any surviving manu-
script of the LXX nor to the standard MT of the Hebrew OT. All of these use
personal pronouns Paul omits (here and in Rom 1:17). Some manuscripts of
the LXX refer to my righteous one (emphasis added), as does Heb 10:38.
The MT has his faith (emphasis added). Most LXX manuscripts have my
faith (emphasis added).
The future tense verb will live is a logical, not a predictive future. It
refers to the end-times salvation already available to believers in Christ (see
Hab 3:18-19; Gal 3:11). The phrase by faith indicates how the righteous will
receive salvation, that is, how they will be justied in Gods sight (Hays 1983,
151). The Greek words translated righteous (dikaios) and justify (dikaioo3) be-
long to the same cognate family, despite the English differences. Two ques-
tions are crucial to any interpretation of the passage:
First, who is the righteous one? Interpreters typically take the righteous
to refer to all who are justied by faith (e.g., Longenecker 1990, 119). In Acts
3:14; 7:52; 22:14; 1 Pet 3:18; and 1 John 2:1 (following Isa 53:10-12) the righ-
teous one seems to refer to the Messiah (Hays 1983, 151-54).
Second, by whose faith will the righteous one live? Faith translates the
Hebrew emunah, faithfulness. Its Greek equivalent, pistis, may mean both
faithfulness and faith. Hays contends that Paul omitted the pronouns in his
quotation of Hab 2:4 to make the point that salvation life came because of
Gods faithfulness, the faithfulness of the Messiah, and the faith Gods people
S
A
M
P
L
E
191
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:11-12
place in him. Paul held all of these understandings at once (Hays 1983, 156-
57; see Longenecker 1990, 119, and Witherington 1998a, 234-35, for an alter-
native explanation).
Pauls gospel is founded upon the story of a Messiah who is vindi-
cated (= justied) by God through faith. This Messiah (Jesus Christ)
is not, however, a solitary individual whose triumph accrues only to his
own benet; he is a representative gure in whom the destiny of all
Gods elect is embodied. Thus, all are justied through his faith. Their
response to him, however, is also one of faith. (Hays 1983, 156-57)
In the light Christ sheds upon the prophets statement, Paul took Habak-
kuk to speak about justication by faith (Gal 3:8). God promised the Spirit to
Abraham and to his offspring Jesus Christ and to all who by faith participate
in him. Salvation depends entirely on what God has done in Christ. Noth-
ing humans can do, including works of Law, can justify them. In v 12, Paul
explained why by comparing Hab 2:4 with Lev 18:5 (see Rendall 1903, 169).
L 12 The law is not based on faith (ek pisteo3s). This Greek expression appears
at least twenty times in Romans and Galatians (Rom 1:17 [twice]; 3:26, 30;
4:16 [twice]; 5:1; 9:30, 32; 10:6; 14:23 [twice]; Gal 2:16; 3:7, 8, 9, 11, 12,
22; 5:5 [see 3:2, 5]), but never in any of Pauls other letters (and only in Heb
10:38 [quoting Hab 2:4] and Jas 2:24 elsewhere in the NT).
The preposition ek may indicate origin, cause, or reason (BDAG, 296,
s.v. ek 3). The Law did not come from faith, nor was it caused by faith, nor did
its existence depend on faith. The Law did not call for faith, but for absolute
obedience. Paul considered faith and Law opposites. He quoted an excerpt
from Lev 18:5 (LXX) to prove his claim: The [one] who does these things
will live by them.
The rabbinic principle of gezerah shawah) (equal category) encouraged
the interpretation of one passage by comparison with another based on their
common terminology (Bruce 1975, 115). The shared verbs ze3setai, will live,
connect the quotations of Lev 18:5 (in Gal 3:12) with that of Hab 2:4 (in
Gal 3:11). The promise of salvation life by faith stands in stark contrast to
life based on doing what the Law requires (Lev 18:4-5). Law does not call for
faith, but for compliancenot for believing, but for doing.
Paul took for granted that those who confessed Jesus as Lord obeyed him
(Rom 1:5; 16:26). But his concern here was to clarify how one entered into
the experience of salvation life (i.e., justication / righteousness before God).
He insisted that the entrance to this life was by believing, not doing.
Those who have been justied by faith receive the Spirit, who enables
them to live renewed lives of love (Gal 5:6). The obedience of the justied was
not dened by the traditional boundary markers separating Jews and Gentiles,
such as circumcision. The relational nature of justication called for not only
a right relationship with God but also a restored relationship between Jews
and the Gentiles.
S
A
M
P
L
E
192
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:12
Pauls doctrine of justication was not simply a rejection of either con-
temporary Judaism or the OT, as many Protestant interpreters of Pauls gos-
pel mistakenly assumed in the past. They wrongly pitted Christianity against
Judaism, which they unfairly maligned as a degenerate, legalistic religion. E.
P. Sanders opened the possibility of a new perspective on Paul (see Sanders
1983 and Dunn 2005). He insists that Judaism was a religion of grace. Human
obedience was always understood as a response to that grace. The covenant
was given by Gods initiative. The Law provided instruction as to how to re-
main within the covenant, not the means of entering it. He labeled this new
understanding covenantal nomism.
The entire Pauline corpus of letters suggests that grace is always prior to
human effort. Human doing is in response to Gods initiative (Phil 2:12-13).
Good works are the fruit, not the root, of salvation (Eph 2:8-10; Gal 5:6, 13-
15, 22-25). The justied receive nal acceptance with God, so long as they
continue in the faith and obedience grace makes possible (Col 1:21-23). Paul
should not be read as an opponent of messianic Judaism. Jews as well as non-
Jews needed to take seriously that the new age had dawned with the coming of
Jesus as the Jewish Messiah. The old order has gone; a new order has already
begun (2 Cor 5:17b REB). All this has been the work of God (2 Cor 5:18a
REB). This new reality had dramatic implications for the Law.
The dawning of the new age was not a human achievement. It was inau-
gurated by Gods apocalyptic intervention in Christ. Pauls point in Gal 3:12
was not to undermine the Jewish law as Torah, divine instruction. Gods gift
of the Messiah had already made its necessity a matter of accomplished his-
tory. Paul insisted on maintaining the antithesis between human achievement
and divine gift, between works and grace.
Paul distinguished between the law as a power that demands righteous-
ness that humans cannot achieve and law as Scripture that afrms righteous-
ness through faith. Salvation was not a matter of observing a Law that de-
mands good works but produces only the awareness of sin (see Rom 3:20;
Jewett 2008, 297).
Fai t h vs. Works i n Romans 4
In Rom 4 Paul developed his understanding of the relationship between
believing and doing beyond what he wrote in Gal 3. He insisted that the new thing
God had done in Christ did not undo all he had done in the past. On the contrary,
the Law as Scripture is fullled in Christ (Rom 3:31; 8:1-4). Abraham was the
parade example that God had always put people right with himself on the basis of
faith, not works (4:2; 3:27).
Believing is not something people do instead of obeying the Law as a new
means of winning Gods approval. In Pauls view, faith is not a work at all. People
are not justied by their faith, but by God. Otherwise they would have some-
thing to boast aboutbut not before God (4:2). Faith is openness to receiving
S
A
M
P
L
E
193
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:12-13
Gods gift of righteousness. It relies on the divine benefactor, not on human
achievement. Thus, faith and grace are complementary; faith and works
are competitors.
Faith is not a human achievement. Instead, faith means trusting Gods word
and work so completely that we despair of human work as a means of gain-
ing Gods favor. Faith is grateful receptivity to Gods gift. Justication by grace
through faith is wholly apart from any trace of human merit (vv 4-5). Christian
faith, like Abrahams, is not a good work. It trusts the reliability of Gods promise
alone and places no condence in human achievement.
But Christian faith is not passive. It is active surrender, the abandonment
of schemes of self-salvation. It follows the example of Jesus, who acted upon
the conviction that those who save their own lives lose them. Christian faith is
a trusting response to Gods gracious offer of redemption in Christ. Christian
faith is the realization that if we are ever to be saved, God will have to do it; we
cannot save ourselves.
L 13 Paul returned to the discussion of the curse of the law raised by the in-
troduction of the scriptural quotation in v 10. The rabbinic principle of gezerah
shawah) ( v 12) allowed him to interpret Deut 27:26 (quoted in Gal 3:10) in
light of Deut 21:23 (quoted in Gal 3:13).
The solution to the problem of Law was not exegetical, but eschato-
logical. That is, Pauls end-time convictions about what the coming of Christ
implied, not obvious interpretive necessity, determined his conclusions. His
exegetical conclusions depended on his prior assumptions.
In the NT the rare verb redeemed (exe3gorasen) describes the saving work
of Christ only here and in 4:5 (used differently in Eph 5:16; Col 4:5). Re-
demption involves buying back in the sense of setting captives or slaves free
(BDAG, 343; 4:215:1 BEHIND THE TEXT).
Redempt i on
In everyday economic transactions we still use redemption for the pro-
cess of getting a pawned item out of hock or claiming a discount code for an
Internet purchase. But the NT has no interest in the pawn dealer whom Christ
paid to free us from slavery. Nor does it focus on the reduced cost to the buyer.
Paul emphasized the extravagant price God paid to liberate usthe voluntary
death of his Son ( 5:1 BEHIND THE TEXT).
In 1 Cor 6:20a and 7:23a Paul used the same root as here (agorazo3) to
describe the redemption purchase of Christians: You were bought at a price
by God. This verb was often used in antiquity to refer to the purchase of slaves
(Martin 1990, 63). The essential point is that believers now belong to God, not
to whom was the price paid (Sanday and Headlam 1929, 85-86)? If Paul thought
about the question, he never answered it in his letters. They certainly give no
basis for later notions, rst associated with the third-century church father Ori-
gen, about a ransom to Satan (see Auln [2003] on theories of the atonement).
S
A
M
P
L
E
194
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:13
Another common synonym for redemption in the NT is apolytro3sis (see
Luke 21:28; Eph 1:7, 14; 4:30; Col 1:14; Heb 9:15; 11:35). Paul used it in Rom 3:24
to refer to the redemption that came by Christ Jesus. In 8:23 he described the
future resurrection as the redemption of our bodies. Alongside righteous-
ness and holiness in 1 Cor 1:30, it refers to the comprehensive saving work of
Christ. Words in the lytr- cognate family, ransom, appear eighty-ve times in the
NT, sometimes as a synonym of exagorazo3 / redeem (e.g., Mark 10:45 || Matt
20:28; Acts 20:28; 1 Cor 6:20; 7:23; 1 Pet 1:18; 2 Pet 2:1; Rev 5:9).
Regardless of the terminology, redemption serves as a metaphor describ-
ing the consequences of the saving work of Christ. Pauls concern was not with
the details of the purchase or with what once held humanity in its death grip. It
was with the freedom it effected. It is for freedom that Christ has set us free
( 5:1a; see 5:13).
In 3:13, Paul implies that the most revealing synonym of justify is re-
deem from slavery (Martyn 1997, 388). The point of redemption language is
that the saving death of Christ sets people free. Christ liberates, releases, and
delivers them from whatever held them captive. Humanitys personied Cap-
tors included our sins and the present evil age (1:4). Redemption involved
a rescue operation ( 1:4), which cost Christ his life (1:4; see 2:20). By
his death on the cross, he set us free from the curse of the law. This shameful
death meant that Christ became a curse for us.
The genitive construction, the curse of the law, calls for clarication. The
word curse describes the results of pronouncing words threatening disaster
and destruction due to divine retribution ( 1:6-9 BEHIND THE TEXT).
The personied Law utters a curse (subjective genitive) on those who fail to
obey it fully. This succinctly expresses what Paul would argue at length in
Rom 1:183:20. All of us stand guilty before God (see 5:18) as responsible
sinners (see 3:23), deserving divine judgment.
But we are blessed because Christ was cursed. Paul frequently described
salvation brought in terms of the logic of role reversal. A variety of images
throughout his letters express the recurrent theme that salvation is a divine
interchange, in which the assets of Christ are given in exchange for human
decits. See Rom 8:3-4; 1 Cor 1:21-23; 2 Cor 5:14-21; 8:9; Gal 2:19; 4:4-5;
Phil 2:6-9; 3:20-21; 1 Thess 5:10; 2 Tim 2:11.
Sal vat i on as I nt erchange
The second-century church father Irenaeus recognized this theme in his
doctrine of recapitulation: Christ became what we are, in order that we might be-
come what he is (Haer. 5 preface). More recently, Hooker aptly referred to this
as the interchange God effected between believers and Christ (1971 and 1978).
This interchange of experience is not a simple exchange. . . . [Christ] enters
into our experience, and we then enter into his, by sharing in his resurrection
S
A
M
P
L
E
195
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:13
(Hooker 1971, 352). Gods resurrection of Jesus signied Gods acceptance of
the outsider, the cursed law-breaker, the Gentile sinner (Dunn 1993, 178). In
his life and death, Christ acts as the representative of humanity, not its substitute
(Hooker 1971, 358).
In Gal 3:13 Paul declared that Christ freed us from the curse of the law
by becoming a curse for us. To become a curse is to become accursed (Jer
24:9; 42:18; Zech 8:13; Mussner 1977, 233). On the cross, Christ endured the
supreme penalty for Lawbreakers, death under the curse of God, which was
rightfully ours (Matera 1992, 124). God sent his Son, born . . . under law . . .
to redeem (Gal 4:4-5). He endured the curse of the law, not because he was
a Lawbreaker, but to redeem us Lawbreakers.
Paul applied the LXX of Deut 21:23 to Christ. Cursed is everyone who
is hung on a tree. But he omitted the phrase hypo tou Theou, cursed by God,
from his quotation. Christ suffered the consequences of the curse pronounced
on the crucied. Read alongside Gal 1:4, this suggests that Christs shameful
death rescued us from ultimate shamethe penalty of death for our failure
to render the obedience the Law demandedfor our sins. The one who is
hanged is thus regarded as accursed in the sense that, as a publicly exposed
example of the pitiless severity of the Law, he stands under the very curse
which the Law brings on those who transgress it (Bchsel 1964, 450).
What did it mean for Christ to become a curse for us? And how did the
cursed Christ become the source of blessing for us? Hooker claims the answer
lies in the characteristic Pauline formula in Christ: in him old distinctions
are done away, and all are one (see 3:28). God turned the curse into a source
of blessing by setting people free. In the resurrection of Christ, God over-
ruled the judgment of the Law. Christ has brought blessing to the Gentiles
because he himself has become a blessing. Blessing has thus proved more pow-
erful than the curse (Hooker 1971, 351).
Crucixion was not the mode of punishment envisioned by the rst
readers of Deuteronomy. They almost certainly thought of the public expo-
sure of the impaled corpse of an executed criminalinsult added to fatal in-
jury. Such shaming served to deter others who might be tempted to follow the
bad example.
But Paul was not the only rst-century Jew to take Deut 21:23 as a refer-
ence to crucixion (see the Qumran texts 11QT
a
64:6-13; 4Q169 pNah 1:17-
18; Kuhn 1975, 36-37; Wilcox 1977; OBrien 2006). John 19:31 reports that
the Jewish leaders asked that the body of the crucied Jesus be removed from
the cross and buried before sundown, in compliance with Deut 21:23aYou
must not leave his body on the tree overnight.
Who is us for whom Christ became accursed? That is, whom did Paul
have in mind as the recipients of Christs redeeming work in Gal 3:13? Is this
S
A
M
P
L
E
196
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:13-14
an exclusive or inclusive we? Did it exclude or include Pauls Galatian audi-
ence? Did Christ die to redeem Jews only or to redeem all?
In v 13 the frst person plural (= we, us, our) appears for the frst time
since 2:15-16. There Pauls report of the Antioch incident used we
to refer to himself and his fellow Jewish Christians in contrast to the
Gentile members of the community. Does what he said about us here
apply only to Jewish Christians (exclusive)? or,
Does it apply equally to his Gentile-Christian (inclusive) audience
(see Dabelstein 1990, 1)?
A plausible case can be made for the inclusive readingthat redemption
was for all. Galatians 3:13 refers to the Laws curse (Deut 27:26; 21:23) as the
revelation of Gods will; thus, God enforces the curse. Romans indicates that
all humanity, not just Jews, stands under Gods wrath (1:19-32) and judgment
(5:18; see Bchsel 1964, 450).
But perhaps a stronger case can be made for an exclusive reading of Pauls
rst person pluralthat redemption here applies to Jews only.
Galatians 4:5 identifes the redeemed as those under law. In 1 Cor
9:20 those under the law refers to Jews (see Donaldson 1986;
Witherington 1998a, 236-37).
Because the Jews had repeatedly failed to obey the Law God had given
them, they alone were under the Laws curse and in need of redemp-
tion (Wright 1991, 145-47).
The narrative fow of the argument from 3:10 through 4:7 (see Don-
aldson 1986, 95) suggests that Christ became a curse for the Jews to
free them from the Laws curse so that all believers, Jews and Gentiles
alike, might share in the blessings of their redemption (Witherington
1998a, 236-37).
The emphatic placement of us in 3:13 and of the Gentiles in 3:14 sug-
gests a possible intended contrast between the two groups (Wither-
ington 1998a, 237; see Donaldson 1986, 102).
L 14 The words He redeemed us have no basis in Greek. They summarize the
central point of v 13. Pauls Greek sentence (vv 13 and 14) is too long to make
good English sense, so translators break it into multiple sentences.
Verse 14 consists of two purpose or result clauses. It is impossible to be
certain whether Paul explained why Christ redeemed us or the consequences
of his saving death. Did he offer two parallel purposes / results (Rendall 1903,
170)? Or, does the second clause state a further purpose / result of the rst? If
he used us exclusively in v 13, his point was that Christ endured the curse of
the Law to redeem Jews so that the blessings of Abraham might be extended
to the Gentiles (Witherington 1998a, 239).
If this was his point, it was particularly relevant to the Antioch inci-
dent. The death of Christ freed Jewish Christians from the requirements of
the Law that forbade them from associating with Gentiles, such as circumci-
S
A
M
P
L
E
197
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:14
sion and kosher laws. This made it possible for Gentiles as Gentiles to share
in the blessing of being included as Abrahams children alongside his Jewish
offspring. This fullled the promise that all the Gentiles would be blessed
through Abraham (v 8). This, in turn, made it possible for Jews to enjoy the
fulllment of the eschatological promise of the age of the Spirit. No longer
would external coercion to obey the Law be necessary. God would write his
laws on their hearts so they could truly obey him.
But was Pauls point so complicated? Perhaps he merely offered an alter-
native expression of the gospel: Christ Jesus died to provide salvation for all
who believe. Christ died in shame, apparently under the curse of God. He ac-
cepted the death threatened transgressors of the Law. This undeserved curse
opened the way for the blessing promised believing Gentiles.
By the blessing of Abraham Paul undoubtedly referred back to vv 6-9.
The blessing Abraham received was the gift of justication by faith (v 6).
All who share Abrahams faith are his children, including Gentiles (v 7). All
who believe receive the gift of justication by faith, even Gentiles (v 8). Paul
referred not only to the forensic content of justication as a right relationship
with God but also to faith in the crucied Christ (v 1), which also opened the
way for the subjective-experiential content of justicationreceiving the gift
of the Spirit (vv 2-5).
This reading of v 14 presumes that the promise of the Spirit is an epex-
egetical genitive. That is, the promise consists of the Spirit. It was not some-
thing unstated that the Spirit promised (as if it were a subjective genitive).
What God promised was the Spirit.
Promi se
The rst of the nine appearances of the noun epangelia, promise, in
Galatians is in 3:14 (see also 3:16, 17, 18 [twice], 21, 22, 29; 4:23, 29).
The verbal form (epangellomai, promise) of the same cognate family
appears once in 3:19.
The cognate root -angel- merely has a different prepositional prex in
Pauls favorite term for the message he preachedthe gospel (1:6, 7,
8 [twice], 9, 11 [twice], 16, 23; 2:2, 7; 3:8; 4:13).
-angel- is also obviously the root of the English term angel (messenger;
1:8; 3:19; 4:14).
The terminology of promise is not explicit in the OT. But Gods future
assurances to AbrahamI will . . .were understood by Paul and his contem-
poraries as promises. Gods covenant commitments to Abraham and the other
ancestors of Israel were essential to its faith and identity as Gods people (see
Exod 32:13; 1 Chr 16:14-18; Neh 9:7-8; Ps 105:6-11; Sir 44:21; Wis 12:21). But
the term epangelia, however, rst appears in Jewish tradition within the pseude-
pigraphal literature of Hellenistic Judaism (3 Macc 2:10-11; Pss. Sol. 12:6; T. Jos.
20:1).
S
A
M
P
L
E
198
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 6-14
The expression by faith we might receive (3:14) obviously points back-
ward to the same verb in Pauls question in v 2: Did you receive the Spirit
by observing the law, or by believing what you heard? By v 14, the Galatians
surely knew the correct answer, if they did not before.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Abrahamic Faith. Paul argued that Christian faith had its origin in the
OT Scriptures, particularly in Gods covenantal promises to Abraham. This
led the arch-heretic Marcion to omit Gal 3:6-9 from his text (Riches 2008,
157). Proto-orthodox church fathers, like Chrysostom, however, found in
Pauls appeal to Abraham proof that one could be justied by faith before
Law existed. Thus, Christians could be justied by faith, when Law no longer
existed, thanks to Christ. Faith, not race or ritual, made one a child of Abra-
ham. Such views made sense in a context in which the Christian church still
saw itself as competing with Jews for the allegiance of their members (Riches
2008, 158). But what of the situation after the parting of the ways, when
Christianity and Judaism became two distinct religions?
Facing Catholic and Anabaptist rivals, Luther understood Pauls appeal
to Abrahams faith to oppose legalism (Riches 2008, 159-61). Calvin empha-
sized that Abraham-like faith justied because it embraced the transforming
grace of God (Riches 2008, 161-62). Contemporary Wesleyans must not al-
low memories of legalistic excesses in our tradition to give license to an antino-
mian distortion of justication by faith alone. Freedom from Law is not free-
dom to do whatever one chooses (Gal 5). Wesley frequently dened holiness
of heart and life in terms of Gal 5:6, as faith expressing itself through love.
Modern interpreters tend to limit justication to the realm of personal
salvation, ignoring its cosmic scope. Can we, after two millennia, still em-
brace Pauls eschatological conviction that the coming of Christ fullled Gods
promise to Abraham with world-transforming implicationsnothing less
than a new creation (6:15)?
Law and Christ: Curse and Blessing. Luther considers Pauls quotation of
Deut 27:26 in Gal 3:10 a classic damned if you do; damned if you dont situ-
ation. On the one hand, Paul says, Whoever shall do the works of the Law is
accursed; on the other, Moses says, Whosoever shall not do the works of the
Law, is accursed. Luther resolves the dilemma by appealing to the blessing
given to Abraham . . . through Christ. This is the new kind of life believers are
privileged to live by the gift of the Spirit (v 14). The cursed-but-innocent Christ
won human salvation by overcoming the curse of the law (v 13) for us (Riches
2008, 176). Calvin claims that the new life of believers allows them to be doers
of the Law, but not as people striving to meet the impossible demands of the
Law, but as those who are renewed by the Spirit and so perform good works as
naturally as a healthy tree brings forth fruit (Riches 2008, 180).
S
A
M
P
L
E
199
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3: 6-14
Paul treats Christ and Law as antithetical throughout Galatians. But lat-
er Pauline letters suggest that Christ did not bring an end to the Law in its en-
tirety, only certain ordinances within it. Ephesians 2:11-19 identies circumci-
sion as one specic example. Abolishing this boundary marker destroyed the
barrier, the dividing wall of hostility (v 14) separating Jews and Gentiles. In
addition to circumcision, Col 2:14-23 mentions kosher laws, festival obser-
vances, and Sabbath regulations as outmoded requirements in the Law.
Did Paul throw out the baby with the bathwater in Galatians only to re-
trieve it later? That is, did his rhetoric lead him to overstate his case for Christ
alone? Even in Gal 5 and 6 (), he would make clear that freedom from the
Law did not authorize licentiousness. Nevertheless, he was convinced that the
gift of the Spirit more than compensated for the diminished role of the Law.
Circumcision is not a live religious issue in any known Western Christian
community. McKnight suggests that those who add demands on top of the
gospel in order to be accepted by God offer a contemporary analogy to those
Paul opposed who relied on the works of Law (1995, 160). But what kinds of
add-ons to the good news of Christ might be comparable to circumcision? (
5:7-12 FROM THE TEXT.)
Is the imposition of a conservative code of Christian conduct as a sec-
ondary requirement for being recognized as fully Christian analogous? What
about assuming that everyone must experience Gods justifying grace in the
same way? Must everyone kneel at an altar? Must everyone experience the
same emotional response? Do we replace circumcision with the expectation
that believers adopt an evangelical Wesleyan theological understanding of
Christianity? Theology should not make coming to faith more difcult. How
much theology does one need to understand to be fully Christian?
It is always difcult to sort out what is essential from what is simply
culturally conditioned. Our culture has become increasingly relaxed about ap-
propriate clothing for attending church. This bothers some older Christians,
who assume wearing ones best to church is an essential sign of respect for
God. Can an expected dress code function much like circumcision?
The Promise of the Spirit. Paul identied the gift of the Spirit as the dis-
tinguishing mark of present Christian existence (3:14-18). His letters offer
no support for the popular distinction between only converted and Spirit-
lled Christians (see Rom 8:9-11 and Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 238-
46). Gods empowering presence is not given piecemeal. A Christian without
the Spirit was unthinkable for Paul (see Witherington 1998a, 247). But con-
version and the accompanying gift of the Spirit are only the beginning (Gal
3:2) of the Christian life. We must press on to the goal (v 4).
The Spirit is essential at every stage in the Christian journey. He is the
divine agent drawing sinners to faith in Christ. He effects our justication,
sanctication, and glorication. Only as we continue to live by the Spirit (
5:16), to be led by the Spirit ( 5:18), and to keep in step with the Spirit
S
A
M
P
L
E
200
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:15-18
( 5:25) may we experience sanctication (see Rom 8:12-17) and future res-
urrectionthe fullness of Gods gift of salvation.
c. Proof by Appeal to Human Analogy (3:15-18)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Conforming to sound rhetorical advice (Quintilian, Inst. 5.12.14), Pauls
appeal began with irrefutable evidence: the divinely inspired personal expe-
riences of his audience in Gal 3:1-5 and the divinely authorized Scriptures
in vv 6-14. Thus, his strongest arguments appear in vv 1-14. In vv 15-18, he
appealed to the weaker argument of example (Quintilian, Inst. 5.11.22), spe-
cically the analogy of human covenants and divine covenants (Witherington
1998a, 240).
Paul compared the scriptural account of Gods covenant promises to
Abraham to the constraints of a human last will and testament. Gods prior
promises to Abrahams offspring were not revoked by the giving of the Law at
a later date. The primary beneciary of the promise to Abraham was Christ,
his great offspring (vv 15-18). In vv 19-22, he would argue that those who
shared in the blessing of Abraham were those who had faith in Christ.
Paul insisted that Abrahams offspring primarily refers to Christ in vv
16-19. But he also presumed that Abrahams offspring was a collective noun
(v 29; as in Rom 4:16, 18; 9:7-8, 29; 11:1; 2 Cor 11:22). Thus, Abrahams chil-
dren include all who by faith participate in Christ, not just Jews.
Paul apparently understood the land promise to Abraham, as did most
of his Jewish contemporaries. They assumed that he would be heir of the
world (Rom 4:13). But unlike them, Paul did not understand this in terms
of Israel gaining worldwide political dominance (see Acts 1:7). Instead, he
expected all nations to share in the promise of the righteousness that comes
by faith (Rom 4:13).
God did not give the Law to invalidate his earlier promises or to restrict
their scope (Gal 3:17). Nonetheless, Paul explained in Rom 4:14: if those
who live by law are heirs, faith has no value and the promise is worthless. In
Rom 4 those who live by law are unbelieving Jews (the circumcised in vv 9,
12). In Gal 3:10, did Paul similarly assume that all who rely on observing the
law are not Christians? If so, the Galatians were not among those who relied
on the Law, for he considered them Christians ( v 15).
In v 17 Paul insisted that Law did not nullify (katarge3sai) Gods ear-
lier promise. But those who try to be justied by Law nullify (kate3rge3the3te)
their relationship with Christ (5:4). If one could be justied through the Law,
Christ died for nothing (2:21). Participation in Christs crucixion brings an
end to (katarge3the3) the power of sin (Rom 6:6). Terminating (kate3rge3the3men)
our slavery to the Law makes it possible for us to live the new life in the Spirit
(7:6). But preaching circumcision nullies (kate3rge3tai) the offense of the cross
S
A
M
P
L
E
201
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:15
(Gal 5:11). And yet, faith does not terminate (katargoumen) the Law-as-Scrip-
ture (Rom 3:31). Thus, we must shift our focus from the counterproductive
demands of the Law to Gods promises.
When God made his promise, Abraham was an uncircumcised Gen-
tile. So how could Jews be his only legitimate heirs? If the promise were
restricted to those who conform to the Torah, it would no longer be valid for
the ungodly ([Rom] 4:5) (Jewett 2008, 327). If long after the promise was
given, it had been made conditional on obedience to the Law, the whole basis
of the promise as promise would have been rendered meaningless. And God
would have been unfaithful to his promise. Paul considered this unthinkable.
Thus, he made the point that no additional conditions were mentioned at the
time of the original promise, nor was it undermined by the addition of later
amendments.
Gods promise assured blessings that are received by those who have
faith in the truth of the gospel. The Law did not promise blessings on those
who observed it. Rather it invoked a curse on those who violated it (Gal 3:10).
In view of the universal scope of sin, curse is more prominent than blessing in
the Law. Thus, in Romans, Paul insisted that Law produces (katergazetai; see
7:8, 13, 15, 17, 18, 20) Gods wrath (Rom 4:15a; see 1:18; 2:5, 8; 3:5).
I N THE TEXT
L 15 Paul addressed his audience as Brothers and sisters (NRSV), as he did
last in 1:11. He increasingly used this ctive kinship-terminology as he moved
toward the conclusion of the letter (see 4:12, 28, 31; 5:11, 13; 6:1, 18). This
address indicates that, despite their foolish irting with another gospel (1:6-
9), he still considered them friends and fellow Christians (Matera 1992, 126;
Arichea and Nida 1976, 68).
Let me take an example from everyday life is a paraphrase of the same
expression rendered I am using a human argument in Rom 3:5. In Gal 1:11,
Paul described his gospel as not a human invention, because he received it by
revelation from Jesus Christ (v 12). In 3:15-18 he contrasted the divine au-
thority of Israels Scriptures (vv 6-14) and the supernatural origin of the Gala-
tians conversion (vv 1-5) with arguments based on a human example (ESV).
Paul failed to conclude the comparison he began, Just as no one invali-
dates or adds a codicil to a ratied human will. The NIV adds, so it is in
this case, to complete the sense of the analogy. It is implausible (despite Muss-
ner 1977, 241) that Pauls opponents had asserted the opposite (Betz 1979,
159 n. 56). But this is precisely what a consistent mirror-reading approach to
Pauls denials would require ( Introduction).
The point of the analogy would have been obvious to Pauls rst read-
ers because of the dual use of the term diathe3ke3n. In secular legal practice, it
referred to a persons last will and testament (see Heb 9:17). But it was also
used in the LXX to translate the Hebrew b
e
r|<t, covenant. Thus, it applied to
S
A
M
P
L
E
202
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:15-16
Gods unique relationship with his people. Of course, no one assumed the
provisions set by the immortal divine testator were contingent on his death
(BDAG, 228).
Scholars debate (see Longenecker 1990, 128-30) whether any irrevo-
cable human covenant existed in Pauls day. Irreversible property dispositions
were not labeled diathe3che3. Other known human covenants seem always to
have been alterable (Witherington 1998a, 243). Certainly, no third party
could alter a will, although the testator could. But surely God was not so capri-
cious (Longenecker 1990, 130).
Paul could have written of a purely hypothetical human covenant that
was irrevocable. But why bother with a meaningless analogy? Perhaps, his
point was simply that the terms of one covenant had no effect on another.
Gods covenants with Abraham and with Moses were separate and distinct.
Stipulations added 430 years later in the latter could not undermine the terms
of the earlier agreement in the former (Witherington 1998a, 242).
Pauls concern was not to prove that some human covenants were per-
manent. The essential point of his a fortiori (how much more) argument
(McKnight 1995, 166) was that divine covenants were inviolable. By previ-
ously established Paul described Gods covenant with Abraham as ratied
and legally binding (BDAG, 579). Such covenants could not be invalidated,
nullied, ignored, modied, or supplemented (BDAG, 24, 370). God could be
counted on to keep his promises.
In Rom 9:4 Paul used both covenants and promises in his list of Is-
raels unique benets. Ephesians 2:12, however, refers to the covenants of the
promise, essentially equating the two. The word covenant (diathe3ke3) appears
just nine times in the Pauline letters (also Rom 11:27; 1 Cor 11:25; 2 Cor 3:6,
14; Gal 3:17; and 4:24). But promise (epangelia) appears twenty-six times,
usually referring to Gods covenant with the patriarchs of Israel (see, e.g., Gal
3:14, 16, 17, 18, 21, 22, 29; 4:23, 28). The two are used interchangeably in
3:14-29. But in 4:21-31, Paul limited the term promise to what he elsewhere
called the new covenant (2 Cor 3:6-18; 1 Cor 11:25; see Gal 3:24).
L 16 Gods promises concerning the gift of the land of Canaan in Gen 12:7
To your offspring I will give this landis repeated in virtually identical terms
in LXX 13:15; 15:18; 17:8; and 24:7 (compare 26:3, 4; 28:4, 13; 35:12; 48:4;
3:6-14 BEHIND THE TEXT). As in later Jewish tradition (Sir 44:21; Jub.
17:3; 22:14; 32:19; 1 En. 5:7; 4 Ezra 6:59), Gen 22:18 and 28:14 associate
this land-promise with the promise that Abraham would bless all peoples on
earth (Gen 12:3; see Rendall 1903, 170).
Unlike English, Greek word order is not grammatically signicant. The
variable order allows authors to emphasize a word by placing it at the begin-
ning or end of a sentence. The rst signicant word in the rst Greek sentence
is Abraham, the beneciary of Gods promises. The co-recipient of the prom-
ise, his seed, is equally prominent at its end.
S
A
M
P
L
E
203
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:16-17
Like its English cognate, the Greek word sperma, seed, refers to the male
semen (see LXX Gen 38:9). But in Gal 3:16, as generally in the LXX and NT,
it is used by metonymy to refer to the product of insemination, posterity,
descendants (BDAG, 937), that is, his offspring (NRSV).
Most interpreters consider the shift from the singular promise in v 14
to the plural promises here (see v 21; Rom 9:4) of no signicance (e.g., Bur-
ton 1920, 181). Perhaps, promises referred to the threefold promise of land,
progeny, and blessing in Gen 17:1-9 (Schlier 1965, 143) or the eight distinct
promises of 12:2-3 and 17:1-8 (McComiskey 1985, 59-93). Or, perhaps, Paul
used the plural because the promise in 12:7 was repeated often (Lightfoot
1874, 142). Regardless, his concern was not the plural promises, but the sin-
gular seed.
Paul made a particular point of emphasizing that the word seed was in
the singular: The Scripture does not say and to seeds, meaning many people,
but and to your seed, meaning one person. Scripture has no basis in Greek.
In the absence of an explicit noun subject, the antecedent could be God
(CEV, NCV).
Nevertheless, Paul was aware that the word seed was often used as a
collective noungrammatically singular but conceptually plural (compare
crowd, audience, multitude, the press, the legislature, the faculty, etc.). He himself
used the term in this sense in Gal 3:29 (see also Rom 11:1; 2 Cor 11:22). His
concern was not really to defend a singular understanding of seed as the intent
of Genesis. It was to challenge the ethnocentric assumptions of his Jewish
contemporaries, who limited the seed of Abraham to the people of Israel (see
Luke 1:55; John 8:33, 37; Acts 7:5-6; Rom 4:16; 9:7; 2 Cor 11:22). Thus, he
stressed that Abrahams seed, the one person to whom Gods promise point-
ed, is Christ. There is no known rabbinic parallel for this messianic interpreta-
tion of Abrahams seed (Kellermann 1990b, 264; Matera 1992, 127), a view
Paul shared with other early Christians (Acts 3:25).
Paul saw no need to limit Abrahams seed to Christ alone, so long as it
was clear that the broader, collective application referred only to children of
the promise (see Rom 9:6-9; Gal 4:23, 28). Abrahams offspring were de-
ned by their faith in Christ, not by their ethnicity (Rom 4:13-15; 911; Gal
3:29). Paul would argue at length in Rom 9 that Abrahams offspring are both
narrower and broader than ethnic Israel (see Greathouse and Lyons 2008b,
51-57).
L 17 Paul introduced the explicit application of his analogy with the attention-
grabbing words (Betz 1979, 157), What I mean is this (see 1 Cor 7:6). It is a bit
convoluted: The covenant previously ratied by Godthe 430-years-later-
appearing Lawdoes not make void so as to invalidate the promise. But his
meaning is clear: The covenant with Abraham God had ratied centuries earlier
remains in force. If human covenants could be inviolable (Gal 3:15), how much
more Gods! The Mosaic law did not replace or amend the Abrahamic covenant.
S
A
M
P
L
E
204
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:17-18
Its purpose was not to abolish (BDAG, 525, s.v. katargeo3 ) Gods earlier prom-
ises to Abraham (v 16), that is, the Abrahamic covenant ( v 15).
Pauls assumptions are clear: The two covenantsthe promise to Abra-
ham and his seed and the Law given to Moses and Israelwere discrete and
distinct. The earlier covenant was the better of the two and took precedence
over the latter. Gods promises to Abraham reached their fulllment in Christ.
Thus, the Law established through Moses was no longer needed. Demonstrat-
ing these assumptions was the point of vv 19-25.
L 18 Paul explained (For) his reasoning in v 17 with a contrary-to-fact condi-
tional sentence. He rejected the option of compromise, the thought that Law
and promise might coexist. This was a case of either-or. For if the inheritance
is based on the Law, it is no longer based on the promise. But God had
graced Abraham through a promise.
This is the rst of six occurrences of the kle3 ronom- cognate family in Ga-
latians (see also 3:29; 4:1, 7, 30; 5:21). The OT uses inheritance (kle3 ronomia;
Hebrew: nah9
a
la< , permanent possession) to refer to Gods gift of the land to Is-
rael (see Exod 32:13; Num 26:52-56). Paul makes this explicit in Rom 4:13: It
was not through the law that Abraham and his offspring received the promise
that he would be heir of the world, but through the righteousness that comes
by faith.
Originally, Gods promises to Abraham and to his seed (Gal 3:16)
concerned the gift of the promised land of Canaan (Gen 12:7; 13:15; 15:18;
and 24:7). But later OT passages (see Ps 2:2; Isa 60:21; Ezek 47; Dan 12:13)
and early Judaism expanded these promises in an eschatological direction
(Friedrich 1990b, 298).
Paul adopted existing Jewish tradition that presumed the land included
the entire world and resurrection life in the world to come (see Sir 44:21; Jub.
17:3; 22:14; 32:19; 1 En. 5:7; 39:8; 40:9; 71:16; 4 Ezra 6:59; Matt 5:5 [echo-
ing Ps 37:9, 11]; 25:34; Titus 3:7; Heb 1:2; Jas 2:5). Thus, the inheritance
identies the end-times content of the promisethat is, all the benets of
Gods work of salvation (Betz 1979, 159). For the present, salvation consisted
in the gift of the Spirit (see Gal 3:14; Cole 1989, 148). The inheritance is the
more-to-come.
Paul shared the conviction of the author of Heb 1:2 that Christ was
the heir of all things. Thus, believers as children of God are co-heirs with
Christ (Rom 8:17). Paul assured the Corinthians that as Gods end-times
people, All things are yours, whether . . . the world or life or death or the
present or the futureall are yours, and you are of Christ, and Christ is of
God (1 Cor 3:21b-23).
Thus, the inheritance promised Abraham referred to the content of the
still-future hope of believers. In 1 Cor 15:50, to inherit the kingdom of God
is to be resurrected from the dead. That the unrighteous will not inherit the
kingdom of God (Gal 5:21; see 1 Cor 6:10) means they will not be resurrect-
S
A
M
P
L
E
205
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:18
ed. Paul cherished a tangible and material future hope, not a merely spiritual,
ethereal, or heavenly expectation.
The gift of the Spirit was associated with the future hope in Jewish
thought. But Paul and other early Christians were convinced that the Spirit
had already been given to believers as the present experience of the end-times
promise (see 3:2-5; 4:1-7). The promised Holy Spirit . . . is a deposit guar-
anteeing our inheritance until the redemption of those who are Gods posses-
sion (Eph 1:13-14; Rom 8:23). Since God fullls his promise through the
operation of the Spirit, the promise . . . is, at the same time, the promise of
the Spiritthat is, the promise of the means by which sons of Abraham would
be created out of the people who have been enslaved (Williams 1988, 716).
The future inheritance of Abrahams seed did not originate in the Law
(see Rom 4:14). Paul had made a similar point about the present privileges of
believers in Gal 2:16-20 and 3:2-5. Justication, salvation life, and the gift of the
Spirit are not received by works of Law. They are all given by grace. The Laws
demands for doing (see 3:10-12) lacked the unconditioned and entirely gracious
character of promise. Pauls logic was similar in Rom 4:3-8. There he would
insist that righteousness was credited to Abraham as a grace-gift (charin). It was
not earned by his works and paid by God as a debt.
In Gal 3:18, Paul used the perfect tense of the verb charizomai, from the
same cognate family as the noun grace (charis; in 1:3, 6, 15; 2:9, 21; 5:4; and
6:18). This comparatively rare verb in Pauls letters (sixteen times; see, e.g.,
Rom 8:22; 1 Cor 2:12; 2 Cor 2:7, 10 [three times], 13) occurs only here in
Galatians. It emphasizes that God conveyed the promise to Abraham as a gift,
free and undeserved. Far more common is the verb dido3mi, give (seventy-two
times in Pauls letters). Charizomai was used in legal depositions as a technical
term for inheritances granted as a favor (Berger 1990b, 456).
v
FROM THE TEXT
The Purpose and Limits of the Law. Verses 15-18 only begin to explain
the implications of Pauls claim in vv 1-14 that the Christian life of faith is
based on the gift of the Spirit and is wholly distinct from a life based on the
works of the Law (Riches 2008, 188). Paul held rmly to the continuity of
the old and new covenants by focusing on Gods covenant with Abraham, not
that with Moses.
One of Pauls most ardent early admirers, Marcion of Pontus, took such
statements of Paul on the Law and the failures of Israel as justication for his
rejection of the OT and its vengeful God. His radical views were challenged by
proto-orthodox church fathers like Tertullian and Chrysostom. Later Catho-
lic theologians like Augustine and Thomas Aquinas built upon their efforts to
hold together both testaments.
Analogies. Can twenty-rst-century Christians even imagine an inviolable
human covenant (3:15)? More than half of all marriages in the United States
S
A
M
P
L
E
206
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:15-18
end in divorce. So much for solemn vows! Disingenuous campaign promises
feed widespread public cynicism about politics. Corporate greed has made con-
tracts and assurances of retirement benets worthless. Even if the Galatians
knew of irrevocable human covenants and binding promises, we do not.
Only the faithfulness of God allows us to imagine covenant promises
that will be kept, even if he had to die to keep them. And perhaps that was
Pauls point. Despite human failure and rebellion, God can be trusted. He is
adaptable and responsive to changing circumstances. But he is not ckle or
capricious.
Methods and Conclusions. Like most rabbinic interpreters of his day,
Paul did not hesitate to resort to strained interpretations. Rabbinic exegesis
routinely resembles what we would call eisegesis. Operating deductively, its
apparent conclusions actually validate the interpreters prior assumptions. We
may not imitate Pauls methodology, but we can share his christological con-
victions and motives.
Twenty-rst-century Western students of the Bible cannot use the
same exegetical methods as rst-century Jewish Christians. Paul used meth-
ods he knew and his audience considered persuasive. We cannot imitate his
hermeneutics, if we are to be persuasive with our quite different audience and
context. But we can wholeheartedly accept his conclusions. These reect as-
sumptions and convictions based on life-changing encounters with the risen
ChristPauls and others, not the results of inductive study of the OT. A
Christian reading of the OT is fundamentally shaped by christological and
eschatological assumptions not shared with Judaism (Witherington 1998a,
248).
We may not be persuaded by the exegetical logic Paul used to defend his
conviction that Gods promises to Abraham found their singular fulllment
in Christ (v 16). But as Christians, we nd the theo-logic of his covenantal
interpretation convincing. Almost certainly, Paul would nd our individual-
istic Western assumptions as strange and inappropriate as we nd some of his
interpretive moves.
Responsible interpreters attend to the timely as well as the timeless di-
mensions of Scripture. We must realize that the letter to the Galatians was
not written to us. And there are sixty-ve other books in the canon we must
take with equal seriousness as Scripture. The enduring message of a text and
of the canonical collection in its wholeness must capture our attention. And
yet, we cannot ignore the world BEHIND THE TEXT and rush too quickly to
the afterlife of the textwhat arises FROM THE TEXT. We must learn from
the apostle where to focus our attention.
In the present text, we may learn to concentrate on the dependable char-
acter of God revealed throughout the Bible and the central role Christ plays as
the denitive revelation of God. The clear connection between Pauls Chris-
tology and his eschatology emphasized here, perhaps, nds fullest expression
S
A
M
P
L
E
207
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:19-29
in 2 Cor 1:18-22. Simply put, in Christ every one of Gods promises is a Yes
(1:20 NRSV).
2. The Purpose of the Law (3:19-29)
Paul had argued that the Christian life was to be lived out of the power-
ful resources of the divine Spirit, not weak human esh. Only Gods sancti-
fying Spirit, not the Law, could empower the Galatians to continue toward
their goal of nal salvation (3:3-5). To prove his point, Paul appealed to the
Galatians experience of the Spirit (3:1-5), to Gods promise to Abraham pre-
served in Scripture (3:6-14), and to the analogy between divine and human
covenants (3:15-18).
Pursuing the way of Law, specically circumcision, was not the way for-
ward. On the contrary, the Galatians efforts to do what the Law required
would bring them disastercurse, not the blessing promised Abraham, the
promise of the Spirit (3:10-14). Trusting in Christ, not doing works of the
Law, was the way for Gentiles to share fully in Gods gracious promises to
Abraham (3:15-18).
This line of reasoning raised an obvious question: Why did God bother
giving the Law, if it had no effect on his earlier covenant promises to Abra-
ham and his descendants? This is the challenge motivating Pauls argument
in 3:194:7. Pauls answer, simply put, was that the Law was intended to be
only a temporary, stopgap measure until the coming of Christ.
The social consequence of the Law was to separate Gods people from
the nations (Witherington 1998a, 256). As a result, Abrahams descendants
failed to be a means of conveying Gods blessing to the nations. Instead, they
repeatedly yielded to the temptation to pursue foreign gods and their ways.
Such sin, the endemic rebellion of Gods people, made the Law necessary.
Apart from the Law, there may well have been no heirs to receive the fulll-
ment of Gods promise to Abraham.
Paul parted company with his Jewish contemporaries in his views on
the Law in several signicant respects. It is one of the principle doctrines of
Judaism that God gave the Torah for the purpose of providing a way for Israel
into eternal life (Betz 1979, 174; see Lev 18:5; Deut 6:24; 30:15-20; 32:47;
Prov 3:1-2; 6:23; Sir 17:11; Bar. 3:9; 4:1; Pss. Sol. 14:2; )Abot 2.8; 6.1-3; Matt
5:17-20; 7:13-14; Mark 10:17-20; see Bultmann 1964, 855-62). Against such
views, Paul insisted that God never intended the Law to serve as a means of
imparting life (Gal 3:21).
Another Jewish tradition trumped any suggestion that the Law might
offer salvation life. In the Bible, the verb zo3opoieo3, make alive (v 21), almost
always describes a work exclusive to God (2 Kgs 5:7; Neh 9:6; Job 36:6; Ps
71:20; Jos. Asen. 8:3, 9; 12:1; 20:7; Let. Aris. 16; John 5:21; Rom 4:17; 1 Cor
15:22) or Gods Spirit (John 6:63; Rom 8:11; 1 Cor 15:45; 2 Cor 3:6; 1 Pet
3:18; Dunn 1993, 192-93). Law could not make alive.
S
A
M
P
L
E
208
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:19-29
Pauls view that the Law served only a temporary role in the divine econ-
omy (Gal 3:19) was not shared by his fellow Jews. They considered the Law
both preexistent and eternal (see Wis 18:4; Sir 24:9; 2 Esd 9:37; 2 Bar. 4:1;
1 En. 99:2; Jub. 1:27; 3:31; As. Mos. 1:11-18; Philo, Moses 2:14; Josephus, Ag.
Ap. 2.277; compare Matt 5:17-19).
Paul did, however, adopt the standard Jewish view of the double media-
tion of the Law. But the implications he drew from this were the very opposite
of theirs:
(1) The angelic mediation of the Law was a widely held Jewish tradi-
tion (see Jub. 1:27; 2:1; 6:22; 15:25-35; 30:11-12, 21; 50:6, 13; Philo, Dreams
1.133-45; Josephus, Ant. 15.136) based on the LXX of Deut 33:2 (a view
challenged by Gaston 1987, 35-44). The MT refers to the LORDs appearance
on Mount Sinai with myriads of holy ones. But the LXX refers to angels
with him. This understanding is favorably cited in Acts 7:38, 53, and Heb 2:2.
For most Jews, the involvement of angels in the giving of the Law enhanced
its authority.
For Paul, however, the tradition served as evidence that the Law was of
diminished authority and limited duration, compared to the eternity of the
promise. He did not go so far as to appeal to the angelic mediation of the Law
to deny its divine origin (so Drane 1975, 34, 113) or to assert its demonic ori-
gin (so Hbner 1984, 24-36) as did later Gnosticism.
Perhaps, in Pauls thought, another widely held Jewish tradition took
precedence over the generally accepted signicance of the role of angels. It
asserted that whereas God has appointed angels to direct other nations, he
has chosen Israel for himself (e.g., Deut 32:8-9; Sir 17:17; Jub. 15:31-32; 1
En. 20:5; Dunn 1993, 192). That the Law was mediated through angels chal-
lenged Jewish particularism: Israel was no different from the other nations.
Paul may have further reasoned that its Law served as a kind of guardian
angel, equivalent to the elemental forces ([Gal] 4:3) which ruled over the
(other) nations (Dunn 1993, 192).
(2) In the present passage, Paul only indirectly referred to Moses role
as the mediator of the Law to Israel (Exod 32:15, 19; 34:4, 29). He did not
even mention Moses by name, although he did elsewhere (see Rom 5:14; 9:15;
10:5, 19; 1 Cor 9:9; 10:2; 2 Cor 3:7, 13, 15; 2 Tim 3:8). Paul simply took for
granted the Jewish understanding of Moses exalted role as the mediator of the
rst covenant (Philo, Moses 2.166; Dreams 1.143). But this detracted from the
Law in Pauls estimate, since (unlike the promise to Abraham) it did not come
directly from God, but involved human intervention. God does not need an
intermediary (Dunn 1993, 191). In 2 Cor 3:7-18 Paul similarly unfavorably
compared the fading glory of the old covenant and the Mosaic law with the
surpassing glory of his new covenant ministry of the Spirit.
S
A
M
P
L
E
209
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:19-22
right and rebuking and punishing wrong behavior (Belleville 1986, 59; see 74
nn. 28-34 for ancient sources; see also Young 1987 and Brawley 2002, 107-8).
Despite the English cognate pedagogue, the paidago3gos was not a teacher
as much as a disciplinarian (NRSV). Thus, a modern counterpart might com-
bine the job descriptions of a bodyguard, school bus driver, crossing guard,
safety ofcer, vice principal, nanny, and chaperone.
In antiquity, children were not regarded as innocent and impression-
able. They were considered wild, intractable, incorrigible, and insolent beasts
(see Plato, Laws 7.808D-809B). They needed to be restrained and denied
the freedom they would abuse to their own self-destruction (see Plato, Laws
7.810A-C).
The paidago3gos played a role in ancient childrearing that was preven-
tive and protective. It was neither parental nor permanent (see Young 1987,
168-69, 174-75). It was neither entirely positive (against MacGorman 1975)
nor negative (against Betz 1979, 177). Like the Law, the paidago3gos had an es-
sential, but transitional and transient role. He assured that children survived
their childhood to become responsible adults.
I N THE TEXT
L 23-25 Verses 23-25 are a single sentence in Greek. It seems to contrast
life before and after the coming of Christ. The contrast is not simply between
historical existence in the B.C. and A.D. eras, but between our lives before and
after we became believers.
L 23 The long sentence in vv 23-25 begins with the prepositional phrase:
Before the Faith came. Then, Law held us in custody. Faith is personied only
here and in v 25 much as Rom 10:5-9 personies righteousness (Barth 1990,
95). Since the Faith is not really a person, what did Paul have in mind by his
gurative language? What occurred that might be described as the coming of
the Faith? Scholars offer three possibilities: the coming of Christianity, Con-
version, or Christ.
Christianity. Perhaps Paul referred to the appearance on the world scene
of the new faith system we call Christianity (Rendall 1903, 173). He seldom
used faith in the sense of des quae creditur, the content of faith itself, the
Christian religion (Barth 1990, 94). But he did so in Gal 1:23 (). And this
usage is not uncommon elsewhere in the NT (e.g., Acts 6:7; Rom 12:6; Eph
4:5; 1 Tim 1:4, 19; 2:7; 3:9; 4:1, 6; 6:21; Titus 1:1; 2 Pet 1:1; Jude 20).
Conversion. Perhaps the coming of the Faith referred to ones personal
embracing of faith in Christ. Your faith in several of Pauls letters (Rom 1:8;
1 Cor 2:5; 2 Cor 1:24; Phil 2:17; 1 Thess 1:8; 3:2-10; Phlm 5) suggests that he
referred not simply to a unique historical event, but to the turning of anyone
from unbelief to faith in Christ. The subjective actualization of the faith by
individual believers (Schlier 1965, 94-95, 167) occurs across time, not just
at one time. Galatians 3:22 mentions what was promised, being given . . . to
S
A
M
P
L
E
219
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:23
those who believe. In one sense, the gift existed, in potential, from the time
of Christs coming. But in another, the Spirit is received by each believer only
as he or she exercises faith in the gospel message. That is, the claim that by
faith we . . . receive the promise of the Spirit (in v 14) is fully realized only
when we believe. Paul had earlier associated the terms believing and receiv-
ing the Spirit in his description of the Galatians conversion (in 3:1-5).
Christ. Perhaps, by the coming of the Faith Paul referred to the divinely
orchestrated historical Christ event (see 4:4)his coming and crucixion.
Believers trust in him as the ground of faith. The articular noun the Faith
(emphasis added) apparently refers to the faith of Jesus Christ, the pattern
of faithfulness revealed in Jesus (Hays 1983, 231-32; see Longenecker 1990,
145; 3:22). The historical coming of Jesus Christ demonstrated his faith-
fulness to God.
The parallel between the coming of the Seed . . . who is Christ (3:16)
and the coming of the Faith here, suggests that both refer to Christ (Wither-
ington 1998a, 268). Perhaps Paul used this personication to contrast both
Law vs. Christ and Law vs. Faith.
The main clause of the sentence (in vv 23-25) describes our lives before
we received the Spirit promised those who believe in Jesus Christ (v 12): we
were held prisoners by the law (v 23). Pauls verb was the same he used to
describe his experience in Damascus (in 2 Cor 11:32): King Aretas kept the
city gates under surveillance in an attempt to arrest Paul (Betz 1979, 175, and
Longenecker 1990, 145). Paul used the verb favorably in Phil 4:7And the
peace of God . . . will guard your hearts and your minds in Christ Jesus. In
this positive sense, to be under Law was to be under moral supervision. Law
restrained those prone to sin from doing so and provided the power needed to
resist its appeal (Belleville 1986, 57).
Non-Christian, Greek-speaking Jews used the same verb Paul did here
to speak favorably of the Torah. Law served as a protective fence surround-
ing Israel (Let. Aris. 139; see also 130-33; 142; 3 Macc 3:3-7; see Betz 1979,
165 n. 31). Law protected Israel from the evil inuences of paganism (Duncan
1934, 118-21). It kept Israel in protective custody and provided, through its
sacricial system, a temporary solution to the problem of Sin (Dunn 1993,
197-98). Taking seriously Pauls claim that Gods law and Gods promises
were not opposed to one another (Gal 3:21), allows for the translation in v 23:
we were protected by the Law (see BDAG, 1067, s.v. phroureo3).
Interpreters may not arbitrarily choose a reading for the verb phroureo3 in
v 23 that is inconsistent with their reading of the verb synkleio3 in vv 22 and 23.
To refer negatively to imprisonment under Sin (v 22) and positively to being
kept in protective custody under Law (vv 23-25) destroys the structural par-
allelism and results in contextual inconsistency (Belleville 1986, 57). It seems
unlikely that the same verb should have opposite senses in such proximity.
S
A
M
P
L
E
220
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:23
The NIV consistently paraphrases both negatively: the whole world is a
prisoner of sin in v 22; and we were held prisoners by the law, locked up until
faith should be revealed in v 23. Betz (1979, 161) prefers a neutral translation
for both: Scripture has conned everything under sin; and we were kept in
custody under [the] Law, conned until the coming faith was to be revealed.
The same preposition, hypo, precedes Sin in v 22 and Law in v 23. In
both instances, under is a better translation than of and by used in the NIV.
Before coming to faith in Christ, we were closely supervised by two personi-
ed powers: we lived under Sin and under Law. Scholars disagree as to the
precise meaning of the phrase hypo nomon. It occurs eleven times in just three
of Pauls lettersRomans, 1 Corinthians, and Galatiansand nowhere else
in the Greek Bible, OT or NT. To determine what Paul means by the phrase
hypo nomon is to penetrate to the heart of the Pauline concept of law (Belle-
ville 1986, 54).
Under Law
The expression under Law appears in Pauls letters only in Rom 6:14, 15;
1 Cor 9:20; Gal 3:23; 4:4, 21; 5:18. In Gal 4:21, he addressed readers who were
considering becoming circumcised (see 5:2) as you who want to be under the
law. In 5:4, he explained that those trying to be justied by law have been alien-
ated from Christ, . . . fallen away from grace.
In Romans Paul contrasted those under law with those under grace.
Christians are not under Law precisely because they are led by the Spirit (Gal
5:18; see Rom 8:1-4). Paul denitely did not evaluate life under grace negatively.
In fact, Law vs. Grace marks the contrast of pre- and post-Christian existence.
To be under Law or Grace was to live in subjection to the lordship of one or the
other of these personied spheres of power. To be under a power was to be its
subject; to be reigned by it, to be under its mastery (BDAG, 1036, s.v. hypo B.2).
First Corinthians 9:20 uses under the law to dene what it meant to be
a Jew. Despite his Jewish ancestry, Paul maintained, I myself am not under the
law. But he qualied this in v 21: I am not free from Gods law but am under
Christs law. Throughout Gal 5, he emphasized that Christian freedom was not
to be misunderstood as personal autonomy or licentiousness ( vv 1, 6, 13-
23). In 6:2 he referred favorably to fullling the law of Christ (compare Rom
8:2the law of the Spirit of life).
The apparent complicity of Sin and Law in the enslavement of pre-
Christian humanity is taken for granted in both Galatians and Romans. In
Rom 7 Paul exonerated the Law of culpability, identifying it as at once an
unwitting agent and a pathetic victim (along with powerless humanity) of
the deceptive power of Sin (see Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 199-224). The
coming of the Faith solved the problems of powerful Sin and impotent Law.
S
A
M
P
L
E
221
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:23
The participle locked up immediately follows the main clause (we were
held prisoners). It is from the same verb translated imprisoned in v 22. But a
more neutral translationconned and kept in custodymight be justied
in both instances.
Pauls metaphorical imagery in 3:19-22 and 23-25 assumes the existence
of three roles: (1) A Conner, who held the Conned in custody; (2) the Con-
ned, who were held; and (3) the Connementthe reality that restrained
them. In v 22:
The Confner was the Scripture (see v 8 and Rom 9:17), apparently
representing the revealed will of God. Thus, God is the Conner.
The Confned were all things (the whole world)all humanity and
the entire created order.
And the metaphorical Confnement that restrained everything was
Sin.
In Gal 3:23, some of the realities standing behind the picture-world
change:
The passive voice leaves the Confner unidentifed. Assuming this is
a divine-passive, God is the anonymous actor, the source of both the
Law and the Scripture. God held us in protective custody under Law.
The Confned are more narrowly identifed as we.
o This might be an exclusive we, referring only to Jews, like Paul (e.g.,
Betz 1979, 176; Dunn 1993, 198).
o It probably has the same reference as in v 13, where its antecedent it
disputed ().
o If the scope of redemption is universal, it refers to the pre-Christian
existence of all humanity, including Paul, his fellow Jews, and his
Gentile audience in Galatia (Bruce 1982, 182).
The metaphorical Confnement in v 23 is identifed as the Law.
Christs redemptive act overcame both Sin and Law.
The nal prepositional phrase of v 23until faith should be revealed
identies the divinely ordained termination point of human connement. A few
older commentaries took the phrase to indicate the purpose of our connement
(e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 148: guarded, that we might be ready; Burton 1920, 199:
shut up for the obtaining of the faith). But most modern translations and com-
mentaries take it to refer to the time of our connement, as in v 19: until the Seed
. . . had come.
Paul identied no beginning point for our connement. Nor did he ex-
plain why humanity was held captive under Sin and Law. In Rom 5:12-21, he
appealed to the story of Adams fall. Here, he emphasized the divine means of
ending human captivity under Sin and Law through Christ. This gives Pauls
point a chiastic (X-shaped) structure. The rst and nal lines emphasize B.C.
existence. The middle lines characterize that era using synonymous parallelism:
Before the Faith came,
S
A
M
P
L
E
222
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:23-24a
we were guarded [by God] under Law.
We were locked up together [by God],
until the coming Faith was about to be revealed [by God].
Personied Faith at the beginning and end of the sentence refers to the same
event, whether the revelation of the Christian faith, the conversion of those
who have faith, or Gods revelation of the faithful Christ.
Paul had identied Gods end-times revelation of Jesus Christ as the
source of his gospel (1:12) and the occasion of his conversion-call (v 16). He
was well aware of the eschatological connotations of his choice of wordsre-
vealed and revelation. He took for granted that Gods disclosure of Jesus as
the faithful Son of God marked the dawning of the last days. Jesus fullled
Gods ancient promises, launching the messianic era and the age of the out-
poured Spirit.
Paul was aware that Jesus had disappointed typical Jewish messianic ex-
pectations. The old age lingered even after the new age had appeared. The
expected cosmic dimensions of the apocalypse were delayed indenitely. It
required a personal revelation of Gods Son for Paul to turn from his persecu-
tion of Christians and accept Jesus as Gods Messiah (1:13-17). Thus again,
the Faith might plausibly refer to the coming of the Christian faith, personal
conversion, and Christ.
The ambiguous terminology of 3:23 (Betz 1979, 175) allows for nega-
tive, neutral, and positive understandings of Law. Interpreters views of Law
are largely determined by the role they assign the Guardian in vv 24-25 and
by their interpretation of 4:1-11 (Belleville 1986, 59). Both passages depend
on analogies to ancient practices unfamiliar to modern readers of the letter.
L 24a Paul called upon a fresh metaphor to explain what being held in cus-
tody by the Law entailed. He drew upon the familiar imagery of the Greco-
Roman paidago3gos ( BEHIND THE TEXT). The 1984 NIV avoided any
English equivalent, simply explaining the ancient role, which has no exact
contemporary equivalent. It paraphrased: So the law was put in charge. The
2011 NIV has So the law was our guardian.
Negative characterization of the paidago3gos by modern commentators
is unjustied by the ancient evidence. Nor is it consistent with Pauls own
synonyms, guardians and trustees ( 4:2). Distaste for the role is due more
to differences between ancient and modern tastes in childrearing than to
Pauls attitude toward Law. But a positive characterization fails to appreci-
ate his claim in 3:25-29 that mature Christians no longer need the Law as a
paidago3gos.
The world behind the text calls for a free translation of v 24a: Therefore,
the Law became our guardian to protect and restrain us until the coming of
Christ. Pauls image bridges the apparent opposition between promise and
law by synthesizing them into a coherent whole. The law is not opposed to
Gods promises (3,21) because it is a part of a process that moves toward
S
A
M
P
L
E
223
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:24a-25
Christ (Brawley 2002, 108). Pauls main point . . . in the metaphor was that
the Law restricted Israels freedom as a paidago3gos imposed limited the free-
dom of a child (Young 1987, 171). But the time of maturity had arrived with
the coming of Christ and the gift of the Spirit (4:1-6). As adults, Christians
no longer need the Law as their heavy-handed babysitter.
As in 3:19 and 23, the preposition eis means until (NRSV) not to. Do-
ing works of Law could never lead to Christ. Coming to Christ was not like
the natural promotion to the next grade in school. Paul did not think the Law
was given for the purpose of leading us to Christ (against Burton 1920, 200).
Christ had to intervene in the history of Israel and redeem Gods people, not
only from Sin, but from Law (Witherington 1998a, 266).
The immature religious restrictions Paul considered no longer appli-
cable since the coming of Christ included that one must be circumcised and
thus become a Jew in order to be acceptable to God (5:6; 6:15); that free as-
sociation of Jew and Gentile was a sin (2:17); and that ritual days must be kept
(4:8). Both Jews and Pagans had been under such religious taboos (Young
1987, 172). The virtual equation of the experience of Jews under Law and pa-
gans under ta stoicheia tou kosmou ( 4:3 and 9) in 4:8-10 demonstrates that
Paul considered the ritualism and particularism of Judaism just as idolatrous
as Paganism (Young 1987, 173).
The rst person plural (us in 3:14 [] and 24 and we in 3:23 and
25) does not seem to limit what Paul wrote in 3:15-29 about redemption from
Sin and Law to Jewish believers alone (against Witherington 1998a, 266). His
universal language in 3:22the whole worldpoints to its relevance for
Gentiles as well. Galatians 4:1-11 suggests that Paul considered the experi-
ence of Jews and pagans analogous. Even if one were to limit the rst person
plurals in Gal. 3:23-25 to Israel, Pauls conclusion in vv. 26-29 (which shifts
to the second person plural) demonstrates this universalistic concern (Young
1987, 175).
L 24b The ultimate purpose of the Laws interim role was in order that we
might be justied by faith ( 2:16-17; 3:2, 5, 6, 7, 8, 11, 12, 22; 5:4). Law
and Faith are not irreconcilably opposed, despite the tension between them
(stressed in 2:16, 21; 3:2, 11, and 12). Each has its role to play in the divine
economy. Law keeps us from self-destruction until God can make us right on
the basis of faith in what Christ has done.
L 25 The conclusion to Pauls long sentence succinctly summarized the impli-
cations of what he had already said. Because the Faith came, we are no longer
under a guardian. As in v 23, the Faith is personied. It succinctly refers to
the coming of the Christian faith, the conversion of believers, and the faithful
mission of Christ. His death brought the Christian faith into existence. Those
who place their faith in him are set free from the need for the Law as a guard-
ian or supervisor.
S
A
M
P
L
E
224
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:26-29
The preposition under, which dened our relationship to Sin (v 22) and
Law (v 23), here denes our temporary relationship to a Guardian. The word
law does not appear in v 25, despite the NIV translation. It replaces the meta-
phorical term paidago3gon with the law it represents to ensure that readers will
correctly grasp Pauls analogy. With the coming of Christ, the temporary role
of the Law has been played. Now, believers can move on into adult responsi-
bility. In 4:1-3 Paul would exploit the rest of the metaphor, in which coming
to the age of majority is comparable to the coming of Christ. But his meaning
is clear enough already. Having fullled its divinely ordained purpose, the
supervisory role of the Law is no longer needed.
v
FROM THE TEXT
The redemption Christ brought occurred at a unique and unrepeatable
moment in history. But Paul did not experience that redemption until his
conversion-call some years later. Similarly, believers of every age and cultural
background have come to faith in Christ out of their own unique B.C. exis-
tence.
Some may have been raised in a Christian church. But only when they
made the faith of their parents their own did the Christian life cease to be a
smothering, legalistic burden imposed from the outside. The Spirit enabled
them to fulll the law of Christ (6:2) as a spontaneous expression of their
newfound freedom in Christ. But the B.C. experience of others may have been
the exact opposite.
By the prevenient grace of God, as total strangers to the community
of faith, they heard and embraced the good news of Christ. When they did,
they recognized their licentious past for the enslaving addiction to unworthy
masters it was. As Christians, for the rst time they breathed the fresh air of
real freedom in the Spirit.
c. Application (3:26-29)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Shifting Pronouns. Nothing should be made of the shift from the rst per-
son plural (we) in 2:153:25 to the second person plural (you) here. There
is no reason to assume Paul had concluded his discussion of the situation of
Jewish Christians and turned to that of Gentile Christians here (against, e.g.,
Betz 1979, 185; Dunn 1993, 201). The absence of an emphatic hymeis, we,
undermines such assumptions. Instead, Pantes, all, is emphatic (Burton 1920,
202). Those addressed as you in v 26 are identical with those indicated by
the inclusive we in vv 23-25: Gentile and Jewish believers are together in
view (Bruce 1982, 183). Likewise, in ch 4, Paul would move from we to
you language with no discernible difference in meaning (George 1994, 274).
S
A
M
P
L
E
225
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:26-29
Shifting Imagery. In 3:26-29 Paul applied the preceding analogy of the
Guardian and the Law in 3:21-25. His language and imagery seems designed
to remind the Galatians again (as in 3:1-5) of their conversions. Their baptism
afrmed that they were all one in Christ Jesus (v 28). The change of cloth-
ing accompanying the ritual reminded them that they were clothed . . . with
Christ (v 27).
The clothing imagery may also have evoked the customary change of
garments that were part of the rite of passage from childhood to full maturity
in Roman society (Rendall 1903, 174-75; Boice 1976, 471; George 1994, 280).
If so, this anticipated Pauls argument in 4:1-7. There he compared the guard-
ians and trustees of children before they became adults to the role of the Law
before the coming of Christ. He resumed the imagery of 3:21-25, expanded
upon it, and offered further application.
Shifting Boundaries. Whatever else Paul meant by announcing the end of
the three pairs of oppositesJew vs. Greek, slave vs. free, male vs. female in
v 28, he certainly challenged the cultural assumptions of most of his contem-
poraries, Jewish and Greco-Roman. From his perspective, grace trumped the
circumstances of ones birth.
Betz cites considerable evidence for the ancient utopian aspirations for
an end to the ethnic and religious divide separating Jews and Greeks (1979,
191-92, nn. 82-87) and for the abolition of the institution of slavery (1979,
192 nn. 94-107). But he acknowledges that General abolition of sexual dif-
ferences, understood in whatever way, is not found in Greco-Roman sources
(1979, 197).
Did Paul intend his claimyou are all one in Christ Jesusto have far-
reaching, even revolutionary social and political implications? And did his once
pagan audience take him to suggest that the old and decisive ideals and hopes
of the ancient world have come true in the Christian community? Betz (1979,
190) answers: There can be no doubt (see n. 71 for the ancient evidence).
Martyn (1997, 376) maintains that to pronounce the nonexistence of these op-
posites is to announce nothing less than the end of the cosmos ( 6:15).
In the new order, you are all one in Christ Jesus (3:28). Through Christ
and his cross, Paul afrmed: the world has been crucied to me, and I to the
world (6:14). The social, religious, and cultural distinctions characteristic
of the old world-order are inconsequential to Christians (Betz 1979, 190).
Perhaps Paul shared the view of many Hellenistic Jews and Stoicism that the
unity of [humankind] corresponds to the oneness of God (Betz 1979, 192;
n. 88 cites ancient sources). Christ fullled the highest aspirations not only of
Jews but of Gentiles as well.
Several ancient GreeksThales, Socrates, and Platowere credited
with expressing gratitude that I was born a human being and not a beast,
next a man and not a woman, thirdly, a Greek and not a barbarian (Diogenes
S
A
M
P
L
E
226
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
3:26-29
thority. Survival instincts, not conviction, led many to celebrate state holidays,
even if reluctantly.
Julius Caesar set the precedent for subsequent Roman emperors by ex-
empting Jews from such expressions of civic piety as the worship of gods
other than their own throughout the empire, including Asia Minor (Jose-
phus, Ant. 14.185-267; Nanos 2002b, 260). Evidence of Jewish loyalty to the
emperor was demonstrated by daily sacrices, funded by the temple tax, of-
fered in the Jerusalem temple for his well-being (Smallwood 2001, 124-43;
Nanos 2002b, 262-63 n. 109).
As non-Jews, the uncircumcised Galatian Christians were apparently
faced with two choices: either return to what the outside world considered
proper behavior by complying with at least the minimal requirements of pub-
lic religionthat is, be properly Gentileor become fully Jewish (Kahl
2010, 225; see Nanos 2002b, 265). Paul rejected both (Nanos 2002b, 271).
I N THE TEXT
L 8-9 The sentence begins with three Greek words, marking a new direction
in Pauls letter.
But marks the contrast between the Galatians Christian (3:6-7) and
pagan status (v 8).
Formerly identies the time before their conversions (Betz 1979, 213;
Rogers 1989, 122), when they did not know God, with the present.
The third, on the one hand, omitted in English translations, antici-
pates v 9: But now that you know God.
Paul contrasted the Galatians pre-Christian existencenot knowing
God (v 8), with their present knowing God (v 9). By doing so, he treated two
different Greek verbs (oida and gino3sko3) as synonyms. He ignored the classical
distinction between theoretical knowledge based on abstract observation and
the acquisition of practical knowledge based on personal experience (Horst-
mann 1990, 493). His concern was not that the Galatians lacked the right kind
of knowledge of God. Knowing God personally was not more essential than
knowing about God. He preferred to describe conversion as God coming to
know us (v 9).
Israels privileged knowledge of God was more than an awareness that
God existed. It experienced the revelation of his character, faithfulness, and
covenant love in their national history. It called upon him in prayer and ac-
knowledged him by obedience (Deut 4:39; Judg 2:10; 1 Sam 3:7; Pss 9:10;
46:10; Prov 2:5; 9:10; Isa 1:3; 43:10; Jer 22:16; 31:34; Hos 4:6; 6:6; 8:2; Mic
6:5; Wis 2:13). Gentiles did not know God in this sense (Ps 79:6; Jer 10:25;
Jdt 9:7; 2 Macc 1:27; Wis 12:27).
Paul used traditional Jewish terminology distinguishing pagans and Jews
(1 Cor 1:21; 1 Thess 4:5; 2 Thess 1:8) to describe the change from paganism
to Christ . . . in terms of knowledge (George 1994, 313). If he had misgiv-
S
A
M
P
L
E
254
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4: 8-9
ings about the adequacy of coming to know God as descriptive of conversion,
it was not due to the later abuse of knowledge in gnostic circles referring to
esoteric revelation.
The phrase or rather in v 9 introduces a thought that supplements and
so corrects what has just been said (see Rom 8:34; 1 Cor 14:1, 5; Longenecker
1990, 180). Paul preferred to speak of coming to be known by God (v 9). The
aorist tense emphasizes the beginning of this experience in their conversion,
not to a now past reality (Longenecker 1990, 180; see 1 Cor 1:21 and 13:12 vs.
Gal 2:9). Pauls correction . . . underscores his recognition that any relation of
acceptance by God is of divine initiative (Dunn 1993, 225).
As omniscient, God does not need information about us. Paul under-
stood Gods knowing in the sense of the Hebrew verb ya3da(, referring to mu-
tual personal and experiential intimacy involving the total self, not merely
the mind or thought processes (George 1994, 313). For him, to be known
by God means to be elected, loved, and accepted by God (Schmithals 1990,
250; see Gen 18:19; Ps 1:6; Hos 5:3; 13:5; Amos 3:2; Nah 1:7; Matt 7:23;
Rom 8:29; 11:2; 1 Cor 8:3; Phil 3:12; 2 Tim 2:19; see BDAG, 200, s.v. gino3sko3
7). Divine adoption and the gift of the Spirit enable believers to respond to
Gods initiative by acknowledging that they are his children (Gal 4:5-6).
In v 8 Paul described the Galatians former lives when they did not know
God: you were slaves to those who by nature were not gods (see 4:1, 3, 7). This
reects widely shared Jewish assumptions about Gentile idolatry (2 Chr 13:9;
Isa 37:19; Jer 16:20; Ep Jer 23, 29, 51-52, 64-65, 69, 72).
Pauls reference to the Galatians former idolatry conceded a reality to the
objects of their worship, while insisting that they were by nature . . . not gods
(v 8). He gave no clues as to what his converts former religions may have been
specically. Had they worshipped the old Celtic gods, or were they adherents
of one of the new cults? Or had they been merely nominal participants in the
expected civic cult of the deied emperor (Winter 1994, 125-43)? His point
was not to insist that the so-called gods they had worshipped were not real
(CEV, NCV) or did not even exist (NLT; see 1 Cor 8:4-6). But they were not gods.
Hellenistic Judaism, well before Pauls time, had adapted the ancient
theory of religion called Euhemerism to distinguish deities that were physei
(in reality) as opposed to thesei (by human convention) . . . to criticize
Greek mythology and religion (Betz 1979, 214). The apostles Greek philo-
sophical categories demoted the traditional supposed-gods of paganism (Dunn
1993, 224) and dismissed the absurd divine claims of the Roman emperor
(Kahl 2010, 138-67). These undeniably powerful (1 Cor 12:2) beings were
in their essential character (Arichea and Nida 1976, 95; see Burton 1920,
227-28) not divine, but demonic (Bruce 1982, 201; Rogers 1989, 121). This
interpretation is consistent with the conclusion of Pauls lengthy excursus on
food sacriced to idols in 1 Cor 810 (see esp. 1 Cor 8:1-8; 10:19-21).
S
A
M
P
L
E
255
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4: 8-9
Pauls brief account of the Galatians pre-Christian lives in contrast to
their lives as Christians in vv 8-9b prepared the way for his questions in v
9cd: how is it that . . . ? and, Do you wish . . . ? Despite the interrogative for-
mulation, Paul was not seeking answers. His rhetorical questions negatively
assessed the Galatians future plans as incomprehensible. As with his question
to Cephas in 2:14, he was puzzled: How could you possibly do such a thing?
His rhetoric challenged the Agitators assumptions, rejecting their persuasion
(BDAG, 901, s.v. po3s).
In rhetorical questions, the interrogative adverb how characterized their
plans as shocking (Hendricksen 1968, 165), absurd (Burton 1920, 230), even
irrational (Rogers 1989, 122). Paul posed two questions: First, why would you
turn back to worthless nongods? Second, why would you want to be enslaved
again? This is certainly not what they thought they were doing.
First, how can you be turning back [epistrephete] again to those weak
and worthless elemental spirits [stoicheia]? (v 9c). The verb epistrepho3 was a
semi-technical term for a religious or moral conversion in Hellenistic-Jewish
and Christian circles (Bertram 1971, 722-29). It usually had a positive sense
a change for the better (see, e.g., Deut 30:10; 1 Kgs 7:3; 2 Chr 3:16; Isa 6:10;
55:7; Jer 3:14; Sir 48:10; Josephus, Ant. 10.53; Matt 13:15; Mark 4:12; Luke
1:16-17; 22:32; John 12:40; Acts 3:19; 9:35; 11:21; 14:15; 15:19; Jas 5:19-
20; 1 Pet 2:25; Barn. 2:33; 1 Clem. 7:5; 8:3; 18:13; 2 Clem. 16:1; 17:2; 19:2;
Herm. Mand. 6.1.5; Herm. Sim. 9.26.3; Pol. Phil. 7:2). The LXX normally
used a different word (apostrepho3) when the underlying Hebrew word (s]u3b) re-
ferred to turning away from God, to apostasy (e.g., Num 14:43; 1 Sam 15:11;
1 Kgs 9:6; Ps 78:41; Jer 3:19).
But Paul rarely used the verb epistrepho3 in a favorable sense (only 2 Cor
3:16; 1 Thess 1:9). Here he characterized the Galatians prospective change as
for the worse (see Num 14:43; 1 Sam 15:11; 1 Kgs 9:6; Ps 78:41 [LXX]; Prov
26:11; Jer 3:19; 2 Pet 2:21-22; Barn. 4:8; Herm. Sim. 8.7.5). His language had
an ironic edge. They were on the verge of committing apostasy, of reversing
their conversion and returning to paganism. Such a change was unthinkable.
For a post-Christian existence Paul leaves open only atheism or superstition
(Betz 1979, 216).
If the traditional understanding of the situation prompting Pauls letter
to the Galatians is correct, they certainly did not think they were returning to
paganism. They were, rather, considering a switch from Pauline Christianity
to a form of Jewish Christianity which required circumcision and obedience
to the Torah (Betz 1979, 216). Pauls assessment of their plans as apostasy to
paganism makes sense only if he equated being under Law with being under
the elementary principles. They were treating the Law just like another false
god (Dunn 1993, 226).
The present tense of the verb epistrephete suggests that the Galatians
apostasy was still in progress or only contemplated; it was not yet complete.
S
A
M
P
L
E
256
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4: 8-9
Paul similarly used the present tense in his rebuke of the Galatians in 1:6: I
am astonished that you are so quickly deserting [metatithesthe] the one who
called you by the grace of Christ and turning to a different gospel. Apparently
the males in the Galatian churches were only considering circumcision. Most
had not yet undergone the surgical procedure.
Why did Paul describe the stoicheia ( 4:3) as weak [asthene3] and miser-
able [pto3cha]? The adjective asthene3s in the NT regularly describes one suf-
fering from a debilitating illness (see Matt 25:43-44; Luke 9:2; Acts 5:15-16;
1 Cor 11:30) or some other physical incapacity or limitation (Matt 26:41;
2 Cor 10:10; 1 Pet 3:7). It also describes something as ineffective or rela-
tively unimportant (1 Cor 1:25, 27; 4:10; 12:22; Heb 7:18; BDAG, 142, s.v.
asthene3s). Such a claim about supposed supernatural powers considerably de-
moted their presumed status. But Paul often turned the tables on human es-
timates of power and weakness (see, e.g., 1 Cor 1:182:5; 2 Cor 1012).
The adjective pto3chos normally described poor people, whose econom-
ic disadvantages reduced them to begging for survival (see, e.g., Matt 26:11;
Luke 14:13, 21; 16:20-22; Gal 2:10). The traditional understanding of beg-
garly (KJV, NKJV, NRSV, RSV) today calls for the translation bankrupt (HCSB,
ISV, NJB) or worthless (ESV, NASB, NET). The elementary principles to which
the Galatians were returning were powerless and impoverished.
And yet in their pre-Christian existence, the Galatians were enslaved by
these bogus gods (4:8)! They had worshipped spirit beings that [could] do
nothing (BDAG, 142). Yet these gods demanded sacricial offerings from
them. This explains why Paul characterized the gospel of the one true God he
preached in terms of freedom (see 2:4) and truth (2:5 and 14)!
Pauls rhetorical question made it seem totally incongruous that the Ga-
latians should trade the freedom Christ offered for a yoke of slavery (5:1).
How absurd to prefer the illusion of idolatry to the truth of the gospel! And
yet the warnings found in early Christian writings suggest that some Chris-
tians continued to nd Judaism attractive (Dunn 1993, 226, citing Ign. Magn.
8:1; 10:3; Barn. 3:6; Justin, Dial. 47:4).
Second, Pauls rhetorical question in v 9d asked: Do you wish to be en-
slaved by them all over again [palin ano3then]? Palin appears also in Gal 1:9, 17;
2:1, 18; 4:19; 5:1, 3. But ano3then appears only here in Pauls letters. These two
Greek adverbs are essentially synonymous, (lit.) again again.
The innitive to be enslaved repeats the letters familiar imagery of slav-
ery. But the main verb, Do you want, asked, in effect: What kind of future do
you Galatians desire?
We cannot be certain precisely what the Agitators wanted from the Ga-
latians. Paul consistently put a negative spin on both their wishes and motives:
In 1:7, they want to pervert the gospel of Christ (NRSV).
In 4:17, they want to exclude you (NRSV).
S
A
M
P
L
E
257
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4: 8-10
In 6:12, they want to make a good showing in the fesh . . . only that
they may not be persecuted for the cross of Christ (NRSV).
And in 6:13, they want you to be circumcised so that they may boast
about your esh (NRSV).
Paul also wanted something from the Galatians:
In 3:2 he claimed: The only thing I want to learn from you is this: Did
you receive the Spirit by doing the works of law or by believing what
you heard? (NRSV).
In 4:20 he would write: I wish I were present with you now and could
change my tone, for I am perplexed about you (NRSV).
But what did the Galatians themselves want? In 4:21 Paul suggested that
some of them want to be under the law. He insisted that they had to take
sides as a community and decide what they really wanted. They needed to de-
cide between serving the esh and serving the Spirit, or they would never be
able to do what they wanted (6:12). Here Paul asked, Having tasted the free-
dom of the gospel, do you really want to return to your former life of slavery?
In 4:9 Paul characterized the Galatians future plans as a return to pa-
ganism. Was this all rhetoric? Did he malign circumcision and Jewish calendar
observance as comparable to pagan practices? Or, should we take Paul literally?
The incongruity of the traditional scholarly assumptions about the Ga-
latians plans as Judaizing leads Martin to challenge the consensus reading of
the behind-the-text situation of Galatians. He agrees that the Agitators had
insisted that Gentiles had to be circumcised to be fully Christian. But he dis-
agrees that Pauls converts were considering circumcision. On the contrary, he
assumes they had decided to abandon Christianity to avoid it (Martin 1995;
Introduction).
L 10 You are observing special days and months and seasons and years!
seems less a comment than an accusation. The present tense of the verb sug-
gests that the Galatians were already guilty. But in Greek, Pauls statement
could be a question: Are you observing special days . . . ? (so Bruce 1982,
205). The oldest (ca. 200) surviving manuscript of Galatians, p
46
, treats v 10
as a continuation of the question in v 9c: Do you wish to be enslaved by them
all over again, by scrupulously observing days . . . ? Perhaps, they were only
considering the calendar-observances to which Paul objected.
We have already noted ( BEHIND THE TEXT above) that it is un-
clear precisely what the Galatians were doing or considering that troubled
Paul. A rejection of Sabbath observance might seem to be coherent with Pauls
rejection of circumcision elsewhere in the letter. The two were the leading
marks of Jewish identity during the rst century (see Josephus, Ant. 11.346;
Jub. 2:17-33). But what disturbed Paul about the Galatians time-keeping
scheme cannot have been that the holidays they proposed to observe were
of Jewish origin. He made no attempt to identify their proposed calendar as
distinctively Jewish.
S
A
M
P
L
E
258
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:10
He referred to days (he3meras), not to Sabbaths, as in Col 2:16. In
Rom 14:5-6a, he treated observing or not observing the Sabbath day
as indifferent.
If Paul referred to the Jewish calendar, the observance of months
(me3nas) could refer to the extra Sabbaths associated with the new
moon festival (Num 28:11-15; 1 Chr 23:31; Isa 66:23). But he did not
mention neome3nias, New Moon celebration, as in Col 2:16.
In the LXX (Exod 23:14, 17; Lev 23:4) seasons (kairous; lit., times)
referred to Jewish festivals of longer duration. But Paul said nothing of
a religious festival (heorte3s), as in Col 2:16.
In combination with seasons, years (eniautous) may have alluded to the
sabbatical years outlined in Lev 25.
Many of Pauls generic calendar terms appear in Jewish texts (e.g., Gen
1:14; Jub. 2:9; 1 En. 75:3; 79:2; and 82:7). But they better conform to the cat-
egories characteristic of a pagan time-keeping system than to Jewish practice
(Martin 1996, 112). Pagans typically grouped the calendar into these catego-
ries:
three sets of ten days,
comprising twelve months of thirty days each, and
three months made up one of four seasons,
which together formed years.
If Paul referred to a pagan calendar, we may still ask, Which one? Honoring of
seasons and cycles of the year was part of Celtic religion (Jervis 1999, 115; see
Mitchell 1993). But it also characterized the Priene Calendar (9 B.C.), which
established the Roman Imperial cult in Asia Minor. By the second half of
the rst century, this dominated every aspect of Galatian public life (Winter
1994, 129-31; Kahl 2010, 118-289, esp. 124, 225-26, 255).
If the Galatians were inappropriately syncretizing Jewish and pagan
time-keeping schemes, would Pauls brief comment here have been enough
for them to know what they were to do differently and why? Both he and
they knew what they were considering; we can only speculate. We are reading
anothers mail.
Pauls other letters and Acts give us no reason to believe he would have
opposed the Galatians adopting the Jewish calendar. But he clearly considered
participation in pagan cultic activities out of the question for Christians (see
1 Cor 10:14-22). This would have included the civic obligations towards the
imperial cult (Winter 1994, 133). To observe days and months and seasons
and years by worshipping the deied emperor and his family and by partici-
pating in the accompanying pagan revelry would have meant apostasy from
the One true God. But what did a calendar have to do with circumcision?
Agitators in Pauls Galatian churches were undoubtedly pressuring his
Gentile converts to get circumcised. But why? And why did Paul so adamantly
oppose it? After all, he conceded that circumcision vs. uncircumcision was
S
A
M
P
L
E
259
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:10-11
ultimately a matter of indifference ( Gal 5:6; 6:15). But he also insisted that
Christ would be of no benet to Gentile Christians who were circumcised
(5:2 NRSV). To accept the Agitators circumcision gospel would be tantamount
to apostasy ( 1:6-9; 3:4; 4:11; 5:4).
Why did Paul repeatedly assess the Agitators motives as suspect and
self-serving ( 1:7; 4:8-9, 17; 6:12-13)? Had they recommended circumcision
as merely a pragmatic means of sparing themselves from persecution ( 6:12-
13)? If the males in the Gentile Christian communities of Galatia were cir-
cumcised, they would appear to government ofcials to be Jewish. This would
afford them the same exemption from participation in the Imperial cult Jews
enjoyed (Nanos 2002b, 260, 267). But more importantly, Jewish Christian
communities would not be suspected of being an illicit new religion, and thus
avoid persecution (Winter 1994, 133, 137; Hardin 2008, 24-81).
Paul rejected strategic compromises on either calendar issues or the mat-
ter of circumcision. So, what were the Galatians to do? If they were to act
consistently with the truth of the gospel (2:5, 14), they needed to embrace
the offense of the cross of Christ (5:11; 2:19-21; 6:12-14). Compromise
in the interests of comfort was not an option.
L 11 Paul expressed despair over the developments in Galatia: I am fearful
for you that I may perhaps have toiled for you for nothing. Were his ministry
efforts (see Rom 16:6, 12; 1 Cor 15:10; 16:16; Phil 2:16; Col 1:29; 1 Thess
5:12) in their behalf to be wasted ( Gal 3:4)? They seemed determined to
return to an enslaved existence like that from which they had been delivered.
Pauls fear was for the Galatians, not himself. They were in danger of
falling from grace and being alienated from Christ ( 5:4). The apostle cher-
ished no doctrine of the eternal security of believers. He faced the possibility
that his ministry might not have enduring results ( 2:2; see 1 Thess 3:5).
Nevertheless, the present tense of the verb fear indicates that Paul did
not consider the Galatians fall nal (Longenecker 1990, 183). By the time he
reached 5:10 (), he was able to express optimism that they would take his
side and reject the claims of the Agitators: I am condent in the Lord that you
will take no other view.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Conversion. Paul did not limit his account of Christian conversion to
a single formula. He described the conversions of the Galatians in 3:1-5 as
marked by receiving the Spirit through faith in the message of Christ cruci-
ed. In 4:8-9, the antitheses of Formerly, when you did not know God and
now that you know Godor rather are known by God dened their conver-
sions. Through conversion they gained freedom from slavery to false gods (v 8;
see 5:1). Pauls conversion-call in ch 1 sets as antitheses his previous way of
life in Judaism (in 1:13-14) and his life after God revealed the risen Christ to
him (in 1:15-16; see v 10).
S
A
M
P
L
E
260
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4: 8-11
Pauls descriptions of the conversions of other Gentile Christian com-
munities emphasize different contrasts. The Thessalonians turned to God
from idols to serve the living and true God (1 Thess 1:9) by receiving the
word of God in faith and becoming imitators of Christ and the apostles (vv 3,
5, 6, 8; 2:13, 14). The Corinthians, previously chosen by God, responded in
faith to Pauls preaching of the cross of Christ. He became for them righteous-
ness, holiness, and redemption (1 Cor 1:262:5). The Romans used to be
slaves to sin, but were set free from sin when they wholeheartedly obeyed
what they were taught (Rom 6:17-18).
We would do well to imitate Pauls example and not restrict our vocabu-
lary of conversion to getting saved, forgiven, or born again. To imitate Paul
requires us to appreciate that his descriptions of conversion depend heavily
on gurative language. We dare not close any of the many biblical windows
into the divine-human interchange we call conversion. The one we ignore may
be the one that sheds the light of God into the darkness of some still in need
of hearing and appropriating the good news of Christ and the transforming,
spiritual renewal he can effect in all who will believe.
Apostasy. Paul apparently believed it was possible for genuinely convert-
ed believers to be lost. The Galatians plans to abandon Christian freedom and
return to slavery caused him to fear that they might forfeit their nal salvation
(see Gal 4:9, 11; 5:1-5, 13; see 1 Thess 3:5). Did they not realize that both
their would-be circumcision and calendar observance equally threatened their
future well-being? Was this all a serious miscalculation? Or, were they pre-
pared self-consciously to abandon the future Pauls gospel promised in favor
of another gospel (1:6-9)? Would they embrace circumcision and the Law or
return to their former paganism? Or, would they remain faithful to the cross
of Christ and reject both other alternatives?
Calendars. Why did Paul object to the Galatians fascination with time?
His own practice suggests that he paid attention to the calendar and the recur-
ring cycles of Jewish festivals. Did he consider it inappropriate for Gentiles to
do so? Was the Galatians scrupulous observance excessive and obsessive? Had
they adopted a pagan time-keeping scheme that was compromised by idolatry?
Had they associated astrological determinism with their calendar interests?
Were they guilty of inappropriately syncretizing Jewish and pagan calendars?
Or, were they considering the safe course of political expediency? Paul told us
too little to be certain, even if his rst readers knew what he meant.
Ambrosiaster concluded that the problem with scrupulous calendar ob-
servances was the superstitions they fostered (see Edwards 1999, 60). This
would certainly speak against notions associating bad luck with days like Fri-
day the 13th. But was this all that concerned Paul?
There seems little danger that contemporary Christians might soon re-
turn to the bygone legalism of Sunday Sabbatarianism. But would Paul caution
against the resurgence of Christian interest in Jewish festivals, particularly
S
A
M
P
L
E
261
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12-20
Passover and the Seder meal? Is there a danger that Christians might inappro-
priately xate on rituals and miss the reality of Christ as our Pascal Lamb and
Eucharist as the Christian Passover?
What would Paul say about our calendar observances? Every name for
the days of the week and most of the names of our months are derived from
the names of pagan deities. Some Christians have serious misgivings about cel-
ebrating holidaysnot just Halloween, but Christmas and Easter, and seasons
such as Lentthat have pagan antecedents. Has the Christianization of the
calendar thoroughly purged these ancient festivals of their pagan connections
and converted them into Christ-honoring alternatives? Is Christian con-
sumerism contributing more to the repaganization of (say) Christmas than its
forgotten connections with the winter solstice or the birthday of the Persian
sun god Mithras?
Many politically conservative Christians in the United States seem
oblivious to the dangers inherent in the American civil religion that weds piety
and patriotism. They think nothing of confessing at once the lordship of Jesus
and pledging allegiance to the ag. In fact, they tend to fault Jehovahs Wit-
nesses less for their aberrant theology than for their refusal to salute the ag.
If 4:9 and 10 are mutually interpretive, it appears that Paul was con-
cerned that the Galatians compulsive time-keeping had the potential to en-
slave them. Despite growing interest in the occult, the more serious Western
preoccupation with time has nothing to do with ancient astrological supersti-
tions, idolatrous worship, or politicized religion.
We face a more urgent problem. Many Christians are slaves to the clock
and the calendar. Our overly full and inexible schedules have left us little
time or freedom to serve one another in love (5:13) or do good to all people
(6:10), much less for intimacy with Godknowing him and being known
by him (4:8-9). Do we imagine that all our frenzied activity will justify our
existence and somehow earn Gods favor? Have we so lled even our church
calendars with events that we have programmed God out of our lives?
ii. Pleading for a Christian Future (4:12-20)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Following the conventions of deliberative rhetoric, in 4:12-20 Paul pled
with the Galatians to consider the advantages of the better future his gospel
offered. He urged them to resume their former friendship and return their
exclusive allegiance to him and his gospel (vv 12-17). This would entail fol-
lowing his example (v 12a) and accepting him as their true friend (v 12b), who
remained deeply concerned for their Christian progress (vv 19-20). It would
also mean parting company with the Agitators, who were merely false friends
and atterers (vv 17-18).
S
A
M
P
L
E
262
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12
Paul was perplexed about the Galatians (v 20). He was gravely con-
cerned and uncertain as to what to do next. Beyond persuasion, what could
he do? They apparently imagined they had two alternatives: circumcision or
compromise on the calendar. He offered another option.
Paul warned thatdespite Gods faithfulness and saving intentions for
the Galatians, his ministry among them, and their experience of the Spirit
Gods investment in them might be entirely wasted by their wrong choices
(3:4; 4:11; 5:4). He pictured himself in the anguish of childbirth, awaiting
the formation of Christ among them (4:19). He had not despaired of their
Christian future. If he had considered them hopeless, there would be no ex-
planation for his letter, impassioned plea, and wish to revisit them mentioned
in the present passage.
In vv 12-15 Paul employed the imagery of masculine friendship and fra-
ternal mutuality (Betz 1979, 221-23; Martyn 1997, 420). He resorted to emo-
tional arguments (pathos) to plead with the Galatians to consider him their
true friend, as they had when they rst met. At the same time, he hoped they
would come to see the Agitators for the manipulative atterers they were and
return to the true gospel he had preached. The way forward would be the way
back to where it all began.
From the friendship motifs in vv 12-18, Paul shifted in v 19 to the ma-
ternal imagery of labor pains, which were at home in Jewish apocalyptic lit-
erature ( v 19). Both structurally and argumentatively vv 12-20 occupy a
central position in Pauls letter. It marks a signicant turning point in the letter
(Dahl 1973, 95; Hansen 1989, 48; Longenecker 1990, 184). Here the apostle
shifted from rebuke to request, paving the way for his decisive appeal in 5:1-2.
Here he appealed not to logic (logos), but to emotion (pathos).
As a real letter, it should not be surprising that in this, one of its most
personal parts, obscurities remain that puzzle later readers. We are reminded
again that we are reading anothers mail. The autobiographical and biographi-
cal events mentioned in 4:12-20 were experiences shared by the author and his
original audience. Since we were not there, they remain cryptic to us.
I N THE TEXT
L 12 Become as I, because I also as you; friends, I beg you. This translation
represents as nearly as possible in English the Greek word order. It reects
Pauls puzzling omission of verbs, conjecturally supplied by English transla-
tions: become like me, for I became like you, or become as I am, for I also
have become as you are (NRSV; compare 1 Thess 1:5-6; 2:14; 1 Cor 4:16;
7:7-8; 10:33; 11:1; Phil 3:17). The underlying idea, Betz (1979, 222) insists,
is the topos from popular philosophy that true friendship is possible only
among equals.
Here Paul directly addressed his audience for the rst time since 3:15.
He would engage them again in 4:19, 21, 28, 31; 5:11, 13; 6:1, and 18. The
S
A
M
P
L
E
263
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12
word adelphoi (lit., brothers) might address both brothers and sisters (NIV
2011; 1:2, 11; 3:15). But circumcision made the men in the community his
primary audience.
Become is the rst imperative verb in the entire letter. The urgency of
Pauls command is reinforced by the strong words that conclude his Greek
sentence, I beg you. Paul moved from diagnosis to prescription. Clearly, he
wanted the Galatians to do something, or become something. But what?
The ambiguity of Pauls appeal allows for several general possibilities.
It could be no more than an invitation for them to become friends again: Be
as frank and loving with me as I have always been with you (Cole 1989, 168;
compare 2 Cor 6:11). Within deliberative rhetoric, appeals to imitation were
intended to unite friends around shared values and behaviors (Sanders 1981;
Witherington 1998a, 307). Paul sought to reconcile the Galatians to himself
and to end their internal divisions ( 5:15).
In what sense were they to become like Paul? Scholars debate whether
Gal 4:12 should be associated with the Pauline passages (1 Cor 4:16; 11:1; Phil
3:17; 1 Thess 1:6; 2:14; 2 Thess 3:7, 9) that explicitly use the words mime3te3s
(imitator) or mimeomai (imitate), absent here (yes: Lagrange 1926, 110-11;
Stanley 1959, 874-76; Borse 1984, 149; Lyons 1985, 165; Fiori 1986, 175, 186;
Gaventa 1986b, 321-22; Matera 1992, 159; Castelli 1991, 115-16; Dodd 1999,
161-64; Eastman 2007, 27-29; no: Luther 1953, 397-98; Michaelis 1967, 672
n. 29; Betz 1979, 222-23; Martyn 1997, 420).
If Paul implicitly called the Galatians to imitate his example, what spe-
cically did he have in mind? Was there something about their initial meeting
(4:13-15) that would have been obvious to them? Or, did he expect them to
think back over his autobiographical remarks in chs 1 and 2 and extract from
them exemplary lessons from his life to apply to theirs?
The autobiographical narrative in chs 1 and 2 may suggest what Paul in-
tended (Lyons 1985, 165; Longenecker 1990, 189): Imitate me by remaining
free from the Law (e.g., Burton 1920, 236; Betz 1979, 222; Dunn 1993, 164-
65; Dodd 1999, 164). Or: Become a Gentile like me, for I became a Gentile
like you (see 2:15-17; e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 174; Martyn 1997, 420). Or: Be
loyal to the truth of the gospel (see 2:5; Longenecker 1990, 189).
Throughout Pauls autobiographical narrative in 1:12:21 he contrasts
what he was before and after his conversion-call (1:12, 15-16; see Lyons 1985,
146-52). As a result, the onetime persecutor of Christians became a perse-
cuted Christian (see 1:13-24; see 4:29; 5:11; 6:12-13, 17).
Undoubtedly, the basic facts of Pauls story were already familiar to
the Galatians, before his reminders in chs 1 and 2 (Lyons 1985, 146-47).
He merely highlighted the parts he considered most relevant to the situation.
Once a people-pleaser, he was now Christs slave (1:10). His former egocentric
existence under Law had come to an end, replaced by a cruciform life of faith
in Christ (2:19-20).
S
A
M
P
L
E
264
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12
Pauls conversion-call was not merely a matter of his personal choice, but
a result of the apocalyptic intervention of God (1:1, 10-12, 15-16). As a slave
of the crucied Christ, Paul participated in Christs sufferings and embodied
the gospel he preached (1:4; 2:19-21; 3:1, 13-14; 5:11, 24; 6:12-14). Crucial
to the before-after transformation of Pauls life was his abandonment of Law, at
least those aspects that would have made his mission to Gentiles impossible,
in particular circumcision and food laws.
The same temporal contrast between before and after marks Pauls two
scriptural expositions in 3:6-14 and 4:21-31. Between these he highlighted the
paradigmatic signicance of the temporal contrast by his descriptions of both
Jewish and Gentile Christian existence. Jewish Christians were no longer un-
der Law as they were before the coming of faith (3:23-25). Gentile Christians
were freed from their former enslavement by the redemption Christ made
possible (4:3-5). They were no longer slaves but sons and daughters of God
(v 7).
Only inattentive listeners would have missed the pervasive presence of
the temporal contrast between the past and present existence of believers.
Pauls before-after description of the Galatians in 4:8-11 immediately precedes
this appeal in vv 12-20. But here, there is a new twist. Paul found incompre-
hensible what his converts were considering. Formerly enslaved to idols, now
included among Gods free people, they seemed bent on reversing the process
of Christian formation (v 19). They were returning again to an existence of
slavery, only now under the Law (4:9-11, 21). The temporal contrast for the
Galatians was twofold:
Past slavery before Christ vs. present freedom in Christ
Present freedom in Christ vs. future slavery under Law
Pauls autobiographical narrative in chs 1 and 2 anticipated and gave
paradigmatic emphasis to the argument of the entire letter. He contrasted the
Galatians past, the present, and two possible futures. The future he urged
them to pursue required them only to afrm the new creation Christ inaugu-
rated (6:15), to continue to live as the free children of Abraham and of God.
Positively, sustaining their freedom called for continued imitation of
Paul (4:12-20). Negatively, it required them to refuse to become virtual slaves
(4:30) and, thus, to reject the Agitators arguments urging them to get cir-
cumcised so they might become what they already werechildren of Abra-
ham. A future marked by freedom would require them to return to their past,
to repeat their initial encounter with the gospel.
A future marked by circumcision would bind them to observe the whole
Law and separate them from the grace of Christ (5:2-4). This explains Pauls
appeal in 5:1: Stand rm in the freedom Christ made possible and refuse
to be enslaved. To accept circumcision or to return to paganism would cause
them to forfeit both Christ and freedom.
S
A
M
P
L
E
265
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12
Closely associated with the before-after antithesis in Pauls autobiography
is the divine-human contrast (see Lyons 1985, 152-56). His gospel and his
apostleship were of divine and not human origin ( 1:132:21). His encoun-
ter with Christ had split his life in two. But his personal revelation was initi-
ated by the same God who had previously set him apart and graciously called
him before he was born ( 1:15-16; Eastman 2007, 34-35).
In the same way, the giving of the law came after Abrahams call, and
the reign of the law came to an end when faith camethat is, when
Christ came (3:23-24). In Pauls retelling of both his own history and
Israels history, life under the law is bracketed by divine call and divine
apocalypse. (Eastman 2007, 35-36)
Pauls former life was not evil, but an interruption encompassed by the gra-
cious activity of God (Eastman 2007, 36).
Paul told the story of his Galatian converts in much the same way. Their
redemption and adoption as Gods children ended their former lives of igno-
rance and slavery (3:25-26; 4:1-9). The temporal break between past and
present comes in the fullness of time with Gods sending of the Son. By
turning to the Law they were returning to their pre-Christian past.
Paul urged the Galatians instead to return to their more recent Chris-
tian past (4:8-11) and to their former friendship with Paul (vv 12-15). This
would be to turn back to their origin in the message of faith through which
they received the Spirit (3:2-5; Eastman 2007, 37). Thus, Paul narrates the
Galatians, like himself, as having two pasts, although in reverse order from
those of the apostle (Eastman 2007, 38).
Paul ignored the detailed differences between his Jewish and the Ga-
latians Gentile pasts to focus on their similarities. Both were slaves of the
taskmasters who belong to the present age, which is passing away. Thus, we
were conned under the law (3:23); we were slaves of the stoicheia (4:3)
(Eastman 2007, 39). Flirting with the Agitators threatened everything that
matteredtheir friendship with Paul (4:16), union with Christ (5:4), experi-
ence of grace (v 5), freedom (vv 1-2), possession of the Spirit (vv 6-7, 29-31),
and hope of righteousness (5:5).
Although details remain obscure to us, Pauls rst readers would have
seen how their story was inextricably intertwined with his. Pauls solution to
the Galatians threatened apostasy was simplethe way forward was the way
back to the beginning of their Christian existence: Return to an existence
like mine, in relationship with methat is, return to our shared life in Christ
(Eastman 2007, 32 n. 18; see 30-32).
Paul explained the reason why the Galatians were to imitate his exam-
ple: because he had become like them. What had the apostle done to become
like them? And how might this motivate them to reciprocate and become like
him? Paul had abandoned the pretentious claims to his Jewish status to live
among them as a Gentile (2:15-18; see 1 Cor 9:19-23; Goddard and Cummins
S
A
M
P
L
E
266
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12-13
1993, 96-97). To become like Paul meant to live free from the Laws boundary
markers separating Jews and Gentiles.
The distinction between Jew and Greek did not matter in Christ (3:28).
Both circumcision and uncircumcision were inconsequential (5:6; 6:15). They
reected merely human concerns about the obsolete present evil age (1:4).
The Galatians were the free children of God, who had already received the
Spirit of the new age (4:28). They were not born according to the esh, but
according to the Spirit (4:29). God had called both Paul and the Galatians by
his grace prior to the advent of the law in their lives, just as God also called
Abraham (1:6, 15; 3:6) (Eastman 2007, 40).
Immediately following Pauls appeal, he insisted, You have done me no
wrong. What motivated him to assure the Galatians they had not offended
him or treated him unjustly? Why would he insist that no apology was neces-
sary (Lightfoot 1874, 174; Betz 1979, 223)? Was this an example of the gure
of speech litotesan emphatic afrmation of something by denying its op-
posite (Porter 1997, 128)? Did he merely afrm that they had treated him
justly? Or, did he imply that, although they had done him no wrong on his
founding visit, their current defection from him and his gospel (1:6-9) had
changed that (so Burton 1920, 237)?
In 2 Cor 2:5-11 and 7:2-13 Paul spoke with similar ambiguity about
perceived wrongs that had alienated him and his church in Corinth. Whatever
injustice had been done him there, Paul accepted their sorrowful repentance
as sufcient evidence of their readiness to see justice done (v 11). But he said
nothing of repentance in Galatians.
Perhaps, Pauls point was that rather than doing him an injustice, they
had actually wronged themselves by listening to the Agitators (Gal 4:21; 5:2).
Trying to be justied by Law would mean alienation from Christ (5:4). Paul
wanted to return to their good graces, to resume their friendship. But he was
willing to risk being treated as their enemy in the interests of the truth. Far
more was at stake than their friendship. Their continued existence as Chris-
tians was at risk.
L 13 Whatever wrong the Galatians may have done Paul or themselves was
well known to both. But it remains enigmatic to us. He could remind his origi-
nal audience of incidents from their earlier meetingI rst preached the gos-
pel to you (see 3:1). Because of the dramatic changes in their lives that came
as a result of their encounter, Paul did not need to go into detail: you know
(see 1:6-9; 3:2-5; Betz 1979, 224). All we know depends on what he wrote.
The expression rst preached does not imply that Paul had visited Ga-
latia twice (against Lightfoot 1874, 174-75; Burton 1920, 237; Rogers 1989,
128; with Betz 1979, 224 n. 51; Cole 1989, 169; Longenecker 1990, 190). To
proteros can mean the rst of two or more times (BDAG, 889). But here it
probably means simply formerly, in contrast to the present letter.
S
A
M
P
L
E
267
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:13
Pauls mission to Galatia was not part of a well-contrived plan: it was
because of a weakness in my esh (see Lightfoot 1874, 174; Betz 1979, 224).
Did this situation bring him to Galatia contrary to his plans or merely kept
him there longer than planned? How did conceding that his founding visit was
the result of a misfortune serve his purposes for reminiscing about the good
old days (Gttgemanns 1966, 174; Eastman 2007, 101)?
Most interpreters and translations presume that astheneian, weakness,
refers to some unspecied physical inrmity (NRSV), some bodily illness.
Martin (1999) challenges this consensus. A remarkable range of illnesses have
been proposed as explanations for Pauls weakened condition in Galatia (see
Gttgemanns 1966, 163-64; Longenecker 1990, 191). Since Paul never stat-
ed his symptoms, every suggestion is merely speculation (Martyn 1997, 420;
Sieffert 1886, 261-62).
Specul at i ng About Paul s I l l ness
Lightfoot (1874, 186-91) lists the conjectures of early interpreters
church fathers, later ascetic monks, and the Reformers. They tended to equate
this bodily weakness with Pauls so-called thorn in the esh (2 Cor 12:7). Their
suggestions included headaches, sufferings inicted by his opponents, sexual de-
sires, and spiritual trials.
Nineteenth-century commentators delighted in bold and fanciful guesses
as to the precise nature of the apostles chronic/recurring physical ailment. Brit-
ish scholars proposed malaria (Ramsay 1896, 93-97) and ophthalmia (a chronic
eye disease; Rendall 1903, 135-36, 178; recently Dunn 1993, 236; and Wither-
ington 1998a, 308-10). Germans favored epilepsy (e.g., Wrede 1908, 22-23;
Schweitzer 1968, 152-54).
Following Jerome, Martin (1999, 78-86) takes an entirely different tack.
He proposes that the eshly weakness in Gal 4:16 referred to the Galatians
preconversion sinful status (as in Rom 6:19), not to Pauls ill-health. He takes the
reference to the trial in Pauls esh (Gal 4:14) as a veiled reference to Pauls cir-
cumcision, a physical condition Gentiles considered socially unacceptable (Martin
1999, 86-90). Pauls circumcised esh provided a temptation for them to reject
and despise him as well as his message about Jesus Christ (Martin 1999, 89).
Despite their human deciencies and his circumcised state, Paul and the Galatians
became friends.
Since we are reading others mail, we cannot be certain. But based on
what is explicitly stated in Galatians, the physical consequences of persecution
seem (to me) the most plausible guess as to what led to Pauls unplanned mis-
sion in Galatia (so Goddard and Cummins 1993). He had been a persecutor
of Christians before his conversion-call (1:13, 23). And he expected persecu-
tion as a normal part of Christian experience (see Rom 8:17; 1 Thess 3:3-4,
7). Perhaps the point of Gal 3:1 () was that he had graphically portrayed the
S
A
M
P
L
E
268
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:13-14
crucied Christ before the Galatians, not by his picturesque preaching, but by
the marks of persecution he bore on his body ( 6:17).
The closest parallel to 4:13 is not Pauls discussion of his thorn in the
esh in 2 Cor 12:7 (Martin 1999, 75-78), but 1 Thess 2:2. Paul reminded the
Thessalonians of the painful circumstances surrounding his rst visit with
them. He had preached in Thessalonica despite his previous persecution in
Philippi through the power of the Holy Spirit. Ironically, suffering for Christ
provided evidence that God approved of his ministry (1 Thess 1:4-6; 2:1-6,
14; see Lyons 1985, 189-208).
In the larger context of 2 Cor 12:7, in 2 Cor 11:2112:10, Paul similarly
presented his weaknesses as the credentials of his ministry. They provided an
opportunity for Christs power to rest upon him. Among these weaknesses,
he listed no illnesses, only various forms of persecution that had routinely
accompanied his ministry (see Carver 2009, 318-42). Eastman (2007, 107)
suggests: In Gal 4:12-20, as in 2 Cor 11:2113:4, Pauls weakness is central
to the way he contrasts his ministry with that of his opponents, who avoided
persecution by preaching circumcision ( 6:12).
L 14 The word peirasmon may be translated trial or temptation (ASV, KJV,
REB). Most translations prefer trial; commentators prefer temptation. If the
weakened physical condition that occasioned Pauls preaching in Galatia (v 13)
was his, why was it a trial to the Galatians (lit., your trial)?
The variants in the manuscript tradition indicate that early scribes puz-
zled over Pauls meaningwas it your temptation or my temptation? How
did his distressing physical condition test them (e.g., Arichea and Nida 1976,
102)? Did it tempt them to despise and reject him (so e.g., Lightfoot 1874,
175; Burton 1920, 241; Betz 1979, 225; Bruce 1982, 209; Longenecker 1990,
191)? Did the demands of hospitality overextend their resources and stamina?
Were his physical symptoms repulsive?
Paul did not explain how or why his bodily weakness was a trial to the
Galatians. He emphasized only that they did not respond as one might have
expected: you did not treat me with contempt or scorn. His detractors in
Corinth disdained him for his weakness (2 Cor 10:10). But the Galatians did
not.
It was widely believed in antiquity that physical suffering was a divine
punishment for wrongdoing (see, e.g., John 9:1-2). Paul might have expected
his weakness to be perceived as demonically induced (Martyn 1997, 421;
Longenecker 1990, 191) or the result of a curse (Elliott 1990) or deserved
persecution.
The Galatians might have spit at (exeptysate; only here in the NT) him
as a sign of scorn for his pitiful state. But no. Was their unexpected friendship
what he referred to in Gal 4:12? You have done me no wrong as litotes (lit.,
understatement), might be paraphrased: You treated me well.
S
A
M
P
L
E
269
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:14-16
Paul rst described the Galatians reception negatively, in terms of what
they had not done to him. Next, he described it positively: But you welcomed
me as an angel of God, as Christ Jesus. Their hospitality went well beyond
what might have been expected by a man in robust health, much less an in-
jured man (see Acts 14).
Why was Paul received as a supernatural gure, given his weakened
bodily state? Was this only hyperbole, complimenting the Galatians for treat-
ing him with the same respect they would have given a divine messenger
or Christ himself? Why did he express himself in this way? Only after he
preached the gospel did they learn about Christ. Did their acceptance of him
in his weakened state compare with their faith in the apparently weak, cruci-
ed Christ (see 6:17; so Eastman 2007, 49-50)? Because we are only eaves-
dropping, we cannot be certain.
L 15 Paul turned from this brief summary of their initial meeting to pose a
rhetorical question: Where then is your blessing? He was not seeking informa-
tion. His question implied only that they no longer felt the same way about
him (Arichea and Nida 1976, 103). What had become of the happiness of their
rst meeting?
Paul mentioned further evidence of his initial favorable reception by the
Galatians (lit.): For I bear witness to you that, if possible, after you tore out
your eyes, you gave them to me. Of course, this is hyperbole. They had not ac-
tually engaged in auto-enucleation. This was a hypothetical, contrary-to-fact
condition (Longenecker 1990, 193): I can testify that, if you could have done
so, you would have torn out your eyes and given them to me.
Some interpreters take the metaphor as evidence that Pauls physical
condition involved eye problems. But our expression, You would have cut off
your right arm for me, does not indicate that the speaker had a handicapped
dominant arm. The proverbial saying indicates only the Galatians extravagant
willingness to sacrice their most priceless assets for Paul (e.g., Betz 1979,
227-28). As true friends, they accepted him as their true friend.
L 16 Paul concluded the account of his initial visit with the Galatians with
what some take as a rhetorical question: So, have I become your enemy by
telling you the truth? (e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 176). Others, however, read it as
a statement, allegedly reecting the Agitators accusations (so, e.g., Burton
1920, 244; Longenecker 1990, 193).
The inferential conjunction So customarily introduces commands and
conclusions in Pauls letters (e.g., Gal. 3:9, 24; 4:7), not questions (Rendall
1903, 179). Here it begins an ironic exclamation: So [now] I have become
your enemy telling you the truth! (Witherington 1998a, 313).
Pauls So did not express pessimism as to how his frank words in the
present letter would be received (against Hendricksen 1968, 173). Instead,
their future plans, which put him and his message in a negative light, occa-
sioned the letter. The perfect tense of the verb Have . . . become refers to the
S
A
M
P
L
E
270
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:16-17
present consequences of a past event. Pauls truthful words refer to his preach-
ing among them on his one visit to Galatia, not subsequently.
We do not know how Paul learned of the Galatians plans or that they
no longer spoke well of him and his message (see 4:15a; 1:6-9) or of their new
friendship with the Agitators. His letter mentions no intermediate visit to
Galatia nor other communication to or from them.
Paul had not changed his message or his attitude toward the Galatians.
He had remained steadfast and consistent. But his reputation among and re-
lationship with them had been damaged by their anonymous, new, supposed
friends (see 4:17). The Agitators must have made him appear to be their en-
emy rather than their friend. And they must have maligned his gospel as false
or incomplete (see 1:6-9). As Paul saw it, they tripped up the Galatians and
kept them from obeying the truth (5:7).
Both Paul and the Galatians were well aware of the ancient expectations
of friendship. Among them was the conviction that true friends spoke frankly
with one another (see Lyons and Malas 2007, 57-58). In telling them the
truth Paul is their best friend (Bruce 1982, 211). His description of himself
as their enemy was obviously ironic. False friends were manipulative atterers,
who feigned friendship for selsh ends. This is how Paul portrayed the Agita-
torsThose people in 4:17 and 18.
Flatterers see themselves as competitors who must exclude their friends
other friends (Lyons and Malas 2007, 55). The Agitators wanted to eliminate
Paul from the Galatians friends, to treat him as their enemy. But he insisted
that he was a true and loyal friend to the Galatians.
The apostles time apart from his Galatian friends had tested their
friendship more than the injuries that forged it had (v 14). The Agitators had
taken advantage of his absence. Paul reminded the Galatians of the ancient
axiom that true friendship is based on shared values, not just physical prox-
imity or personal afnity. . . . true friends praise us in [our] absence [apontas]
rather than in our presence [parontas] (Lyons and Malas 2007, 58).
L 17 Paul could take for granted a good deal in writing to his original audi-
ence. Who are Those people, and why did he mention them? His original au-
dience understood perfectly to whom he referred. But he did not even assign
them an explicit pronoun. The English pronoun They is merely implied in the
third person plural ending of the verb: They are zealous [ze3lousin] for you.
They must have been the Agitators (e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 176; Arichea and
Nida 1976, 104). But, by cursing them with anonymity, there is no grammati-
cal antecedent for the implicit pronoun They.
That the Agitators were zealous for the Galatians (you) probably meant
that they wanted Pauls converts to become their friends and to share their
understanding of the gospel. But the one friendship excluded the other. The
Greek word translated zealous can have either a favorable (see 2 Cor 7:7, 11;
S
A
M
P
L
E
271
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:17-19
9:2; 11:2; Phil 3:6) or unfavorable sense (as jealousy in Rom 10:2-3; 13:13; 1
Cor 3:3) in Pauls letters.
Israels commitment to their Law (see Acts 21:20), their God, and the
right (Rom 10:2-3; see 1 Kgs 19:10, 14; 1 Macc 2:58) was good. But it had
been perverted into violent exclusion and persecution of violators of the Law,
as Paul knew from personal experience (Gal 1:14; Phil 3:6). Their delusional
zeal expressed itself as ethnocentrism and intolerance of diversity.
Zeal becomes a vice when protecting the uniqueness and prerogatives
of ones friends calls for the violent exclusion or elimination of ones enemies.
Such zeal is narrow-minded and nearsighted. As Paul saw it, the Agitators
were zealous, but not in a good way. Instead, they want to exclude you from
friendship with me, in order that you may be zealous for them.
Paul cared little for the true motives of the Agitators. This was rhetorical
combat. He was not attempting to be fair or to give those who opposed him
the advantage of the doubt. He could think of no good reason for what they
were urging his converts to do. The Galatians stood in the middle of polemical
crossre. Pauls persuasion would have been no different had he thought the
Agitators were well-intentioned.
Not intentions, but the truth was at stake (v 16). If the Galatians were
to be friends with the Agitators, they had to sever their ties of friendship with
Paul (e.g., George 1994, 327-28; Bruce 1982, 211; Longenecker 1990, 194).
He blamed his opponents for making it necessary to take sides.
L 18 Paul was as zealous for the Galatians allegiance as were the Agitators.
He did not insist on being their only friend, only that true friends were loyal,
whether present or absent, in good times and bad (Lyons and Malas 2007, 58).
Consistency was a prerequisite of true friendshipalways and not just
when I am with you (Burton 1920, 247; Longenecker 1990, 194). If we must
mirror-read, Pauls comment, It is ne to be zealous provided the purpose is
good, may have implied that the Agitators zeal was awed: They were out-
of-sight-out-of-mind, false friends. Paul considered the motives of the Agita-
tors interest in the Galatians entirely selsh. They urged circumcision so that
theythe Agitatorscould avoid being persecuted for the cross of Christ
(6:12) and have something to boast about (v 13).
But Pauls comment here may have had another force: It is good to be
made much of for a good purpose at all times, and not only when I am present
with you (NRSV; e.g., Betz 1979, 231). If so, his point was to afrm the Gala-
tians former zeal for him as a good thing. If so, he perhaps hinted that their
changed attitude toward him after his departure indicated that they were fair-
weather friends. Regardless, he certainly asserted the constancy of his friend-
ship for them (Burton 1920, 247).
L 19 What is the point of Pauls parenthetical comment in v 19? It interrupts
both vv 18 and 20, which express his desire to be present with the Galatians,
and vv 17 and 20, which contrast what Those people . . . want and what he
S
A
M
P
L
E
272
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:19
wanted (I wish). And how is v 19 related to its context? Does it express a
distinct and unrelated thought (Betz 1979, 233; Longenecker 1990, 194)?
Does it explain why Paul longed to visit the Galatians again or what his zeal for
the good (vv 17 and 18) of the Galatians entailed (Burton 1920, 247)?
In v 19, Paul directly addressed his audience, as in v 12. There, however,
he referred to them metaphorically as brothers and sisters. Here, for the only
time in all his letters, he addressed his hearers as my children (or in some
manuscripts My dear children or my little children [NRSV]). This remarkable
shift in familial metaphors was motivated by the maternal imagery he was
about to apply to himself.
My children, for whom I am again suffering with labor pains [see
4:27] until Christ is formed in you. Did this convey only Pauls motherly af-
fection for the Galatians (so Jerome, cited in Edwards 1999, 64)? Or, did it
also imply some slight rebuke (Arichea and Nida 1976, 106), with consider-
ably less sting than the address in 3:1: You foolish Galatians!
Paul as Parent
In 1 Cor 4:15 Paul presented himself as the father of the Christian com-
munity he founded in Corinth. The present passage pictures him as a mother in
labor. The metaphor morphs. We might have expected him to refer to the em-
bryonic church developing in his apostolic womb. But instead, he pictured Christ
as developing within the Galatian community (you plural).
In addition to Gal 4:19, other maternal metaphors appear in 1:15; Rom
8:22; 1 Cor 3:1-2; 15:8; and 1 Thess 2:7. Paternal imagery appears in Gal 4:6;
Rom 8:15; 1 Cor 4:14; Phil 2:22; 1 Thess 2:11-12; and Phlm 10. There are gender-
neutral parental images in 2 Cor 6:13; 12:14 (see Eastman 2007, 89-90 n. 1).
The Greek grammatical gender of the noun children is neuter. But the
relative pronoun referring to it is masculine. This could refer generically to
persons of both genders (BDAG, 727). But the prominence of the issue of
circumcision in the letter suggests that Pauls primary audience was male.
The adverb again (see 1:9, 17; 2:1, 18; 4:9; 5:1, 3) indicates that Pauls
suffering was caused by the Galatians threatened apostasy. His renewed labor
pains were like those he experienced before they came to faith in Christ the
rst time (v 13; so, e.g., Betz 1979, 234). Was their conversion incomplete?
Did they need to be reborn (Burton 1920, 248)? Or, did they merely need to
mature as Christians (Cole 1989, 175)?
In 5:4, Paul would say of those who are trying to be justied by law:
You . . . have been alienated from Christ; you have fallen away from grace.
He agonized over apparently wasted experiences on their part (3:4) and wast-
ed efforts on his (4:11). Despite his worst fears, he was condent the Agitators
would not abort his children. His protracted suffering would continue until
Christ was formed in the Galatian communities. He was prepared to repeat
S
A
M
P
L
E
273
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:19
the process of conception and birth, and to begin again the proclamation of
the gospel and the formation of the community (Phlmann 1990, 443).
This raises two questions: First, what was so painful about Pauls
preaching? (Eastman 2007, 99). Second, what did he understand to be the
character and content of Christian formation?
The imagery of labor pains gures prominently in prophetic / apocalyp-
tic descriptions of the suffering anticipating the birth of the new creation
(Gal 6:15; 2 Cor 5:17; see Isa 13:6-8; 42:13-15; Jer 6:24; 8:18-21; Mic 4:10; 2
Esd [= 4 Ezra] 4:42; 1 En. 62:4-5; 2 Bar. 56:6; 1QH III, 7-10; Matt 24:8; Mark
13:8; Rom 8:22; 1 Thess 5:3; Rev 12:2; Eastman 2007, 114-16). In Jewish and
Christian circles it was customary to speak of a coming cataclysm, however
interpreted, as being accompanied by anguish like that of a woman giving
birth (Gaventa 2007, 34).
Pauls participation in the suffering of the crucied Christ (Gal 2:20-21;
6:17) probably stands in the background of the bold metaphor of Gal 4:19
(Eastman 2007, 123). Paul drew upon biblical images of the suffering of God
(see Isa 42:14; 45:10; Jer 8:21). The anguished cry of the apostle in the throes
of labor echoed Gods own suffering. Only God could bring the process to
completion (Eastman 2007, 123).
The passive verb is formed in Gal 4:19 is undoubtedly a divine passive.
God was doing the forming (Sanders 1983, 13 n. 18). But there was a syner-
gism between the apostles suffering in behalf of the Galatians and Gods cre-
ative activity, which would reshape them into Christlikeness (Louw and Nida
1989, 1:584). Like the weak apostle, they needed to allow their existence to
be shaped by the cross (2:20; 6:17) (Eastman 2007, 108).
The verb morphoo3 (form) appears only here in the NT. In 5:13-25 Paul
would explain the Christian formation of the Galatians communities as spiri-
tual formationbeing led by the Spirit and bearing the fruit of the Spirit
(Eastman 2007, 13). But the apocalyptic origins of Pauls birth-pangs imagery,
however, make it unlikely that he referred merely to his longings for the Gala-
tians to achieve spiritual (Burton 1920, 248) or moral (Lietzmann 1932, 28)
maturity or christological soundness (Mussner 1977, 312-13).
The process of Christian formation was painful because Paul faced op-
position from antichrists (see 1 John 2:18-23; 4:1-3; 2 John 7; Gal 2:21; 5:2-4)
working through the Agitators to thwart the eschatological redemption of
the elect (Martyn 1997, 430). Paul participated in Gods struggle with all
dominion, authority and power resistant to Gods reign (1 Cor 15:20-28). In
Galatia, this resistance was represented by the Agitators. His pains of child-
birth reected the anguish of the whole created order as it awaits the fulll-
ment of Gods action in Jesus Christ (see Rom 8:22-23; Gaventa 2007, 34).
It is impossible to separate entirely the formation of Christ in each in-
dividual from the formation of the body of Christ in their community as
a whole (Bruce 1982, 212). Galatians 4:19 alone is insufcient to require a
S
A
M
P
L
E
274
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:19
two-stage Christian experiencejustication followed by the formation of
Christlikeness. It is rather that the one implies the other (Bruce 1982, 213).
Other passages using words from the morphoo3 cognate family in Pauls
letters (Rom 12:2; 2 Cor 3:18; Phil 3:10) suggest that he conceived of justica-
tion as concomitant with initial sanctication. Gods sanctifying work begins
at justication but must continue uninterrupted until glorication.
Christian formation means collectively putting on Christ to be all one
in Christ within communities in which human differences are inconsequen-
tial (Gal 3:27-28). Christ transforms individual believers, Christian commu-
nities, even the entire cosmos (6:15). The Christian life is the state resulting
from being co-crucied with Christ (2:19b-20). Egocentric existence comes
to an end as Christ lives in believers and believers live by faith in the crucied
Son of God. Thus, the formation of Christ among the Galatians is simultane-
ously their crucixion with Christ (Gaventa 2007, 36).
Paul longed for Christ to become the real ego of the Galatian com-
munities, in the sense that he will live in them as he already lives in Paul
(2:20) (Martyn 1997, 424). This could be no private matter. The formation
of Christ is a communal event (Martyn 1997, 425), requiring crucixion to
the old age and its crucixion to the community ( 2:20; 6:14).
Pauls labor pains would continue until Christ was formed in the Gala-
tians (4:19). The word until indicates that he expected the Christian forma-
tion of the Galatians to occur in the present age as part of an ongoing process
that would continue until the new age came in its fullness (Rom 6:1-4; 8:29;
1 Cor 3:1-4; 15:49; Gaventa 2007, 36).
Paul understood authentic Christlikeness to require a place for pain and
suffering in the experience of Christians. The Agitators apparently offered cir-
cumcision as a quick and easy way. Both could escape persecution if the Gala-
tians would submit. But he assessed this briey painful surgical procedure dif-
ferently. The cutting off of the foreskin would cut them off from Christ ( Gal
5:4). Paul was anxious to move beyond this misunderstanding and begin again.
Pauls labor pains were bearable. He knew that the present evil age
(1:4) had been invaded by a new reality: a crucied Lord who confronts and
overturns the world (Gaventa 2007, 37). His labor refers to his own con-
tinuing suffering as he preached the gospel in the face of resistance from the
Agitators. His suffering displayed the crucied Christ and replicate[d] Gods
creative labor in bringing forth a new people of God (Eastman 2007, 19).
The apparent aw in Pauls analogyhis mixed metaphorwas due to
his conviction that believers were not born to develop to their full poten-
tial either individually or autonomously. On the contrary, it is Christ who
is formed, and the apocalyptic maternity is completed only when Christ is
formed. Spiritual formation is Gods gift, never simply a human achievement
(Gaventa 2007, 37).
S
A
M
P
L
E
275
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:20
L 20 Paul concluded the appeal begun in v 12 with the expression of an im-
possible wish. He longed to trade the necessity of communication by letter for
a personal visit: I wish I were present with you now (NRSV). The imperfect
tense of the verb wish politely expressed Pauls preference, which could not be
achieved at the moment (e.g., Betz 1979, 213).
The second half of Pauls wish was that he could change his tone. Many
interpreters take this to suggest that he wondered whether a gentler approach
might be preferable to the strident one he had taken in the letter (e.g., Light-
foot 1874, 179; Burton 1920, 250; Martyn 1997, 426). But only a face-to-face
meeting could determine this. And if the apostle had serious misgivings about
the tack he was taking, he could simply have changed his approach and written
a different letter.
What Paul wished for was to exchange the written medium of the let-
ter, necessitated by his absence, for the aural medium of his voice (so Rendall
1903, 180; Betz 1979, 236; Longenecker 1990, 196; Hays 2000, 296). His
two wishes were mutually interpretive. That is, he wished to be physically
present with the Galatians to speak with them directly and personally.
Paul explained the reason why he wished for a return visit to Galatia: I
am perplexed about you! He was in a confused state of mind, . . . at a loss,
. . . in doubt, . . . uncertain . . . disturbed (BDAG, 119, s.v. aporeo3). Was he
unsure of how to deal with the Galatians apostasy (Lightfoot 1874, 179)? Or,
was he befuddled as to why they would trade their newfound gospel freedom
for slavery like that they had escaped? Im completely puzzled by what youve
done! (GW). Whatever he meant, 5:10 indicates that he was not totally pes-
simistic about the Galatians (Witherington 1998a, 316).
Unlike the Agitators, Paul argued in 4:17-20 that he always zealously
sought the best interests of his converts. His letter repreached the circumcision-
free gospel. This preaching was his painful but productive apocalyptic labor.
As their surrogate mother, he yearned to be physically present with the Gala-
tians, his children, as Christ was formed in them (Eastman 2007, 110).
v
FROM THE TEXT
Emotional Arguments. Most older evangelical Christians recall the emo-
tion-laden stories evangelists often used in preparation for the altar call.
Were they merely following Pauls example in the present passage? Today,
most churches consider such guilt-manipulating tactics inappropriate emo-
tional blackmail. The argument from pathos . . . was a familiar type of rheto-
ric in the ancient Mediterranean world. Audiences and readers expected this
sort of appeal, and it would not have grated on their sensibilities in the same
way it would on . . . a congregation in our time (Hays 2000, 217). We might
well learn from Paul to employ artfully the rhetorically persuasive conventions
of our culture, not just slavishly imitate Pauls rhetorical tactics.
S
A
M
P
L
E
276
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12-20
That said, in our postmodern world, academics need to be reminded that
human beings are not merely disembodied minds. Deep personal relation-
ships and loyalties do matter. Emotions play a crucial role in all of our lives.
Sometimes the best argument is not the one that appeals to reason alone. It is
possible to avoid shameless manipulation and yet appeal to the hearts of those
we try to persuade to take the gospel seriously.
Role Models. Many twenty-rst century readers of Galatians nd Pauls
invitation to imitation arrogant and egocentric. But to do so is to misunder-
stand the difference between our cultural setting and his. Paul was not unique
among thinkers in Greco-Roman antiquity in the view that models [Latin: ex-
empla] are more helpful and easier to follow than precepts [Latin: praecepta;
see Seneca, Ep. 6:5-6; 75; 40:1]. Seneca [Ep. 52:8] held that the best models
are those who teach us by their lives . . . who tell us what we ought to do . . .
and then prove it by their practice (Lyons 1995, 194).
Does it matter if we practice what we preach? In rapidly repaganizing
Western civilization, we may need to rethink our reticence to be role models.
Secular people no longer know the Christian Scriptures, traditions, or life-
style. How else are we to engender truly Christian living where there is no
preparation and few or inadequate contemporary precedents (Lyons 1995,
188)? As the old adage has it, we may be the only Bible some people will ever
read. It will not do simply to point to faraway saints like Mother Teresa; one
task of the churchs ministry is to identify and acknowledge those women and
men in our midst who embody the gospel (Hays 2000, 217).
Christian Love as Friendship. Paul understood his relationship with his
churches and of their mutual relations within the framework of the Greco-
Roman conception of friendship (Lyons and Malas 2007, 58; see 67-68). That
is, he conceived of the church as a society of many friends (Lyons and Malas
2007, 56; see 59 n. 31). Galatians 4:12-20 focuses on two of the three ma-
jor problems with friendship as understood in the ancient world: the abuse
of friendship and attempts to reconcile when friendships dissolve (see Lyons
and Malas 2007, 51 n. 4). Paul wrote to the Galatians as a friend to alienated
friends. He wrote to encourage them to reconsider the disadvantages of their
supposed new friends, the Agitators, who seemed intent on excluding Paul
from their friendship.
All of Pauls letters were saturated with the terminology and ideals
of friendship and kinship in the ancient world. I grew up in a bygone era in
which it was expected that children address older church members as Sister
or Brother So-and-so. But reality is more important than the terminology we
prefer. Christian love might seem less religious and ethereal and more relevant
and earthly in our postmodern context, if we thought of it as a variety of
true friendship modeled by Jesus Christ. In this light, what are the words and
deeds demanded by true friendship: unity, partnership, equality, moral excel-
lence, frankness, and loyalty (Lyons and Malas 2007, 69)?
S
A
M
P
L
E
277
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:12-20
Spiritual Growth. Paul dened Christian existence as having Christ . . .
formed within a community of believers. Of course, the community is born
through the growth of Christ in individuals (Wikenhauser 1964, 44; see Bur-
nett 2001). But the legalistic practice of the classic Christian disciplines
meditation, prayer, fasting, study, simplicity, solitude, submission, service,
confession, worship, guidance, and celebration (Foster 1998)cannot guar-
antee that Christ is formed.
The means of grace, as John Wesley identied these disciplines, are
effective only as God works in the lives of individuals and communities in
transforming ways. As divine grace meets human openness, remarkable in-
ner changes may take place. But spiritual formation takes time and is often
as painful for the spiritual director as for the directed. Labor pains may be
expected. There is no quick and easy path to Christian maturity, whether
circumcision or the momentary catharsis of a dramatic religious experience.
Virtual vs. Real Presence. The Internet revolution has only exacerbated a
problem that has existed since well before Pauls day. Written communication
has always been an inferior substitute for face-to-face conversation. Emoticons
cannot replace actual facial expressions and the tone of ones own voice. But
a variety of constraints sometimes require the use of less than ideal means
to compensate for bodily absence. Paul was perplexed over his unfulllable
wish to be physically present with the Galatians. Letters could not weep (see
Chrysostom in Edwards 1999, 65).
I have taught online classes for over a decade. For many active pastors,
online is the only realistic means to continue their education. In a perfect
world, a virtual classroom is never preferable to a face-to-face environment.
Genuine online community is possible, but disembodied learning lacks an es-
sential element of authentic human community. Most online students attend
graduation ceremonies, because they need to connect in person with those
who have formed and befriended them in the articial world of the Internet.
Difcult as it is to imagine, there have been attempts to celebrate virtual
Communion over the Internet. But can staring at the backs of one anothers
heads in the way most of our churches meet be construed as personal, bodily
presence? We need to consider how we may spur one another on toward love
and good deeds in such assemblies (Heb 10:24). Does what happens before
and after what we call church do that? Does more mutual encouragement
take place in the narthex (the place of sinners) than in the sanctuary (the
holy place)? Do impersonal pleasantries exchanged during the few moments
scheduled for fellowship during our assemblies sufce? Does it matter that
the only voice of encouragement we usually hear when we gather for church
comes from the front by way of a digitally enhanced amplication system?
How personal is that?
S
A
M
P
L
E
278
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:21
5:1
The Voice of Scripture. The fth-century saint and doctor of the church,
Jerome, suggests yet another application of Pauls perplexity over the inad-
equacy of mere words on paper.
Holy Scripture edies even when read but is much more protable if
one passes from written characters to the voice. . . . Knowing, then, that
speech has more force when addressed to those who are present, the
apostle longs to turn the epistolary voice, the voice conned within writ-
ten characters, into actual presence. (Cited in Edwards 1999, 65-66)
The canon of Holy Scripture emerged over the rst ve centuries of the
Christian church. It was not a decision made behind locked doors by councils
and cardinals. It arose through the consensus practice of ordinary believers in
Christian churches over a long time and a wide geographical area. The books
they read and reread aloud in these churches came to be recognized as in-
spired, because they continued to inspire their hearers. It is alarming how
little Scripture is given voice in so-called Bible-believing churches today. If the
canon were being determined now, what might it look like?
4. Scriptural Appeal: Abrahams Wives and Sons
(4:215:1)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Nowhere else in Pauls letters is there such an extended allegorical inter-
pretation of an OT passage. The strangeness of this interpretive approach to
modern readers is compounded by its location at a crucial point in the letters
argument (so, e.g., Betz 1979, 238-40; Kennedy 1984, 144-52). There were
rabbinic precedents for Pauls allegorical method (see Ellis 1957; Longenecker
1999, 109-13). But it has been generally unpersuasive to later readers (e.g.,
Luther 1953, 278; Calvin 1841, 115-16; Dunn 1993, 243).
Allegoria [Allegory] is an enunciation which while signifying one thing
literally, brings forth the thought of something else (Tryphon of Alexandria,
De tropis 1.1, cited in Di Mattei 2006, 105-6). In Gal 4:21-31 Paul speaks
of one thing, paidiske3 [slave woman] and eleuthera [free woman], but intends
something other than what is said, two covenants (Di Mattei 2006, 106).
The verb alle3goreo3 during the rst century did not usually mean to inter-
pret allegorically, but to speak allegorically. It was less an interpretation than
an application. Paul did not pretend to explain the OT passage. He used it to
explain a contemporary situation. The conclusions of an allegorical application
are implicit in its assumptions. Thus, sympathetic readers of Pauls allegory
need not be persuaded by his arguments. But they must grasp his point.
Many commentators follow Barretts (1976) speculative assumption that
Paul was compelled to address this aspect of the Abraham story because his
opponents had used it to support their case for circumcision (e.g., Barclay
1988, 53-56; Longenecker 1990, xcvii, 200; Martyn 1997, 433; Hays 2000,
S
A
M
P
L
E
279
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:21
5:1
300). If the Agitators defended the necessity of circumcision by appeal to
Scripture, they almost certainly used Gen 17:9-14. It explicitly calls for all the
sons of Abraham to be circumcised. But Paul says nothing of it.
Mirror-reading might suggest that Pauls allegory challenged the Agita-
tors claim that the earthly Jerusalem is our mother with proof that the heav-
enly Jerusalem is our mother (v 26; Eastman 2007, 128). Or, they may have
claimed, like several apocryphal Jewish texts, that Abraham was an observer
of the Torah even before it was given through Moses (Jub. 15:9-14, 26, 33-34;
16:28; Sir 44:20; 2 Bar. 57:2). Was Pauls allegorical reading intended to turn
such claims on their heads? If so, nothing he said made this clear (but see 1
Cor 1:11; 5:1; 6:12; 10:23; 15:33).
Di Mattei makes a plausible case for thinking Paul appealed to the pas-
sage completely of his own initiative (2006, 119 n. 61). Pauls allegorical
reading is fully intelligible from known Jewish traditions. This makes unnec-
essary elaborate reconstructions about anonymous opponents, known only
from Pauls rhetorically charged descriptions.
The larger OT context of Pauls allegory is Gen 1621. The leading
characters in the story are Abraham (generally accepted as the founding head
of the family of Israel), his concubine Hagar, her son Ishmael, his wife Sarah,
and her son Isaac. But Sarah and Ishmael are never mentioned by name in
Pauls summary. Do such omissions indicate that he took for granted that his
readers were familiar with the story? That they should be able to ll in the
gaps in his table of comparisons? Or, was there a hidden agenda in these un-
mentioned names?
Paul neither quoted nor retold the biblical story. He simply identied the
allegorical equivalents of Abrahams wives and sons. Then, he invited his audi-
ence to nd themselves in the story and respond appropriately. His allegory
took for granted the Greco-Roman slave and family law existent in his day
(Lhrmann 1992, 90).
To be born as the son of the legitimate wife meant to be born into free-
dom as a son who could inherit the status, social location, and family
property of the head of the household. To be born as the son of the slave
concubine did not afford this possibility and meant the inheritance of
her slave status. (Elliott 1999, 661 n. 2)
Pauls quotation of Isa 54:1 in Gal 4:27 signicantly shaped the way
he read the story (see Harmon 2010, 173-85). It encapsulates the combined
stories of the barren woman and the city of Jerusalem, and that this story
functions in Galatians both as a picture of Gods transforming power and as a
promise of a lasting community and habitation for Gods people in Jerusalem
above (Eastman 2007, 129).
The interpretation of Pauls quotation of Gen 21:10 in Gal 4:30 is hotly
disputed by scholars. Did Paul appeal to Scripture to urge the Galatians to ex-
communicate some from their Christian communities? Did he deny Jews and
S
A
M
P
L
E
280
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:21
5:1
Law-observant Jewish Christians the possibility of salvation? Or did he warn
his auditors of the danger of excluding themselves from end-times salvation
by failing to own their true identity as free, Spirit-lled children of Abraham?
Pauls understanding of the story of Abrahams children encouraged him
to believe that his painful labor in behalf of the Galatians was not in vain, that
his converts would not abandon the true gospel (4:11, 19; 5:10). The alle-
gory also prepared the way for Pauls description of the Spirit-led community
(5:136:16) (Eastman 2007, 129). Thus, 4:215:1 serves as a transitional
bridge ( 4:8-11) from the theological section of the letter in 3:64:7 to the
paraenetic section in 5:136:10 (Eastman 2007, 136).
In 5:1, the concluding verse of the passage, Paul drew on the language
and practice of sacral manumission (see Deissmann 1910, 322-41). Slaves
were legally barred from initiating or negotiating legal contracts. To gain their
freedom, however, they were allowed to deposit into the temple treasury of
their patron deity the amount of money required to purchase their freedom.
At the temple, this legal-ction allowed their owners to receive the purchase
price from the god. This made their slaves ofcially the deitys property. By
becoming slaves of their god, they gained their freedom (Boring, Berger, and
Colpe 1995, 463).
The customary language of ancient inscriptions recording such transac-
tions resembles Pauls words in 5:1:
For freedom [the gods name]
bought from [owners name]
a slave named [slaves name].
The purchase [slaves name]
has committed to [gods name]
for freedom.
Pauls appropriation of this usage as a metaphor for Christian redemption im-
plies that he assumed Christ was God (Witherington 1998a, 340).
I N THE TEXT
L 21 Paul had previously addressed his audience as foolish Galatians (3:1),
his Christian brothers and sisters (1:2, 11; 3:15; and 4:12), and his spiritual
children (v 19). But here he addressed some of them as you who want to be
under the law ( 3:23; 4:4, 5; 5:18). The signicance of this is crucial to un-
derstanding the passage and the entire letter.
Most interpreters assume Paul addressed the Galatians in 4:215:1 (e.g.,
Longenecker 1990, 206; Dunn 1993, 298). If so, he made no effort to distin-
guish those who had remained faithful to his Law-free founding principles from
those who were enamored with the Agitators. On the contrary, 4:21-31 pre-
sume that all the Galatian churches were deserting the one who called them
and turning to a different gospel (1:6). But the rest of the letter indicates that
not everyone had been persuaded by the perverted gospel of the Agitators.
S
A
M
P
L
E
281
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:21
Martin (1995, 450) considers the identication of the addressees . . . the
most signicant exegetical problem in 4:215:6. He assumes that the Gala-
tians as a whole had no intentions of submitting to circumcision or keeping the
Jewish law (1995, 451). Thus, he proposes that Paul rhetorically addressed
the Agitators, not the Galatians in these verses. The Agitators were not among
Pauls intended readers. Thus, Martin treats this passage as a diatribe in which
Paul imaginatively addressed the opponents as if they were present. But Gal
4:215:6 bears little resemblance to the diatribe style in Romans, where it is
generally acknowledged (see, e.g., Rom 24; 67).
So, who were these legal enthusiasts? Were they Agitators zealous to
win over Pauls Galatian converts (see 4:17)? Or were they those being led
astray by them? Pauls double curse on such people in 1:8-9 notwithstanding,
4:215:1 suggests that he did not consider them beyond hope or persuasion.
In fact, he continued to address his readers as brothers and sisters (4:28).
It would be a mistake to imagine that the apostle assumed those who
want to be under the law included everyone in all the Galatian churches. Mar-
tin is probably correct that the Galatians would have known immediately to
whom Paul was speaking (1995, 451). But we are not the Galatians. We have
no way of knowing the relative strengths of the loyal and the disaffected fac-
tions in these communities. He apparently did not send different letters to the
various parties.
Pauls references to the Agitators in Galatians are always enigmatic. It
is difcult to be certain how much he knew about the situation and how he
acquired this information. Did he believe that his reading (see 4:24) of Gen
21:8-21 would persuade any who wanted to be under the law to change their
minds? Or, did he believe his arguments might help persuade the loyal and the
ambivalent that the Agitators were mistaken?
Pauls closing argument before turning to ethical advice in Gal 5:1
6:10 appealed to Scripture, as in 3:64:7. The biblical proof began with a
question: Tell me, you who want to be under the law, do you not hear the law?
( 3:23). His question presumed that the Galatians were already familiar
with the passage he was about to apply. Perhaps, they had not yet adequately
understood it (as in 1 Cor 14:2) or grasped its relevance to the situation in
Galatia (Lagrange 1926, 122).
Pauls omission of the names of key gures in the story supports the
assumption that his audience knew it, at least to some extent. But how? Had
they become familiar with it from Pauls earlier preaching? from their own in-
dependent reading? from hearing it read in the synagogue? from the Agitators
different interpretation of it?
The word law in Pauls description of his hearers refers to the legal regu-
lations of the Mosaic law. But in his question, law referred to the Pentateuch,
particularly to the Genesis account of Abrahams family. Paul made a similar
S
A
M
P
L
E
282
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:21-23
shift in his use of the term nomos in Rom 3:31, appealing to another feature
of the Abraham story to validate his understanding of justication in Rom 4.
L 22 For the purposes of his allegory, Paul did not bring up Abrahams mar-
riage to Keturah and her six sons mentioned in Gen 25:1-4. In Gal 4:21-30, he
focused exclusively on the tensions between Ishmael and Isaac in Gen 1621.
Thus, he could assert: For it is written that Abraham had two sons.
Elsewhere in Pauls letters, the introductory formula For it is written is
always followed by a quotation (as in 4:27 and 3:10; see Rom 12:19; 14:11; 1
Cor 1:19; 3:19 [9:9]). This was also the case when he used the formula as
it is written (Rom 1:17; 2:24; 3:4, 10; 4:17; 8:36; 9:13, 33; 10:15; 11:8, 26;
15:3, 9, 21; 1 Cor 1:31; 2:9 [?]; 10:7; 2 Cor 8:15; 9:9; compare 1 Cor 14:21;
15:45; Gal 3:13).
But this was not the case here. Instead, Paul merely summarized the
main features of a lengthy narrative and suggested allegorical equivalents.
Longenecker characterizes these equations as a shocking realignment of per-
sonages and places in a Jewish understanding of salvation history (1990, 213).
Paul never explicitly named Ishmael (Gen 16:11, 15, 16; etc.), Abra-
hams son by the slave woman (see Gen 16:1, 2, 3, 5, 6, 8). In Gal 4:24, Paul
identied this woman as Hagar, the Egyptian slave of his wife, Sarah, who
became Abrahams concubine. Only later would Paul name Abrahams son,
Isaac (v 28), the other son by the free woman. Abrahams wife, Sarah, is never
mentioned by name in the allegory. And she is never called a free woman in
Genesis.
Pauls imposition of such descriptions on the text was undoubtedly mo-
tivated by the point he intended to make. He was not really interested in the
characters in the story itself, but in what these characters represent (promise
and freedom on the one hand or esh and slavery on the other) and what their
story tells us about the ways of God with his people (Witherington 1998a, 329).
L 23 In addition to their different mothers, Paul highlighted one additional
contrast between Abrahams two sons (v 22): the one by the slave woman
was born according to the esh [kata sarka; see v 29]; and the one by the free
woman was born as the result of a promise (di epangelias).
Paul consistently substituted the verb gennao3, beget (vv 23, 24, 29) for
the LXX verb give birth, tikto3, in the Genesis story (Gen 16:1, 2, 11, 15,
16; 17:17, 19, 21; 18:13). Martyn (1997, 451-54) considers this substitution
theologically signicant. But this is doubtful, since Paul left tikto3 in the only
passage quoted in Gal 4:21-31 (Isa 54:1 in Gal 4:27).
Jewish tradition identied Ishmael as a Gentile (Jub. 16:17; 15:30). But
Gen 17:23 indicates that Abraham circumcised both his sons (see Jub. 15:23).
Paul ignored all the Genesis references to circumcision.
Paul referred to Gen 16:4a, which briey describes the ordinary (kata
sarka: according to the esh) circumstances surrounding the birth of Ishmael.
Sarah schemed to provide an heir for Abraham through a surrogate mother;
S
A
M
P
L
E
283
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:23-24
he agreed. And he went in to Hagar, and she conceived. Paul did not suggest
that Isaac was conceived without sexual intercourse (compare 16:4 and 21:2).
The difference was in conception through human plans vs. divine promises
(Cole 1989, 179-80).
The extraordinary circumstances surrounding the birth of Isaac, which
occupy the biblical narrator in Gen 1221, make it a miracle of divine grace
(21:1-2). That Ishmaels birth was kata sarka identies it as a merely human
event (see Rom 1:3; 4:1; 9:3, 5; 1 Cor 1:26; 10:18; 2 Cor 1:17; 5:16; 10:2, 3;
11:18; Eph 6:5; Col 3:22). The expression kata sarka appears twenty times
in Pauls letters. In this, its rst appearance in Galatians, as in 4:29, it is the
polar opposite of by the power of the Spirit (kata pneuma, as in Rom 8:4, 5, and
12-13). Here, it is specically the antithesis of di epangeliasas the result of
a promise.
By describing the birth of Isaac as di epangelias, Paul resumed terminol-
ogy that had dominated his discussion of Gods assurances to Abraham in Gal
3:10-29 (). The gift of the Spirit received by all believers in Christ fullled
that promise (v 14). The contrast of esh vs. promise (= Spirit) effectively
resumed the divine-human contrast emphasized since ch 1.
L 24 The words These things may be taken guratively begin to connect the
biblical story with its contemporary signicance. Paul literally claimed to in-
terpret the passage as an allegory (Schlier 1965, 219; and Mussner 1977, 319-
20). But scholars since the fourth century (Chrysostom, Jerome, and Theo-
dore of Mopsuestia, cited in Edwards 1999, 68) have debated whether it might
actually be an example of typology (Cosgrove 1987, 219, 221 n. 12; see Ellis
1957, 130; Bruce 1982, 217; Longenecker 1990, 209-10; Dunn 1993, 247;
Hays 1993, 113).
Paul contemporized the Genesis story by reading it allegorically. That
is, he used it to say something else than it seemed to say on the surface. The
words say and mean one thing but now are used to refer to something else
(Witherington 1998a, 329). Thus, a better translation would be: These things
are spoken allegorically (see Di Mattei 2006, 109). As with Jewish pesher ex-
egesis, it is difcult to say whether Paul was actually reinterpreting Scripture
or merely using it to address a contemporary situation.
Pauls application begins with the explanatory conjunction gar, for.
These things are spoken allegorically, for the women are two covenants. The
linking verb are equates features of the story with their gurative counter-
parts. With the substitutions in place, Paul said: Abraham had two sons, each
one born from two different covenants (Di Mattei 2006, 111). Paul paved
the way for his discussion of the covenant here in 3:15 (). There a human
covenant refers to a persons last will and testament. In 3:17, Paul used the
covenant in contrast to the law. There covenant referred to Gods uncon-
ditional promise to Abraham.
S
A
M
P
L
E
284
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:24
Here, Paul referred to two covenants, but he identied only the covenant
. . . from Mount Sinai, obviously referring to the Law and the Mosaic covenant.
He did not explicitly name the other covenant. Based on his Table of Contrasts
( v 25 below), however, the other covenant is associated with Gods prom-
ise, freedom, and the Spirit.
In 2 Cor 3:6 and 14, Paul contrasted the new covenant and the old
covenant, following the precedent of Jeremiah (31:31-32) and Jesus (1 Cor
11:25). Jeremiah had described the old covenant as broken by Israels dis-
obedience. Paul associated the old covenant with Moses, the letter of the
Law, fading glory, death, and spiritual blindness. The new he associated with
Christ, the Spirit, enduring and surpassing glory, life, and righteousness (see
Carver 2009, 128-35). But what covenants are referenced in Gal 4:21-31?
Some interpreters assume that Paul contrasted the old vs. new covenants
in v 24 as in 2 Cor 3. If so, he compared Gods dealings with his people under
the Torah with those under Christ (e.g., Betz 1979, 244; Lincoln 1981, 16;
Longenecker 1990, 271). Others assume he contrasted the covenant of prom-
ise with Abraham and the covenant of Law with Moses as in Gal 3:8, 16-18,
and 4:18 (e.g., Ridderbos 1953, 175-76; Bruce 1982, 218; Cole 1989, 183;
Arichea and Nida 1976, 112; Dunn 1993, 249). Pauls reference to his readers
as children of promise in v 28 seems clearly to point back to his discussion of
Gods earlier covenant promises to Abraham in contrast to the later Law. But
since Christ is the fulllment of that promise (3:19, 22), there is no substan-
tial difference (Schreiner 2010, 301).
Paul read the narrative of Abrahams two wives and two sons in Gen
1621 as an allegory of two covenants. Isaiah 54:1 allowed him to present
Sarah as the spiritual source of Gods covenant promises to Abraham. Hagar
allegorically represented the later Sinai covenant, the source of Abrahams
eshly offspring (Di Mattei 2006, 119-20; Harmon 2010, 183).
When God made his covenant with Abraham (Gen 15:18), Sarah was
barren. His rst child, born to him by Hagar, was only a temporary solution to
Sarahs barrenness (16:1-3), although they did not know it at the time (17:18-
21). The covenant with Hagar was only a temporary provision that did not
alter Gods covenant promises concerning Sarahs future son. Paul had argued
in Gal 3:15-22 that the Law was similarly only a temporary provision until
the coming of Abrahams promised SeedChrist (see Di Mattei 2006, 118).
God established his covenant with Hagar and her descendants, through
his angel, on the road to Hagra / Sinai (see Gen 16:9 and Gal 1:17; 3:19;
4:25). Pauls apocalyptic reading of Isa 54:1 ( Gal 4:27) allowed him to see
an elaborate allegory here in the Abraham narrative (Di Mattei 2006, 118).
On this basis, he identied the covenant representing Hagar as from Mount
Sinai. The traditional association of Mount Sinai with the giving of the Mosaic
law (see Exod 31:18; 34:32; Lev 26:46; Neh 9:13; Acts 7:38) created an obvious
connection with those who want to be under the law (v 21; see Marcus 2001).
S
A
M
P
L
E
285
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:24-25
Paul applied the Genesis narrative to the contemporary situation allegori-
cally. The mother of those who want to be under the law is Hagar, the slave
women. She bears children who are to be slaves, because those belonging to
the Sinai covenant are born to serve the Law (see Pss 86:16; 116:16; Wis 9:5;
Di Mattei 2006, 110). As Yahwehs handmaid, Jerusalem is the mother of its
citizens, the children of the Sinai covenant (Di Mattei 2006, 114 and n. 43).
L 25 Several noteworthy textual variants appear in the manuscript tradition
of v 25. The evidence is evenly divided on whether or not the name Hagar ap-
pears. Without it, we have: Sinai is a mountain in Arabia. With it, we have:
Hagar is Mount Sinai in Arabia.
First-century Jewish traditions associated the name Hagar / Hagra with
Mount Sinai ( 1:17). This probably prompted Pauls equation: the name
Hagar is a mountain, Sinai, in Arabia (Di Mattei 2006, 111; see 112). His
play on words explains both the textual problems in v 25 and why copyists
gave such attention to a puzzling geographical identication of uncertain rel-
evance.
Jewish tradition connected Gen 16 and Isa 54 ( Gal 4:27). This may
have inuenced Pauls identication of the covenant with Hagar and the Sinai
covenant. The Aramaic paraphrase of Gen 16:9 in the Targum claims that the
covenant with Hagar and her descendants was established through an angel of
God by a spring beside the road to Hagra, that is, Sinai (Gen 16:9; Di Mattei
2006, 119).
Regardless of the original text, we are left with one of the more puzzling
features of Pauls allegorical application. His comments in Gal 4:25a merely re-
peat what he had already written (see vv 22 and 24). Does the location of Mount
Sinai in Arabia merely add geographical trivia of no consequence?
What was Pauls point in mentioning a mountain in Arabia? What rel-
evance did this have to his interpretation? He never explained it or offered an
allegorical counterpart. What difference would this have made to his original
audience? Did it have more than a coincidental connection with his mention
of Arabia in 1:17 ()? Are we left to profess ignorance or engage in point-
less speculation? Did the coincidence of geographical names motivate Pauls
allegorical substitutions? Did Pauls association of Hagar with a mountain si-
multaneously discredit both the Law and Mountain Mother goddesses widely
honored in Galatia (so Elliott 1999, 681)?
What did earthly Jerusalem (1:17 sidebar, The Spelling of Jerusalem)
represent in Pauls allegorical application? Did it refer by metonymy to non-
Christian Jews, that is, to unbelieving Judaism (Lightfoot 1874, 181; Burton
1920, 261; Betz 1979, 246)? to the whole legal system of Judaism (Bruce
1982, 220)? to the whole Jewish nation . . . under Roman occupation and
under bondage to the Law (Arichea and Nida 1976, 113)? Or, does it refer to
S
A
M
P
L
E
286
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:25-26
the circumcision faction in the Jerusalem Christian church ( 2:3-5, 11-12;
Longenecker 1990, 213; Martyn 1997, 457-66; Witherington 1998a, 333)?
In military parlance, the verb systoicheo3, corresponds, described lines
or ranks of soldiers. It became a technical term in Pythagorean tables (see,
e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 181; Burton 1920, 261; Martyn 1997, 438-40). Here,
Paul probably referred to parallel columns of corresponding polar opposites.
Pauls comparison includes both explicit counterparts, implicit counterparts
[in square brackets], and features without equivalents (blank).
Tabl e of Cont r ast s : Two Covenant s
[Abrahams son]
by the slave woman (v 22)
[Abrahams son]
by the free woman (v 22)
[Ishmael]
born according to the esh (v 23)
[Isaac, v 28]
born as the result of a promise (v
23)
covenant . . . from Mount Sinai (v
24)
bears children to slavery (v 24)
Hagar (v 24)
Hagar is Mount Sinai in Arabia (v
25)
Hagar . . . corresponds to the
present city of Jerusalem (v 25)
[Sarah corresponds to] the Jerusalem
that is above (v 26)
[Hagar / Jerusalem] is in slavery with
her children (v 25)
the Jerusalem that is above is the
free woman (v 26)
she is our mother (v 26)
you, brothers, like Isaac, are
children of promise (v 28)
the son born according to the esh
persecuted the [other] son (v 29)
the son born according to the Spirit
[was persecuted by the other son] (v 29)
we are not children of the slave
woman (v 31)
we are . . . children . . . of the free
woman (v 31)
L 26 Paul claimed that there were two Jerusalems (see Porteous 1967). The
earthly Jerusalem he called the present Jerusalem (v 25). But the present
Jerusalem had for its heavenly counterpart the above Jerusalem. Curiously,
Paul mixed the Jewish apocalyptic temporal antitheses of present vs. future
(v 25) with the spatial antitheses of above vs. below (v 26). The Jerusalem that
is above is free.
S
A
M
P
L
E
287
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:26
Heavenl y, Fut ure, I nvi si bl e J erusal em
Jewish and Christian eschatology conceived of a heavenly Jerusalem in both
spatial and temporal terms. That is, the future was in some sense already a pres-
ent reality in the invisible heavenly order. Spatial and temporal imagery some-
times coexist within the same apocalyptic writings.
The new Jerusalem could be described in terms of space, as above vs.
below (see 4 Ezra 13:36; 2 En. 55:2; 2 Bar. 4:2-6; 59:4; 4 Bar. 5:35; Heb 11:10-14;
12:22; Rev 3:12; 21:2, 922:5). Perhaps, this understanding developed from OT
passages (e.g., Exod 25:40; 1 Chr 28:19; Wis 9:8) referring to Gods plan for the
tabernacle / temple and its human execution. Jerusalem could also be described
as invisible vs. visible (see 4 Ezra 7:26; 10:25-28). Or it could be described in
terms of time, as present vs. future (see 1 En. 90:28-29; 4 Ezra 7:26; 8:52; 2 Bar.
32:2-7; Heb 13:14).
The future, heavenly Jerusalem is pictured as a disconsolate, barren woman
in 4 Ezra 9:3810:54, as in Isa 54:1, which Paul quotes in Gal 4:27. In 4 Ezra,
Jerusalem (= Zion) is called the mother of us all . . . our mother (2 Esd [= 4
Ezra] 10:7 NRSV; Gal 4:26 (KJV); see Rom 4:16, which refers to Abraham as the
father of us all), as in Gal 4:26.
The city of Jerusalem above is mentioned in 4 Bar. 5:35, written after
the A.D. 70 destruction of Jerusalem (see also 2 Bar. 4; see Bruce 1982, 220-21).
The two other NT books that refer to the heavenly Jerusalem were probably also
written after A.D. 70 (Heb 11:10, 16; 12:22; Rev 3:12; 21:2, 922:5).
For Further Reading, see: Porteous 1967; Lincoln 1981, 18-22; Bruce
1982, 220-21; Longenecker 1990, 213-16.
Pauls rst reference to freedom in Galatians occurred in 2:4. During his
second visit to Jerusalem, he steadfastly resisted the spy tactics of false broth-
ers. They threatened to undermine the freedom we have in Christ Jesus
and to make us slaves. But Paul refused to give in to the urging of those who
wanted to circumcise his Gentile associate Titus (2:3) so that the truth of the
gospel might remain with the Galatians (2:5).
Paul next broached the subject of freedom in the present passage (4:21-
31). Here he introduced it as an issue by referring to Sarah, not by name, but
as the free woman (vv 22, 23, 26, 30, 31). She is the positive counterpart
of Hagar the slave woman (vv 23-25). This free woman is the Jerusalem
that is above. Thus, the heavenly Jerusalem is the free woman, and she is our
mother (v 26). In v 31 he claimed again, we are . . . children . . . of the free
woman.
Galatians 4:26 is the earliest surviving reference to the Jerusalem above
(see the sidebar). Thus, it is remarkable that the identication of the heavenly
Jerusalem as our mother is made as if it went without saying (Cosgrove
1987, 226). None of the surviving apocryphal or NT references to heavenly
Jerusalem mention her freedom. This is Pauls unique emphasis. Neither the
S
A
M
P
L
E
288
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:26-27
description of Sarah nor of Jerusalem as free are explicit in the passages Paul
used. Freedom was his not-so-hidden agenda.
Paul identied the heavenly Jerusalem as the female progenitor of the
Christian church: she is our mother. The heavenly Jerusalem of the last days
already existed. It was to be found on earth in law-free Gentile Christian
communities (Ps 87:5; Maier 2007). The members of the church, as citizens
of heavenly Jerusalem, enjoyed freedom from circumcision as a birthright.
The Galatian Christians who want to be under law (v 21) would deny their
birthright by accepting circumcision.
L 27 Paul substantiated his remarks about the Jerusalem that is above (v 26)
by appeal to Isa 54:1 (Harmon 2010, 156-61). He introduced this with the
quotation formula, For it is written (see v 22). Except for the omitted closing
words, says the LORD, the quotation follows the LXX verbatim.
In Jewish liturgical practice, a thematically linked passage from the
Prophets was customarily read in the synagogue following the selection from
the Torah. Isaiah 54:1 was that passage for Gen 1617 in the Palestinian
triennial lectionary cycle. It was the hermeneutical key to unlocking Pauls
allegorical exposition (Di Mattei 2006, 114; see n. 44). Jewish tradition had
associated barren Sarah and barren Jerusalem well before Pauls time. The
connection may have originated in gezerah shawah, a midrashic exegetical
technique that linked passages with shared or similar terms or themes (com-
pare Rom 4:1-12). Both Gen 16:1 and Isa 54:1 referred to not bearing chil-
dren. Similarly, Gen 11:30 and Isa 54:1 share the word barren. In the annual
Babylonian liturgical reading, Isa 54:1 was paired with Gen 11:30 (Barrett
1976, 12).
In its original context the barren woman of Isa 54 personied the aban-
doned city of Jerusalem during the exilic period. She was the desolate woman,
depopulated as a result of the Babylonian destruction in 587 B.C. Her children
(citizens) had been taken captive by the enemy conquerorthe other woman
who has a husband. Exile left Jerusalem empty and childless.
The prophet expected more than the restoration of earthly Jerusalem
(see Stanley 1999, 136-37). He invited the personied city to join the celebra-
tion: Be glad . . . break forth and cry aloud. His description of the rebuilt city
in Isa 54:11-12 clearly stands behind Johns description of the Holy City, the
new Jerusalem in Rev 21:2, 10-11.
Pauls quotation of Isa 54:1 may have been an implicit call for his au-
ditors to rejoice in their part in its end-times fulllment. God had kept his
covenant with Jerusalem by fullling his promises to Abraham and Sarah and
their children (Di Mattei 2006, 119). Paul read Isa 54 from an apocalyptic
perspective much like the seer of Revelation. Isaiahs prophetic announce-
ment refers to the end of days, . . . to the New Jerusalem (i.e., Pauls Jerusalem
above) (Di Mattei 2006, 116). Paul read Isaiah as speaking of the events of
S
A
M
P
L
E
289
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:27
the nal generation (see 1QpHab7; 4Q164 fr.1; Rom 5:14; 15:4; 1 Cor 10:11;
Di Mattei 2006, 116 n. 50).
Like Jewish tradition, Paul applied end-times expectations to the story
of Abrahams two wives. But he turned the imagery of Genesis on its head.
Sarah had a husband and experienced labor pains (so Isa 51:2). Hagar had
no husband and was left desolate in the wilderness (so Gen 21:14). Nothing
within the quotation obviously points to either woman, apart from the catch-
words concerning barrenness.
In Pauls appropriation of the quotation from Isa 54, the unnamed, child-
less Sarahthe Jerusalem that is above (v 26)is the barren woman, the
desolate woman. Hagar (vv 24, 25), the present city of Jerusalem (v 25), is
the woman who has a husband (v 27). The entry of Gentile converts into the
elect community of the new age (4QIs
d
, cited in Cosgrove 1987, 230) was
conceived as a miraculous birth with no labor pains (v 27).
The catchwords and traditional Jewish liturgical practice served as war-
rants for Pauls use of Isa 54:1 in his application of Gen 1621. There are fre-
quent promises of the conversion of the Gentiles throughout Isa 4066 (esp.
49:6; 51:4-5; 52:10; 54:2-3; 55:5; Hays 1993, 304). The apostle obviously
did not consider the postexilic return to Jerusalem of a few thousand Judeans
under Ezra and Nehemiah a satisfying ultimate fulllment of these promises.
This was to be found in the success of his Gentile mission. His Galatian con-
verts were among Sarahs many children, fullling the ancient promises. The
nations were to be the heirs of the heavenly Jerusalem.
How could Paul think of the Galatian Christian communities as chil-
dren born with no labor pains? In 4:19 he claimed to be suffering again in the
pains of childbirth until Christ was formed in the Galatians. His end-times
assumptions, implicit in the tension between what is present on earth and the
contrasting heavenly reality, provide a partial explanation.
Vi ct or y i n Heaven, Suf f eri ng on Ear t h
Revelation offers a striking parallel to the tension between the birth pangs
in Gal 4:19 and painless birth in 4:27. Revelation 1115 employs lavish imagery to
explain repeatedly how God asserted his right to rule. After plagues of judgment
resembling those of Egypt, God achieves victory, not by the death of the oppres-
sors rstborn, but by the death of his rstborn (11:7-14; 12:5).
Judgment discloses Gods holy revulsion at evil. Gods wrath is motivated,
not by vengeance, but by an insatiable desire that sinners repent (see Rom 2:1-
11). Sadly, many refuse (Rev 9:20-21; 16:9-11). But Gods purposes for the world
will not be defeated.
With Christs rst coming, God exercised his sovereign claim on this rebel-
lious world (11:17-18). The future is now. Satan and his minions have already been
defeated and expelled from heaven (12:8-10; Luke 10:18; John 12:31). God wins!
God rules unchallenged in heaven.
S
A
M
P
L
E
290
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:27
But Christs enthronement as king brings both salvation and disaster (Rev
12:12). Heavens victory is not yet an earthly reality. For now, Satans defeat only
makes matters worse on earth, although his days are numbered (v 14; 13:5; 19:17-
21; 20:7-10). Believers are warned to expect persecution.
And yet, heavenly martyrs (6:6-9) also win! They overcame Satan because
they did not cling to life even in the face of death (12:11 NRSV). The insurgent
forces of Satans defeated regime continue their doomed rebellion against Gods
rule. And suffering intensies for the saints (vv 12, 17).
The victory of Gods people looks like defeat to the world, because their
victory, like their Lords, comes by self-sacrice (7:14). Empowered by Christs
victory, paradoxically, faithful martyrs are nonetheless overcomers. Their wit-
ness does not cause Satans defeat (5:9-10; 7:9-17; 20:4-6); but it testies to their
faithfulness to Christ, who is the Victor.
The imagery of pain-free childbirth for mother Jerusalem in Isa 54:1 is
picked up and expanded in 66:7-9. The later passage announces an end to the
curse of womans labor pains (Gen 3:16). Thus, Isa 54:1 provides an eschato-
logical promise in counterpoint to the apostles missionary labor in Gal 4:19
(Eastman 2007, 157). So long as the present evil age (1:4) persists, there
will be labor pains. The distinction between Pauls suffering in behalf of the
Galatians in 4:19 and the painless labor of Jerusalem above illustrates well the
tension between the already and not-yet (Eastman 2007, 159).
The heavenly Jerusalem is Gods promissory church in heaven. The
Jerusalem above is already the mother of the church in which Christ is still
being formed (4:19). The Galatians were born by the power of Gods promise
in the circumcision-free mission to the Gentiles (Martyn 1997, 441). But if
they listen to the Agitators, they will self-abort, miscarrying Gods end-times
plans by returning to their former slavery.
The Isa 54:1 quotation does not validate Pauls allegorical interpretation;
it applies it. All of its main verbs are second person singular imperatives. The
quotation invited those who want to be under the law (v 21) to celebrate
their freedom, not surrender it. The Greek root of the imperative verb Be
glad appears only here, in Rom 15:10 (quoting Deut 32:43), and in 2 Cor 2:2
within Pauls letters. In Rev 11:10; 12:12; and 18:20 the verb belongs to the
language of eschatological celebration. By celebrating their freedom, the Gala-
tians would spare Paul his ongoing labor pains (4:19).
Thus, the Isaiah quotation functions much like the catena of OT pas-
sages cited in Rom 15:9b-13. Here, as there, the citation suggests that the
acceptance of the Gentiles [is] an eschatological miracle (Ksemann 1980,
386). The inclusion of all nations in the heavenly Jerusalem expresses the
prophetic hope for the inclusion of pagans in the saved community of the Last
Age (e.g., Isa 49:6; 51:4-5; 52:10; 54:2-3; 55:5).
S
A
M
P
L
E
291
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:28-29
L 28 Paul here addressed his audience as You, brothers and sisters ( 4:12).
Some manuscripts have the rst person plural instead, We, brothers and sis-
ters. Referring to the Galatians now as on his side should not be taken to
indicate that Paul no longer addressed those who want to be under the law
(v 21). On the contrary, his shift in pronouns and designations subtly invited
those entertaining a different gospel (1:6) to reconsider. If any had already
taken the misstep of receiving circumcision, restoration was possible ( 6:1).
If not here, in 4:31, he would address his audience as we, brothers and sisters.
Paul applied his allegorical interpretation to his Galatian audience: Now
you, brothers, like Isaac, are children of promise ( vv 23-24). In light of his
earlier discussion of Gods covenant promises to Abraham ( 3:154:7), the
reiteration of promise here emphasized the full Christian standing of his audi-
ence. They were already Spirit-lled Christians. The heavenly Jerusalem, the
eschatological community symbolized by the free woman, was their mother
( v 26). The inclusion of Gentiles among the people of God was no less a
miracle than the birth of Isaac to the postmenopausal Sarah and her centenar-
ian husband Abraham. Pauls Gentile converts fullled the OT prophecies of
the end-times inclusion of the nations in an expanded Israel ( v 27).
The verbal noun promise, in the genitive construction, children of prom-
ise, has a subjective force. That is, by faith in Christ Jesus Pauls Gentile con-
verts had become Gods children (3:26) and children of Abraham (3:29, 7).
They were among the nations God had promised to bless through Abraham
(3:8). They were the fulllment of eschatological prophecy.
The apostles Galatian converts were the children God had promised
Abraham centuries before. They had no need to be circumcised to become his
children. To realize fully the promise, they were not to waver, but to remain
on the Isaac side of the table of contrasts ( 4:25). Only by preserving their
freedom (5:1) from circumcision could the Galatians maintain their identity
as the Gentile children of promise. Were they to become circumcisedcon-
verted Jewsthey would deny their heritage (4:30) and frustrate Gods end-
times purposes.
L 29 Here Paul compared then and now. He placed the historical experience
of the actors in the Genesis story of Abrahams sons alongside the contempo-
rary experience of Paul and his Galatian converts.
Ishmael remains unnamed; identied again (see v 23) as the one born
according to the esh. But Isaac (v 28) is now called the son born by the
power of the Spirit. This change supports the evidence that Paul understood
the promise to Abraham as fullled in the gift of the Spirit ( 3:14). The
antithesis of esh vs. Spirit assumes thematic importance in the balance of the
letter. Here, esh is associated with Law and Spirit with promise (see 4:23,
29). The obvious link between esh and Law is circumcision (see the LXX of
Gen 17:13-14, 23-25; 34:24; Lev 12:3; Jer 9:25; Ezek 44:7, 9; Sir 44:20; Jdt
14:10; Jub. 15:13-33; 2 Esd 1:31).
S
A
M
P
L
E
292
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:29-30
There is only little evidence in the Genesis account that Ishmael perse-
cuted [edio3ken] Isaac. Genesis 21:9-10 explains Sarahs request that Abraham
send away Hagar and Ishmael. She saw Hagars son paizonta metaplaying
with, fondling, jesting with, or mocking (LSJ, 1288)her son. Paul followed
Jewish tradition in reading Ishmaels actions as persecution (Mussner 1977,
329-31; Cosgrove 1987, 229-30; Longenecker 1990, 200-206, 217; Matera
1992, 170-71). Philo claimed that Abrahams son Ishmael and his mother were
banished because he mocked the legitimate son, as though he were his equal
(Sobriety 8).
Nothing else in Galatians suggests that Pauls audience was being per-
secuted ( 3:4; Ziesler 1992, 66). Nevertheless, Pauls then-now comparison
identied the contemporary, enslaved children of Abraham by their perse-
cution of the free children of Abraham. The law-free, Spirit-endowed chil-
dren of Abraham were almost certainly the Christian community included in
Pauls we: we are . . . children . . . of the free woman (4:31).
If the Galatians were being persecuted, we must ask: how, why, and
by whom? That is, who were the eshly, enslaved, persecuting contemporary
counterparts of Ishmael?
Cosgrove identies the persecutors as non-Christian Jews (see 1:13,
23; 4:29; 5:11; 6:12). He notes that Paul never explicitly claimed that Jewish
Christian Agitators mistreated the Galatians (1987, 224 n. 26). If they were
the Agitators, they certainly misguided and confused Pauls young converts
through their false teaching. This is possibly all he claimed ( 1:13; 2:12;
5:11). His letters seem to take for granted that to the extent that they are
Gods children, all Christians suffer persecution (see, e.g., Rom 8:17, 35-39;
1 Thess 2:14-16; 3:4).
But how were the Galatian Christians being persecuted? Nothing in the
letter indicates that they were being physically abused by Jewish opponents.
They were being hounded and pressured by the Agitators to accept circumcision.
Would Paul have considered this persecution? The verb dio3 ko3 (persecute) can refer
to such pestering (BDAG, 254). Did government magistrates threaten the uncir-
cumcised Galatians with persecution as improper Jews if they failed to participate
in the Imperial cult ( 4:10; Kahl 2010, 242-43)? Was the requirement that the
Galatians undergo the painful surgical procedure that is circumcision an implied
threat of persecution (so Schreiner 2010, 305)?
L 30 For the third time in the letter the Scripture speaks (see 3:8, 22). Here,
Paul quoted Sarahs orders to Abraham almost verbatim from the LXX of
Gen 21:10. The apostle retained the second person singular form of the com-
mand, Drive out the slave and her child (NRSV). The only second person
singular commands in the letter appear within Scripture quotations (vv 27
and 30). Elsewhere, Paul preferred second person plural (3:7; 4:12, 21; 5:1
[twice], 13, 15, 16; 6:1, 2, 7, and 11) or third person singular imperatives (1:8,
9; 6:4, 6, 17).
S
A
M
P
L
E
293
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:30
Interpreters disagree as to the point of Pauls quotation of Gen 21:10.
Two dominant views have emerged. Most take it as an indirect call to expel
certain people from the Galatian Christian communities. Others take it as a
call to reject the Law / circumcision. Most interpreters consider the quota-
tion in 4:30 a climactic warning directed to Pauls readers and the point of
the entire allegory in 4:215:1 (e.g., Schlier 1965, 227; Cosgrove 1987, 232;
Martyn 1997, 445-46; Hays 2000, 306; but see Eastman 2007, 132-33).
The Di sput ed I nt erpret at i on of Gal at i ans 4 : 30
Burton, like most interpreters until recently, takes v 30 to be a rejection
of the Jews in favor of Christians (1920, 267). This supersessionist reading of v
30 denies for all time salvation to Judaism and to non-Christian Jews. The Law-
free Christian church replaces the synagogue; and Christianity, Judaism (Eastman
2006, 310-12).
A new consensus (e.g., Mussner 1977, 332; Betz 1979, 250-51; Matera
1992, 178-79) understands the quotation as an implicit call for the Galatians to
excommunicate Jewish Christian Agitators from their midst. It assumes that they
were sponsored by the Jerusalem church and required circumcision. They sought
to undermine Pauls Law-free mission by denying membership in the saved com-
munity to the uncircumcised.
New-consensus interpreters assume that in v 30 Paul returned the favor,
denying salvation to the Law-observant, Jewish Christian mission (Eastman 2006,
311-12; summarizing Mussner 1977, 332; Longenecker 1990, 211-17; Hays 2000,
303-6; Dunn 1993, 250; Barclay 1988, 250; and Witherington 1998a, 325-39).
Paul commanded the expulsion at a particular point in time of a specic group of
people from within the Galatian congregations (Eastman 2006, 312). Even new-
consensus interpreters agree that the difference with the traditional interpreta-
tion is a ne one (Barclay 1988, 250 n. 50).
Both dominant readings of Gal 4:30 raise serious questions: Why would
Paul urge the Galatians to remove non-Christian Jews from Gentile Christian
communities to which they did not belong (Eastman 2006, 312)? Were his
churches merely Christian-dominated messianic synagogues? If the Agitators
were Jewish Christian outsiders from Jerusalem, why would he use the language
of excommunication to call for their expulsion? Did he think of the church in
such universal terms that visitors were considered members of the Galatian com-
munities? Why would he conclude a section addressed to those who want to
be under the law (v 21) with a call to expel from their communities those who
advocated the Law / circumcision?
Di Mattei insists that v 30 neither denied salvation to anyone nor called for
their excommunication. Within Pauls allegory, Sarahs demand for Abraham to
expel Hagar and Ishmael from their household meant: Throw out the Sinai cov-
enant (Di Mattei 2006, 121). Pauls plea reinforced his earlier claims about the
temporary role of the Law ( 3:18, 19, 25). Chrysostom took Pauls appeal to
mean simply, abandon the Law (cited in Riches 2008, 231). He merely insisted,
S
A
M
P
L
E
294
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:30
as he had throughout Galatians, that the Law was unable to grant salvation life
(3:21; Di Mattei 2006, 122). Paul called for abandoning the Sinai covenant so that
Jews and Gentiles might share together in the salvation Christ makes possible
only to believers (Di Mattei 2006, 122). Thus, he urged the Galatians not to listen
to the Agitators, but to the voice of Scripture (Schreiner 2010, 306).
Eastman emphasizes that the imperative of v 30 (quoting Gen 21:10) ad-
dressed Abraham, not the Galatians (Eastman 2007, 133 and n. 24). In 3:8, Scrip-
ture announced the gospel in advance to Abraham. Just so, in 4:30 the Scripture
announced the gospel through Sarah. She instructed Abraham not to try to use
eshly meansthe slave womanto fulll Gods promises. In Pauls allegorical
reading, the Galatians overheard this as a call to reject eshly means of achieving
Gods favorspecically, circumcision (Eastman 2006, 326).
Recent scholars (e.g., Di Mattei, Eastman, and Schreiner) insist that Pauls
concern was not to deny salvation to anyone. What he denied was the saving
merit of the boundary markers of the Sinai covenant, which separated Jews and
Gentiles. The point of Scriptures proclamation is that the promise of progeny
will be fullled only through Gods miraculous faithfulness, not through any hu-
man act (Eastman 2006, 333).
Traditional readings of v 30 presume that Paul was not averse to cliquish
and coercive exclusionary practices, which sharply divided insiders from outsid-
ers. Even if this reading is mistaken, the conditional curse of 1:6-9 remains. Pauls
certainty that he spoke for God offends postmodern expectations of tolerance.
But recent approaches cannot be dismissed as merely special pleading motivated
by a concern to make Paul politically correct. Their interpretations cohere with
what he said more clearly elsewhere in Galatians and in his other letters.
Galatians 4:30 is not a pronouncement on the fate of outsiders, as in the
traditional interpretation (Eastman 2006, 326-27). It is not an attack on un-
believing Jews or on ultraconservative Jerusalem Jewish Christians. It seems
plausible (in light of 1:8-9; 5:2-4, 21b; 6:17), however, to take it as an implicit
command to expel the Agitators from the Christian communities of Galatia.
But this makes sense only if the Agitators were intransigent insiders.
It seems equally possible, however, that Pauls concern was to warn his
hearers about the danger of excluding themselves from their God-given heri-
tage (inheritance) as free, Spirit-lled children of Abraham (Eastman 2006,
327). Addressing his auditors as you who want to be under the law (4:21), he
surely reminded them of what he had said earlier about the Law:
in 3:10: All who rely on observing the law are under a curse.
in 3:18: If the inheritance depends on the law, then it no longer de-
pends on a promise; but God in his grace gave it to Abraham through
a promise.
in 3:23: Before the faith came, we were imprisoned under Law.
in 3:29: If you belong to Christ, then you are Abrahams seed, and
heirs according to the promise.
S
A
M
P
L
E
295
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:30
5:1
in 4:5: Gods son came to redeem those under law, that we might
receive the full rights of sons.
in 4:7: So you are no longer a slave, but a son; and since you are a son,
God has made you also an heir.
In 5:18, Paul would insist, If you are led by the Spirit, you are not under
law. And in 5:21 he would warn that those who live according to the esh
will not inherit the kingdom of God. Thus, Gal 4:30 might be taken as a
prediction or a command: The son of the slave woman will never inherit
with the son of the free woman (see BDF, 184 365; Moulton 1985, 177). It is
impossible to be at once Christian and justied by Law, to be led by the Spirit
and under Law. The Galatians could not live in two incompatible spheres of
reality (5.18) . . . with one foot in the old cosmos, characterized at least in part
by divisions between the circumcised and the uncircumcised, and one foot in
the new creation (Eastman 2006, 328).
Paul quoted Gen 21:10 to warn the Galatians not to disinherit them-
selves. He urged them to choose a future on the side of the Spirit not Law,
freedom not slavery. They should listen to what the Law / Scripture says (vv
21, 30): Only the son of the free woman will inherit the promise. Therefore,
if the Galatians listened to the law, they will not pay attention to the Juda-
izers (Schreiner 2010, 295; see 305).
L 31 Paul again addressed his auditors directly as brothers and sisters.
Throughout 4:125:1, he had attempted to draw his wayward converts back
into the friendship they were in danger of abandoning by irting with the
Agitators.
In v 21, he referred to you who want to be under law.
In v 28, he addressed them as you, brothers and sisters.
But in v 31, he enfolded them within his frst person plural: we are not
children of the slave woman, but of the free woman.
Pauls allegorical table of contrasts ( v 25) had reached its end. There-
fore introduced a summary of what he had said in vv 21-30 (Cole 1989, 185).
Would the Galatians recognize themselves as who they really were? Would
they own their identity in Christ, live out of the resources of the Spirit, and
inherit what God promised? Or would they fall victim to the curse of the
law from which Christ redeemed us (3:13)?
The command to expel the slave woman and her child in v 30, whatever
its precise application, is not the climax or the main point of 4:215:1 (East-
man 2007, 132-33). Surely this is to be found in the call for the Galatians to
celebrate their status as free children in 4:27 (see v 30) and to persist in that
freedom in 5:1 (Barclay 1988, 92; Cousar 1982, 103).
L 5:1 Galatians 5:1 serves a transitional function (e.g., Longenecker 1990,
223-24; Schreiner 2010, 307). It simultaneously concludes Pauls allegorical
exercise in 4:21-31 (e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 185; Bruce 1982, 226; Martyn 1997,
468) and introduces his exhortations in 5:2-15 (e.g., Burton 1920, 269-70;
S
A
M
P
L
E
296
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1
Betz 1979, 253, 255; Matera 1992, 180). In this respect, it functions much
like a hinge, belonging to both the frame and the door it connects ( 4:8-11).
It is at once a summary of all that has gone before and a transition to what
follows (Boice 1976, 486).
Commentators widely agree that 5:1 is the thematic verse of the entire
letter (e.g., Boice 1976, 486; Martyn 1997, 407; Hays 2000, 306). Despite the
many variants in the verse (see the discussion in Lightfoot 1874, 185, 200-
202; Burton 1920, 270-72), interpreters agree that the original text is almost
certainly the critical consensus underlying modern translations.
The rst Greek sentence in v 1 begins by identifying the purpose of
Christs liberating actfor freedomand ends with the verb freed. Both rst
and last sentence positions are emphatic. The direct object of this liberating
eventusand the active agent in the deliveranceChristare enclosed
within the bookends of freedom. The combination of the verb freed and the
cognate dative noun freedom emphasize that Christ has set us completely free
from our former slavery (see CEV, NLT).
In the Greek world, a free person enjoyed the full rights of a member
and fellow citizen (in contrast to aliens, non-citizens, conquered populations,
and slaves) (Niederwimmer 1990, 432). Paul adopted this terminology to
refer to the privileges Christ granted believers as citizens of the new age (Nie-
derwimmer 1990, 433). The present experience of Spirit-inlling anticipated
this gift of the future world. What did Christian freedom entail and exclude?
Did the fact that Christ redeemed us from the curse of the law imply
that Christians were not obliged to observe the Jewish Law ( 3:13)? Were
they free to ignore every aspect of the Law (including, e.g., the Ten Com-
mandments), or only those portions of the holiness code that separated Jews
from non-Jews? Were Christians granted freedom from the Law, or only from
legalism and misguided efforts at self-salvation? Paul clearly ( 5:13; 6:2)
indicated that Christian freedom could not be taken to open the door to li-
centiousness.
Paul insisted here that Christ was the source of Christian freedom, with-
out saying why or how he had set people free. The aorist tense of the verb
freed probably points to the past event of his death on the cross (see 1:1; 2:19-
21; 3:1; 6:14). Using different Greek synonyms, in 1:4, he claimed that Christ
gave himself for our sins to set us free from the present evil age (NRSV; 1:4;
2:20). And in 3:13-14, he maintained that by his crucixion, Christ freed us
from the curse of the Law ( 3:13). According to 4:4-5, Christs God-given
mission was to free those under Law, that we might receive adoption as chil-
dren ( 4:4-5). God called [us] to be free, but not to abuse our freedom in
eshly indulgence ( 5:13). Christ accepted death on the cross to set us free
to live in the freedom of mutual service ( v 6).
Galatians 5:1 illustrates again Pauls often inexplicable pronoun chang-
es. Here he shifted from the rst person pluralusto the second person
S
A
M
P
L
E
297
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1
pluralYou. You is implied, but unexpressed, in the double imperative: You
stand rm and do not let yourselves be burdened again. No distinction of an-
tecedents seems to have been intended. Paul did not contrast us Jews and you
Gentiles. Both us and you included the Galatians.
On the basis of what Christ did, Paul made two appeals. The rst, posi-
tive plea employs a second person plural present imperative verb: Stand frm.
This identical exhortation appears in 1 Cor 16:13; Phil 1:27; 4:1; 1 Thess 3:8;
and 2 Thess 2:15. Here, as elsewhere, he described in an almost codelike way
Christian existence in contrast to wavering or falling (see 5:4) from Chris-
tian faith (Wolter 1990a, 207).
Paul referred to standing in faith (1 Cor 15:1; 16:13; 2 Cor 1:24), in the
Lord (Phil 4:1), or in the Spirit (1:27). Ongoing Christian status could not be
taken for granted. It is provisional upon remaining steadfast in the freedom
Christ died to make possible. Pauls exhortation presumed that he still con-
sidered the Galatians Christians, despite their irting with the Law. But their
standing was denitely at risk.
Pauls second, negative plea was: Do not let yourselves be burdened
again by a yoke of slavery. The present passive imperative urged the Galatians
steadfastly to resist the efforts of unnamed others to enslave them. It is pos-
sible that Pauls terminology was inuenced by the analogy of Israel in the
wilderness. Although God had redeemed them from slavery in Egypt, they
were in danger of forfeiting their freedom (Wilson 2004, 563-70).
Consistent with rabbinic practice, here, as in Acts 15:10, the metaphori-
cal imagery of yoke probably refers to the requirements of the Jewish Law (Sir
51:26). In both passages, circumcision was the specic requirement, which
represented the obligation to obey the whole law (Gal 5:3). Unlike Jesus
(Matt 11:29-30), Peter (Acts 15:10), James (Acts 15:19, 28), and Paul (Gal
5:1), the rabbis did not consider the yoke of the Law a difcult burden to bear,
but a privilege (Rengstorf 1964c).
To maintain their freedom, Paul insisted that Gentiles were to remain
unbound by the Law: Dont ever become slaves of the Law again (CEV). Be-
cause Pauls Galatian audience was Gentile, they had not been previously sub-
ject to the Law (see 1 Cor 9:21). Thus, the adverb again seems inappropriate.
But in Gal 4:1-5, Paul had compared the experience of slavery under the basic
principles of the world (v 3) with the slavery of being under law (vv 4, 5).
In 4:9, he implied that for the Galatians to submit to circumcision was tanta-
mount to returning to their former pagan slavery to the elementary principles
( 4:9).
v
FROM THE TEXT
Allegorical Method. When Paul urged the Galatians to become like him
in 4:12, he was not recommending that they imitate his exegetical method in
4:215:1. Unlike the method practiced in the present commentary series, his
S
A
M
P
L
E
298
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
4:21
5:1
approach to Gen 1621 did not take seriously the world behind the text nor
the integrity of the biblical text itself. It merely applied the ancient text di-
rectly to a contemporary situation. This widely used approach was persuasive
in the ancient world. In our context, it seems disingenuous and ineffective.
We may accept Pauls conclusions (which were also his presuppositions)
without feeling obliged to treat Scripture in an arbitrary manner. Commenta-
tors since the fourth century have had misgivings about Pauls use of allegory.
Calvin attacked those who claimed the apostles example of twisting Scrip-
ture to justify making it say whatever they pleased (Riches 2008, 228).
We are not citizens of the rst century, nor are we apostles, after all. We
address audiences with quite different expectations. If we intend to persuade
our audiences of the truth of the present passage, we must disavow for our-
selves the method Paul used to present the truth.
Paul refused to give up on the Galatians. He considered them duped vic-
tims of the Agitators persuasion, not hopeless apostates to the Christian faith.
The letter exists as testimony to his commitment to out-persuade those who
had led his converts into confusion, using every rhetorical tool in his arsenal.
If the Agitators used the allegorical method, we can be certain they reached
conclusions different from the apostle.
Preserving Our Christian Birthright. Throughout 4:215:1 Paul used the
OT story of Abrahams family to elucidate the current status of his Galatian
audience. He reminded them of their new identity as believerswho they
were and were not.
The current status of the Galatian Christians undermined every argu-
ment those who wanted to be under the law (v 21) might muster in favor of
getting circumcised. In fact, by this misguided course, they would put their
favored status at risk (5:2-4). They did not need to become Jews to become
full sons of Abraham. As pagan Christians, they were the present fulllment
of Gods promise that Abraham would be the means of end-times blessing for
all nations. They had already received the gift of the Spirit. So, Paul urged,
Stand rm and refuse to be burdened again by a yoke of slavery (v 1).
Western Christians today are not being agitated to accept circumcision
as a means of improving on our standing before God. But the contemporary
Christian marketplace bombards us regularly with other supposed improve-
ments on the gospel of grace that we are being urged to buy. Some insist we
must seek and receive the gift of tongues to be truly complete. Some well-
intentioned Wesleyan-Holiness advocates have sometimes presented entire
sanctication as a new and improved experience that will compensate for the
deciencies of being simply Christian. Others advocate a particular variety of
worship or private devotional discipline, the latest how-to seminar or book as
the panacea that will make sense of everything. Paul would insist that nothing
humans can do will improve on what God in Christ has already done through
the gift of the Spirit.
S
A
M
P
L
E
299
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1
6:10
This is not to suggest that Paul encouraged Christians passively to do
nothing. He would urge us to celebrate the miracle we already are, not to ago-
nize over what we are not yet (v 27). He would urge us to hold tightly to the
gift of freedom and resist anything that might compromise this giftwhether
Law or license (5:1, 13).
The balance of the letter to the Galatians identies to what we Chris-
tians must say No and Yes, if we are to preserve our Christian birthright. We
must live by the Spirit (5:16, 25), be led by the Spirit (v 18), and keep in
step with the Spirit (v 25). As we do this, we can trust God to lead us into the
life of sanctication (see Rom 68), which is the ongoing work of his Spirit in
our lives, never our eshly achievement.
5. Moral Guidance (5:16:10)
Paul continued to make his case against the Agitators call for circum-
cision and the Law (5:2-12). But he was equally intent on making clear that
freedom from the Law should not open the door to moral license (5:1, 13). He
urged his audience to draw the strength from the Spirit to live lives pleasing to
God. The same life-giving Spirit who freed the church from slavery to the Law
would unfailingly empower its members to love one another, and thus fulll
the Laws central concern. But this would be possible only as believers let the
Spirit lead (vv 16, 18, 25).
At the center of Pauls discussion of the ethical implications of his gospel
(vv 15-26), he addressed the social havoc that the circumcision controversy
had created in the Galatian communities. He insisted that neither circumci-
sion nor uncircumcision was consequential for salvation (5:5; 6:15). This issue
was not worth destroying the church over (5:15).
Pauls well-known treatment of the works of the Flesh (vv 19-21) and
the fruit of the Spirit (vv 22-23) were not exhaustive, general lists of timeless
private vices to avoid and virtues to inculcate. They focus instead on the con-
trasting marks of communities that surrender to the Flesh vs. the Spirit. The
alternatives were clear. Self-preoccupied humanity left to its own devices de-
stroyed the possibility of life together. Only those who follow Christs model
of seless service to others may experience the kind of community that antici-
pates the kingdom of God (v 21). Thus, he urged the Galatians not to pursue
these virtues, but to keep in step with the Spirit (v 26).
The well-being of all in the Christian community called for self-exam-
ination and the gentle restoration of those who fell into sin (6:1-5). Paul re-
minded the Galatians that their choice of lifestylespleasing themselves vs.
pleasing the Spiritwould determine their eternal destiny (vv 7-8). There-
fore, he urged them to share all good things with their teachers (v 6), with
their fellow believers, and with all others as opportunity allowed (vv 9-10).
S
A
M
P
L
E
300
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1-12
a. Freedom from Circumcision (5:1-12)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
The goal of deliberative rhetoric was to persuade or dissuade an audience
concerning the most benecial vs. detrimental course of action for the future.
This explains Pauls rationale for rejecting circumcision. Had the Agitators
claimed that faith in Christ was of no value to uncircumcised Gentiles? Or
did they urge circumcision for more pragmatic reasonsto avoid persecution
( 4:10; 6:12-13)?
Whatever benet the Agitators claimed circumcision offered, Paul in-
sisted that instead getting circumcised would jeopardize the Christian stand-
ing of his Gentile audience: Christ will be of no value to you at all (v 2). But
he also insisted that those who called for circumcision had entirely misunder-
stood Christianity: in Christ Jesus neither circumcision nor uncircumcision
has any value (v 6). In vv 7-12, Paul turned his attention away from the Gala-
tians to attack those who were trying to lead them astray.
How are v 2 and v 6 to be reconciled? Did circumcision matter or not?
Pauls conditional construction in v 2 persuades most interpreters that he as-
sumed most of the Galatians remained uncircumcised. If they were consider-
ing the procedure, it had not yet been performed. But the present tense of the
verb (you let yourselves be circumcised) might indicate that circumcisions
were already underway.
Circumcision is a relatively quick surgical procedure for each individual,
not a drawn-out process. But circumcising every male in the various Galatian
churches would have taken some time. Perhaps only a minority of the males in
the Galatian communities had been circumcised / wanted to get circumcised.
Was it these early adopters who were agitating the others to follow their lead?
That is, were the Galatians who were being circumcised (in 5:2-3 and 6:13)
also the Agitators ( Introduction)? The middle passive voice of the verbs
might suggest that they were the circumcised, not the circumcisers.
In 5:2you are letting yourselves be circumcised or you are being
circumcisedclearly referred to Pauls Galatian audience.
In 5:3every man who is letting himself be circumcised or every
man who is being circumcisedhas a universal application.
But in 6:13those who are letting themselves be circumcised or
those who are being circumcisedclearly referred to the Agitators in
contrast to the Galatians: they want you to be circumcised.
Is there any way to clear up the confusion? It may be helpful to distin-
guish between three senses in which Paul used the verb circumcise and the
noun circumcision. The terms may
refer either to an act, or a state, or a practice. As an act, circumcision
relates to the physical operation itself. Following this surgery, a person
S
A
M
P
L
E
301
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1-2
I N THE TEXT
ii. The Agitators Are Mistaken (5:7-12)
L 7 Paul indicated that the Galatians were running well (NRSV). They began
their Christian lives in an entirely satisfactory way: You were running a good
race (see 1 Cor 9:24, 26). In Gal 2:2 the same verb depicted his present and
past missionary efforts (see Phil 2:16). As with many issues in Galatians, we
can only guess how Paul knew about their progress.
The apostles commendation of the Galatians was immediately followed
by a rhetorical question: Who cut in on you? Unlike most rhetorical questions,
this one did not presume its answer. But, it is not really a question. It is an
implicit accusation. Paul probably, and the Galatians certainly, knew who had
hindered their progress. He did not seek information. Instead, he alleged that
some unnamed person had thwarted the Galatians progress as Christians.
Paul framed his question so as to avoid giving the Agitators free public-
ity. He doomed them to anonymity while negatively characterizing what they
had done as an unfortunate diversion. They kept the Galatians from obeying
the truth (see Rom 2:8), the true God revealed in Christ (Hbner 1990a, 59).
The Galatians began their Christian lives correctlywith the Spirit
(Gal 3:2-3, 5). But to pursue circumcision was a misguided means to attain
[their] goal by human effort(i.e.) by the esh (v 3). In v 1 Paul asked, Who
has bewitched you? With different imagery, in 5:7 he asked, Who cut in on
you? The answer in both instances would have been the same: The Agitators
had contributed to the Galatians change for the worse.
Paul obviously considered those urging his converts to be circumcised
a serious threat to their Christian standing (vv 1-6). Did he self-consciously
describe this hindrance to their progress with a play on words alluding to the
surgical procedure: Who cut in [enekopsen] on you . . . ? or, Who cut you off
. . . ? Did he intend this as a pun? And, if so, did his audience get it? Or does
this English translation read too much into Pauls choice of terms?
Mixed metaphors in the passage complicate matters. The verb describing
the beginning of the Galatians Christian journey seems to refer metaphorical-
ly to a footrace (Mark 5:6; John 20:2, 4; compare 1 Cor 9:24-27; Phil 3:14; 2
Tim 4:7; Acts 20:24; Gal 2:2). If the race metaphor dominates, cutting in
seems to refer to interference with a runners progress by a competitors lane
change. If the Agitators were visiting Jewish Christian missionaries (as most
interpreters assume), he may have accused them of interfering where they did
not belong, of poaching on his missionary territory (see 2 Cor 10:12-18).
As a military term, the verb translated cut in referred to the construc-
tion of an obstacle or breaking up a road (Boice 1976, 489; Bruce 1982, 234).
Popular philosophers before Pauls day used running to characterize efforts
to advance spiritually or intellectually. Thus, Pauls point may simply have
S
A
M
P
L
E
313
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:7
been: you were making such ne progress (BDAG, 1015). And his question,
Who cut in on you? may have blamed some unnamed person (or persons) for
removing their potential to grow.
The verb enkopto3 in Greek guratively means hinder or thwart by
making progress slow or difcult (BDAG, 274; see Acts 24:4; Rom 15:22; 1
Thess 2:18; 1 Pet 3:7). Parallels in 1 Thess 2:18; Rom 15:22; and 1 Cor 9:12
may suggest Satan as the source of such hindrances (Betz 1979, 264). Did Paul
imply that the Agitators were agents of Satan (so Bruce 1982, 234)?
Did Pauls description of the obstruction self-consciously allude to the
surgical procedure the Agitators were pressuring the Galatians to accept? Ety-
mologically, enkopto3 is derived from the verb cut off. Was the word intended to
evoke images of a rabbis knife?
Taken literally, enkopto3 typically applied to lopping off such things as
tree branches (e.g., Num 13:23; Deut 19:5). Applied to people or cities, cut-
ting off referred to massacres (see Deut 25:18; Josh 10:20) or the utter de-
struction of a city (see Judg 1:17). But signicantly, kopto3 in the LXX never
referred to the surgical procedure of circumcision.
If Paul intended to apply the term enkopto3 to circumcision (dismissed as
far-fetched by Bruce 1982, 234), it would have conveyed a violently negative
nuance comparable to describing a haircut as getting ones hair chopped off
or a manicure as getting ones nails amputated. Pauls shocking description of
circumcision (peritome3) as katatome3 (mutilation) in Phil 3:2 suggests that he
was capable of characterizing circumcision as butchery.
But here it seems more plausible that Paul accused the Agitators of
thwarting the forward progress of Pauls Galatian converts by urging them to
get circumcised. The issue of circumcision had apparently created heated divi-
sion within the community (Gal 5:15), which had diverted them from more
urgent matters.
Obviously, Pauls question, Who was interfering with the Galatians? was
rhetorical rather than real. He almost certainly knew who was responsible
for their arrested development. And they denitely did. But they may have
considered the Agitators a help rather than a hindrance. Pauls question char-
acterized the activities of the Agitators negatively, while maintaining their
anonymity. As in v 8, he reminded the Galatians that neither he nor God were
responsible for their diversion (see 4:16-17).
The dawning of the new creation Christ inaugurated (6:15) called for
believers to obey the commands of God (1 Cor 7:19), to fulll the law of
Christ ( Gal 6:2). Obedience expresses a believers faith by loving service
to one another (5:6, 13-15). By cutting in on the Galatian churches, the Agi-
tators were preventing them from obeying the truth. Preoccupation with a
petty matter of indifferencecircumcision vs. uncircumcision ( 5:6)had
deterred them from attending to the one thing that really matteredobeying
the truth.
S
A
M
P
L
E
314
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:7-8
In 2:5 and 14, Paul did not simply treat the truth as a synonym for the
gospel (against Martyn 1997, 475). There the truth of the gospel referred
to Pauls conviction that Gentiles did not need to become Jews to become fully
Christian. The Agitators had persuaded some of Pauls converts to believe a
lie. Their requirement of circumcision was contrary to the true gospel. This
was creating division within the Galatian Christian communities (5:15).
The passive form of the verb peitho3, obeying in v 7, appears only here
in Pauls letters. In this sense, obeying the truth, means being persuaded by
the truth. Active forms of the verb peitho3 appear in 1:10 (win the approval,
persuade) and 5:10 (am condent, am persuaded). And the noun cognate,
peismone3, persuasion, appears in 5:8. The language of rhetoric suggests that
Paul was attempting to outpersuade his opponents, who had succeeded in
unsettling his Galatian churches. Their persuasion had shaken the Galatians
initial condence in the adequacy of his circumcision-free gospel (see BDAG,
791, s.v. peitho3 2).
L 8 Such dissuasion from obeying the truth (v 7) did not come from the one
who calls the Galatians. This is the earliest use of the noun persuasion (peismone3 )
in Greek. Paul used it with an obviously negative force and connotation, perhaps
as empty rhetoric or rhetorical gimmickry (Betz 1979, 265). He tarred the
Agitators as fast-talking con artists. Their message was compelling, but untrue. It
was of merely human origin.
Paul implicitly answered his own rhetorical question in v 7. The one
ultimately responsible for their hindered progress was not the one who invited
them to become Christianswhether God or Gods apostolic agent, Paul (
1:6). This understanding of Pauls meaning would be more obvious, had he
used the aorist tense of the verbthe one who called yourather than the
present tensethe one who calls you ( 1:6).
Perhaps Paul used the present tense to emphasize that the divine invita-
tion to join the people of God without circumcision was still open. Did this,
like 4:19, suggest that the Galatians have gone back to square one and were
being called again to accept the truth of the circumcision-free gospel? Or, did
he simply emphasize the person who called them (Lightfoot 1974, 206), not
the time when they were called (so Bruce 1982, 234).
Paul was Gods agent in calling the Galatians to the Christian faith. And
he did not seek to persuade pagans to adopt Jewish ways to become a part of
Gods end-times people. More importantly, God did not expect Gentiles to
get circumcised!
Was this news to the Galatians? Or, was Paul stating the obvious? Had
they come up with the idea of getting circumcised on their own, or had out-
side inuences, perhaps claiming to represent the Jerusalem leadership of the
church (as most interpreters assume), deliberately misrepresented the apos-
tles true position?
S
A
M
P
L
E
315
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5: 8-9
Had some of Pauls Galatian converts mistakenly assumed that he, as a
circumcised Jew, would approve of their circumcision? It seems unlikely that
4:12 () was the rst time he had urged them to become like him. Why not
in this respect? Apparently, some of Pauls married converts in Corinth had
mistakenly assumed that his celibacy required them to refrain from marital
intercourse (see 1 Cor 7:1-11).
In Gal 5:11 Paul conceded that he had once preached circumcision. Were
those he opposed in Galatia innocently mistaken about his present practice?
Or, were they consciously and maliciously claiming that he still advocated
the circumcision of Gentiles (v 11)?
L 9 Pauls appeal to the imagery of bread-baking at this point in his argument
seems unexpected: A little leaven leavens the whole batch of dough. The
English term yeast mistakenly suggests a product foreign to ancient baking
practice. Paul referred to a piece of fermented dough (BDAG, 429), compa-
rable to the starter used in sourdough. But, what was his point? Why did he
quote this proverbial saying?
The Galatians almost certainly did not have the advantage of having read
1 Corinthians. In the context of 1 Cor 5:6, the same proverbial saying called
for the church in Corinth to expel the unrepentant incestuous man from their
community (see 1 Cor 5:1-12). His point there was that the evil inuence of
this wrongdoer among them, if left undisciplined, like leaven in a mixture of
bread dough, would permeate and negatively impact the entire church.
If the proverb in Gal 5:9 had appeared in closer connection with the
Scripture quotation in 4:30, Get rid of the slave woman and her son, it might
serve the same purpose it did in 1 Corinthians. But in the present context, it
does not call for excommunication (against Lyons 1985, 127-28 n. 17).
In the Greek sentence, the word little is in the emphatic rst position.
Paul may have called particular attention to the comparatively small number
of Agitators the Galatians were allowing to exercise a disproportionate inu-
ence on their whole community. Just a few advocates (or only onesee v 10)
of circumcision were responsible for hindering the Galatians and persuading
them to abandon their commitment to obeying the truth (v 7).
Often in the NT and later Christian literature leaven has negative con-
notations referring to the spread of some kind of corruption or evil (see Mark
8:15; 1 Clem. 5:6; Ign. Magn. 10.2; quote from Witherington 1998a, 372).
Would Pauls Gentile audience have been familiar with the thoroughly nega-
tive connotations leaven had in Jewish tradition from its associations with
Passover regulations (see Exod 12:15, 19; 13:7; Deut 16:3-4; Matt 16:6, 11-
12; Mark 8:15; Luke 12:1)? Interpreters cite only one pagan parallel to this
understanding (Plutarch, Quaest. rom. 109)insufcient to assume the un-
derstanding was universal.
Betz (1979, 266) notes that it was customary to cite proverbs in ancient
letters. But this one is known only from Pauls usage, even if it came from
S
A
M
P
L
E
316
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:9-10
popular wisdom. If the meaning of the proverb in context . . . speaks for
itself (Betz 1979, 266), why has the dominant interpretation of the passage
been mistaken since the second century (Betz 1979, 266 n. 130)? At the least,
the Galatians surely gathered that Paul urged them to eliminate the inuence
of the Agitators while it was comparatively small.
L 10 The emphatic rst word in the Greek sentence in vv 10 and 11 is the
explicit rst person singular pronoun I. This makes Pauls self-reference dou-
bly emphatic. The superuous pronoun set him in stark contrast with the one
who was throwing the Galatians into confusion. Pauls persistent condence
in them stood opposed to the unsettling inuence of the Agitator, who was
trying to persuade them to another point of view.
The Greek verb translated I am condent is from the same cognate fam-
ily as the verb translated obeying in v 7 and the noun persuasion in v 8.
The perfect tense of the verb here emphasizes Pauls condence as a continu-
ing state resulting from a past event. He probably referred to their Christian
conversion when he rst preached the gospel among them (see 3:1; 4:13-14).
Pauls condence toward the Galatians was in the Lord (see Eastman
2007, 43). He was all too aware of their foibles and failures. They were desert-
ing their calling; they had been confused, fooled, bewitched, and fast-talked
by clever preachers of a perverted gospel (1:6-9; 3:1-5; 5:8). Paul had little
reason for condence in any human (Phil 3:3-4; 2 Cor 10:2), much less the
Galatians. There is no reason to take this as suggesting he had just received an
encouraging report from Galatia (against Martyn 1997, 475).
Paul was condent that the Lord would not easily abandon his children
(see Rom 8:35-39; Phil 1:6). He was convinced that Christ (see Rom 14:14;
Phil 2:24; 2 Thess 3:4; Dunn 1993, 276) was more powerful than his op-
ponents (Rom 5:12-21; 16:17-20; Phil 1:19-26). His condence was that the
Lord would lead the Galatians to agree to accept no other gospel than the one
he had preached.
In Gal 1:7, Paul had insisted there is not another gospel. To take a view
translates the future tense of a verb meaning you will think or hold an opin-
ion. The parallel in Phil 3:15 suggests that Paul urged the Galatians to reach
a consensus agreement. He was condent in the Lord that the Agitators con-
trary gospel would not prevail. He was anxious that the opposition had used
confusion to divide the Galatian communities and set them at odds with one
another (Gal 5:15).
Paul was certain that the Galatians would agree with him on the matter.
But he was also convinced that the one who was throwing them into confusion
would pay the penalty for his troublemaking. The present participle tarasso3n
is the basis for the frequent choice of the term Agitators to label the Galatian
opposition. It refers to causing turmoil, stirring things up, unsettling matters.
Figuratively, it concerned mental or spiritual confusion, trouble, or agitation
(BDAG, 990).
S
A
M
P
L
E
317
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:10-11
In 1:7, Paul used the present participle in the plural to refer to Agita-
tors (tarassontes)some people are throwing you into confusion. There was
surely more than one troublemaker, despite the generic singular in 5:10. Some
think Paul was ignorant about the specics of the situation in Galatia (With-
erington 1998a, 372; Cole 1989, 200; Longenecker 1990, 232)? More likely,
his rhetorical aims dictated that he not give the opposition more publicity
than they deserved (Betz 1979, 267-68).
Paul did not expect his Galatian opponent(s) to prevail, but to be di-
vinely punished: he will pay the penalty. The same verb, bastasei, translated
pay here, is rendered carry in 6:2 and 5 (bear [NRSV]). There it is applied
to ones metaphorical burdens or load.
What the Agitator will bear is the judgment of divine condemnation
(see BDAG, 567). The Greek future tense does not always have a predictive
force. Perhaps Paul called for the Galatians to discipline the troublemaker: he
must pay the penalty (BDAG, 171, s.v. bastazo3) or accept Gods judicial con-
demnation at the end of time (see 1 Cor 3:10-15; Longenecker 1990, 232).
Whether the judgment Paul expected was to be dispensed by congre-
gational consensus or divinely administered, temporal or eternal, it was to be
impartial, without respect to the identity of the wrongdoer. This was the point
of the nal clause in v 10: whoever he may be ( 2:4-6). Pauls studied ano-
nymity has not prevented German interpreters from speculating as to likely
suspects, including Peter or James (see, e.g., Sieffert 1886, 309; Mussner 1977,
358 n. 104).
Pauls vague references to the Agitators were probably rhetorically mo-
tivated. Both he and the Galatians knew who they were. By refusing to name
them, he added insult to his condemnation of their actions. (Compare the
refusal of the temple authorities to mention Jesus in Acts 5:25-40.) It made
no difference who they were; they were wrong. Whoever preached a false
gospel, whether an angel or an apostle, called for divine judgment: let him be
eternally condemned! (1:8, 9).
L 11 Paul framed his rhetorical question as a conditional sentence. The verbs
in both the condition (protasis) and the result (apodosis) clauses are in the
present tense and the indicative mood. This construction might suggest that
both the condition and the result were real. But Paul was still being persecut-
ed (see 6:17). He granted the assumption that he was still preaching circumci-
sion merely for rhetorical purposes. The condition and result could not both
be true. Thus, the prior assumption was unreal (BDF, 190 372[3]).
The undeniable fact of Pauls persecution made it absurd and thus im-
possible to think that he was still preaching circumcision (Betz 1979, 268).
It is utterly implausible that his denial responded to an accusation to the con-
trary (against Boice 1976, 490). Who could have actually held and advocated
such a view? The condition is a false construction by Paul (Betz 1979, 268),
S
A
M
P
L
E
318
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:11
a purely hypothetical case: if I were preaching . . . (Arichea and Nida 1976,
128). Obviously, he was not.
Of course, it is possible that the Agitators misunderstood, either by
mistake or by intention, Pauls indifference to ethnic Jews continuing the
practice of circumcision (Betz 1979, 268). What made no difference to him
as a Jewish Christian made all the difference for them as Gentile Christians
(Betz 1979, 268 n. 152). For Jews, circumcision was irrelevant since it was
not a condition for salvation (Betz 1979, 269). Paul did not consider his dif-
ferent ways of dealing with Jews and Gentiles an inconsistency. For him, it was
a matter of missionary principle (1 Cor 9:19-23).
Despite the English translation, the rst word in Greek is I. Paul pre-
supposed a twofold contrast between himself and the Agitators. He did not
require circumcision as a condition for salvation; they did. He was being per-
secuted; they were not (see 6:12). Thus, his words, if I were still preaching
. . . , convey both a rhetorical concession and a contrast.
Paul conceded that he once had preached circumcision. The temporal
adverb still was an implicit admission that he had formerly been an oppo-
nent of the circumcision-free gospel he now advocated ( 1:13, 23). But that
was then. Now ( 5:10), after his encounter with Christ (vv 15-17), all had
changed. Betz speculates that he may have continued to preach circumcision
during his early days as a Jewish Christian (1979, 268-69).
Paul was not now seeking human approval (1:10 NRSV). So, he was no
longer still preaching circumcision. He required neither the surgical proce-
dure nor the exclusionary practices associated with it. His conversion-call had
transformed him from being a persecutor of the church, into an uncompro-
mising advocate of the circumcision-free gospel.
Perhaps Paul was still being persecuted because he was considered a
turncoat. In Galatians he never identied why or by whom he was being per-
secuted (see Smith 1996). And he made no attempt to enumerate his perse-
cutions beyond his enigmatic reference to the marks of Jesus he bore on his
body (6:17).
Based on the circumstantial catalogs of sufferings in 2 Corinthians (and
Acts), these marks may well have been lingering scars from his persecutions.
There he reported being ogged to the legal limit ve times. He was beaten
with rods on three occasions. Both were customary synagogue discipline (2
Cor 11:24-25; 6:5; see Acts 16:23). He was stoned and left for dead (2 Cor
11:25; Acts 14:19). He had received injuries as a victim of various imprison-
ments and riots (2 Cor 6:5; see Acts 17:5) and shipwrecks (2 Cor 11:25). This
is to say nothing of the verbal abusecurses and slanderhe received from
unbelieving Jews (1 Cor 4:10-13; Acts 13:45, 50; 14:2; 17:13; 21:27).
In 1 Thess 2:16 Paul accused his Jewish persecutors of being motivated
by an effort to keep [him] from speaking to the Gentiles so that they may
be saved. The weakness in the esh responsible for Pauls founding visit to
S
A
M
P
L
E
319
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:11
Galatia may refer to persecution. Perhaps he was incapacitated due to the
physical injuries suffered for preaching. This persecution may have led him
to retreat to Galatia ( Gal 4:13). He explicitly claimed to have preached in
Thessalonica in spite of strong opposition (1 Thess 2:2) and the experience
of suffering and insults received earlier in Philippi.
In Gal 5:11 Paul directly addressed his Galatian audience as Christian
friendsbrothers and sisters. In his previous such reference in 4:31, he re-
minded them of their shared status as the free children of Abraham. He would
refer to them again in 5:13: You, my brothers, were called to be free. Be-
tween these two references, Paul insisted that circumcision, which threatened
their freedom, must be steadfastly resisted.
Pauls nal claim in v 11 demonstrates that the initial assumption of
his conditional sentencethat he still preached circumcisionwas unreal.
Obviously, the inference that the offense [skandalon] of the cross has been
abolished was totally preposterous to Paul. He was well aware that his mes-
sage of Christ crucied was a stumbling block [skandalon] to Jews (1 Cor
1:23). His gospel offended, revulsed, and incited Jewish opposition (see Sir
7:6; 27:23; Jdt 5:20).
Paul preached that, because Christ was crucied, becoming a Jew by cir-
cumcision was not a condition for salvation (see 1 Cor 1:182:5). The gospel
of Christ crucied rendered both circumcision and uncircumcision inconse-
quential (7:18-19). Pauls gospel was the scandalous message that Jews and
Gentiles alike were made righteous before God on the basis of faith in Christ
alone. The crucied Christ was a stone that causes men to stumble [skand-
alon] (Rom 9:33; see 9:3010:4).
To abolish the scandalous message of the cross would have been effec-
tively:
to preach a different gospelwhich is really no gospel at all (1:6-7);
to insist that Christ died for nothing (2:21);
to set aside the grace of God (2:21);
to deny the redemption from the curse of the Law Christ made pos-
sible by becoming a curse for us (3:13);
to prefer the slavery of the Sinai covenant to the freedom of the cov-
enant of promise (4:215:1);
for the Galatians to deny their own identify as Spirit-flled Christians
(4:215:1);
for the Galatians to be burdened again by a yoke of slavery (5:1);
to choose a future in which Christ will be of no value to you at all (5:2);
to have been alienated from Christ (5:4a); and
to have fallen away from grace (5:4b).
Paul offered the Galatians just two possible futures: the way of the cross or cir-
cumcision. The Agitators way meant a return to the slavery they had escaped
when they became Christians ( 4:8).
S
A
M
P
L
E
320
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:11-12
If pagans had to become Jews to be saved, circumcision was essential.
But if Christ was the Savior, ones status as Jew or Gentile, circumcised or
uncircumcised, meant nothing. For in Christ Jesus neither circumcision nor
uncircumcision has any value (5:6a; see 6:15). The offense of the cross has
not been abolished (kate3rge3tai). On the contrary, those who try to be justied
by law have been alienated [kate3rge3the3te] from Christ (5:4a).
L 12 Interpreters have often taken Pauls unattainable wish (BDAG, 743;
BDF, 194 384)O that those who are troubling you would cut themselves
off! as a cruel pun. That is, he wished his circumcising opponents would
castrate themselves (BDAG, 113, s.v. apokopto3). If so, was this a sincere wish
or only crude scatological humor? If this was the imagery he intended, did his
Galatian audience get the joke? The fourth-century commentator Ambrosia-
ster interpreted Pauls unfulllable wish as that those who had deprived the
Galatians of the grace of God should themselves be cut off from the grace of
God (cited in Edwards 1999, 80).
With circumcision under discussion, Pauls wish that the Agitators
would cut themselves off might hint of emasculation. But in light of Deut
23:2, his reference might have been that they would separate themselves from
the Galatians by self-excommunication (Sthlin 1965, 854). Did Paul long
that the Agitators would just go away (Witherington 1998a, 374)?
Rendall (1903, 185) claims that apokopsontai was habitually used to
describe the practice of mutilation . . . prevalent in the Phrygian worship of
Cybele. The Galatians were necessarily familiar with it, and it can hardly bear
any other sense (see now Elliott 1999, 675). For Paul to have compared the
ancient Jewish rite of circumcision to pagan practices would have been star-
tling. It would have treated the circumcising efforts of the Agitators as pro-
moting abhorred pagan practices. And it would have linked their desire for
circumcision to that which even in Judaism disbarred one from the congrega-
tion of the Lordcastration (Lev 21:20; 22:24; Deut 23:1; Boice 1976, 491).
Self-castration would have barred the Agitators from the Jewish temple (Deut
23:1; but see Isa 56:3-8; Acts 8:26-39).
The verb apokopto3 in ancient Greek literature did refer to castration (see
Deut 23:2; BDAG, 113). But the LXX never used the unprexed verb kopto3
to refer to circumcision ( Gal 5:7). Would the Galatians have associated this
verb with circumcision? If Paul intended to make a crude pun on circumcise
(peritemno3, from the verb temno3, cut and the preposition peri-, around),
apotemno3, cut off (LSJ, 222) would have been a more obvious choice of
words.
In the Hebrew of Gen 17:14, God instructs Abraham: Any uncircum-
cised male, who has not been circumcised in the esh, will be cut off from his
people (compare Lev 22:24; Deut 23:2). Despite the Hebrew pun, the LXX
translators interpreted the contextual force of the Hebrew karet, be cut off,
using the verb exolethreuthe3stai, be utterly destroyed. The LXX translators
S
A
M
P
L
E
321
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1-12
ignored the Hebrew pun and correctly interpreted the contextual force of the
Hebrew. If Paul reversed the logic of the LXX of Gen 17:14, his wish was not a
crude call for castration. It was an even more uncharitable wish for the eternal
damnation of the Agitators by God, effectively repeating the anathema-curse
with which the letter began ( Gal 1:8-9).
Interpreters have ignored a far more obvious play on words in 5:12. The
verb translated agitators (hoi anastatountes) here is from a different cognate
family than the synonym tarasso3nthe one who is throwing you into confu-
sionin v 10. Anastatoo3 in political contexts described disturbances, revolts,
and social instability (BDAG, 72). Given Pauls mention of the offence of
the cross in v 11, a play on words exists between anastauroo3, crucify, and
anastatoo3, agitate. The scandalous cross brought the good news of freedom to
the Galatians; circumcision, only community chaos.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Balancing Antitheses. In many respects these verses aptly summarize the
essential message of Galatians.
The Christian life is one of freedom. But freedom often involves a dif-
cult balancing act between the extremes of legalism and license.
And yet, freedom is not to be misconstrued as autonomy. Christ re-
leases us from slavery to our past (4:8-9) to live lives of love and mu-
tual service (5:6 and 13).
Non-Jews must Stand rm (v 1) and refuse to be enslaved by demands
that they become Jewish in order to enjoy full Christian standing (vv
1-4).
Faith in Christ alone makes possible a right relationship with God in
the present and the certain hope of nal salvation in the future. Faith
is not a one-time event, but must be sustained in ongoing faithfulness
to Christ.
Perseverance in faith and freedom is not a matter of human determi-
nation. The Spirit alone empowers believers to live in hope and obedi-
ence.
Ethnic heritage, cultural practices, legal observances, and human ef-
fort contribute nothing to justication before God. The only thing
that counts is faith expressing itself through love (v 6).
Therefore, Paul urged his Gentile converts to refuse to get circum-
cised to become Jewish Christians. Circumcision was not the solution
to problems with the Flesh.
Contemporary Circumcision. The centrality of opposition to circumci-
sion in Galatians puts it at risk of rendering the letter totally irrelevant to
twenty-rst-century Western Christians. But it has always been irrelevant in
this respect to the majority of Christianswomen.
S
A
M
P
L
E
322
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1-12
Is there a contemporary, gender-neutral analogy to circumcision? The
routine circumcision of newborn males in U.S. hospitals (originally for hy-
gienic purposes) performed by medical professionals with no religious or cov-
enantal associations is no real analogy to the practice Paul opposed.
Any proposed contemporary equivalent would seem to need to satisfy
criteria such as these:
It must be a generally recognized distinguishing mark of those who
consider themselves the people of God, which separates them from
those who are not.
i
In a cross-cultural setting, might contemporary circumcision in-
volve the expectation that Christian converts adopt Western cul-
tural practices and dress?
i
In our increasingly casual culture, could it be the expectation that
people dress up for church?
i
Have we adopted an insider jargon that new believers must master
to be considered fully acculturated into our evangelical Christian
communities?
i
Do we expect every believer to have had a conversion experience
similar to ours? Is walking down a church aisle and kneeling at an
altar the only way to get saved?
i
Do we insist on a particular translation of the Bible and presume
that those who use any other cannot be truly Christian?
Does a contemporary analogy to circumcision need to be something
tangiblephysical and observable, but not necessarily immediately
obviousthat is relatively permanent? Long gone are the days when
distinguishing countercultural haircuts were expected of Christian
men or when long-hair-put-up-in-buns marked holiness women. Is
there any contemporary counterpart comparable in this respect?
Contemporary circumcision must be something that a religious com-
munity might insist upon as essential to shared Christian worship or
fellowship.
i
This might include a particular worship or music styleinstrumen-
tal vs. noninstrumental, organs vs. guitars, hymns vs. choruses, li-
turgical vs. charismatic, and so forth.
i
But other expectations might include similar socioeconomic status,
political afliations and convictions, shared family values, and so
forth (suggested in an email message by Hal Cauthron on February
5, 2008).
Is there a contemporary analogy to one other reason the Galatians may
have considered circumcision? That by accepting it they might avoid
persecution and the stigma of the cross of Christ ( 5:11; 6:12)? What
are the things we seek to provide safety and security in our lives that
S
A
M
P
L
E
323
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:1-12
contribute to our evasion of the gospels call to cruciformity (suggest-
ed in an email message by Don Dunnington on October 16, 2011)?
What in our cultural and historical context threatens the centrality and
nality of Christ as circumcision did in Pauls? What if we recall that circum-
cision is more than a surgical procedure, but an exclusionary-discriminato-
ry practice, presumed to separate the true people of God from pretenders?
Would Paul urge contemporary Christians, Do not change denominations?
Does one denomination or theological tradition have a unique claim on Christ
or salvation?
Some Christians have (I believe mistakenly) concluded that Pauls rejec-
tion of circumcision applied consistently entails treating any and all ritual-
sacramental acts as comparably irrelevant. Many Christians seem to consider
all rituals as superuous at best or petrifying at worst (suggested by Terence
Paige in an email message on February 5, 2008).
But Christ and his apostles commanded followers to baptize and to ob-
serve communion. Because of the centrality of Christ in these sacraments,
they function as means of grace, not occasions for falling from grace. Never-
theless, the OT identies God as the sponsor of circumcision. Paul opposed
circumcision because it had been abused, misunderstood, and misapplied in
his day.
In Rom 4:11, Paul identied Abrahams circumcision as a seal of the
righteousness that he had by faith while he was still uncircumcised. This
was not the circumcision Paul railed against in Galatians. He rejected what
circumcision had come to symbolize after the second century B.C. It was little
more than an identity marker, distinguishing insiders from outsiders to the
faith community, but making no transforming difference in their lives(
2:3 sidebar, Why Circumcision Mattered). Unfortunately, for many cultural
Christians baptism has become merely a legalistic, empty ritual that func-
tions as a barrier to true faith rather than a conduit for it (Rod Reed in an
email message February 5, 2008).
There was a time in Christian culture when it was taken for granted
that ones conversion was incomplete apart from making restitution. Were the
expectations of the newly converted to right the wrongs of their pre-Christian
past a counterpart to circumcision or merely the expected fruit of repentance?
Is it possible to identify a likely candidate for contemporary circumcision by
the way we complete this sentence: You are not really saved until you _____?
Have the various Christian traditions adopted their own contemporary
counterparts to circumcision as essential signs of enculturation into these tra-
ditions? Within evangelical communities certain daily devotional disciplines
(prayer and Bible reading, especially) and pious practices (faithful church at-
tendance, tithing, and witnessing, for example) are often urged as essential
to maintaining a right relationship with God. Even these can be perverted
into analogies to the circumcision Paul opposed. Recall Jesus critique of the
S
A
M
P
L
E
324
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:13-26
leading marks of piety in his dayalmsgiving, prayer, and fastingfor their
preoccupation with human recognition and immediate rewards (Matt 6:1-18).
And he warned his Jewish contemporaries that it was possible to study the
Scriptures and miss the real point (John 5:39-40).
Nothing we do contributes to our salvation. Faithfulness to Christ alone
matters. We must Stand rm in Christ, who set us free and keeps us free. To
depend on anything or anyone else puts us at risk of losing all the benets he
has freely given at great expense to God. In Gal 5:16-26, Paul offered life in
the Spirit, not Law, as the alternative to life in the Flesh.
b. Life in the Spirit (5:13-26)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Christ freely set us free from all that enslaved us. But Christian freedom
cannot be taken for granted. We must steadfastly refuse to be enslaved by
anything that promises to do what Christ has already done (5:1). Circumci-
sion will never replace faithfulness to Christ. What humans can do without
God may, in fact, lead Christians to wrench themselves from the grip of Gods
grace (vv 2-4). Preoccupation with something as inconsequential as circumci-
sion vs. uncircumcision can lead us to miss the only thing that counts . . . faith
expressing itself through love (v 6).
If legalism is a dead end in the path of freedom (5:1-12), neither was the
call to freedom to be misunderstood as autonomy, independence, or license
(vv 1, 13-15). God called us to freedom, not to indulge ourselves, but to serve
others in love. Human efforts to observe the Law cannot save us (3:21). But
as we love our neighbors as ourselves we coincidentally accomplish the Laws
essential end (5:14).
The circumcision debate in Pauls Galatian churches had created deep
divides within these Christian communities. He was rmly convinced that the
Agitators were wrong and that God would punish them for the wrongs they
had done to their fellow believers (5:7-12).
But the issue of circumcision vs. uncircumcision (i.e., Jew vs. non-Jew)
itself was ultimately inconsequential. What really mattered were practical ex-
pressions of love and Gods new order of existence (5:6; 6:15). Therefore, Paul
called for an end to the inghting within the Galatian churches. The mutual in-
civility on both sides of the circumcision debate threatened to destroy them all
(5:15). He urged them to put aside their boasting of spiritual superiority, which
provoked some and led others to be envious (v 26). As Christians, they had
crucied the Flesh; there was no reason to glorify eshly matters (vv 24-26).
Galatian preoccupation with an insignicant piece of human eshthe
foreskinprobably accounts for Pauls framing of the decisive issue as one of
Flesh vs. Spirit in vv 16-26. Their misguided preoccupation with trivia had
devastated their lives together. Thus, their preoccupation was not trivial. Paul
S
A
M
P
L
E
325
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:13
repeatedly reminded his audience to let the Spirit determine the course of
their lives (v 16), to be led by the Spirit (v 18), and to keep in step with the
Spirit who had given them life (v 25). The quality of their social interaction
in the present and their eternal destiny would be determined by their choice:
Would they pursue fulllment ( v 16) in the Flesh or in the Spirit (vv 19-
23)? People and communities who let the Spirit bear his fruit in their lives do
not need the Law ( v 23b).
i. Freedom to Love (5:13-15)
I N THE TEXT
L 13 As in v 11, Paul directly addressed his audience as fellow believers,
brothers and sisters. The explicit second person plural pronoun You stand-
ing in the emphatic rst position in the Greek sentence strongly distanced his
audience from the agitators (v 12). They were destined for destruction; but
the Galatian Christians were called to be free.
Paul explained why (For) he wished those troubling his converts would
cut themselves off (Burton 1920, 291). The Agitators call for circumcision
was drowning out Pauls earlier call to freedom.
The passive voice of the verb were called presumes God as the source
of the invitation to be free. Its aorist tense refers back to the conversion of the
Galatians, when Paul, as the divine spokesman, brought them the good news.
Despite the NIV translation to be free, Paul repeated the same abstract noun
he had used in v 1freedom (eleutheriai).
In v 1 Paul had used freedom in the simple dative case. Here the prepo-
sition epi precedes freedom. Although prepositions, as function words, some-
times help remove ambiguity, they are notoriously difcult to translate. With
dative case objects, epi could mean on, in, above (BDAG, 363). It could
allow the abstract noun to function as an adverb, emphasizing that God had
freely chosen the Galatians. Or, it could stress the goal, object or purpose
(Louw and Nida 1989, 366) toward which God called themunto liberty
(KJV).
Christian freedom meant release from slavery to a new kind of existence
that was previously impossible. Galatians emphasizes freedom from the Law
(Bruce 1982, 239), Jewish nomism (legalism: Longenecker 1990, 239), Sin
(Stott 1968, 139), and especially from the requirement of circumcision.
Paul added a single reservation to distinguish Christian freedom from
license. A wooden translation of v 13 would be: For you, brothers and sis-
tersyou were called to freedom, only not freedom for an opportunity for
the esh. Instead, through love serve one another. There is no explicit verb
in the negative clause. The words do not use your have no basis in Greek. It
is unclear what verb Paul ellipsed. Neither the preceding verb call nor the
following verb serve make sense in the negative clause. And the equative verb
S
A
M
P
L
E
326
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:13
to be would call for a predicate nominative, not the accusative form of the
noun freedom. Despite these ambiguities, Pauls meaning was clear enough.
The Christian call to freedom was not to be abused for the purpose
of creating an opportunity for the esh. The Greek noun aphorme3 was used
literally to refer to a base or circumstance from which other action becomes
possible, such as the starting-point or base of operations for an expedition or
the resources needed to carry through an undertaking. In the NT it generally
referred to a set of circumstances for carrying out some purpose occasion,
opportunity (BDAG, 158).
The 1984 NIVs translation of te3i sarki as the sinful nature was unjusti-
ed and unhelpful. The 2011 NIV correctly returns to the traditional esh.
Characteristically Paul thought of sarx, fesh, in contrast to the Spirit. Weak
human beings apart from the powerful presence of God (see Rom 8:3; 7:5, 14,
18) lack the strength to please God (Rom 8:8). Freedom did not leave the Ga-
latians antonymous, forced to depend on their own inadequate resources. Nor
did it leave them independent, encouraged to live for selsh ends. The NRSV
appropriately paraphrases: Do not use your freedom as an opportunity for
self-indulgence.
The Christian ideal of freedom paradoxically releases Christians for un-
fettered service. Christians are free to love God and other humans, free to
subordinate all selsh desires to perfect love (Rendall 1903, 186; compare
1 Cor 7:22).
The esh-Spirit contrast should not be taken in the sense of Platonic
dualism. Paul did not believe there was something inherently wrong with be-
ing creatures of esh. We are weak human beings, just creatures, entirely de-
pendent on God. Acknowledging this to God is what it means to have faith.
Paul did not equate humanity with sin (as the 1984 NIV suggests). Nor did he
assume that to be a creature was to be fallen.
Problems with the esh arise when we humans choose to live as if we
are not weak, as if we are autonomous / independent. We cannot live without
God. We cannot please God without his empowering presence (see Rom 8:1-
11). For Christians to attempt to live as if we were set free simply to be free is
to indulge ourselvesto excuse the esh for its weakness. To orient our lives
around the created order rather than to acknowledge our ongoing dependence
on the Creator is to live in anarchy, licentiousness, and rebellionnot in free-
dom. As creatures of esh, we experience true life and freedom only paradoxi-
cally as we live no longer for ourselves but by faith in the Son of God (Gal
2:20; 5:1-6 FROM THE TEXT).
Christian freedom does not give the esh permission to become a new
slave master. The Lord who has set us free sets the terms of our liberation.
And he liberated us to love others, not to indulge ourselves.
For the Galatians to yield to the Agitators demands to be circumcised
would be give the esh an opportunity. Paul insisted that no mark in human
S
A
M
P
L
E
327
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:13
esh justied boastful self-condence that one was a member of the covenant
community (see Phil 3:3-4). The gospel of Christ crucied undermines all
vaunted human claims (see 1 Cor 1:184:7). Selsh, human interests cause
independent humans to distort the Law into a means of self-aggrandizement,
to pervert circumcision into a means of achieving human honor (see Gal 6:13),
not a sign of the covenant of grace (see Rom 4).
The Tr ansl at i on of Sar x
Before the NIV appeared in 1973, all standard committee versions of the
English Bible translated the Greek sarx literally as the esh. The translation
sinful nature reects a Reformed interpretation of sarx as a perverse compo-
nent of human nature. This emphasizes a Platonic, not a biblical understanding of
human nature. The 1978 revision of the NIV added the marginal note the esh
in the twenty-three instances, mostly in Romans and Galatians, in which sarx is
translated sinful nature (Rom 7:5, 18, 25; 8:3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12, 13; 13:14; 1 Cor 5:5;
Gal 5:13, 16, 17 [twice], 19, 24; 6:8; Eph 2:3; Col 2:11, 13; 2 Pet 2:10). The 1984
NIV and the 2005 TNIV retained the unfortunate translation sinful nature. The
2011 revision of the NIV eliminates this theologically biased translation, returning
to esh.
Paul acknowledged that sin metaphorically resided in human esh (Rom
7:23-25). The Spirit of God is certainly not responsible for our sin. But human
esh is not inherently sinful, just weak, as the OT frequently emphasizes, refer-
ring to the Hebrew equivalent ba3s8a3r (see 8:3). Weak humans need the resident
power of the Spirit to free us from sins power (vv 8-9).
Paul conceived of sarx not as a negative, but a neutral reality. It becomes
sinful only as humans indulge it, rather than giving sway to the Spirit (see Gal 5:16-
18). Flesh designates humanity in its embodied totality before or apart from
Christs grace and the liberating power of the Spirit (see Rom 7:18). Wesley
identied esh as the whole man as he is by nature (1950, 545).
The Reformed theology reected in the 1984 NIVs rendering distorts
the biblical view of human nature. Human sinfulness is not a substance nor an
unalterable fate destined by our status as creatures. It is a redeemable condition.
Humans were made by God and for God. Flesh is fallen humanity as it exists in
a distorted relationship with God, or rather without God. This is our existential
circumstance. There is nothing wrong with material existence or with being a
creature of esh. Our problem is what we lack: an innate relationship with God.
Out of our deprivation, we have chosen to live for the esh to the neglect of and
in opposition to our Creator. Naturally deprived, we become depraved by our
self-destructive choices.
Some scholars suggest that Paul used esh as the equivalent of the Jew-
ish concept of the evil inclination, the counterpart to the good inclination, both
of which resided in every human being. But Paul focused instead on the tension
between Christians as naturally human creatures and as supernaturally lled with
the Spirit of God. The tension of esh and Spirit is not a matter of our physical /
S
A
M
P
L
E
328
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:13
lower vs. our spiritual / higher nature (Witherington 1998a, 377). It is the tension
between the human and divine emphasized throughout Galatians.
Pauls concern for the potential misuse of freedom in Gal 5:13 seems to
have been similar to that expressed in Rom 6:1, 14, and 15. There his concern
was the prospect of a licentious misunderstanding of life under grace. Divine
grace does not encourage sin, as if it were merely a divine indulgence. Grace
is the indwelling Spirit of God, empowering weak human beings to obey God
without the necessity of external constraint (Law).
Christian freedom is not a platform for self-indulgence. The alternative
Paul urged involved the imperative: serve one another in love. Freedom is not
an opportunity for self-preoccupation but for loving service to others.
The reciprocal pronoun one another emphasizes the mutuality of the
command. Service was the responsibility of everyone to everyone in each of
the Christian communities the apostle addressed. As everyone served others,
everyone would in turn be served. This command, as surely as Gal 3:28, meant
the rejection of racial, social, and gender distinctions within the church. No
one was too exalted to serve; and no one, too lowly to be served.
The paradoxical and countercultural character of Pauls command is far
more obvious in Greek than in English. The verb translated serve is douleuete,
from the same cognate family as doulos, slave. Since elsewhere he treats slav-
ery and freedom as polar opposites (see 4:31), it is remarkable that he should
identify the proper exercise of freedom as mutual love-slavery in contrast to
slavery to the Law (5:1; see Matera 1992, 193).
The phrase in love might indicate the manner in which the Galatians
were to serve one another. Or it might indicate that love was to be the ef-
cient cause . . . through which their service should express itself (BDAG,
224). Regardless of the nuance, love was to be more than an inward disposi-
tion. Gods love became visible in the costly gift of Christ in behalf of others
(2:20). Christian love is an activity that gives tangible expression to our faith.
Mutual service entails loving one another. Rather than slavish submission to
circumcision, Paul called for a voluntary commitment to serve the real needs
of fellow believers. Chrysostom believed Paul recommended mutual service
as a means to bring the divided community together again (cited in Edwards
1999, 81).
Mutual service (5:13) and neighbor love (v 14) might be taken to exclude
unbelievers (see Rom 13:8, 10; 14:13, 19; 15:5, 7, 14; 16:16). The parable of
the Good Samaritan challenged the common Jewish assumption that only fel-
low Israelites were their neighbors (Luke 10:29-37). Pauls love exhortations
in Rom 13 clearly include outsiders (Rom 13:8; see 7:3, 4; 12:13, 14, 18, 20; 1
Thess 3:12; 5:15). Love was to begin within the Christian community, but to
embrace everyone (Gal 6:10).
S
A
M
P
L
E
329
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:14
L 14 Pauls understanding of freedom in vv 1 and 13 entailed freedom from
the Law. So why would he care to validate his exhortation to loving service
in v 13 as the fulllment of the entire law. In v 14, Paul appealed to the Law,
specically Lev 19:18Love your neighbor as yourself, to explain why he
appealed for the Galatians in 5:13 to serve one another in love (Longenecker
1990, 238).
Several caveats are in order:
Paul did not identify his source using a Scripture-quotation formula.
Despite the NIV, he did not refer to it as a command but as a word or
saying (logo3i).
Grammatically, Love your neighbor is not a command. The verb is
a future indicative, not an imperative. It is not so much a prediction
as a promise: Each of you will love your neighbor. This imperatival
future is common in LXX commands quoted in the NT (Robertson
1919, 874).
The entire law referred to the law regarded as a whole, in contrast to its
individual parts (BDAG, 784). His concern was not to insist that love and law
were compatible, nor to identify the Law as the source of the love-command,
nor to identify Lev 19:18bLove your neighbor as yourselfas a timeless
demand. It was to claim that the whole law (NRSV) has been fullled in
neighbor love. But what did this mean?
Was the entire Law fully and adequately summarized in this single
word (BDAG, 828, s.v. ple3roo3 3)? Did Paul claim that those who prac-
tice neighbor love completely and essentially observe all that the Law
really requires? That is, was the whole intent of the Law to promote
such love (BDAG, 829, s.v. ple3roo3 4b)?
Does loving others make attention to further legal requirements un-
necessary?
i
Was Pauls point the opposite of Jas 2:10whoever keeps the
whole law and yet stumbles at just one point is guilty of breaking all
of it?
i
Was it that those who love their neighbors need not bother attend-
ing to anything else the Law requires?
i
Is Pauls claim comparable to that of 1 Tim 1:9, that the law is made
not for the righteous but for lawbreakers ( 5:23)?
i
In Rom 13:8, Paul claimed that those who love others have fullled
the Law. If his point in Gal 5:14 was that all who love their neighbors
have done everything the Law demands, this is not what he wrote.
He did not claim that everything the Law required was fullled in
the lives of Spirit-empowered believers (as in Rom 8:4). Stated ac-
tively, Gal 5:14 indicates that a single command . . . summed up the
entire law.
S
A
M
P
L
E
330
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:14
Is loving others simply the entry point for observing the rest of the
Law with undiminished rigor? Galatians 5:3 () suggests not. There,
Paul wrote disparagingly of doing the whole law.
i
The slight nuance of difference in the meaning of the two adjectives,
all and entire, does not adequately account for the tension.
i
Are the shades of meaning of the verbs do and fulll sufcient to
explain this?
J
In 5:3, Paul characterized the obligation to obey (to do) the entire
law as an onerous, if not impossible task. He warned the Galatians
that this would be expected of them if they got circumcised.
J
In v 13 he commanded mutual love before insisting that the entire
law is summed up in the command to love ones neighbor as one-
self (v 14). The Greek verb pleroo3 used in v 14 literally refers to
lling an empty container. But what does this mean as applied to
the Law? In what gurative sense has the love command lled the
Law?
J
Did Paul claim that one fullls / performs the many require-
ments of the Law by fullling / performing the one requirement
of neighbor love (so Martyn 1997, 488)?
i
Romans 13:9 refers to neighbor love as summarizing all the other
commandments. The immediate context of this verse, between Rom
13:8 and 10, suggests that what summarizes the Law fullls the
Law. That is, other-oriented love simplies the Laws 613 specic
requirements into one comprehensive task. Loving others achieves
everything the Law expects of Gods people.
Loving others fullled the Law by perfecting it. Love achieved all God
intended Law to be and accomplish (see John 15:11; Phil 2:2). The love com-
mand replaced the Law for Christians (against Moo 1983, 815). Paul said, in
effect: Never mind the 613 rules. Loving one another is enough. The rest is
only detail. Jewish Christians considered the Torah the sole and indispensable
guide to righteousness. Paul, however, insisted that love provided a sufcient
and more fundamental basis for obedience. Loving others is what obedience
demands.
Paul insisted that all the commands of the Law concerning our relations
with others were fullled by obeying one command. This was not from the
Ten Commandments, but from Lev 19:18b: Love your neighbor as yourself.
It is not that all commandments are reduced to love, but that neighbor love is
the essence of obedience.
Paul and Jesus stand within a long Jewish tradition that attempted to
summarize the entire Law in a single fundamental principle (see Martyn 1997,
515-18). But the Christian principle is different. Prior to Jesus and Paul there
are no explicit references and few allusions to Lev 19:18 in Jewish tradition.
But it is the NTs most frequently cited passage from the Pentateuch (Matt
S
A
M
P
L
E
331
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:14-15
5:43; 19:19; Mark 12:31, 33; Rom 13:9; Gal 5:14; Jas 2:8; see Did. 1:2; see
Furnish 1972; Wischenmeyer 1986; Longenecker 1990, 243-44). Later tradi-
tion credits Rabbi Akiba with calling Lev 19:18 the greatest general principle
in Torah (Gen. Rab. 24.7; Sifra on Lev. 19:18) (Witherington 1998a, 383).
Like Jesus, Paul did not limit the application of the command to Love
your neighbor as yourself to fellow Israelites. Most Jewish interpreters before
him did. Nor did Paul make self-love the basis of neighbor love. Despite the
claims of some modern preachers, high self-esteem is not the foundational
truth of the Christian gospel. The gospel calls for honest self-examination
(Rom 12:3; Gal 6:3-4; Phil 2:3), not self-exaltation.
Neighbor love includes all Law commands and goes beyond what it
prohibits (see 1 Cor 13:4-7; Gal 5:23b; Matt 5:43-48). It invites us to place
ourselves in the position of our neighbors and to allow our actions to ow
from the question, What would I desire in this situation? Love is the Spirit-
empowered, concrete expression of the self-giving modeled by Christ (Gal
2:19-20; see Rom 15:1-3). This allowed Paul to call it both the fruit of the
Spirit (Gal 5:22) and the law of Christ (6:2). Those who practice neighbor
love do not need the Law ( 5:23).
Believers fulll the law not because they continue to be obligated to it
but because, by the power of the Spirit in their lives, their conduct co-
incidentally displays the behavior that the Mosaic law prescribes. In this
verse, then, Paul is claiming that believers have no need of the Mosaic
law because by their Spirit-inspired conduct they already fulll its re-
quirements. (Thielmann 1994, 140)
L 15 Pauls quotation of Lev 19:18 concerning the necessity for everyone to
practice mutual love was not just a general reminder of a basic Christian prin-
ciple. There actually were serious shortcomings in the Galatians existing in-
tercommunity relations. In contrast to the mutual love the apostle called for,
he warned, If you keep on biting and devouring each other, watch out that
you are not consumed by one another. The division within the Galatian com-
munities on circumcision and the Law had created a factious situation, which
threatened to split the congregations in Galatia (Witherington 1998a, 379).
At this point in the letter, Paul approached the Galatians as if their prob-
lems were internal, not with him or with Agitators from outside the com-
munity. The churches disputes were with one anothera division between
Pauls detractors and devotees. The apostle blamed anonymous troublemakers
for agitating the Galatians. Paul implied that the Agitators were members of
the Galatian communities, not outsiders from Jerusalem or elsewhere. This
lends credibility to the hypothesis that Paul thought of the Galatians as in a
situation analogous to that of Israel in the wilderness. As with Israel, commu-
nal inghting was a live issue. . . . Even a cursory reading of ExodusNumbers
reveals the fact that these same sorts of social vices [as Paul listed among the
S
A
M
P
L
E
332
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:15
works of the esh] characterized the wilderness generation (Exod 1617;
Num 1117; Wilson 2004, 569).
Betz (1979, 276-77) considers Gal 5:15 a sarcastic and hyperbolic
warning. Comparisons of bad conduct with the behavior of wild animals
were a commonplace in Greco-Roman diatribe literature (compare Matt
7:15; Gal 3:15; Phil 3:2; 1 Cor 15:32). The Galatians probably were not actu-
ally behaving like cannibals.
Philo of Alexandria, however, described pagan banquets as marked by
drunken participants irrationally biting and gnawing each others noses, and
ears, and ngers, and other parts of their body (Contempl. Life 39). If the
internal disputes in the Galatian communities had led to physical violence,
the Galatians would not have been the only Pauline communities who abused
the Lords Supper by bringing their pagan assumptions to the table (see 1 Cor
11:17-34).
It is difcult to identify the precise nature of the inghting Paul meta-
phorically described as biting and devouring each other. The most plausible
eating analogy elsewhere in the Bible involves the destruction resulting from
divine judgment (see Lev 10:2; Deut 32:42; 2 Sam 18:8; Ps 21:9; Prov 1:12;
see Ryken, Wilhoit, and Longman 1998, 227). Had the Galatian disputants
pronounced curses on their opponents? Had the opposing sides treated one
another with contempt, praying for the destruction of fellow believers and
threatening the survival of their churches?
Philos allegorical interpretation of the Genesis account of Gods cre-
ation of the animals, wild and domesticated, offers another possible explana-
tion. He noted that the human emotions of desire, pain, fear, and anger may
serve potentially good or evil ends, biting the soul (Philo, Alleg. Interp. 2.8).
Such passions helpfully make it impossible for us to be indifferent about lifes
experiences. But like wild beasts, untamed emotions can be destructive.
Both Pauls and Philos biting translate the Greek word dakno3. Philo con-
trasted the control of reason with self-destructive desires (Alleg. Interp. 2.24).
In Gal 5:16-25, Paul contrasted the proper and improper exercise of divinely
created human desires (v 16) as the fruit of the Spirit vs. the works of the
esh.
The Greek word translated devouring in v 15 in 2 Cor 11:20 describes
the exploitive tactics Pauls opponents had used to take advantage of his Co-
rinthian converts (as in Ps 13:4). We might have expected him to character-
ize the beastly behavior of the Agitators in these terms. But he also indicted
those who had remained faithful to his gospel. The words one another (NRSV)
suggest that both sides in the dispute had stooped to conduct unbecoming to
Christians, threatening everyone with mutual destruction.
Pauls imperative warning, watch out, serves a similar function else-
where in his letters (see 1 Cor 8:9; 10:18; 16:10; Eph 5:15; three times in Phil
3:2; Col 2:8). Paul did not urge caution as an alternative to mutually assured
S
A
M
P
L
E
333
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:13-15
destruction: watch out or you will be destroyed by each other. Rather, he
warned: watch out that you are not consumed by one another. Unless they
ended their mutual attacks, self-destruction was inevitable.
What exactly did Paul predict when he wrote, you will be destroyed by
each other? The word translated destroyed means to do away with some[thing]
completely by using up. As a commercial metaphor, his plea might suggest,
see to it that you are not squandered by one another (BDAG, 67; see Prov
30:14). But the eating imagery probably calls for the translation consume.
The metaphor may have suggested itself because the Galatians were divided
over desires of the esh (Gal 5:16 NRSV). The same Greek word sarx literally
referred to meat and guratively to bodily existence (BDAG, 914-16).
The apostle almost certainly did not imagine a literal feeding frenzy in
the ofng. He feared, however, that the ongoing intercommunity strife among
the Galatian Christians would bankrupt them spiritually and probably lead
to the virtual dissolution of the churches he had founded there.
This was the concern Paul expressed in 3:4Have you suffered so
much for nothingif it really was for nothing? and 4:11I fear for you, that
somehow I have wasted my efforts on you. The Galatians might not actually
kill and consume one another. But Paul feared that internal division would
cause their churches to surrender their commitment to Christ, to lose their
faith, and nally cease to exist.
v
FROM THE TEXT
We must guard the freedom Christ made possible from being lost
through preoccupation with the Law (5:1-6). But freedom is equally at risk
through preoccupation with ourselves (vv 13-15). Paul used Flesh far more
comprehensively than to refer only to the sinful nature. The more obvious
expressions of Flesh in the chaotic list of the works of the Flesh (vv 19-21) be-
gin with an egocentric orientation. Left to our own resources, each of us alone
and all of us collectively, without Gods empowering presence are capable of
great evil. Abusing freedom for self-indulgence is a work of the Flesh.
Christ provides the model for the seless service of others (see 2:19-
20). The Spirit, the empowering presence of God, enables us to maintain the
fragile gift of Christian freedom for its divinely intended purpose. Just as faith
expresses itself in tangible deeds of love (5:6), so freedom allows us to serve
one another as love-slaves (v 13).
Mutual love accomplishes in our relations with one another all the Law
demands and more. Jesus and Paul emphasized love as the distinguishing cen-
ter of the early Christian ethic. A church without love is M.A.D. Paul warned
that the failure to love within the Christian community had the potential of
Mutually Assured Destruction (v 15).
Pauls concern was not for abandoned church buildings scattered
throughout Galatia. There were no church buildings before the third cen-
S
A
M
P
L
E
334
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:16-26
tury. The earliest Christians gathered in house churches. The households that
served as the settings for the Galatian churches would have continued to ex-
ist, even if they ceased to be Christian. Likewise, the institution we call the
church, in places, survives even after it has lost its reason for existence.
What would Paul say about our Christian churches and institutions that
sometimes become hotbeds of dysfunctional human relations? At times I have
rationalized my failure to invite non-Christian friends and neighbors to my
church with the truthful excuse, They have enough problems already! Are
there churches that need to declare a moratorium on evangelism until they
learn to love one another?
ii. Live by the Spirit (5:16-26)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
As in Gal 3:15; 4:1; and 5:2, But I say marks the beginning of a new sec-
tion in the letter (see Matera 1992, 199). Paul insisted that the inuence of the
Spirit creates Christian community (vv 16-18, 22-25). The inuence of the
Flesh creates unhealthy competition that destroys community (vv 19-21, 26).
In other words, we have here a deliberative argument for unity and concord,
not merely an adaptation of a typical virtue and vice catalog (Witherington
1998a, 389).
The divisive issue of circumcision threatened to destroy the Galatian
churches. The Agitators had distorted an issue of indifference ( 5:6; 6:15)
out of proportion to its importance. Paul wrote Galatians primarily to per-
suade his pagan converts not to become Jewish Christians by adopting cir-
cumcision.
Despite its irrelevance, circumcision represented an issue Paul could not
ignore. What the Galatians decided to do about circumcision would deter-
mine how they would move forward in their Christian lives. Would they at-
tempt to attain [their] goal by works of Law or by the Spirit ( 3:3)? Would
they be content to live according to the Fleshout of human resources alone?
Or, would they conduct their lives in total dependence on what only God
could do as they lived according to the Spirit (5:18)? They could not have it
both ways. Only by conducting their lives by the Spirit could they avoid letting
the desires of the Spirit determine their goal (v 16 NIV 2011).
The two ways of lifeFlesh and Spiritare in irreconcilable conict (v
17). Paul urged the Galatians to decide: Would they sustain their Christian
freedom (see vv 1, 13) by being led by the Spirit? Or, would they submit to
subservience to the Law (v 18; 4:5)? Only by letting the Spirit lead could
they achieve what they really desired (v 17).
The path the Galatians chose would determine the future moral out-
come of their lives. Only as the Spirit led could they expect to bear the fruit
of the Spirit (v 22). His fruit would sustain and enhance the quality of their
S
A
M
P
L
E
335
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:16
lives together. The Spirit, not Law, would empower them to live in law-abiding
ways (v 23). If they failed to decide for the Spirit, the inevitable results would
be the works of the Flesh (v 19). Whats more, by failing to submit to Gods
present rule by the Spirit, they would deny their heritage in Gods future
kingdom (v 21).
I N THE TEXT
(a) Either Spirit or Flesh (5:16-18)
L 16 To avoid the bleak future Paul feared would be theirs if they continued
on their current path toward self-destruction, he urged the Galatians to focus
their attention on the Spirit rather than the Flesh. He interjected himself into
the conversation with the introduction, I say (as in 1:9; 3:15, 17; 4:1; 5:2).
Mentioning himself maintained the conversational tone of the letter, avoiding
the formality of an ethical treatise.
Pauls central exhortation throughout vv 16-25 is simply: live by the
Spirit. The rest is elaboration on the positive implications of taking his advice
and the negative implications of failing to do so. Despite the identical English
expressions in vv 16 and 25, the Greek words are different. In v 16, his appeal,
in the imperative mood, is literally, you must walk by the Spirit. In v 25, his
conditional statement, in the indicative mood, is we live by the Spirit.
Verse 15 contains the only instance of the verb peripateo3 in Galatians.
Frequent elsewhere in Paul and other NT authors, following Jewish prece-
dents (Hebrew: ha3lak), the imagery of walking refers to the habitual ethical
conduct of ones life (see BDAG, 803, s.v. peripateo3 2; compare Rom 6:4; 8:4;
13:13; 14:15; 2 Cor 12:18). The dative case of the noun Spirit might identify
the Spirit as the instrumental basis for ethical living: Conduct yourselves in
the strength the Spirit provides. Or it might refer to the Spirit as the context
for Christian morality: Live your lives in the realm of the Spirit.
The translations Walk in the Spirit (vv 16 and 25 KJV), live in the
Spirit (v 25 KJV), and live by the Spirit (vv 16 and 25) leave Pauls meaning
as ambiguous in English as it is in Greek. This seems to be a self-conscious
adaptation and alteration of the OT exhortation to take the Law as ones way
of life (Exod 16:4; Lev 18:4; 1 Kgs 6:12; Jer 44:23; Ezek 5:67; T. Ash. 6:3; so
Witherington 1998a, 99). If so, Paul here reintroduced the implicit antithetic
contrast between Law and Spirit ( 3:10-13; 5:2-5).
The Spirit was the source of the Galatians Christian standing. The
Spirit entered their corporate experience when they believed the gospel (Gal
3:2-5, 14). He made them children of God (4:6); and he was the basis for their
future hope (5:5). Therefore, they should always allow his empowering pres-
ence to be manifested in the way they conducted themselves.
The verb gratify (carry out / fulll) is in the subjunctive mood. It might
be taken (as in the NIV) as the conclusion (apodosis) of an implicit conditional
S
A
M
P
L
E
336
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:16-17
sentence: If you live by the Spirit, then you will never gratify the desires of
the esh (see BDF, 184 365). But it is possible that Paul offered instead a
secondary exhortation: Live by the Spirit . . . and do not gratify the desires
of the esh (NRSV).
The root of the Greek verb here (telese3te) recalls the rhetorical question
in 3:3Having started with the Spirit, are you now ending [epiteleisthe] with
the esh? (NRSV). Did the Galatians imagine their human efforts could im-
prove on what Christ had already done? He does not think of life in the Spirit
as temptation-free.
Besides Gal 5:18, the only other Pauline instance of the expression led
by the Spirit is in Rom 8:14those who are led by the Spirit of God are sons
of God. Gods children may expect trials and suffering (Rom 8:17). Outside
Paul, Luke 4:1 alone uses this terminology, describing Jesus as led by the
Spirit in the desert to face temptation.
Pauls emphatic double-negative rejects the notion that one might actu-
ally achieve spiritual goals through the Flesh (5:16). The Greek verb trans-
lated gratify concerns goal-oriented behavior. Life in the Spirit was the means
of frustrating the selsh ends of the Flesh. So long as they followed the Spirit,
the Galatians would never follow through on what the Flesh desired (compare
Rom 13:14). Augustine notes that Paul did not say Walk in the Spirit so that
you will not have desires of the esh but so that you will not gratify them
(cited in Edwards 1999, 86).
The Flesh should not be taken to refer merely to base, sexual passions.
It may apply to something as innocent as the human drives to survive, to love,
and to be loved. The 1984 NIV translation of the Flesh as the sinful nature is
unjustied ( Gal 5:13). Human desire is not sinful. Nor is it always equated
with lust or covetousness. Nevertheless, desires, even legitimate ones, may
become sinful when they oppose what the Spirit wants.
The desires of the hearts of those who reject God (Rom 1:24) are as sin-
ful as misdirected desire of the Flesh. The desires of the mortal body may be
enslaving (6:12). The hearts and bodies of Christians are not intrinsically evil.
But they, like the Flesh, may be used for sinful ends. Life in the Spirit allows
Christians to avoid doing what they do not really want to do. They need not
be hapless victims of eshly desires.
L 17 Paul explained the reason why the Galatians needed to conduct their
lives by the Spirit (v 16). The Flesh desires against the Spirit; and the
Spirit, against the Flesh. The present tense verb desires in the rst clause is
from the same cognate family as the noun desire in v 16. The second clause
lacks an explicit verb. But the ellipsis clearly presumes the verb desires.
Stoic philosophy held that freedom was secured not by fullling ones
desires, but by removing them (Epictetus, Diatr. 4.1.175). Buddhism identies
desire as the source of all human suffering. But Paul did not consider desires
(v 16) to be the human problem. Nor did he consider freedom from desire
S
A
M
P
L
E
337
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:17-18
the human ideal. After all, the divine Spirit desires. Our problem as fallen
humans is that we desire what is contrary to Gods desires for us. But what do
Spirit-lled believers desire?
Humans cannot be neutral about the competing desires of the Flesh and
the Spirit. Paul explained why Christians must take sides: The Flesh and the
Spirit are in confict with each other. It is not that the Spirit and the Flesh
are combatants in an ongoing metaphorical battle within the human psyche.
Pauls simple point was that Flesh and Spirit are opposites: these things are in
opposition to each other (BDAG, 88).
It is unclear whether Paul explained the purpose or the result of this
antithesis. Would failing to live by the Spirit (v 16) lead to unintended con-
sequences? Would the unresolved tension between the opponents Flesh and
Spirit result in moral stalemate: so that you do not do what you want? Or, did
the ongoing opposition somehow serve a divine purpose?to prevent you
from doing what you want (NRSV).
Interpreters disagree as to whether what you want is bad or good. But
if the words desires (v 16) and wants (v 17) are synonymous; and if Paul re-
ferred to the desires of Christians (Betz 1979, 281), the Spirit surely inspires
wholesome moral strivings and yearnings, not baser impulses (Cole 1989,
211).
Whether Paul thought of the nal clause in v 17 as a purpose or a result,
the antithesis of Flesh and Spirit had implications for the Galatians: You may
not do whatever you want to do on your own. Romans 7:7-24 emphasizes the
total inadequacy of moralism as a solution to the human problem. It is impos-
sible to fulll Gods Law through human effort. But 8:1-16 emphasizes that
overwhelming victory over sin has been achieved by Christ. Believers may
participate in his victory as they live in the Spirit (8:1-4). Galatians 5:16-17
makes much the same point: The Spirit defeats the Flesh, empowering, but
not coercing, Christians to do the will of God (see Mussner 1977, 377-78).
L 18 Paul essentially equated walking by the Spirit with fullling the Spirits
desires (v 16), being led by the Spirit (v 18), living by the Spirit, and keeping
in step with the Spirit (v 25). The rst-class conditional construction, But if
you are led by the Spirit, assumes the truth of both the protasis (Burton 1898,
102; Longenecker 1990, 246) and apodosis: Since you are being led by the
Spirit, you are not under law ( 2:15-16; 3:13, 23-25; 4:5, 21).
The Spirit is more than an invisible reservoir of power enabling Chris-
tian obedience. The Spirit, not the Law ( 5:23), is the Lord who leads by
determining how Christians ought to live. Being led by the Spirit not only
entails refusing to live by desires of the Flesh (v 17) but also implies that you
are not under law (v 18; 4:24).
Christians are not free to do whatever the Flesh desires. To be led by
the Spirit is to be guided by an inwardly motivated and empowered desire to
obey God. As in the promise held out by the prophets Ezekiel (11:19-20) and
S
A
M
P
L
E
338
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:16-18
Jeremiah (31:3), the gift of the Holy Spirit means that Gods people no longer
need the outward code of the Law to tell them what to do and not do ( Gal
5:22).
Galatians 5:18 is the last of the ve instances of the expression under law
in Galatians ( 3:23; 4:4, 5, 21). Romans 6:14-15 describes being under law
as the antithesis of being under grace. Those under law mistakenly imagine
they may enter and sustain a right relationship with God on the basis of hu-
man effort alone ( Gal 4:15). But this is precisely what it means to attempt
to live according to the Flesh.
In Galatians, both Flesh and Law are personied surrogates for the issue
of circumcision ( 4:12). Being led by the Spirit is the alternative to being
circumcised. Circumcision, as a requirement of the Law, was concerned only
with maintaining eshly distinctionswhether one was a Jew or a Gentile. As
the opponents of the Spirit, neither Flesh nor Law could enable the Galatians
to achieve the spiritual ends they desired (5:17d).
Flesh, Sin, and Law had conspired to use circumcision to enslave human-
ity. In Galatians, Paul did not explain the nature of their sinister collaboration,
as he would later in Romans. The antithesis of Spirit and law (v 18) anticipates
the theo-logic Paul would fully explicate only later in Rom 78.
v
FROM THE TEXT
Christians want to do what pleases God. But apart from the Spirit, we
are too weak to follow through and actually do it. We must take sides. We
must choose our master. Neutrality is impossible. We must align ourselves
with the Spirit and against the Flesh. Left unresolved, the human body is a
battleeld on which the powers of the esh and the Spirit ght against each
other, so that the human will is disabled from carrying out its intentions
(Betz 1979, 280-81).
God never intended the Christian life to be a never-ending, losing battle.
He longs to set us free from slavery and stalematea forever frustrating cycle
of short-lived successes and serious failures. Paul did not consider the Spirit
and the Flesh to be evenly matched inuences in the lives of Christians and
Christian communities (Matera 192, 202; Witherington 1998a, 394). Since
we live by the Spirit (v 16), divine power will triumph over human weakness!
This is a Wesleyan reading of a passage that has been one of the clas-
sic battlegrounds on which Wesleyan and Reformed interpreters have crossed
swords. Interpretive ambiguity here cannot be resolved without appeal to oth-
er Pauline letters. Exegetical decisions concerning Gal 5:16-17 often tell more
about a commentators prior theological commitments than about the passage
(for a Reformed reading, see Dunn 1993, 297-300).
An incurable optimism of grace persuades Wesleyans that the Christian
life may be victorious. Reformed interpreters generally dismiss such claims as
Pelagian. But Wesleyans reject such accusations, insisting that victory is pos-
S
A
M
P
L
E
339
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:16-18
sible only so long as Christians keep in step with the Spirit (v 25). This is
always the Spirits triumph, not the Christians. This is entirely of grace, not
works. Neoplatonic dualism, not Paul, leads Reformed interpreters to the pes-
simistic conclusion that, in this life, believers must remain at once sinners and
justied. Wesleyans are persuaded that holiness of heart and life are possibili-
ties of grace here and now.
Pauls later letter to the Romans, particularly his discussion of the di-
vided self in Rom 7:14-25 (see Greathouse and Lyons 2008a, 216), provides a
helpful commentary on Gal 5:16-18. But since its interpretation is disputed,
we must guard against allowing a later letter too much inuence on our read-
ing of Galatians (Barclay 1988, 113). That said, a pessimistic view of what is
normalan existence forever foiled by a divided willis entirely inconsistent
with Pauls description of the Spirit-lled life in Rom 8.
Paul never suggested there was something innately sinful about substan-
tial matter, nor righteous about intangible spirit. Scripture refers to evil spirits
and rebellious angels as well as the Holy Spirit and angelic spirits in the service
of God.
What God has already done in Christ offers humanity a way out of re-
bellion against God and its fatal consequences. Christians are not doomed to
endure a life of perennial defeat or deadlock, resolved only at the end of time,
when God nally delivers us from awed bodies of esh that were our undoing
before ( Gal 1:4 on rescue . . . from the present evil age).
The Christian hope is the resurrection of the body, not the abandonment
of creaturely existence. If, in 5:16-17, Paul had claimed that the Flesh con-
stantly defeated or deadlocked the Spirit, he would have had no argument for
walking in the Spirit (Witherington 1998a, 395).
Christians are not helpless pawns in an inner conict. It is true that what
unredeemed humanity (Flesh) wants and what God (Spirit) wants are antitheti-
cal. But thanks to the coming of Christ, Christians have been redeemed, freed
from their former slavery ( 4:4). The grip of Flesh and Law has been broken.
Competing desires no longer result in moral stalemate for Christians who:
live by the Spirit (5:25),
walk by the Spirit (v 16 ESV),
are led by the Spirit (v 18), and
keep in step with the Spirit (v 25).
The Spirit-lled Christian life is not a never-ending struggle between
the forces of Flesh and Spirit. Paul presented the table of contrasts between
the works of the esh (NRSV) in vv 19-21 and the fruit of the Spirit in vv 22-
23 ( 4:25) to urge his audience to align themselves with the Spirit.
Paul claimed in v 17 that the unresolved tension between the Flesh and
the Spirit meant that you do not do what you want. Interpreters suggest several
possible implications of this:
S
A
M
P
L
E
340
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:19-23
Conicted: Christians live conicted lives with contradictory desires.
We will remain at once justied and sinners. Our Spirit-inspired de-
sires to please God are short-circuited by inescapable eshly desires to
do whatever they please (so Longenecker 1990, 245-46).
Neutral: Whether believers want to fulll the desires of the Flesh or
the desires of the Spirit, they will be stymied. The Flesh compromises
their noble ends. And the Spirit prevents their ignoble ends. On such
a vicious treadmill, no real change or growth should be expected. Our
every step forward is matched by a step back.
Changed: Believers may choose to live according to the Spirit or ac-
cording to the Flesh. But we cannot fulll opposing desires simultane-
ously. If we submit to the Spirit, we will be progressively sanctied
and nally saved (see Rom 6:11-23). But if we choose to live according
to the Flesh, we will inevitably return to our pre-Christian slavery, fall
from grace, be alienated from Christ, and be nally lost (Gal 4:8-11;
5:1-5).
(b) Works of the Flesh vs. Fruit of the Spirit (5:19-23)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
In 5:19-26 Paul explained and contrasted the different outcomes of liv-
ing on the basis of the Flesh and living by the Spirit. In vv 19-21 he described
some of the more obvious behavioral expressions of living out of human re-
sources alone. Paul referred to these as works of the esh (v 19 NRSV).
Similar lists occur elsewhere in nearly contemporary Judaism (e.g., Wis
14:25-26; 4 Macc 1:26-27; 2:15; Qumran: 1QS 4.9-11; Philo, Sacrices 32; 2
En. 10:4-5) and elsewhere in the NT (Matt 15:19; Mark 7:21-22; Rom 1:29-
31; 13:13; 1 Cor 5:9-11; 6:9-10; 2 Cor 12:20-21; Eph 4:31-32; 5:3-5; Col
3:5-9; 1 Tim 1:9-10; 6:4; 2 Tim 3:2-5; Titus 3:3; 1 Pet 2:1; 4:3; Rev 9:21) and
in other early Christian literature (e.g., 1 Clem. 30:1; 35:5; Did. 5:1-2; Barn.
20:1-2).
Scholars have traditionally (but imprecisely) identied these as lists of
vices and virtues. Paul referred to them as outcomes of the respective inu-
ences of the personied power of the Flesh vs. the Spirit. He transformed
these lists into something fundamentally differentmarks of a community
under the sway of the Flesh contrasted with marks of a community under the
leading of the Spirit (Martyn 1997, 499; see 532-36).
The scribes who added adultery and murders to the works of the
Flesh in Gal 5:19-21 reect the misunderstanding of it as a general catalog
of vices to avoid (compare Mark 7:21-22; Longenecker 1990, 248). In fact,
Paul drew selectively from traditional material (see Witherington 1998a, 407)
those social sins that were particularly relevant to the divisive situation in
Galatia ( Gal 5:15; Matera 1992, 210; Witherington 1998a, 391-94). In vv
S
A
M
P
L
E
341
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:19
I N THE TEXT
L 24 For Those who belong to Christ Jesus, we would say simply Christians,
a term that never appears in Pauls letters (Christianos: Acts 11:26; 26:28; 1
Pet 4:16). Christians have crucied the esh with its passions and desires
(NRSV). Paul used forms of the verb crucify ten times in his letters (in Rom 6:6
and Gal 2:19 [with the syn- prex]; 1 Cor 1:13, 23; 2:2, 8; 2 Cor 13:4; Gal
3:1; 5:24; and 6:14). This is one of the four gurative uses (Rom 6:6; Gal
2:19; 5:24; 6:14).
Here, unlike 2:19 and 6:14, Christians are described not as the objects
but as the agents of this crucixion (Barclay 1988, 117). Believers have not
literally crucied the Flesh. To have done so would have rendered them all
physically dead. But to become a Christian is to identify with Christ so com-
pletely as to be dead to our old lives (Gorman 2001, 14).
The aorist tense of the verb probably alludes to the Galatians conver-
sions and baptisms. Baptism ritually reenacts incorporation into Christs death
(Rom 6:4; see Gal 3:27). It publicly demonstrates the end of the old self-
centered way of living and initiation into the new cross-shaped people of God.
To crucify the Flesh is to refuse to gratify the desires of the Flesh by
living by the Spirit (see v 16). The conict of Flesh vs. Spirit (v 17) does not
leave Christians in constant inner turmoil, tossed between crippling, contra-
dictory desires. God in Christ has made liberation from the old slavery to sin
possible. The Spirit enables Gods redeemed people to live in obedience to
God. The active voice of the verb crucied emphasizes that believers assume
personal responsibility to put an end to the rule of Flesh over their conduct.
This is much the same point Paul made in Rom 6, when he moved from
the indicative of salvation to the imperative of sanctication. There he urged
Christians to present themselves to God as instruments of righteousness for
the purpose of holiness. God sancties only those who let him.
Christians have been made alive by the Spirit (Gal 5:25). So, it seems
logical that they should make a self-conscious choice to live exclusively for the
Spirit. Christians have turned their backs on their old way of life, so that the
struggle between Flesh and Spirit is potentially behind them. But conversion
is only the beginning of the Christian life. Thus, the aorist verb have crucied
may have an inceptive force (Bligh 1969, 205). That is, we must continue to
do what we have only begunto reject the rule of the Flesh and sustain our
surrender to the sovereignty of the Spirit.
In 6:14, Paul reiterated his personal point on a universal scale: Through
[the cross of our Lord Jesus Christ] the world has been crucied to me, and
I to the world. The perfect tense emphasizes the ongoing demand to remain
with Christ on the cross ( 6:14; 2:20). Christians live under a new sover-
eign. We are no longer slaves to the Flesh. But we must continuously choose to
keep in step with the Spirit (5:25).
S
A
M
P
L
E
358
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:24-25
The need for ongoing Christian vigilance ( 5:1) is not due to a de-
ciency on Gods part or a awed conversion. The crucixion of the Flesh was
complete (Burton 1920, 319). Liberated from preoccupation with ourselves,
we crucied the passions and desires of the Flesh. All vestiges of our old lives
under its sovereignty have been eliminated. The terms passions and desires
here are synonyms (Kremer 1990, 1).
The word pathe3ma, passions, usually means suffering in Pauls letters
(Rom 8:18; 2 Cor 1:5, 6, 7; Col 1:24; 2 Tim 3:11; BDAG, 747). Galatians
5:24 and Rom 7:5 are the only exceptions. Here it has the force of an inward
experience of an affective nature, feeling, interest . . . in a bad sense (BDAG,
747). Thus, it has the same negative force as lusts in Rom 1:26; Col 3:5; and
1 Thess 4:5.
The word desires translates epithymiais. Not all desires are wrong (see
Ps 119:20; Isa 58:2; Phil 1:23; 1 Tim 3:1). But the clear association here of
desires with the Flesh (as in Gal 5:16; Rom 13:14; Eph 2:3) suggests that it
refers to forbidden or excessive desirescovetousness (Exod 20:17; Rom 7:7-
8; see Rom 6:12).
Stoics considered epithymiai beastly passions that needed to be subdued
(Jewett 2008, 448). Similarly, most Jews in Pauls day considered covetous-
ness the root sin, the original sin of Adam and Eve in the garden (see 4 Macc
2:6; 2 Esd [4 Ezra] 3:20-26; 4:30-31; Apoc. Mos. 17:1-2; 19:3; Apoc. Abr.
24:10; Jas 1:15). It can express itself as the arrogant human drive for self-asser-
tion, self-exaltation, and self-rule (see Rom 8:6-7; Isa 14:12-14), the perverse
aspiration to dethrone the Creator and enthrone the creature (Rom 1:18-25).
The Flesh may manifest itself as self-idolatry. But it may also express
itself as unhealthy dependencies on other people or things instead of God. If
we belong to Christ, the crucied Flesh in all its perverse forms must be given
a decent burial.
L 25 This sentence is a rst-class, real condition. If (NRSV) begins the sen-
tence. But, in Pauls mind, the protasis (condition) did not state an uncertain-
ty. The conjunction also in the apodosis (conclusion clause) indicates that
the two clauses are not in any kind of tension. Therefore, the NIV translation
is justied: Since we live by the Spirit. This was the present and ongoing expe-
rience of all Christians: we are being made alive.
Paul began this major section of the letter in v 16 with the exhortation:
live by the Spirit. Despite the identical English translations, the Greek verbs
in vv 16 and 25 are different. In v 18, Paul urged the Galatians to walk by
the Spirit. That is, they were to conduct their moral lives through the Holy
Spirit. In v 18, he referred to being led by the Spirit. In the present passage,
he emphasized that the Spirit was the constant source of the life of Christians.
In Galatians (2:14, 19, 20; 3:11, 12) and often in Romans, Paul used the
verb zao3 interchangeably with the verbs walk, lead, and live (see Rom
6:13; 8:1, 4, 9, 11, 12, 13, 14). Because the Spirit has made us alive, he urged,
S
A
M
P
L
E
359
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:25-26
let us keep in step with [stoicho3men] the Spirit. The hortatory subjunctive
includes Paul with his audience in this call to ongoing activity. Persuaded that
his appeal had succeeded, Paul used the present tense to imply that all the
Galatians were already following the Spirit: Let us continue to keep in step
with the Spirit.
Paul may have intended to do no more than remind his audience that
Christians should follow the Spirit (BDAG, 946). It is unclear whether the
Galatians heard the military imagery in his call to line up ( BEHIND
THE TEXT) any more than most English speakers are aware of the coarse
origins of the military acrostic that has entered everyday speech in the word
snafu. He urged the Galatians to align their behavior with the Spirits leader-
shipto agree with the Spirit and with one another.
The rst person plural verb emphasizes that this was not just a personal
matter. Paul invited the entire community to join him (and other Christians)
in a corporate commitment to follow the Spirits lead. They were to get on the
same page with one another and the Spirit (to shift to a modern metaphor).
Paul warned the Galatians to abandon their divisiveness and bitter in-
ghting (Gal 5:15). In v 26, he again suggested that their competitiveness was
not only unseemly but out-of-line with the life of the Spirit. Mutual agree-
ment is the main concern in every NT instance of the verb stoicheo3 (Plmacher
1990, 278). To make his appeal, Paul employed deliberative rhetoric to call for
unity in a divisive situation (see Mitchell 1991, 60-64).
L 26 This verse might be considered the conclusion to vv 16-26 (Arichea and
Nida 1976, 143) or the introduction to 5:266:5 (as in the REB). Perhaps, here
as elsewhere, Paul constructed a smooth transition from one section of the
letter to the next ( 5:1).
The positive appeal for the Galatians to agree with one another in the
Spirit in v 25 is matched by the negative appeal (another hortatory subjunc-
tive) in v 26. Pauls central request was: Let us not become conceited or boast-
ful (BDAG, 538). The Greek adjective combines empty and glory.
Within the Bible the word doxa generally refers to the radiance of the di-
vine glory. But in compound it has its secular Greek meaning: notion, opinion,
judgment (LSJ, 444). Pauls rejection of boasting was a matter of principle:
May I never boast of anything except the cross of our Lord Jesus Christ
(NRSV; Gal 6:14a; compare Phil 2:3; 4 Macc 2:15).
Paul supplemented his negative plea not to become boastful with two
adverbial participles. They may add two secondary appeals: Let us not pro-
voke one another and let us not envy one another. The reciprocal pronoun
one another appears twice. Boasting sets in motion an escalating and self-
destructive cycle of provocation by one group and envy by the other.
Paul failed to specify what might have been the perceived good that
some might have become conceited about. Did someone in the community
receive circumcision and appeal to it as a basis for claiming spiritual superior-
S
A
M
P
L
E
360
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:26
6:10
ity? Did his act and boasting about it provoke others to envy his status as a true
Jew? This educated guess connects this threat to the communities well-being
to the central concern of the letter. But Pauls exhortation is far too general to
be certain.
In the opening chapters of 1 Corinthians, Paul attempted to undermine
Corinthian claims to superior wisdom and spiritual maturity by appealing to
the message of the cross. In Gal 6:1-5, his exhortations immediately follow-
ing this one, he may have had something similar in mind. But we are reading
anothers mail. The Galatians rsthand knowledge of the specic events that
prompted the letter allowed them to take for granted a good deal that remains
ambiguous to later readers.
Did fallen transgressors envy the supposedly spiritual crowd? Did the
spiritual imagine they were beyond temptation ( 6:1)? Would the Galatians
have considered transgressors those who received circumcision or those who re-
fused it? Did those who thought they were something only deceive themselves
(v 3) by making inappropriate comparisons with others? Did some boast: Im a
circumcised son of Abraham and you are not? Or, was it vice versa?
v
FROM THE TEXT
Much remains uncertain in Gal 5:24-26. We can claim with certainty
only that Paul fundamentally challenged some of the underlying assumptions
and practices of his culture, while afrming its other more noble aspirations
as among the fruit of the Spirit. It required serious theological reection and
inspired discernment to decide which were which. Paul sincerely believed that
life in the Spirit could overturn deeply engrained cultural assumptions about
the way things were and the way they ought to be. Circumcision and submission
to the Law were supercial solutions to such complex challenges. Paul recom-
mended looking beyond anything mere human beings could do in their own
strength to the transforming work only the Spirit of God could accomplish.
c. More Advice (5:266:10)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
A plausible case can be made for reading this entire section as related
to the nancial concern that becomes overt in v 6. Chrysostom took all of vv
6-10 as encouraging material aid to fellow believers (cited in Witherington
1998a, 418-19). Strelan (1975) identies ten terms frequently used in antiqui-
ty referring to nancial matters in vv 1-10 (accepted by Witherington 1998a,
418-19; rejected by Young 1977).
Nevertheless, it seems more likely that Paul referred to two different but
related expressions of keeping in step with the Spirit (5:25). Both called for
sharing. In 5:266:5 he urged the spiritual to share in the failures of their
fellow believers by gently restoring them and helping them bear the weight
S
A
M
P
L
E
361
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:26
6: 5
of their weaknesses. In 6:6-10, he urged the nancially able to share all good
things with those in need. In both passages, Paul called attention to the mu-
tual benets of sharing and the disadvantages of not sharing.
i. Fullling the Law of Christ (5:266:5)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
This section consists of a series of six commands with supplementary
comments:
A transitional hortatory subjunctive, which concludes the previous (
5:24-26) and introduces the present unit (5:266:5): Let us not be-
come conceited, provoking and envying each other (5:26).
The apodosis (conclusion) of a conditional sentence: You spiritual
people must restore (v 1a).
An imperatival adverbial participle. Its imperatival force arises from
its circumstantial relationship with the explicit imperative: You must
watch yourself (v 1b).
Another second person plural imperative: Carry each others burdens
(v 2).
A third person singular imperative: Each one should test (v 4).
A future indicative with an imperatival force (as in 5:14): You will
love your neighbor as yourself.
I N THE TEXT
L 26 ( 5:24-26)
L 1 Paul again directly addressed his audience as Brothers and sisters (see
1:11; 3:15; 4:12, 28, 31; 5:11; 6:18). Only in 1 and 2 Thessalonians are per-
sonal interactions more frequent.
The concessive clause refers to the rhetorical possibility of a Christian
falling into sin. Pauls grammar suggests that this was highly improbable (Bur-
ton 1898, 115): Even if . . . (not a near certainty [Longenecker 1990, 273]:
Whenever . . . ).
The protasis resembles the form of mis]pa3t[|<m, case laws, which dominate
Exod 21:122:16 in the LXX. This if-then construction, which originated in
ancient Near Eastern casuistic legislation, seems particularly unexpected in a
letter noted for its negative assessment of Law. Here, the protasis described
a hypothetical situation in which someone might commit an unspecied sin.
The apodosis (then) clause offered guidance as to how to respond.
Paul presented the hypothetical scenario: a person might be caught in
some sin. The subject could refer to any human being. But surely he applied
this to some member of the community, some Christian. Otherwise, there
would be no need for the condition. After all, unbelievers routinely trans-
gressed as a matter of course (e.g., Rom 4:25; 5:16, 20). But this was an un-
S
A
M
P
L
E
362
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:1
expected, extraordinary incident. Apparently, Christians might normally be
expected not to be transgressors.
The verb prolambano3, is caught, refers to detecting something by sur-
prise (BDAG, 872). In this hypothetical scenario, the aorist tense refers not
to some past event, but (as in Exod 2122) to any future occurrence: If some
Christian should ever be detected in some sin. The passive voice probably in-
dicates that the transgressor was taken off guard, only retrospectively realizing
he or she had sinned unwittingly or inadvertently. The lapse was unexpected
and unintended (Burton 1920, 325-26). Augustine considered it a sin of igno-
rance or inrmity (cited in Edwards 1999, 92).
The passive voice might indicate, however, that Christians unexpectedly
witnessed another Christian transgress. Perhaps Paul referred to one of the
sins listed in Gal 5:19-21 (so Betz 1979, 296). They caught him or her in the
act, but the detection of the misstep was accidental. It was not the result of
surveillance or entrapment (contrast 2:4).
The abstract noun parapto3 mati originated in the imagery of one making a
false step so as to lose footing. In the Bible transgression refers to a violation
of moral standards, offense, wrongdoing, sin (BDAG, 770). Here it refers to
a specic sinful actan offense against God, as opposed to, hamartia, sin con-
ceived as a personied, controlling power (Wolter 1990b, 33). A transgres-
sion was a violation of law (Witherington 1998a, 421).
Of the sixteen Pauline occurrences of parapto3ma, six are in Rom 5:15-20,
referring to humanitys original fall into sin. The cognate verb, parapipto3, fall,
in Heb 6:6 refers to apostasya total rejection of Christ and the church. This
was Pauls worst fear for the Galatians ( Gal 5:4 for ekpipto3, fall from).
The word tempted hints that the fallen Christian had yielded to some
overwhelming temptation or in the midst of some difcult trial. In Gal 6:1
parapto3ma appears to be used with a meaning that is distinctly weaker than
that of hamartia, in the sense of a lapse that does not exclude one from the
community (see Pss. Sol. 3:7; 13:5, 10; Wolter 1990b, 34). The indenite
adjective some leaves the precise character of the sin totally ambiguous. Any
wrongdoing would sufce. It seems unlikely that Paul thought of this hypo-
thetical sin as threatening a nal loss of salvation (as in Heb 6:6; 2 Pet 3:17).
In Rev 2:5, the risen Christ promised even the seriously fallen restora-
tion, if they would repent. Paul considered it the responsibility of the stand-
ing to care for the fallen; the fallen could not restore themselves.
It seems reasonable to assume that Paul used this example because:
Something like this scenario had already occurred in at least one of
the Galatian communities and it was not treated as the apostle advised
here.
Something like this had occurred in one of the other churches he had
planted, perhaps even in the place from which he wrote Galatians.
And / or
S
A
M
P
L
E
363
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:1
Paul considered something like this likely to happen in one of the Ga-
latian communities in the future.
The apodosis (conclusion clause), as usual, employs no Greek equivalent
for then. Unlike the precedent in OT case law, Paul directly addressed his
audience with an explicit you plural. Since Greek verbs do not require nomi-
native forms of any pronoun, this you is emphatic. The pronoun is unexpected
with an imperative verb. Of the 219 second person plural imperatives in Pauls
letters, the only close analogy is 1 Cor 10:15.
Emphatic personal pronouns usually stand in contrast to another person:
you vs. someone else, here the fallen brother or sister. The demonstrative such
a one (Gal 6:1 NRSV) refers to the fallen Christian in a gender-neutral way.
The explicit pronoun requires a translation something like: you who are
spiritual should restore such a person. But this is not prudential advice; it is a
command: restore! It is possible that the antecedent of you referred only to an
elite minority among the Galatians (see Schmithals 1972, 46-51). But else-
where in the letter, you addressed everyone ( 4:21 and 5:4 are exceptions).
If by spiritual Paul referred to all who had the Spirit, his you was inclusive of
all the Galatian Christians (see 3:2-5, 14; 4:6, 29; 5:5, 16-18, 22-23, 25; 6:8;
Longenecker 1990, 273; Witherington 1998a, 422).
This is the only instance of the adjective pneumatikos, spiritual, in Ga-
latians. Elsewhere in Paul, it is used as a substantive (1 Cor 2:15 is the only
exception). The substantives in 1 Corinthians, the wise (1:20), the mature
(2:6), and the spiritual, seem to have been arrogant Corinthian self-desig-
nations, which Paul used only ironically (see 1 Cor 3:14:20). Would Paul
have surrounded the spiritual in Gal 6:1 with scare-quotes, had he written
in contemporary English? This convention would have alerted his readers that
he used the expression with serious reservations. Perhaps they were not as
spiritual as they imagined themselves (Schlier 1965, 270).
Betz (1979, 296-97), however, insists: There is no hesitation or irony
in Pauls use of this loaded term, and we have every reason to believe that the
Galatians themselves approved of it and used it as a self-designation. The title
bets them best because of Pauls constant emphasis upon the Spirit (pneuma)
which they possess. If he used the expression sincerely, it allowed him to
distinguish those who did not fall into sin from the one who fellyou who are
spiritual vs. such a one (NRSV). The previous section of the letter had urged
the Galatians to
walk in the Spirit (5:16),
be led by the Spirit (v 18),
evidence the fruit of the Spirit (v 22),
live by the Spirit (v 25), and
keep in step with the Spirit (v 25).
What more appropriate designation might be assigned those who heeded
Pauls appeal than the spiritual?
S
A
M
P
L
E
364
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:1
Of course, we must not forget all the reservations sounded throughout
the letter about the threatened spiritual well-being of some of Pauls readers.
But this is, after all, an entirely hypothetical scenario. Anyone who might fall
was to be restored.
The imperative verb katartizete, restore, means to cause to be in a con-
dition to function well, put in order (BDAG, 526). In the Gospels (Matt
4:21; Mark 1:19) it describes the cleaning, mending, [and] folding together
of shermens nets (BDAG, 526). In 1 Thess 3:10, it describes Pauls plans to
provide what was missing in his Thessalonian converts faith. In 1 Cor 1:10 the
verb refers to the changes the Corinthians needed to make to become a united
community. The cognate noun katartisis in 2 Cor 13:9 gures in Pauls prayer
report: our prayer is for your perfection. That is, he prayed that the Corin-
thians might be equipped to live as mature believers (see 2 Pet 1:3-11). In Heb
13:21 and 1 Pet 5:10 the verb described the process by which weak Christian
communities became strong.
Paul described what the Galatian communities were to do should a
Christian brother or sister ever fall into sin. The responsibility of the rest of
the community was to do whatever was required to lift to their feet those who
fall and set them in the right direction. The goal was to enable them to walk
as Christians again.
Paul added an adverbial prepositional phrase to make clear in what man-
ner this restorative process was to be carried out: restore such a one in a
spirit of gentleness (NRSV; emphasis added). The word spirit here is the same
Greek term used to refer to the divine Spirit elsewhere in Galatians. Greek
did not utilize capital letters to distinguish references to the Third Person of
the Holy Trinity from a persons inner attitude or disposition intended here
( 6:18).
Gentleness was listed as the eighth fruit of the Spirit in 5:23 ().
The spiritual members of the community were to restore the fallen one in
a manner betting his or her unique situation. To restore each one gently
meant that there was no one-size-ts-all approach to such situations. A gentle
approach recognizes the need to adapt the medicine to the patient and the
disease. This is not a call for the kid glove treatment. Not all fallen sinners
are equally fragile. The physicians of the soul, if they are spiritual, discern the
appropriate approach to each situation.
Paul added a signicant caution by way of an adverbial participle of at-
tendant circumstance: But watch yourself, or you also may be tempted. The
adversative conjunction But is demanded in English if the force of the parti-
ciple is imperatival. It has no basis in Greek. The NIV translation depends on
the reasonable assumption that the participle supplements the leading com-
mand and has the same force. Other interpretations are possible.
Paul clearly urged the spiritual to pay careful attention to (BDAG, 931)
their own potential for failure. They were not to be more scrupulous about
S
A
M
P
L
E
365
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:1-2
the conduct of others than their own. A failure to watch themselves would
result in the spiritual being tempted to sin themselves. Self-examination was
needed to prevent unpleasant consequences (BDAG, 642; see Arichea and
Nida 1976, 146).
The emphatic second person singular pronoun you and the reexive
pronoun yourself narrow the focus of Pauls caution. He no longer addressed
Brothers and sisters and you [plural] that are spiritual, but a single addressee.
Did Paul address only a specic leader he knew had dealt harshly with a fallen
believer? Or, was this shift in pronouns intended merely to make the warning
more personal? No individual is exempt from the need for self-examination.
Whatever the precise connection between not watching oneself and be-
ing tempted, Paul equated transgression and temptation (as in 1 Thess 3:5). If
tempted conveys the proper force of the verb, the question remains: Tempted
to do what? It may mean being tempted to do the same sin, but more likely
it means to be tempted to see oneself as superior. . . . There is a temptation
to develop self-righteousness and arrogance with regard to the wrongdoer
(Stutzman 2008, 235). In Gal 6:3 and 4 Paul warned against the dangers to
community well-being presented by vain conceit and competitiveness.
In 1 Cor 10:9, Paul identied peirasmos, temptation or testing, as the
common lot of all humans. In 7:5 he warned married couples to avoid pro-
longed conjugal abstinence so that Satan will not tempt you because of your
lack of self-control. Christians were not exempt from temptation. But Paul
apparently believed that certain situations increased the intensity of tempta-
tion and Christians vulnerability to it (see 1 Tim 6:9).
It seems doubtful that Paul considered it as serious to be tempted to
sin as to yield and actually sin. Nonetheless, temptation should not be taken
lightly. Christians may fall victim to temptation and be lost, because testing
is accompanied by burdening, risk, uncertainty, and even danger. Positively, a
test can be a proof of ones faithfulness; negatively, an enticement to failure
(Popkes 1990c, 65).
Perhaps, Paul paraphrased Jesus warning: Do not judge, or you too will
be judged. For in the same way you judge others, you will be judged, and with
the measure you use, it will be measured to you (Matt 7:1-2 || Luke 6:37).
On this interpretation, the verb peirazo3 has the force of test (as in Gal 4:14; 1
Cor 10:9; 2 Cor 13:5).
This interpretation treats Pauls warning as prudential wisdom: Watch
yourself; you too might be tested. To test is not to entice to do evil. Those who
criticize others inevitably make themselves more vulnerable to criticism from
others. Augustine claimed there was no surer test of the spiritual person than
his treatment of anothers sin (cited in Edwards 1999, 93).
L 2 Pauls second explicit command resumed the second person plural, ad-
dressing the entire community. He no longer hinted of any distinction be-
tween the spiritual (Gal 6:1) and others. Carry each others burdens. The
S
A
M
P
L
E
366
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:2
reciprocal pronoun of one another emphasizes the mutuality needed to fulll
Pauls request. Each person must carry the burdens of each other person in
the church. Burden carrying was not the task of leaders or the strong alone.
Everyones help was enlisted. And no one was exempted from the need for
assistance.
Burdens are literally weights. In the NT a burden always has the meta-
phorical force of an experience of someth[ing] that is particularly oppressive
(BDAG, 167). If Pauls commands in vv 1-5 are related, burdens must refer to
the universal human vulnerability to temptation, testing, and transgression.
To bear the burdens of others is to support and sustain one another. All carry
the weight of their own weaknesses (v 5) and must endure the hardships of
helping others do so (see Rom 15:1; BDAG, 171, s.v. bastazo3).
In about half its appearances in the Pauline corpus, burden-bearing re-
fers euphemistically to nancial burdens (see, e.g., 1 Thess 2:5-9; 2 Thess
3:8; 2 Cor 12:16). The context makes this quite possible here (Witherington
1998a, 423). To bear one anothers burdens was a fulllment of the Law of
Christ because it amounted to taking up ones cross and following the pattern
of Christs life and also heeding his teaching about self-sacricial behavior
(Witherington 1998a, 425).
The next phrase might describe the future consequences of burden-
bearing: and in this way you will fulfll the law of Christ. Future indicative
verbs often have the imperatival force of commandments. Thus, Paul may
have ordered (see Gal 6:5): fulll the law of Christ in this way.
Pauls only clues as to what might be the law of Christ are its associations
with carrying one anothers burdens. None of the Gospels reports a saying
of Jesus resembling this. Did Paul refer to an agraphaan oral tradition that
never made it into a written Gospel?
More likely Paul simply referred back to burden-bearing as a tangible
expression of the love command in 5:14. If so, he referred to Jesus great com-
mandment as the law of Christ. Jesus elevated the obscure command in Lev
19:18 to a position of prominence as the corollary to the great command-
mentto love God without reservation (Matt 22:34-40 || Mark 12:28-34;
Luke 10:25-27). Jesus did not invent the command to love ones neighbors
as oneself. But he did assign it an importance it lacked in then contemporary
Judaism ( Gal 5:14). Thus, the designation law of Christ seems appropriate.
The verb fulfll, anaple3ro3, appears four more times in Pauls letters (1
Cor 14:16; 16:17; Phil 2:30; 2 Thess 2:16). But it is translated fulll only here.
The cognate verb ple3roo3, without the intensifying prepositional prex ana-,
however, appears often.
The command to love fellow believers fulflls or sums up the Law (Gal
5:14).
The entire Law is fulflled in believers who walk in the Spirit (Rom
8:4).
S
A
M
P
L
E
367
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:2-3
The one who loves another has fulflled the law (Rom 13:8 NRSV).
It is remarkable, given Pauls negative assessment of the law elsewhere in
Galatians ( 4:21), that he should refer to it favorably here. Although he op-
posed the imposition of laws that separated Jews from Gentiles, he endorsed
laws that encouraged community unity and upbuilding.
Inasmuch as this faith is the indwelling faith of the Son of God (2:20)
it is the fruit of the Spirit (5:22), that is, the activity of the Spirit of
the Son. The loving death of the crucied Messiah has redened the law
of love. It is now the law of the Messiah, as Paul says in 6:2. It is a law
shaped by the faithful, self-giving, loving death of Jesus. It is the law, or
pattern, of cruciform faith active in cruciform love. (Gorman 2001, 221)
L 3 This parenthetical aside is a rare departure from the concentration of
exhortations in vv 1-5. If it meaningfully relates to its context, it signicantly
affects our interpretation of these commands. It explains and substantiates the
preceding exhortations. Paul challenged the comfortable assumptions some
readers had about themselves.
As in v 1, Paul again used a singular subject, narrowing his community
message to a single representative individual. Also as in v 1, it is formulated
as a condition. Whereas the earlier condition was hypothetical, the present
one is universal in its application. If anyone thinks he is something when he
is nothing, he deceives himself. In Greek this message clearly referred to self-
deceivers of either gender.
Just as Paul left the self-deceiver anonymous, he left the precise nature
of the self-deception ambiguous. We can only surmise what that something
was that he or she imagined. Paul leaves us guessing about this persons fantasy
self.
Did some think they were so spiritual, in contrast to those caught in
a sin (v 1), that they imagined they were beyond falling?
Did they imagine they were above helping their fallen social inferiors?
Were some so deluded as to fancy that they had no burdens they need-
ed help carrying?
Did Paul refer anonymously to the Agitators in the community (so
Witherington 1998a, 426)?
Had some been circumcised and claimed to be religiously superior to
the uncircumcised majority?
We can only speculate. But Paul must have been condent that his rst readers
would know immediately who and what he meant.
The verb thinks refers to ones subjective opinion (BDAG, 254). But
what one considers probable and supposes to be true may, in fact, be an illu-
sion. The verb was used by Jewish authors to approximate the antithesis in
the wisdom literature between appearance and truth (Schunack 1990, 340).
Two parallel constructions in 1 Corinthians illustrate Pauls appropriation of
S
A
M
P
L
E
368
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:3-4
Wisdoms concern for the need to avoid presumption (1 Cor 3:18; 14:37; see
Phil 3:4).
The verb translated deceives appears only here in the NT (see Titus
1:10). But the root with a different prex is the same as the more common
verb translated deceive (in 1 Cor 3:18; see Rom 7:11; 16:18; 2 Cor 11:3; 2
Thess 2:3; 1 Tim 2:14). The phren- prex (see 1 Cor 14:20; BDAG, 1065)
identies the deception as based on mistaken thinking. The self-deceived had
not tested their assumptions about themselves against their own actions.
L 4 The focus on individual responsibility emphasized in v 3 continues in vv 4
and 5. But the mood shifts from the indicative to the imperative. The subject
is Each one in contrast to the other.
Since English has no equivalent to the third-person imperative, every
translation must paraphrase. This is a universal command, not merely encour-
agement: Each one must test and approve ones own work. The verb dokimazo3
describes a critical examination of someth[ing] to determine genuineness
(BDAG, 255). Here, something is ones own work.
Test Ever yt hi ng
Paul apparently considered critical reection an essential prerequisite of
life in the Spirit. This calls for thoughtful and honest evaluation of the evidence
neither unmerciful faultnding and scrupulosity, nor mindless presumption and
inattention to matters of right and wrong, good and evil.
In 1 Thess 5:21a, Paul urged: Test everything. Not everything that alleged
to be inspired by the Spirit was to be accepted at face value. Hold on to the
good. Avoid every kind of evil (1 Thess 5:21b-22; compare Rom 12:9).
In 1 Cor 11:28 and 2 Cor 13:5 as in Gal 6:4, Paul encouraged candid self-
examination. In Rom 2:18; 12:2; and Phil 1:10, he recommended testing and ap-
proving Gods will. That is: What is the evidence that this or that is what God
wants?
In 1 Cor 3:13b, Paul identied the Last Judgment as the nal examination
of ones accomplishments. He used the imagery of metal rening as an analogy
for evaluating the consequences of ones life and ministry. Genuine faith will be
revealed with re, and the re will test the quality of each mans work.
Some Reformed interpreters have distorted Pauls emphasis on faith vs.
works to imply that God is indifferent to what Christians do. But the apostle can-
not be charged with this error (see Rom 2:6-9, citing Ps 62:12 and Prov 24:12).
Ones work (= actions) in Gal 6:4 refers to the deeds of humans, exhib-
iting a consistent moral character (BDAG, 390). This is a frequent use of the
term in the LXX (Ps 105:35; Job 11:11; Jonah 3:10) and elsewhere in Pauls letters
(Rom 2:6-7; 4:2, 6; 9:12, 32; 11:6; 13:3; 1 Cor 5:2; 2 Cor 9:8; 11:15; Eph 2:9-10;
Phil 1:6; Col 1:10; 1 Tim 5:10, 25; 6:18; 2 Tim 1:9; 2:10, 21; 3:17; 4:14; Titus 1:16;
2:7, 14; 3:1, 5, 8, 14).
S
A
M
P
L
E
369
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:4
Results matter. Therefore, Christians must periodically take stock of what
they have done with their lives. What kind of persons are we becoming? Rigorous
and thoughtful introspection can prevent self-deception (Gal 6:3).
John Wesley wrote in his Plain Account of Christian Perfection:
Beware of that daughter of pride, enthusiasm. O keep at the utmost
distance from it! Give no place to a heated imagination. Do not hastily
ascribe things to God. Do not easily suppose dreams, voices, impressions,
visions, or revelations to be from God. They may be from him. They may
be from nature. They may be from the devil. Therefore, believe not every
spirit, but try the spirits whether they be of God [alluding to 1 John 4:1].
Try all things by the written word, and let all bow down before it. You are
in danger of enthusiasm every hour, if you depart ever so little from Scrip-
ture; yea, or from the plain, literal meaning of any text, taken in connexion
with the context. And so you are, if you despise or lightly esteem reason,
knowledge, or human learning; every one of which is an excellent gift of
God, and may serve the noblest purposes. (Wesley 1979, 11:429)
Paul urged all in his Galatian audience to examine their actions. Did
the consequences of their choices and the marks of their character correspond
with their self-assessment? Were they truly spiritual (v 1)? Did they fulll
the law of Christ by sharing the burdens of others (v 2)? Were they truly
something or merely self-deceived (v 3)? What kinds of persons were they
really? Their actions, not their spiritual faade or self-image, alone mattered.
Their work was the true test of their consistent character.
Paul apparently assumed that self-examination would validate the genu-
ineness of most in his Galatian audience. The consequence he expected was:
Then he can take pride in himself alone, without comparing himself to some-
body else. His somebody else referred to the hypothetical transgressor (v 1),
(lit.) the other (Longenecker 1990, 277).
It was important to distinguish a true from a false basis for boasting
(pride; 6:14; see Rom 4:2; 1 Cor 5:6; 9:15-16; 2 Cor 1:14; Phil 1:26; 2:16;
see Bultmann 1965). Paul considered it inappropriate to boast about oneself
at the expense of others. Christians were not to imagine they were better than
other Christians. They were to measure themselves by what God expected of
them, not by comparison with the success or failure of others. On this basis
alone could they take satisfaction in their accomplishments.
Here Pauls greatest concern becomes explicit. It was that the Galatians
should not assess themselves by comparison with others. They were not to
grade themselves on the curve, so to speak. Those who had not fallen into
transgression could not assess themselves as spiritual simply because others
had fallen. Every Christian is equally vulnerable to failure and self-deception
(vv 1 and 3). It is always possible to test ourselves by comparison with others
to our advantage. Thus, we are to examine ourselves, and not to judge others.
S
A
M
P
L
E
370
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 5
L 5 The reason why Paul preferred self-examination to faultnding was sim-
ple: each one should carry his own load. On the surface, at least, Pauls state-
ments in vv 2 and 5 seem contradictory. The verbs translated carry are the
same ( v 2). And, surely, the words burdens (bare3) and load (phortion; see
Matt 11:28-30; 23:4; Luke 11:46) are synonymousthe daily struggles of life
with its unavoidable pressures and problems (against Rendall 1903, 189). But
there is no real contradiction, for sharing the burdens of life does not elimi-
nate the fact that everybody must learn how to live with himself or herself
(Betz 1979, 304).
Here, should carry translates a future indicative verb, which often func-
tion as commands (BDF, 195 387). If this is not an implicit command, it is
probably a logical future. That is, by avoiding unfavorable comparisons with
others, each person will give appropriate attention to his or her own problems.
Pauls point seems to have been that one is to be concerned about
ones own burden, rather than compare himself complacently w[ith] others
(BDAG, 1064). The call to assist others with their weaknesses and failures (v
2) does not discharge us from personal responsibility (v 5). A contemporary
expression of Pauls point might be: Mind your own business!
The Greek expression translated his own, to idion, refers to what is unique
to each individual (as in the derived English termsidiomatic or idiosyn-
crasy). It can refer to private property (Acts 4:32; Rom 14:4-5), hometowns
(Matt 9:1; Luke 2:3), compatriots (1 Thess 2:14), native languages (Acts 1:19;
2:6, 8), personal piety (Acts 3:12; Rom 10:3), personal expenses (Acts 28:30;
1 Cor 9:7), personal efforts (1 Cor 3:8; 4:12), individual bodies (1 Cor 6:18;
15:38), ones own food (1 Cor 11:21), ones own will (1 Cor 7:37), ones own
business (1 Thess 4:11), etc. Here, it refers to ones own unique weaknesses,
faults, and failures.
Obedience to the law of Christ (v 2) called for the restoration of fallen
brothers and sisters (v 1). There was no call for their condemnation, much less
ones own self-exaltation at their expense. Those who honestly examine them-
selves will soon realize that they have little room for arrogance or harsh criti-
cism of others. Each of us has his or her own unique load to carry. Even as we
voluntarily bear the burdens of others, we cannot escape living with ourselves.
Each of us is personally accountable to God (Rom 14:10-12; 2 Cor 5:10).
v
FROM THE TEXT
Pauls practical ethical advice here deals with perennial issues in the life
of the church. Churches are composed of awed and fallible individuals. We
must still be concerned about both personal and communal responsibilities.
The principle upon which the Spirit-lled life is based is simplekeep
in step with the Spirit (Gal 5:25). Christians are called to lives of total obedi-
ence to God. Thanks to the Spirits work in our lives, this is possible; and so
S
A
M
P
L
E
371
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:26
6: 5
it is expected. But the problem is that Christians sometimes sin. What then?
How do we deal with the problem of sin in our midst?
Pauls prescription was restoration. But he warned of its potential to be
more serious than the problem. The point of the entire passage was to get his
readers to turn their gaze from the failures of others to themselves and their
own fallibility. One of the practical, personal implications of the Spirit-lled
life is that Christians sometimes fail to live up to the possibilities of grace.
Despite Gods intentions for usthat we might never sinsin happens (see
1 John 2:1).
Paul seemed less concerned about the offense than with the possibility
that the handling of such a case might become a source of evil for those who
administer it (Betz 1979, 296). The apostle knew Gods grace was more than
competent to cure the criminal. His concern was with the would-be physi-
cians. Jonathan Edwards, a famous early American preacher, is best remem-
bered for his sermon Sinners in the Hands of an Angry God. Pauls concern
was for sinners in the hands of spiritual people.
The gentle procedure Paul prescribed was to treat the sin in a manner
betting spiritual people and benetting the fallen brother or sister. Sinners
need to be restorednot punished; not condemned, cured. The discipline
Paul called for here was of spiritual persons, not of sinners. Watch yourself!
Keep a critical eye on yourself; be compassionate to others. Transgressors are
to be treated with remarkable leniency and tolerance. The faithful are to focus
their critical powers on themselves, not on the failures. They are to be gentle,
not gloat. The fallen Christian is to be brought back to the right path in a man-
ner that reects Gods grace.
Contradictions between the ideal and reality in the church bring with
them the temptation to self-righteousness and arrogance. The prescription for
the problem of transgression may threaten the community, with an opportu-
nity for the works of the esh (Gal 5:19). Paul was keenly aware that a self-
righteous posture of prosecutors can cause greater damage to the community
than the offence done by a wrongdoer (Betz 1979, 298).
Thus, he urged, Carry each others burdens (v 2a). To bear anothers
burdens is not merely to tolerate them. It is actively to assist and relieve them.
When we share the burdens and misfortunes of others, we sympathize and
support them in their daily struggles (Betz 1979, 299 n. 61). We bear with
their problems and help them cope with them. When we enter into the lives
of otherswalk a few miles in their shoes, so to speakit becomes more dif-
cult for us to condemn them.
To realize, There but for the grace of God go I, is not to condone the
sins of fallen Christians. It is to refuse to yield to the temptation to self-righ-
teousness. But more than this, it is to fulll Christs Law (v 2). It is to obey the
second half of the Great Commandmentto love our neighbor as ourselves.
S
A
M
P
L
E
372
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
5:26
6: 5
This is not a condition, but a result of salvation. According to 5:14, to
fulll the love command is to fulll the whole law. And since, according to Gal
2:20, it is Christs love that secures our salvation, the law of love may aptly be
called Christs Law (Betz 1979, 301). By bearing one anothers burdens, we
will fulll the law of Christ (v 2).
Paul did not say: The strong are to carry the burdens of the weak. We all
have burdens, no matter how spiritual we are. And we all can help others carry
their burdens, no matter how weak we may be.
Learning to live with ourselves begins with knowing ourselves. This
calls for an extraordinary measure of honesty. It is remarkable how capable we
are of self-deception. Today, even Christian spokespersons urge us to develop
high self-esteem. This makes Pauls advice seem both out-of-date and coun-
tercultural: If anyone thinks he is something when he is nothing, he deceives
himself (v 3).
It is remarkable how university students, supposedly suffering from low
self-esteem, manage to accept full responsibility for their successes and nearly
none for their failures. The test was too hard . . . unfair. Others cheated. My
high school teachers prepared me poorly. Grade ination only reinforces their
illusions. Most American students, despite their university entrance exam
scores, manage to rate themselves as better than average.
The good news of the gospel is not that we have been set free by Christ
to love ourselves, but that we have been set free from self-obsession. Sooner or
later, we must learn, usually the hard way, to swallow our pride, acknowledge
our humanity, and declare our utter dependence on God. There is a tremen-
dous sense of relief that comes in discovering that the security and acceptance
we were struggling to earn has been given to us freely by the God whose love
and acceptance matter most.
There is nothing wrong with being nothing or a nobody, for apart
from Gods grace, that is what one actually is. It is wrong, however, to be de-
luded into thinking one is somebody. . . . Human beings must learn to accept
that they really are nothing (Betz 1979, 301).
Applied to Pauls rst readers, this was a warning that if they thought
they were spiritual, when they were not, they were caught up in a dangerous
and preposterous illusion (Betz 1979, 301). I leave it to your imagination what
the apostle might say to those who profess to be entirely sanctied, but whose
lives and relationships reveal nothing of the cruciform character of Christ.
Just as surely as Christian self-examination does not permit us to con-
demn others, it denies us the right to grade ourselves by comparison with
others. The most widespread illusions occur because of comparison of [our-
selves] with others. In playing this game, [we] can manipulate things at will so
that the comparison always turns out in [our] favor . . . and to the disadvantage
of the person with whom we compare ourselves (Betz 1979, 303). Why do
we seem to take special satisfaction in seeing extraordinarily successful people
S
A
M
P
L
E
373
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 6-10
cut down to size? Do we imagine that we grow taller because others are
brought to their knees?
There is nothing wrong with achievement. But a true achievement
is one which exists only . . . with reference to [ourselves] . . . not as a result
of comparing [ourselves] with others (Betz 1979, 303). And, there is noth-
ing wrong with taking pride in our achievements. But if we understand our
achievements correctly, Christian boasting becomes a form of worship. As
Paul wrote in 1 Cor 15:10, By the grace of God I am what I am, and his grace
to me was not without effect. No, I worked harder than all of themyet not I,
but the grace of God that was with me. Or again in Gal 6:14a, May I never
boast except in the cross of our Lord Jesus Christ. Proper boasting praises
God for his achievements in and through and often in spite of me.
And there is nothing wrong with Christian self-sufciency. After all,
each one should carry his own load (v 5). The apostle claimed that the se-
cret of being content in any and every situation, whether well fed or hungry,
whether living in plenty or in want was the realization: I can do everything
through him who gives me strength (Phil 4:12-13).
ii. Do Good to All (6:6-10)
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Verse 6 has no obvious relation to vv 1-5, which precede it, or with vv
7-10, which follow it. Semantically, however, the metaphorical force of the
verb carry in vv 2 and 4 is synonymous with the verb koino3neo3 (share) in v 6
(see Louw and Nida 1989, 35.32 and 57.98). Sharing with others is a practical
way to keep in step with the Spirit (5:25).
All Christians share in the failures of each in the life of the church (6:1-5).
All share also in nancial matters (Witherington 1998a, 430). Few things more
clearly disclose our priorities than the use of money. Boice (1976, 503) identi-
es three reasons for thinking money was Pauls primary concern in vv 6-10:
1. Doing good, emphasized in vv 6 and 10, is almost certainly a euphe-
mism for giving. Verses 7-9 expand on v 6. Thus, the entire section
concerns nancial matters.
2. The proverb quoted in v 7, as it certainly does in 1 Cor 9:11-12 and 2
Cor 9:6-11, probably encourages generosity.
3. Financial considerations preoccupied Paul, especially the collection
for the Jerusalem poor (see 2:10).
Martyn (1997, 552) speculates that Pauls directions were motivated by
the Agitators (whom he calls the Teachers) intention to terminate Pauls in-
structors and replace them with their partisans. He further imagines that the
letter to the Galatians may well have failed to win the day. This forced his
instructors to move to Ephesus, where they preserved the letter for posterity
S
A
M
P
L
E
374
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 6
(Martyn 1997, 29). This gives far too much weight to a hypothesis that can be
neither veried nor falsied.
I N THE TEXT
L 6 The rst word in the Greek sentence is the imperative verb Koino3neito3,
share. Paul called for a practical expression of generosity (NRSV; NIV: good-
ness), one of the fruit of the Spirit ( 5:22; Martyn 1997, 551). In three
of its four other appearances in Pauls letters (Rom 12:13; 15:27; Phil 4:15),
the verb has economic and material implicationsassisting others in nancial
need (1 Tim 5:22 is the exception). The cognate noun koino3nia often has this
force in Paul (Rom 15:26; 2 Cor 8:23; 9:13; Phil 1:5; 1 Tim 6:18).
Most early commentators (Theodore of Mopsuestia, Theodoret, Chrys-
ostom, Ambrosiaster, Jerome) took Paul to recommend that students share
their material goods with the teachers in their local communities. Some
modern commentators agree (e.g., Lightfoot 1874, 218; Betz 1979, 305; Cole
1989, 229). Others take it in a broader sense as including both material and
spiritual goods (Betz 1979, 304; e.g., Burton 1920, 338-39; Duncan 1934,
183-85; Oepke 1973, 191-93). Still others (Lhrmann 1992, 117; Hurtado
1979; Strelan 1975) take it as a reference to the nancial needs of the Jerusa-
lem church (compare Rom 15:27).
The Pythagorean communal idealfriends share all things in com-
monwas widely held in antiquity (Betz 1979, 305), even by rabbis (Bruce
1982, 263). The verb share in the imperative mood probably commends nan-
cial support for the teachers in the community (against Schlier 1965, 275-76).
Education was part of the life of the Galatian churches. Paul used the exem-
plaric singular (Betz 1979, 305-6) to refer to all those leading the churches
educational ministry (see 1 Cor 9:3-18; Luke 10:7).
Paul endorsed the reciprocity of community relationships . . . in which
having a share obligates one to give a share (Hainz 1990, 304). In return
for the instruction the Galatian communities received, Paul encouraged each
member to share all good things with their teachers. He left the specics to
his Galatian audience.
It is extremely doubtful that Paul here requested nancial support for
himself (Bruce 1982, 263). Most interpreters agree that he urged support for
the local teachers serving the Galatian churches in his behalf (see Rom 15:24;
2 Cor 11:7-11; Phil 1:5; 4:15; 1 Thess 2:9; 2 Thess 3:7-10).
In Pauls other letters, he employed words from the didask- word group
to refer to teachers. Teachers were among the Spirit-endowed members of
the body of Christ God had appointed to serve the church in 1 Cor 12:28-29.
In Rom 12:7 Paul listed among Gods grace-gifts the one who teaches. Ephe-
sians 4:11 mentions teachers among Gods gifts to equip the church for
works of service.
S
A
M
P
L
E
375
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 6-9
Instead of the expected noun, didaskalos, Paul used a substantive adjec-
tival participle, the one who teaches, from a different cognate group. It seems
unlikely that he used to3i kate3chounti with any technical force, since he referred
to the individual members of the community as the one who is taught (ho
kate3choumenos). The Greek root of kate3cheo3 is the source of the English word
catechism.
Translating the participle as teacher (NRSV) or instructor gives the mis-
taken impression that Paul referred to an established ofce within the Gala-
tian communities. It is doubtful that he referred to a full-time, paid catechist,
but only to the informal role or activity of instructing others. Paul character-
ized the content of the teachers instruction as the word. This was the gospel,
the Christian message (as in Rom 9:6; 1 Cor 1:17-18; 2:4; 15:2; 2 Cor 2:17;
4:2; Eph 1:13; 6:19; Phil 1:14; 2:16; Col 1:5; 4:3; 1 Thess 1:5-6, 8; 2:13; 2
Thess 3:1; 4:2; Titus 1:3, 9; 2:5). Nowhere does the NT simply equate the
word with Scripture, popular usage notwithstanding.
L 7-9 Paul continued in the imperative mood, shifting from the third person
singular (in 6:4-6) to the second person plural. In vv 7b-8, he offered a reason
for the command in v 7a. In vv 9 and 10 Paul gave further directives, using the
less forceful hortatory subjunctive.
L 7 Pauls negative command to the entire community was: Do not be de-
ceived (see 1 Cor 6:9; 15:33; Luke 21:8; Jas 1:16). This was not a warning
against would-be deceivers like the Agitators (Dunn 1993, 329). Stoic phi-
losophers (see Braun 1965, 244) used this as an introductory formula before
solemn warnings (Longenecker 1990, 279). Here Paul cautioned the Galatians
to make no mistake about the serious consequences of defying God (BDAG,
821-22).
Pauls audience was not to forget that God cannot be mocked (mykte3 rizetai).
The Greek word conveys the imagery of people turning up their noses in a cynical
sneer (see Job 22:19; Pss 44:13; 80:6; Prov 1:30; 11:12; 12:8; 15:5, 20; 23:9; Ezek
8:17; Rendall 1903, 189-90). The point: God is not to be treated with contempt
(BDAG, 660).
The earliest surviving quotation of this command appears in Polycarps
Letter to the Philippians 3:5. This second-century Christian martyr used the
saying as the rationale for living in a manner worthy of Gods commandment
and glory. He took v 7 as reinforcing Pauls command in v 6 that the Galatians
were to care for the needs of their teachers. Longenecker (1990, 280) takes it
with v 8 as a warning against ignoring the cause-and-effect relationships of
[divine] justice. Dont trivialize divine judgment.
Paul substantiated the claim that God was not to be mocked with the
truism: For whatever a person sows, he or she will also reap that same thing.
This proverbial restatement of the lex talionis emphasized the equity and ap-
propriateness of divine judgment. God will repay in kind human deance of
his commands. The association of divine justice with the imagery of sowing
S
A
M
P
L
E
376
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:7-8
and reaping implies that God does not actively pursue and punish wrongdoers
as bets their crimes. Instead, he allows nature to take its course. The evil
consequences sin sets in motion makes sin its own punishment (compare Rom
1:18-32). The same agricultural imagery appears in 1 Cor 9:11-12 and 2 Cor
9:6-11.
Paul defended the right to be paid for ones ministry, although he had
refused to exercise that right personally. His use of this agricultural imagery
elsewhere suggests that his appeal to it in Gal 6:7 reinforced his appeal for
the Galatians to support their teachers in v 6. But the apostle was capable of
applying the same metaphor differently (contrast 1 Cor 15:36-44). The com-
mon element in both applications was the inescapable connection between
conduct and consequencesthe beginning and the end of a growth process.
Nearly contemporary Jewish (Sand 1990a, 145; see Job 4:8; Prov 22:7-9; Jer
12:13; Sir 7:3) and Greco-Roman authors (Betz 1979, 307 n. 157) appealed
to the same imagery.
The future tense of therisei, he will reap, and the Jewish and early Chris-
tian association of harvest and nal judgment connect resurrection for the
righteous and damnation for the unrepentant (see )Abot 1.7; 4 Ezra 4:28-30; 2
Bar. 70:2-4; Midr. Cant. 8:14; Matt 3:12; 13:30, 39; Luke 3:15; John 4:36-38;
2 Thess 3:13; Jas 5:7; Rev 14:15-18; 1 Clem. 56:1657:7). The T. Levi 13:6
urged: And sow good things in your souls, That ye may nd them in your life.
But if ye sow evil things, Ye shall reap every trouble and afiction (APOT,
2:311). Pagans (Aristotle, Rhet. 3.3.4; Plato, Phaedr. 260D) similarly used the
proverb to emphasize cause-and-effect relationships. The future consequenc-
es of ones conduct should motivate moral responsibility (Sand 1990a, 145).
L 8 Paul explained the connection between sowing and reaping with two chi-
astic (X-shaped) opposing constructions.
a The one who sows
b to his own esh
b' from the esh
a' will reap destruction;
but
a the one who sows
b to the Spirit
b' from the Spirit
a' will reap life eternal.
The subject clause of both is the substantive participle, The one who sows . . .
Paul assumed there were just two ways of living. People will either sow
the deeds and words of their lives in the soil of their own esh or of the Spir-
it. He did not contrast the physical and spiritual aspects of humanity (against
Burton 1920, 342). As in 5:16-26, he opposed the merely human and the di-
vine, those who trust themselves vs. those who trust and obey the Holy Spirit
of God.
S
A
M
P
L
E
377
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 8
To sow to the esh might entail seeking circumcision and works of Law
as a means of self-salvation or self-preservation. Or it might mean self-indul-
gence, abandoning oneself to the works of the esh (5:16-19). To sow to . . .
the Spirit entails living for God in total dependence on his grace. This is what
Paul calls elsewhere in the letter the posture of trust / faith, which is the ap-
propriate human response to the offer of justication ( Gal 2:16; 3:8-9,
11, 24; 5:5). What and where people plant (i.e., place their trust) determines
their eventual harvest (compare Rom 6:19-23; 8:5-17). The predicate of both
constructions uses the future tense of the verb reap to describe the opposite
end-times consequences of the two ways of life. The contrasting harvests are
as death-and-life antithetical as the two soils.
The one who lives for the esh will reap destruction. Destruction is of-
ten associated with the last judgment in the NT (see, e.g., Matt 3:12; 13:24-29,
36-43; Rev 14:17-20; Ryken, Wilhoit, and Longman 1998, 365-67). In nature,
destruction refers to the breakdown of organic matter (as in Col 2:22; 2 Pet
2:12). Here it refers to total destruction . . . in the last days; that is, death
(Arichea and Nida 1976, 152), the opposite of eternal life (BDAG, 1054). De-
struction would seem to entail exclusion from the kingdom of God ( Gal
5:21; see 2 Thess 1:5, 9). The word hell never appears in Pauls letters. It is
impossible to determine whether he conceived of the end-times retribution of
the unrighteous as annihilation or unending torment. End-times destruction
would seem to be as enduring as eternal life.
In contrast to the destruction awaiting those who sow to the esh, the
one who sows to the Spirit will reap eternal life. Sowing to the Spirit is another
way of referring to
walking by the Spirit ( 5:16);
being led by the Spirit ( v 18);
living by the Spirit ( v 25); and
keeping in step with the Spirit ( v 25).
We might have expected Paul to have identied the harvest as the fruit of the
Spirit ( v 22) or the life of holiness (Rom 6:16-22). But Gal 6:9 implies that
sowing to the Spirit means persistence in doing good.
Romans 2:7 promises eternal life as the reward of those who by per-
sistence in doing good seek glory, honor and immortality. It is the gift God
gives those who have been justied and sanctied by faith in Christ (Rom
5:21; 6:22-23), the future heritage of Spirit-led believers in the kingdom of
God ( Gal 5:21).
The Greek adjective translated eternal is derived from the noun aio3n,
age. Accordingly, eternal life refers to the quality of life expected in the com-
ing age. It can mean a long period of time, without reference to its duration
(see 1 Tim 1:16; Titus 1:3; 3:7). As applied to God it refers to a period of time
without beginning or end. Here it probably indicates a period of unending
duration, without end (BDAG, 33). Jews used this language to refer to resur-
S
A
M
P
L
E
378
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 8-9
rection existence, not to the heavenly intermediate state (Dunn 1993, 331;
Witherington 1998a, 432).
L 9 Paul continued to exhort his readers, shifting from the imperative to a
hortatory subjunctive. He included himself among those encouraged (contrast
2 Thess 3:13). The verbs present tense emphasizes the ongoing need of Chris-
tians not to become weary or disheartened doing good.
The present adverbial participle translated doing good could be inter-
preted in several plausible ways, each with a slightly different nuance. Pauls
ambiguity allows for one or more of these possibilities:
With a temporal force, while we are doing good would call for untir-
ing commitment to doing good things.
With a causal reading, because we are doing good would offer a ratio-
nale for not becoming weary.
As manner or means, Let us not become tired by doing good would
recommend moderation, even in doing good things.
As an attendant circumstance, Pauls point may have been: Let us
keep doing good and let us not grow weary.
The adjective good can convey an aesthetic (beautiful or useful) or
an ethical force (morally good; BDAG, 400, s.v. kalos; v 10). Here it refers
to noble and praiseworthy deeds (as in Gal 4:18; Matt 5:16; Mark 14:6; Rom
7:18, 21; 12:17; 2 Cor 8:21; 13:7; 1 Tim 5:10, 25; 6:18; Titus 2:7, 14; 3:8; Heb
10:24; 1 Pet 2:12; Jas 3:13; 4:17). Such good deeds are universally recognized
as obviously the right thing to do.
The second half of the sentence offers the reason why Christians should
be tireless in doing the right thing: for at the proper time we will reap a harvest
if we do not give up. In due time (BDAG, 395) leaves the timing of harvest
ambiguous. Paul did not claim to know when the nal judgment, with its ac-
companying rewards and punishments, would occur.
The same verb translated reap three times in vv 7 and 8 is rendered
reap a harvest here. These verses are mutually interpretive. It is not enough
to sow / do good deeds, even with the Spirits assistance; perseverance was
essential. Paul encouraged tirelessly persisting in doing good by negating two
synonymous verbs both meaning become discouragedenkakeo3 and eklyomai.
The rst is a hortatory subjunctive: Let us not become weary. The sec-
ond is an adverbial participle of attendant circumstance, and let us not give
out. If the participle has a conditional force, it could mean if we do not give
up; as a causal, because we do not become slack (see BDAG, 243). Lethargy
or apostasy could cause one-time Christians to be lost ( 5:3-4; see Longe-
necker 1990, 282; Witherington 1998a, 433).
The apostle offered no explicit reasons why Christians might grow wea-
ry or give up. End-times urgency is always difcult to sustain (see Luke 18:1;
2 Cor 4:1, 16; Eph 3:13; 2 Thess 3:13; Heb 2:1-4; 10:24-25, 36; 12:1-15; Rev
2:3; 2 Clem. 2:2; Herm. Mand. 9.8). The cardinal problem of all enthusiasts
S
A
M
P
L
E
379
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:9-10
[is] time. As time goes on, enthusiasm fades away . . . and . . . the esh gets
its chance (cf. 5:13) (Betz 1979, 309).
L 10 The delay of the Parousia was no excuse for laxness. It gave believers un-
expected timeopportunity (see Rom 13:11-14) to do good. Paul concluded
the advice section of Galatians with a hortatory subjunctive, which summa-
rized the implications of Gal 6:6-9: So then, . . . let us work for the good of
all (v 10 NRSV). As the nal sentence in the body of the letter, it also sums
up in a general way . . . what the Apostle regards as the ethical task of the
Christian community. Hence, it serves also as a denition of Christian ethics
(Betz 1979, 310).
Translating this simply let us do good to all people disguises Pauls use of
a verb from the work cognate family (ergon). Although he could treat faith
and works of Law as antithetical (in 2:16; 3:2, 5, and 10), he clearly expected
Christians to work. Good deeds as an imagined means of achieving standing
with God were not the same as good deeds as an ongoing bodily expression of
faith in Christ (compare Eph 2:8-10).
Unlike Gal 6:9, the adjective translated good here is agathon. Pauls us-
age in such proximity suggests that he intended no real distinctionthey were
synonymous. The change was merely for the sake of stylistic variety. Both
Greek terms are sufciently ambiguous to include serving one another in
love (5:13), embodying the fruit of the Spirit (5:22-23), restoring fallen
transgressors (6:1), bearing the burdens of others (6:2), and sharing materially
with Christian teachers (6:6). In fact, doing good comprehends any action
done for others . . . that results in well-being (Arichea and Nida 1976, 152).
Decisive here is Pauls clarication of the meaning of doing good in v
9. Working for the good of all people is a universal necessity. The comprehen-
siveness of the demand is not narrowed by his qualication: especially to those
who belong to the family of believers.
Paul stressed the urgency of doing good most of all, above all, [or] . . .
particularly (BDAG, 489) for the household of faith (see Eph 2:19; Num
20:29; 2 Sam 1:12; Ezek 3:4; Jdt 4:15; Pss. Sol. 17:42; Qumran: 1QS 5.6; 8.5;
CD 20:10, 13). Most interpreters (e.g., Betz 1979, 311; Bruce 1982, 266; Lon-
genecker 1990, 283; Dunn 1993, 333) take this to refer to fellow Christians,
the family of believers. Hurtado (1979) takes it as a reference to the collection
for the Jerusalem church ( Gal 2:10).
Although the apostle gave priority to caring for other Christians, he did
not make doing good to unbelievers optional. The word especially did not
create an exemption clause. The church was to be the base from which good
deeds were to begin, not end.
In seriously divided communities, immersed in internecine disputes like
those in Galatia, Pauls call to treat fellow believers well was not perfunctory.
Perhaps, it was even more difcult to be civil to one another under such cir-
cumstances than it was to treat strangers hospitably.
S
A
M
P
L
E
380
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 6-10
v
FROM THE TEXT
Money Matters. To what extent do we sow to the esh when we indulge
our appetites for entertainment? How do we justify all the money we spend:
on tickets to professional sporting eventsbaseball, football, basketball, etc.?
for a day at an amusement park? for concerts? vacations? luxury cruises? cable
or satellite TV subscriptions? the latest and largest at-screen televisions? sur-
round-sound music systems? game consoles? boats, snowmobiles, and ATVs?
Are we amusing ourselves to death?
Why do we chafe when pastors preach their annual sermons on steward-
ship? Why do we imagine we have no room in our budgets to help support a
missionary? a compassionate ministries project in a developing country? an
orphan in the two-thirds world? Why do we appeal to Gal 6:5each one
should carry his own loadto justify self-indulgence in light of v 6Anyone
who receives instruction in the word must share all good things with his in-
structor? Why do we endorse v 10let us do good to all peopleso long as
it has no nancial implications? Have we become weary in doing good (v 9)?
Paul called not for a new form of legalism, but for honest self-examination of
our true priorities ( 6:4).
Wesleyans may be surprised to learn that John Wesley published more
sermons on money than on holiness. In his sermon The Use of Money (1979,
6:124-36) he urged Christians to make wise nancial decisions, reecting
Christian principles and goals. As a gift from God, our money should serve
noble ends, providing food for the hungry, drink for the thirsty, clothing for
the naked, shelter for the homeless, advocacy for widows and orphans, defense
for the oppressed, health for the sick, eyes for the blind, feet for the lame, life
for the dying.
Christians need to be instructed as to how money may achieve these
glorious ends and in the highest degree. Wesley reduced all his instructions on
money matters to three simple rules. By carefully observing all of these, we
may be faithful managers of worldly wealth. The outline of Wesleys essential
preaching and teaching is familiar enough: First, gain all you can. Second, save
all you can. Third, give all you can.
To gain all you can applies not only to money. Wesley insisted it is a
shame for Christians not to improve on whatever we do. We should be con-
tinually learningfrom the experience of others or our own; from reading and
reectionto do everything we do better today than we did yesterday.
By save all you can, Wesley did not have in mind wise investments in real
estate or the stock market. The virtue he recommended was frugality: Do not
waste any God-given assets. Wesley was green before his time.
Wesley warned against imagining that we have done anything, by gain-
ing and saving all we can. If we stop here, all this is for nothing. We do not save
S
A
M
P
L
E
381
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6: 6-10
anything, if you only pile it up. Not to use our money or other gifts wisely is
effectively to throw them away.
Having gained all we can and saved all we can, we must give all we can.
Wesley had witnessed the social lift brought by the gospel. Holy living nec-
essarily produces both industry and frugality. And these inevitably produce
riches. But as riches increase, so do pride and greed. He was persuaded that
there was only one way to prevent the continual decline of genuine spiritual-
ity. We ought not to forbid Christians to be diligent and frugal. We must en-
courage one another to gain all we can and to save all we can. But to do so is,
in effect, to urge us to grow rich!
Wesley insisted that there was only one way to avoid letting our money
send us to hell. If those who gain all they can and save all they can likewise
give all they can. By this means, the more they gain, the more they grow in
grace (Wesley 1979, 13:258, 260-61).
Wesleys rationale for giving all we can is grounded in the biblical convic-
tion that God alone is the Owner of heaven and earth. We are in his world, not
as proprietors, but as managersstewards. God has entrusted us, for a while,
with assets of various kinds. But they remain his property. We do not even
belong to ourselves. We are his, as is all we enjoy.
Paul was convinced that generosity was one inescapable expression of
keeping in step with the Spirit. Can we claim to be Christians and be more
interested in leisure, self-indulgence, and miserliness than in generous shar-
ing? There is no reason to think that, just because we live in an urban vs. agrar-
ian culture, the proverb about sowing and reaping does not apply to us. God is
not morally indifferent to what we do with our lives and our livelihoods. What
are we doing with the gracious opportunity that is ours to do good?
Wesley warned rich Christians like us against imagining that we can
discharge our responsibilities to those in need by simply giving money for oth-
ers to minister in our behalf. He considered it essential that we share what is
surely the most precious commodity of twenty-rst-century Western Chris-
tiansour time. He considered personally administered works of mercy
real means of grace (Wesley 1979, 5:195; 7:117-19). Not surprisingly, those
who return from work and witness missions often report that they went to
help others in need but found that they were more helped than those they
served.
S
A
M
P
L
E
S
A
M
P
L
E
383
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11-18
III . AUTOGRAPHICAL PERORATION:
GALATIANS 6:11-18
a
BEHI ND THE TEXT
Galatians concludes with a carefully crafted rhetorical per-
oration. In antiquity, such conclusions functioned to recapitulate
the persuasive emphases of a speech and to arouse the emotions
of the audience to act accordingly. These same verses are also an
epistolary, autographic postscript.
It was customary in antiquity for amanuenses, professional
scribes, to transcribe letters (see Rom 16:22; Col 4:18; 2 Thess
3:17). This is comparable to the modern practice of secretaries
who type letters dictated by their employers. These scribes some-
times took dictation verbatim. But it was not uncommon for trust-
ed scribes to compose letters with general instructions only, esh-
ing out the details following cultural conventions. Again, there are
contemporary analogies.
In either approach to the use of scribes, letter senders typi-
cally took up the writing implement and added autographical con-
clusions in their own handwriting. This validated the authority
behind the transcribed communication in much the same way that
a signature still does in letters printed using word processors. More
than authentication, the autograph served to reiterate the major
concerns of the letter in an aural setting. This Paul did in vv 12-18:
He took the pen from his amanuensis to authenticate the letter
in his own handwriting and to summarize its main points. Thus,
vv 11-18 are the hermeneutical key to the entire letter, offering
interpretive clues as to Pauls major concerns (Betz 1979, 312-13).
Special note should be made of how closely he connected persecu-
tion, circumcision, and the cross (see 5:11 and 6:12-18; see Mit-
ternacht 2007).
S
A
M
P
L
E
384
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11-18
The conclusion of Galatians consists of a series of antitheses contrasting
the views of Paul and the Agitators:
boasting in circumcision vs. boasting in the cross;
avoiding persecution for the cross vs. accepting persecution and the
marks of the Crucied One;
compelling circumcision vs. treating the difference between circumci-
sion and uncircumcision as indifferent;
preferring the old age vs. living in the new creation (Weima 1993).
Had the Agitators claimed that circumcision would diminish the scan-
dalous character of the preaching of the cross? How so? How would persuad-
ing Pauls Galatian Gentile Christian converts to become Jews spare not them,
but their would-be circumcisers from persecution? What was the connection
between persecution and circumcision? Who would persecute others for fail-
ing to persuade pagan converts to accept full Jewish identity and why? Pauls
silence on these questions has not prevented scholarsancient and modern
from making educated guesses.
Jerome speculated that the would-be persecutors were the Roman au-
thorities. Roman laws forbidding superstitions (= new religions) made Chris-
tians subject to persecution when it was clear that they were distinct from
Jews ( 5:11; 6:16).
Caius [Julius] Caesar and Octavianus Augustus, and Tiberius, the
successor of Augustus, had published laws that permitted the Jews scat-
tered throughout the whole sphere of the Roman Empire to live by their
own code and observe their ancestral ceremonies. Whoever was circum-
cised, therefore, even if he was a Christian, was reckoned as a Jew by
the Roman authorities. But anyone who was not circumcised and by his
uncircumcision proclaimed himself no Jew became liable to persecu-
tion, both from Jews and from Gentiles! So those who were leading the
Galatians into evil, wishing to evade the persecution, were persuading
the disciples to circumcise themselves for protection. This the apostle
calls making a good show in the esh. (Cited by Edwards 1999, 101)
Winter (1994) revives this ancient theory. By becoming Jewish, Gentile
Christians would protect all the Jewish Diaspora Christians from persecu-
tion. In the eyes of the authorities of Galatia they would all be Jewish and not
a mixed association. Those Gentiles who joined them and observed the Jewish
law in daily life would, as Jewish converts, be exempt from the imperial cult
(137). If the Galatian Gentile Christians accepted circumcision, all Chris-
tians would have been perceived as a sect within Judaism, a religio licita, not as
members of a new and forbidden religion, a religio illicita (Winter 1994, 133;
but see Hardin 2008, 85-114).
This might explain the coercive measures of local Jewish-Christian Agi-
tators. Robert Jewett offers an alternative hypothesis that might explain why
Judean Jewish Christians may have urged circumcision:
S
A
M
P
L
E
385
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11-18
Jewish Christians in Judea were stimulated by Zealotic pressure
into a nomistic campaign among their fellow Christians in the late 40s
and early 50s. Their goal was to avert the suspicion that they were in
communion with lawless Gentiles. It appears that the Judean Christians
convinced themselves that circumcision of Gentile Christians would
thwart Zealot reprisals. (1970, 205; 2:11)
Evidence from the rst century B.C. and A.D. indicates that to make
a good showing in the esh (NRSV) had legal connotations (Winter 1994,
137). Circumcision would have given Gentile Christians the same protected
legal status as Jews (Winter 1994, 138) and thus exempt them from partici-
pation in the imperial cult (Winter 1994, 139).
Earlier in the letter Paul had three times associated zeal for circumcision
and persecution. In 5:11 and 6:12 Paul explicitly linked persecution and the
cross.
(1) He had persecuted the church of God and tried to destroy it before
his life-changing encounter with the crucied and risen Christ (1:13). In fact,
his notoriety for this led Judean Christians after his conversion-call to refer to
him as the man who formerly persecuted us (1:23).
(2) His allegorical interpretation of Abrahams wives and sons implies
that the advocates of circumcision somehow persecuted circumcision-free,
Spirit-born believers (4:29).
(3) In 5:11, Paul asked rhetorically: Brothers, if I am still preaching
circumcision, why am I still being persecuted? In that case the offense of the
cross has been abolished ().
As Paul looked back on his previous way of life in Judaism (1:13) from
his later perspective as a Christian, he realized that he was then more inter-
ested in his reputation among his Jewish contemporaries (1:14) than in pleas-
ing God (1:10). But his encounter with Christ (1:15-17) had changed all that.
He was no longer seeking human approval (1:10 NRSV).
Paul implied that abandoning his one-time preaching of circumcision
had led the non-Christian Jews, whom he had once sought to please, to perse-
cute him. Other than his passing mention of the offense of the cross (5:11),
he did not explain what motivated their persecution. In 1 Thess 2:16, he im-
plied that Jewish persecutors tried to make his life miserable in order to keep
[him] from speaking to Gentiles so that they may be saved.
Jews were not opposed in principle to evangelizing Gentiles to make con-
verts to Judaism (see Matt 23:15; Acts 2:10; 6:5; 13:43). Paul was convinced
that it was not his missionary efforts per se that led Jews to persecute him. His
message of Christ crucied must have scandalized Jews (1 Cor 1:23; see Rom
9:3010:4) because he claimed that the death of Christ was the sole basis for
salvation. This made becoming Jewish by being circumcised unnecessary (see 1
Cor 1:182:5). The cross of Christ rendered the difference between circumci-
sion and uncircumcision inconsequential (1 Cor 7:18-19; see Gal 5:6; 6:15).
S
A
M
P
L
E
386
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11
Paul preached that Jews and Gentiles alike were made righteous before God on
the basis of faith in the crucied Christ alone ( 2:15-16).
Those who tried to compel the Galatians to be circumcised may have
been non-Christian Jews. But Paul did not claim that they considered circum-
cision the sine qua non of inclusion into the people of God and / or entrance
into nal salvation (cf. 5.2-6; 3.3) (against Wilson 2007, 53). Jews promoting
circumcision in Galatia would probably have espoused such an either-or posi-
tion. But Jewish Christians would more likely have favored a both-and posi-
tion: Christ and circumcision.
Signicantly, in 6:12, Paul did not explain his persecution as simply be-
cause of Christ, but specically because of the cross of Christ. This makes
it even less likely that the Agitators were non-Christian Jews. They may have
been professed Jewish Christians who failed to understand the ethical and
theological implications of crucixion as Paul did.
In the Greek OT, the words eire3ne3 and eleos, Peace and mercy, in Pauls
closing benediction in 6:16, appear together in reverse order, and only in Isa
54:10 and Ps 85:10 (see Harmon 2010, 236-38). Elsewhere in the NT, peace
and mercy appear together, but in the OT order and only with a third term
grace (in 1 Tim 1:2; 2 Tim 1:2; and 2 John 3; love in Jude 2).
Isaiah 54:9 refers to Gods restoration of the earth following Noahs
ood, echoing Pauls mention of the new creation in Gal 6:15. Isaiah 54 is
part of a larger pattern of new creation prophecies in Isaiah 4066 which
refers to the restoration of Israel as a new creation (Beale 1999, 211). As in
Isa 54:10, at Qumran (1QH 13), the Hebrew words for peace and mercy are
associated with the new covenant (see Gal 4:24).
New creation, new covenant, and the twofold blessing of peace and mer-
cy are also associated in Jub. 22:9 (see 22:15 and 30). It reports Abrahams
prayer: O my God, may your mercy and your peace be upon your servant and
upon the seed of his sons so that they may become an elect people for you and
an inheritance from all the nations of the earth from henceforth and for all the
days of the generations of the earth forever (OTP).
Revelation 21:18-19, 21 describes the new creation (21:1) in the imagery
of Isa 54:11-12 (Beale 1999, 214-16; see Gal 4:25-31; 6:15-16). If Paul alluded
to Isa 54:10 in Gal 6:16, it served to develop his quotation of Isa 54:1, cited in
Gal 4:27. Thus, the Israel of God in 6:16 must refer to the entire church and
not only the Jewish Christian segment of it (Beale 1999, 208, see 217-19),
excluding the Agitators.
I N THE TEXT
L 11 The second person plural imperative, See, is not an ethical injunction,
nor a command. Here, it serves to arouse attention and to highlight the im-
portance of what follows (Longenecker 1990, 289). Paul invited his Galatian
readers to note the shift to a different font (what large letters) and handwriting
S
A
M
P
L
E
387
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11-12
(I write to you with my own hand) at this point. These changes would have
been no more obvious to Pauls rst listeners, than they are to modern readers
of print editions of the letter. We possess no autograph of any biblical book,
but only copies of copies.
I write is literally I wrote. The epistolary aorist (Robertson 1919, 845)
assumes the perspective of Pauls audience, hearing his reconstituted spoken
words some time after he wrote (see Rom 15:15; 1 Cor 5:11; 9:15; 2 Cor 9:3;
Eph 6:22; Phil 2:28; Col 4:8; Phlm 12, 19, 21). Ziesler (1992, 98) speculates
that the autograph presumes that Pauls messenger circulated just one copy of
the letter throughout the Galatian congregations. But Paul could easily have
added the same autographic conclusion to several copies.
Some imaginative interpreters (most recently Witherington 1998a, 441)
assume that Pauls large letters support the supposition that he had chronic
eye problems ( Gal 4:12-15). More likely he merely called attention to the
contrast between his handwriting and that of the amanuensis (Barrett 1985,
84). He authenticated the letter as his (1 Cor 16:21; Col 4:18; 2 Thess 3:17),
while the larger font emphasized his point (Burton 1920, 347-48; Betz 1979,
314; Dunn 1993, 335).
L 12 Paul characterized his Galatian opponents here, not as Agitators ( 1:7;
5:10, 12), but as Deceivers, even Hypocrites ( 2:11-14). He referred to them
as all those who are wanting to put on a good face in the esh. The letter
sometimes describes the opponents as if they were comprised of one indi-
vidual ( 1:8, 9; 3:1; 4:29; 5:7, 10) and sometimes as a group ( 4:17, 21;
5:4, 11). Rhetoric, not sketchy information about the opposition, probably
determined the variety.
Pauls label was comprehensive enough to t anyone overly concerned
to make a good impression outwardly (lit., in the esh). Given his lengthy
treatment of the antithesis between esh and Spirit in 5:13-25, he implied
that the Agitators concern for esh was due to insufcient concern for the
Spirit of God.
Pauls point was not that the advocates of circumcision claimed the pro-
cedure made men more physically attractive. Rather, their persuasive tactics
misrepresented circumcision and all it entailed ( 5:3) as a benecial option
for Gentile believers. Pauls deliberative rhetorical object was to insist that
circumcision had no real benet ( 5:2-6). Its advantages were only super-
cialeshly, skin-deep.
Paul claimed that the unnamed, would-be deceivers of the Galatians
were trying to compel them to be circumcised. He used the same verb
in 2:3 to insist that no one had forced Titus to be circumcised during
the Apostolic Conference ( vv 1-10) and
in 2:14 to describe the impact of Peters bad example on Gentile be-
lievers in Antiochimplicitly coercing them to adopt Jewish practices
( vv 11-14).
S
A
M
P
L
E
388
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:12
He accused the Agitators of pressuring his Galatian converts to receive the
distinguishing physical mark of Jewish identity.
This is a striking accusation, since the only other contemporane-
ous examples of compelling circumcision, which use this same terminol-
ogy, involve cases of forced Jewish proselytism (Josephus, A.J. 13.318;
13.257-58; Vita 112-13). That the Agitators were using physical coer-
cion or legal pressure, however, is highly unlikely. Paul must, then, be
describing an intense moral pressure, which, as far as he was concerned,
amounted to a kind of militant proselytism. Whatever the Agitators
were saying and doing, it evidently provided the Galatians with no other
viable options; they were left with a singular choice: circumcision. (Wil-
son 2007, 53)
Paul offered them another alternative. He assigned the Agitators purely
selsh motives (wanting): The only reason they do this is to avoid being per-
secuted for the cross of Christ. The dative for the cross seems to have a causal
forcebecause of the cross (against Rendall 1903, 191). Here, the cross is used
by metonymy for the Christian message of the crucied Jesus as the means of
salvation (Burton 1920, 350; 5:11). Did Paul know that the motives of the
opposition were unworthy ( 1:7; 4:17; 6:13)? Did he know why they urged cir-
cumcision? Or, were his charges merely rhetorical surmises and slurs designed
to undermine their persuasive efforts (Witherington 1998a, 447)?
The Agitators apparently saw no irreconcilable tension between circum-
cision and the crossbetween Law and the death of Christ. Paul did. In Phil
3:17-18, he disparaged anonymous Christians, who were preoccupied with
their own comfort. He claimed that they lived as enemies of the cross of
Christ. Despite their profession, the apostle unmercifully insisted: Their
destiny is destruction, their god is their stomach, and their glory is in their
shame. Their mind is on earthly things (Phil 3:19).
If the Galatian Agitators professed to be Christians, they did not share
Pauls understanding of the gospel (see Gal 1:6-10). He believed that if righ-
teousness could be gained through the law, Christ died for nothing! (2:21).
The Agitators apparently advocated a moderating position. They endorsed
both Christ and the Law. Pauls positionChrist or the Lawmust have
seemed extreme to them.
Paul considered the death of Christ the sufcient means of universal sal-
vation for all who believed (see Rom 3:21-31). But he was also convinced that
Christs death was not only vicariousfor us, but also exemplary. He took for
granted that Christians would share in Christs suffering in this present age
(e.g., Rom 8:17; 2 Cor 4:10; Phil 3:10). Thus, he had serious misgivings about
so-called believers who (in his view) compromised the gospel in the interests
of their own comfortto avoid being persecuted for the cross of Christ.
Uncircumcised Gentile Christians must have perplexed the Roman au-
thorities. They were awkwardly neither fully Jews nor pagans. Daily sacrices
S
A
M
P
L
E
389
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:12-13
offered in the Jerusalem temple in behalf of the emperor exempted Jews from
the expectations of emperor worship. But what were ofcials to make of Gen-
tile Christians who neither followed the Law of Israel and nor participated
in the Imperial cult? The Agitators may have argued that becoming Jewish
would afford such Christians the protection illicit new religions lacked (see
Winter 1994, 125-36; Gal 6:16). This explanation is plausible, whether the
Agitators were Jewish Christians or circumcised Gentile Christians.
L 13 Clearly, law was never far from Pauls mind when he referred to the cross
of Christ (v 12). Although the Agitators promoted circumcision, he charged:
Not even those who are circumcised obey the law. Were they hypocritical
Jewish Christians, like Cephas and the other Jewish Christians at Antioch (
2:11-14)? Or were they pagan Christians, who promoted circumcision out of
purely political motives? Either is possible.
Verse 13 justied Pauls claim in v 12 that the motives of the Agitators
were entirely selsh (Longenecker 1990, 292). They sought the circumcision
of the Galatians to avoid being persecuted themselves. Were the Agitators
Jewish Christians who boasted of their prowess at winning converts (Boice
1976, 506; Bligh 1969, 217)? Or, were they recently circumcised Gentile
Christians (so Munck 1959, 87-90; see Barclay 1988, 42-43) who bragged of
their circumcision, hoping to persuade others to join them? Gentile Godfear-
ers ( Introduction sidebar) avoided circumcision as both painful and socially
abhorrent (Witherington 1998a, 448; Martin 1995 and 1996, 114-15). Why
would these Agitators boast of their circumcision?
Pauls rhetoric was designed to distance him and his audience from the
Agitators. Thus, he referred to his opponents in the third person pluralthose
who are circumcised. And he addressed his Galatian audience in the second
person plural: you vs. they. But his reference to those who are circumcised
does not nally settle the question of their ethnic identity. Paul (and other NT
writers) sometimes used the abstract nouns circumcision vs. uncircumci-
sion as equivalent to Jews vs. Gentiles (Acts 10:45; 11:2; Rom 3:30; 4:9,
12; 15:8; Gal 2:7, 8, 12; Eph 2:11; Phil 3:3; Col 3:11; 4:11; Titus 1:10).
Greek middle and passive present participles are identical in form. Con-
strued as a passive, Paul could have referred to those who are being circum-
cised ( Gal 5:3). This could apply to Gentile converts, identifying them in
terms of the circumcision they experienced, not the circumcision they advo-
cated. A passive reading would ill-suit ethnic Jews circumcised since birth.
But the middle voice could refer to the Jewish habitual practice of circumci-
sion (Cole 1989, 235; 5:1-12 BEHIND THE TEXT).
It is unclear whether 6:13 refers only to Pauls opponents, as in 6:12, or
also to the Galatians considering circumcision at their encouragement. This
may be a distinction without a difference. Recently circumcised Gentiles may
have urged their uncircumcised brothers in the Christian communities of Ga-
latia to follow their lead, if only to share the misery and shame.
S
A
M
P
L
E
390
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:13
Paul called attention to the failure of his opponents to obey the law. In
his letters, only Gal 6:13 and Rom 2:26 use the verb phylasso3 for keeping, ob-
serving, or following the law (BDAG, 868; see Matt 19:20 || Luke 18:21; Luke
11:28; Acts 7:53; 16:4; 21:24). By law, he undoubtedly referred to the Mosaic
legislation, as earlier in Galatians ( 5:2-3).
Were the Galatians aware that the Agitators failed to obey the law, or
was this news to them? Did Pauls accusation merely take for granted universal
human sinfulness? That is, were the opponents merely typical humans, nei-
ther exceptionally sinful nor righteous? Were they unaware of or insensitive
to their own failure to keep the Law? Before we jump to such conclusions, we
should note that Paul never claimed no one could actually obey the law be-
cause its demands were impossible to fulll (see Cranford 1994). In fact, un-
less he was speaking only hypothetically in Rom 2:25-27, he seemed to imply
the oppositethat the Law actually can be kept.
Did Paul have in mind a failure of the Agitators to obey a particular law?
Did he point out an inconsistency between their adherence to one law and
neglect of others (see Jas 2:10; 4:11; Gal 5:3)? Did he imply that, in their
preoccupation with (what Paul considered) trivial matters (such as circumci-
sion), they ignored more urgent matters of the Law (like doing good to all [
6:10] and serving one another [ 5:13-15; compare Matt 23:23])? How were
the Galatians to surmise what the apostle meant, given his lack of specicity?
Should Paul be taken literally or rhetorically? Was this a serious charge
or merely a polemical attack? Were the Agitators actually antinomian (so
Schmithals 1972, 27-28)? Or, was Pauls accusation nothing more than a
pejorative way of maligning them as hypocrites? Did they simply not share
the apostles understanding of the implications of circumcision? Did they not
know or accept his Jewish view that every man who lets himself be circum-
cised . . . is obligated to obey the whole law ( Gal 5:3)? Was their interest
in circumcision purely pragmatic, personal, and political ( 6:12)?
Paul considered the Agitators desire for the Galatians to be circumcised
inconsistent with their failure to obey the law. Whatever their reasons for urg-
ing circumcision, Paul could conceive of only perverse motives (compare v
12). He told the Galatians: they want you to be circumcised that they may
boast about your fesh.
What did Paul mean by this claim? Did he hyperbolically suggest that
the Agitators collected foreskins as David did to win the hand of Sauls daugh-
ter (1 Sam 18:25; 2 Sam 3:14)? Did they treat full converts to Judaism as
if they were prizes in a competition? Did they brag about their evangelistic
conquests in such a way as to dehumanize those they circumcised, treating
them as nothing more than statistics (Bruce 1982, 270)? Did they take per-
verse pleasure in their ability to convince others to do their bidding? Were
they more concerned to aunt their prowess at promoting circumcision than
about those they circumcised? Did the opponents brag about their successes
S
A
M
P
L
E
391
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:13-14
in circumcising Gentile converts to those who threatened them with persecu-
tion if they did not ( Gal 6:12)? Did Paul project on his opponents the same
perverse motives he came to understand had motivated his pre-Christian per-
secution of believers (so Witherington 1998a, 449)? We can only guess.
The Greek verb translated boast appears only in 6:13 and 14 in Gala-
tians. Forms of the verb are found thirty-ve times in Pauls letters (in Rom
2:17, 23; 5:2, 3, 11; 1 Cor 1:29, 31 [twice]; 3:21; 4:7; 13:3; 2 Cor 5:12; 7:14;
9:2; 10:8, 13, 15, 16, 17 [twice]; 11:12, 16, 18 [twice], 30 [twice]; 12:1, 5
[twice], 6, 9; Eph 2:9; and Phil 3:3). It appears only two times elsewhere in
the NT (Jas 1:9; 4:16). The cognate noun boast or pride also appears nine
times in Paul, including Gal 6:4, with similar ambiguity. Boasting may have
negative (as in braggadocio) or positive (as in taking personal satisfaction) con-
notations, depending on the context. Paul obviously considered the boasting
of his opponents inappropriate.
L 14 The sentence begins with Emoi, For me, in the emphatic rst position.
Paul starkly contrasts his practice with that of his opponents in vv 12-13.
These opening words are followed by an idiom that expresses a strong negative
wish. Its literal translation is unintelligible: But for me may it never happen to
boast. But what he meant is clear enough.
Elsewhere, Paul used me3 genoito independently, vigorously denying rhe-
torical questions (see Gal 2:17; 3:21; Rom 3:4, 6, 31; 6:2, 15; 7:7, 13; 9:14;
11:1, 11; outside Paul only in Luke 20:16). In this unique NT usage, Paul em-
ployed it within an innitive sentence as a strong negative adverb: But may I
never boast . . . The Agitators wanted to boast in the circumcised esh of the
Galatians (Gal 6:13). But, he wished to boast in nothing except the cross of
our Lord Jesus Christ.
Paul paradoxically boasted in the cross, which unbelievers considered a
scandalous source of shame ( 6:12; see Rom 5:11; 15:27; 1 Cor 1:31; 15:31;
Phil 2:16; 3:3). Such boasting was culturally inoffensive. He took pride not
in his own achievements, but in his salvation received as a gift by means of
Christs death and resurrection. Christian boasting glories Christ alone
(see 1 Cor 1:31; 2 Cor 10:17). It is not self-praise, but doxology or hymn
(Betz 1979, 318).
It was through the cross of Christ that the world had been crucied to
Paul, and that he had been crucied to the world. Obviously, such language is
metaphorical. Neither the world nor he had been literally strung up to die on
a wooden instrument of torture. Dead men do not write letters.
Crucixion here, as in Gal 2:20 (), refers to a denitive end of any
meaningful relationship. Paul no longer cared about the opinion of the world.
For all practical purposes, he and the world were dead to one another. Al-
though Paul remained alive, he owed nothing to the anti-God world order,
but solely to Gods grace (2 Cor 1:12). His end-times convictions persuaded
him that the time was short. He used the things of the world, but refused to
S
A
M
P
L
E
392
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:14-15
be engrossed in them. For this world in its present form is passing away (1
Cor 7:31).
Paul had metaphorically died with Christ to the basic principles of this
world. He no longer belonged to it or submitted to its rules (Col 2:20; Gal
2:19-21; 4:3-10; see Balz 1990a, 312). By world he referred to all that was hos-
tile to God in the present evil age (1:4; 4:3; see Rom 3:6, 19; 5:12-13; 1 Cor
1:20-21; 2:12; 6:2; 7:31-34; 2 Cor 5:19; 7:10). He did not devalue the created
order, but the people, opinions, and systems separated from God, lost in sin,
wholly at odds w[ith] anything divine, ruined and depraved (BDAG, 446).
Pauls conversion-call by the crucied and risen Christ totally altered his
worldview ( Gal 1:13, 23). He was changed from a persecutor to a preacher
of the Christian faith. He came to see the cross as the supreme revelation of
Gods love for sinful humanity (see Rom 5:6-11)that the Son of God . . .
loved me and gave himself for me (Gal 2:20). He was no longer a slave to the
elements of the world, but a free child of God ( 4:1-14).
Paul referred not simply to what had happened to him personally. The
death of Christ had cosmic effects, changing the world itself. Christians were
already being rescued from the present evil age (1:4). The old order contin-
ued to exist, but was passing away (1 Cor 7:31), along with all that belonged
to it, including the Law (2 Cor 3:7-11). All of creation would be renewed when
God brought to completion what he had begun in Christ (Rom 8:18-25). The
old age was as good as dead to Paul. All that mattered were the new eschato-
logical realities brought about because of the death of Christ (Witherington
1998a, 450). Christians were privileged to live already as citizens of the dawn-
ing new age (Rom 13:11-14).
L 15 Paul repeated the point he made earlier in Gal 5:6 () in slightly dif-
ferent words. There he minimized the importance of both circumcision and
uncircumcision (lit., foreskin; 2:7; 5:6) by comparison to faith expressing
itself through love. Here, he did the same, but by comparison to a new cre-
ation. Throughout the letter he had vigorously explained why uncircumcised
Gentile believers should not be circumcised. Now, remarkably, at its end he
argued that neither circumcision nor uncircumcision really mattered. His es-
sential point was that the difference between Jews and pagans was inconse-
quential ( 3:28).
In 5:6, Paul denied both circumcision and uncircumcision any value.
Here, he denied that either was anything. The Greek of 6:15 is terse (lit.): For
neither circumcision is anything nor uncircumcision but a new creation.
Supplying the ellipsed words, Pauls point was that a new creation was truly
something.
Because the old world order was as good as dead (v 14), all that mat-
tered was the new order God had begun in Christ. This Paul called the new
creation. In 2 Cor 5:17 he used the same Greek words to describe a Christian
as a new creature (BDAG, 573, s.v. 2.a).
S
A
M
P
L
E
393
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:15-16
The terminology of new creation metaphorically describes the entire
scope of the divine work of salvation. It certainly comprehends the personal
human experiences of conversion, regeneration, adoption, justication, and
sanctication. The Holy Spirit unfailingly leads sinners to faith and onward to
glory by way of continual growth in holiness and conformity to the image of
Christ. The new creation implies a new nature with a new system of desires,
affections, and habits in the lives of believers (George 1994, 438).
But Paul understood salvation to comprehend cosmic as well as anthro-
pological dimensions. The language of new creation had a long history in the
apocalyptic tradition of Israel (Isa 65:17; 66:22; 4 Ezra 7:75; Jub. 1:29; 4:24-
26; Qumran [11QT 29.7-10; 1QH 11.13; 1QS 4.25]; 1 En. 72:1; 91:15-16; 2
Bar. 32:6; 44:5-15; Pseudo-Philo, L.A.B. 3:10; 16:3; 32:17). Pauls appropria-
tion of this apocalyptic tradition makes it clear that he expected more than
merely personal moral renewal or a renovated cosmos.
As a Christian, Paul believed that before the End, a new creation had al-
ready dawned in the renewed and transformed lives of believing communities
(Rom 13:11-14). Christians become a part of the new creation by participat-
ing in Christ. For them, the old [creation] has gone, the new has come (2
Cor 5:17). The church Christ brought into existence by his death and resur-
rection embodies the new creation (Eph 2:10, 15). The church is Gods cre-
ation of a new people of God, the vanguard of the kingdom of God.
But Paul expected more than a renewed people. He expected the entire
natural order to participate in the comprehensive redemption God had set in
motion in Christ (Rom 8:18-25). Far from repairing the old cosmos, God is
in the process of replacing it (Martyn 1997, 565). As the old world lingers,
Christ is bringing all persons and powers resistant to God under his dominion
(1 Cor 15:20-28). Between the present and the Parousia, the church is called
and empowered to join Christ in the task of bringing unredeemed creation
under Gods rule (1 Cor 15:12-28, 57-58).
Baptism marks the transition from old to new creation (Petzke 1990,
326). But it is Christ, not the water or the sacrament, who inaugurates the
new creation in justication and sanctication. Spirit-renewed persons are cre-
ated in Christ to be Gods people in the worldtruly righteous and holy (Eph
4:24). As they are being renewed in the image of their Creator (Col 3:10),
they participate with Christ in the painful process of world renewal (2 Cor
5:116:2; Rom 8:18-25).
L 16 Paul moved the letter toward its conclusion by pronouncing a condi-
tional blessing to match the conditional curse with which he began in 1:6-10:
Peace and mercy to all who follow this rule, even to the Israel of God.
Paul opened his Greek sentence characterizing those for whom he prayed
Gods blessing: To as many as will fall in step with this standard (emphasis
added). The same word began v 12. There he described the Agitators as All
who want to make a good showing in the esh (emphasis added). Here, in
S
A
M
P
L
E
394
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:16
stark contrast, he referred to all who shared his vision of the Christian life. As
Paul perceived it, the Galatians faced a choice: to accept circumcision or the
cross, the esh or the Spirit.
Stoiche3sousin, follow, in the expression all who follow this rule, is from
the same root rendered keep in step in 5:25. There Paul insisted that keeping
in step with the Spirit was crucial to Christian living ( 5:16-25). Here, the
future tense of the verb is noteworthy. What the Galatians had done in the
past was not Pauls focus. Consistent with his deliberative rhetoric, the ques-
tion was: What would they do in the future?
It is unclear precisely what Paul meant by this rule. What rule? The
word kano3n would later become prominent in developing Christianity, refer-
ring to the generally accepted books of Christian Scripturethe canon. But
it appears only four (or ve) times in the entire NT, all within Pauls letters
(2 Cor 10:13, 15, 16; Gal 6:16 [and in some late mss. of Phil 3:16]). In 2
Corinthians kano3n refers to geographical boundaries. It dened the audience
of Pauls apostolic ministry as new churches planted among those to whom
Christ had not previously been preached (see Rom 15:20). Here, however,
Paul seems to have followed the LXX practice, using kano3n to refer to a rule
of conduct, a standard for making judgments (Sand 1990a, 249).
The demonstrative adjective this suggests that rule characterizes some-
thing mentioned in the immediate context. If Paul referred back to v 14, he
identied the standard in terms of ones source of pridethe cross of Christ
vs. circumcision. If he referred back to v 15, he applied the standard to all
who were part of the new creation community. If he referred ahead to v 17,
he applied the standard to all who no longer troubled him. Regardless, he re-
ferred to Christians who understood the gospel as he did.
The nal clause in the sentenceand to the Israel of Godcould be
taken in either of two senses. First, it could identify two groupsthose who
followed this rule as distinct from the Israel of God. This reads kai as a coordi-
nating conjunction, andits most common function. Second, kai may have an
explicative function, roughly equivalent to that is (BDAG, 393, s.v. kai I.3).
Or, it may serve as an ascensive adverb, even (BDAG, 393, s.v. kai II.2). Both
of these uses identify one group with a twofold designation.
Virtually all interpreters of Galatians through the nineteenth century
concluded that the Israel of God referred to the church consisting of believing
Jews and Gentiles (see Meyer 1873, 349-54). Those who reject the traditional
reading do so on theological grounds, not exegetical (see Robertson 2000).
The phrase became controversial rst among dispensational interpreters and
later among post-holocaust interpreters.
Dispensationalists are interested in maintaining a sharp distinction be-
tween Israel and the Church across a whole range of theological mat-
ters pertaining to prophecy, ecclesiology, and soteriology. They are not
comfortable with the idea that here Paul is using the phrase Israel of
S
A
M
P
L
E
395
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:16
God in a sense that includes Gentiles, because this undermines their
contention that the Church is always carefully distinguished from Is-
rael in Scripture. (Marlowe 2004)
Some recent interpreters have rejected the traditional reading to avoid
the alleged anti-Semitism or anti-Judaism of so-called Christian superces-
sionism (see, e.g., Dunn 1993, 346-48). They correctly reject the belief that
Paul thought the church had simply replaced Israel in Gods saving purposes.
Romans 911 would make it clear that the views of the apostle to the Gen-
tiles on the fate of non-Christian Jews were complicated (see Greathouse and
Lyons 2008b, 45-124). But to take Pauls blessing in Gal 6:16 as evidence that
he expected Jews to be saved, despite their unbelief in Christ, reads far too
much into his words.
If Paul meant to refer . . . to the ultimate salvation of the Jewish
people, including those who in the present time reject the preaching of
the gospel, he has provided no clues of this sort for his readers in Galatia.
He had not yet written the Letter to the Romans, and Galatians nowhere
touches upon the problem of Gods faithfulness to Israel or the ultimate
salvation of the Jewish people. The apostle is concerned with an entirely
different set of problems posed by the demand that his Gentile congre-
gations become Law observant. In the course of his argument he has
asserted in the strongest possible terms that the Gentile members of his
churches in Galatia are children of Abraham, heirs of Gods promised
blessing (3:6-9, 29), rightful heirs of the promise through Isaac (4:28,
31), Sarahs children. It is they who fulll the Law (5:14; 6:2). In light
of these claims there is only one possible way that the original readers
could have understood the blessing of Gal 6:16: The Israel of God refers
to all who are in Christ. . . . It is a description of the elect eschatological
community of faith composed of Jews and Gentiles alike. It is equivalent
in meaning to the household of faith (6:10). (Hays 2000, 300-301)
Contrary to the claims of Christian supercessionism (already in the sec-
ond century, see Justin, Dial. 11:15), Paul did not claim that Gentile Chris-
tians had replaced the Jews in the divine economy. He assumed that the Chris-
tian church was both more and less inclusive than Israel according to the esh
(1 Cor 10:18; see Rom 9:3-5). It included pagans who had faith in Christ and
excluded Jews who did not. Paul is not the only NT author to apply OT lan-
guage referring to Israel to the church, including Gentile believers (see, e.g.,
1 Pet 2:9-10).
Burton (1920, 358) and Longenecker (1990, 297) correctly note that
elsewhere in the NT the term Israel never refers to Gentile Christians, only
to Jews. But this is the only NT instance of the expression the Israel of God.
And it never appears in Judaism (Betz 1979, 322). In light of the rest of Gala-
tians, which 6:11-16 summarizes, it seems implausible that Paul used it to re-
S
A
M
P
L
E
396
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:16
fer merely to Jewish Christians (Weima 1993, 105), much less non-Christian
Jews (see Richardson 1969, 74-84; Dunn 1993, 346-48).
All of the views that take the Israel of God to refer to Jews and not
Gentiles . . . fail to take seriously enough the context of the Galatian letter
(Longenecker 1990, 298). Thus, the traditional interpretationthat Paul re-
ferred to both believing Jews and Gentilesseems most plausible. The people
of God comprise all the children of Abraham.
In Gal 3 ( 3:6-9, 14, 16-18, 29) Paul identied Abrahams children as
all believers in Christ, regardless of their ethnicity. Thus, there seems to be
no reason not to take the Christian church as the Israel of God, the legitimate
contemporary expression of the ancient faith of Israel (see Dunn 1993, 345).
Paul did not consider the Christian church an upstart, unsanctioned supersti-
tion ( 6:12). It was in some sense an expression of the ancient faith of Israel.
However much many educated Greeks and Romans may have despised Juda-
ism, there was even greater opprobrium associated with being part of a new
and unrecognized religion (Witherington 1998a, 457).
Pauls autographical epilogue recapitulates his message throughout Ga-
latians: the blessing in Gal 6:16 . . . summarizes what he has said concern-
ing the opponents and their false teachings. Peace and mercy are wished for
all who agree with this canon (i.e., that of Paul); for through the Spirit the
Christian is a new creation (6:15). Kano3n is thus the new standard for the be-
liever (Sand 1990a, 249).
If the traditional interpretation of the Israel of God is correct, Pauls
benediction of Peace and mercy applied to a single groupall who accepted
the gospel as he preached it. There is no reason to assume he thought of two
distinct groupsthat he offered the blessing of Peace to Pauline Christians,
while praying for divine mercy for non-Christian Jews.
The combination of mercy and peace appears in the Babylonian recen-
sion of the Shemoneh Esreh, the traditional Eighteen Benedictions of later Ju-
daism. Scholars debate whether this was already in use in Pauls day. If so,
pronouncing a Jewish blessing on the church of believing Jews and Gentiles
gives it a curiously ironic twist (Richardson 1969, 84).
Used only here in Pauls letters, the Israel of God in its Galatian con-
text refers to all who took Pauls side in the dispute that divided the Galatian
Christian communities. He turned the tables on his opponents, claiming for
the mixed church a title the Agitators may have reserved for themselves. In
his allegory of Abrahams wives and sons in 4:21-31, he similarly identied
Christians as children of the free woman (Sarah) and maligned his opponents
as children of the slave woman (Hagar).
Such role reversals are not uncommon in Paul. In Phil 3, he inverted
expected labels, designating his Jewish opponents those dogs, those men who
do evil, those mutilators of the esh (v 2). Christians, by contrast, were the
S
A
M
P
L
E
397
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:16-17
circumcision, we who worship by the Spirit of God, who glory in Christ Jesus,
and who put no condence in the esh (v 3).
Redeemed Gentiles now form true Israel, Abrahams seed (Gal 3,29)
together with Jewish Christians because they are identied with and
represented by the individual seed of Abraham, Christ, who sums
up Israel in himself (Gal 3,16). Consequently, Paul did not consider it
twisting the prophetic meaning of Isaiah 54 to apply it to Gentile be-
lievers, since they are now viewed as true Israelites and their return to
God is part of the fulllment of the restoration and new creation prom-
ise made to Israel. (Beale 1999, 217)
To claim for the church the designation the Israel of God was not to
deny it to Jews. Romans 911 clearly demonstrates that the apostle to the
Gentiles was no supersessionist. He insisted upon dening the true children
of Abraham as the children of God. Inclusion in the newly constituted Israel
was not determined by ethnic descent or by the mark of circumcision. It was
not limited to Jews alone. In fact, it included only believing Jews, those who
had accepted Jesus as Israels Messiah. Furthermore, believing Gentiles, who
shared the faith of Abraham, were as truly members of the Israel of God as
those Jews who were his natural descendants.
Peace repeats the rst word in the letters opening salutation ( 1:3).
This implicit prayer for the Galatians requests that God grant them the gift
of comprehensive well-being. Similar concluding peace benedictions appear
in Rom 15:33; 16:20; 2 Cor 13:11; Phil 4:9; 1 Thess 5:23; and 2 Thess 3:16
(compared and contrasted in Beale 1999, 219-21).
The word mercy reminded the Galatians that no one deserved Gods
gifts. In Gal 3:22-23 and Rom 11:32 Paul insisted that God has determined
that humans will relate to him in terms of his grace, not their achievements.
He recognized the comprehensive scope of Gods mercy, not as a guarantee of
universal salvation, but of universal opportunity (see Wis 11:23).
L 17 Paul announced the conclusion of the letter with a Greek idiom mean-
ing Finally. He followed this with a third person imperative: let no one cause
me trouble [kopos]. An entirely different Greek root (tarasso3) refers to Pauls
Galatian opponents as troublemakers in some English versions in Gal 1:7;
5:10, 12 (anastatasoo3). Did Paul choose kopos because of its similarity to kope3,
cutting? This root appears with prepositional prexes in 5:7 (enekopsen: cut
in) and 12 (apokopsontai: cut off ).
Paul justied his request with that claim that he had experienced trou-
ble enough. The evidence was his physical scars: I bear on my body the marks
of Jesus. He had suffered these from his repeated experience of persecution
for preaching the gospel of the crucied Christ (see 1 Cor 15:32; 2 Cor 1:8-9;
11:2327). Paul did not want to be identied by the badge of the old creation
(circumcision) but . . . with the only sign of the new creation: with Jesus, and
his suffering at the cross (Beale 1999, 222).
S
A
M
P
L
E
398
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:17
Paul had mentioned his persecutions in vv 12-17 as part of the explicit
contrast of his boast and that of the Agitators:
They sought the circum-
cision of the Galatians as
a way to avoid persecution
(6:12).
Paul suffered persecution for
refusing to require circumcision
(5:11).
They boasted of the cir-
cumcised esh of the Ga-
latians (6:12-13).
Paul boasted only of the cross
that ended the old creation and
its divisions (6:14).
In the new order, the mark
of circumcision meant
nothing (v 15).
Pauls scars were signs of the
dawning of the new creation
(6:17).
Pauls identication with the cross (2:19-20) was so complete that he
considered his scars from persecution as a Christian the marks of Jesus (6:17).
Paul understands these scars as enduring signs that he belongs to Jesus, signs
making him independent of other people and unassailable. In the postscript
written in his own hand Paul thus asserts that these marks of his relationship
to his Lords suffering really ought to spare him any further troubles from the
Galatians (Walter 1990b, 277).
The term stigmata later referred to brands slaves received identifying
their masters (see Exod 21:5-6; Deut 15:16-17). Perhaps, Pauls scars remind-
ed him that he was a slave of Christ (Rom 1:1; Gal 1:10). In the Greco-
Roman world such identication was used only on slaves who had committed
a particularly serious crime or had tried to escape and on military deserters
or forced laborers. In these instances, then, such marks did not designate any
sort of social standing, but rather were signs of particular dishonor (Walter
1990b, 276). The tattoos of religious devotees honoring their patron deities
(see Isa 44:5; 49:16) were also called stigmata (BDAG, 768).
The comparatively modern religious-psychopathic phenomenon some-
times called stigmata in some Christian circles would not have been a pos-
sible meaning in Pauls vocabulary. There is no reason to imagine that he bore
ve scars, that they were cruciform, or that they resembled the letters of
Christs name (Walter 1990b, 277).
Some Hellenistic Jews considered circumcision a stigma, that is, a
confessional sign that served as a counterpart to religious tattooing (see 3
Macc 2:29-30; Lev 19:28; Rev 7:2-3; 14:9-11; Walter 1990a, 276). As an
ethnic Jew born to observant Jewish parents, Paul could have called attention
to this stigma borne on his body: He was circumcised (see Phil 3:4-5). Cir-
cumcision marked his opponents as slaves of the Law. He emphasized instead
his more obvious and shameful scars, which marked him as at once a voluntary
slave of Christ and yet free in Christ (see Betz 1979, 663-64).
S
A
M
P
L
E
399
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11-18
L 18 The concluding blessing of 2 Tim 4:22 and Phlm 25 are identical to that
here in Galatians. As in Gal 1:3 (), Paul implicitly prayed that God might
freely grant his audiencebrothers and sisters (NIV 2011)all the blessings
of salvation.
Here, your spirit (as in Phil 4:23; Phlm 25), refers simply to you (CEV,
GNT, REB). This emphasizes the inward, spiritual dimension of their lives as
fellow believers. By addressing them again as his spiritual siblings (see 1:11;
3:15; 4:12, 28, 31; 5:11, 13; 6:1), Paul expressed unwavering condence that
the Galatians would be persuaded by his letter to remain aligned with his
circumcision-free gospel.
Amen ( 1:5) gave Pauls parting benediction the force of a prayer-
wish: Indeed, let it be so (Arichea and Nida 1976, 160). He anticipated that
the letter would be read aloud in the various community gatherings of the Ga-
latians. There, he expected them to echo his Amen, conrming their loyalty to
the God who had called them by The grace of our Lord Jesus Christ through
his gospel ( 1:2).
v
FROM THE TEXT
Summary. Pauls autographic conclusion to his impassioned letter gave it
his personal stamp of approval. Reiterating his major concerns, he contrasted
himself and his message with the Agitators. They were preoccupied with mat-
ters of the esh (vv 12-13); he, with matters of the spirit (v 18). They avoided
persecution for the cross of Christ (v 12); he embraced it (vv 14, 17). They
clung to the old order, while he reached out to the new creation (vv 14-15).
Paul was condent that the Galatians would not only keep in step with the
Spirit (5:25), but keep in step with his circumcision-free gospel (6:16). Only
as they did so would they share in the blessings of the Israel of God (v 16).
Crucixion vs. Circumcision. Paul would have had no use for the modern
adherents of the so-called prosperity gospel, who think of Christianity as the
path to worldly success. His ministry was devoted to creating cruciform com-
munities (see Gorman 2001) for whom making a good impression outwardly
and avoiding persecution (v 12) did not matter. He embodied this disdain for
the esh (v 13) and the pursuit of worldly recognition: the world has been
crucifed to me, and I to the world (v 14).
In the dawning light of a new creation neither circumcision nor uncir-
cumcision mattered (v 15). The eshly boundaries dened by the surgical
removal of the foreskin counted for nothing in the new creation (v 15). Stand-
ing within the Israel of God was not a matter of race or ritual. The blessing of
salvation as the people of God belonged to those who would actually live by
the standard of the new creation (v 16).
Circumcision in Galatians is not simply about an outdated surgical pro-
cedure. It is about assigning inordinate importance to supercial matters of
S
A
M
P
L
E
400
G
A
L
A
T
I
A
N
S
6:11-18
the esh. Humans tend to be overly impressed by human recognition, creature
comfort, and the differences that divide us. God is not (2:6).
From the beginning of the letter Paul had cautioned that pleasing God
could entail not pleasing people. What God accomplished through the cross
of Christ can never be replaced by what humans can do, whether through
circumcision or anything else that is only skin-deep. Present salvation is not a
matter of making a good impression outwardlybeing spared from suffering
or receiving temporary honor. The gracious privilege of participating in the
people of God in the new order has invaded the world in the cross of Christ.
Reception History. Interpreters have taken Pauls claims in vv 14 and
15about the crucixion of the world and the new creationin ways that
tell more about their theology than about Pauls. Marcion and later Gnosti-
cism justied their message of a new Creator by appeal to the apostles hope
for a new creation. Tertullian and Chrysostom read his claims as support
for the world-denying logic of asceticism. Augustine and Aquinas identied
the world as the search for worldly status. Augustine expected new-creation
transformation only in the future. Aquinas limited it to individual transfor-
mationfaith working through love (5:6 NRSV). Luther redened world
to include the papacy, traditional church, celibacy, and ascetic tradition. Both
he and Calvin took new creation to refer to justied and transformed believ-
ers. Bultmann took Pauls language to have only the anthropological force of
a new existential self-understanding. Ksemann and Martyn embraced Pauls
cosmological language in a realistic sense (Riches 2008, 289-301).
With the coming of Christ, God has invaded this world and is funda-
mentally changing everything. Only those who align themselves with what
God is up to in this world may experience new creationnow and in the
future. Through the church, Christ is bringing into existence a radical change
in the world order. For the present, the evidence is more sociological than
cosmological.
Within the church, the cross means that all that divides us no longer
matters (Gal 3:28; 5:6; 6:15). In the present evil age (1:4) cruciformity
paradoxically involves both pain and hope. We bear one anothers burdens (
6:2), because we know that in Christ . . . the only thing that counts is faith
expressing itself through love (5:6). As we cooperate in Gods design for
the church, that Christ may be formed within us, we groan as in the pains
of childbirth (Rom 8:22; Gal 4:19). But the eager expectation of cosmic
redemption sustains us (Rom 8:18-25). What counts is the new creation
(Gal 6:15b NIV 2011).
S
A
M
P
L
E